Gnus: Add option to sort threads non-recursively
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
CommitLineData
4009494e
GM
1\input texinfo
2
7fbf7cae
TZ
3@include gnus-overrides.texi
4
db78a8cb 5@setfilename ../../info/gnus
4009494e
GM
6@settitle Gnus Manual
7@syncodeindex fn cp
8@syncodeindex vr cp
9@syncodeindex pg cp
10
89b163db 11@documentencoding UTF-8
01c52d31 12
4009494e 13@copying
ab422c4d 14Copyright @copyright{} 1995--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4009494e
GM
15
16@quotation
17Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
6a2c4aec 18under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
4009494e 19any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
debf4439
GM
20Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
21and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
22is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
4009494e 23
6f093307 24(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
6bf430d1 25modify this GNU manual.''
4009494e
GM
26@end quotation
27@end copying
28
29@iftex
30@iflatex
31\documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
32\usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
33\usepackage{pagestyle}
34\usepackage{epsfig}
35\usepackage{pixidx}
36\input{gnusconfig.tex}
37
38\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
39\else
40\usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
41\usepackage{thumbpdf}
42\pdfcompresslevel=9
43\fi
44
45\makeindex
46\begin{document}
47
48% Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
c7ff939a 49\newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
4009494e
GM
50\newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
51\newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
52
53\newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
54
55\newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
56\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
57\newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
58\else
59\newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
60\fi
61\newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62\newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63
64\newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
65\newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66
67\newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
68\newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
69\newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70\newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71\newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72\newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73\newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
74\newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75\newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
76\newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77\newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78\newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
79\newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80\newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
81\newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
82\newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83\newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
84\newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
85\newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
86\newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
87\newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
88\newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
89\newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
90\newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
91
92\newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
93\newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
94\newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
95\newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
96\newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
97\newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
98\newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
99\newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
100\newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
101\newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
102\newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
103\newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
104\newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
105
106\newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
107\newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
108\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
109}
110
111\newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
112
113\newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
114{\mbox{}}
115}
116
117\newdimen{\gnusdimen}
118\gnusdimen 0pt
119
120\newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
121\gnuscleardoublepage
122\ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
123\chapter{#2}
124\renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
125\renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
126\thispagestyle{empty}
127\hspace*{-2cm}
128\begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
129\put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
130\put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
131\end{picture}
132\clearpage
133}
134
135\newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
136\begin{figure}
137\mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
138#3
139\end{picture}
140\caption{#1}
141\end{figure}
142}
143
144\newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
145\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
146}
147
148\newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
149\margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
150}
151
152\newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
153\margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
154}
155
156\newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
157\margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
158}
159
160\newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
161
162\newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
163\renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
164\section{#1}
165}
166
167\newenvironment{codelist}%
168{\begin{list}{}{
169}
170}{\end{list}}
171
172\newenvironment{asislist}%
173{\begin{list}{}{
174}
175}{\end{list}}
176
177\newenvironment{kbdlist}%
178{\begin{list}{}{
179\labelwidth=0cm
180}
181}{\end{list}}
182
183\newenvironment{dfnlist}%
184{\begin{list}{}{
185}
186}{\end{list}}
187
188\newenvironment{stronglist}%
189{\begin{list}{}{
190}
191}{\end{list}}
192
193\newenvironment{samplist}%
194{\begin{list}{}{
195}
196}{\end{list}}
197
198\newenvironment{varlist}%
199{\begin{list}{}{
200}
201}{\end{list}}
202
203\newenvironment{emphlist}%
204{\begin{list}{}{
205}
206}{\end{list}}
207
208\newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
209\setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
210\addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
211
212\newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
213{
214{
215\ifodd\count0
216{
217\hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
218}
219\else
220{
221\hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
222}
223}
224\fi
225}
226}
227{
228\ifodd\count0
229\mbox{} \hfill
230\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
231\else
232\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
233\hfill \mbox{}
234\fi
235}
236
237\newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
238{
239{
240\ifodd\count0
241{
242\hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
243}
244\else
245{
246\hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
247}
248\fi
249}
250}
251{
252\ifodd\count0
253\mbox{} \hfill
254\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
255\else
256\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
257\hfill \mbox{}
258\fi
259}
260
261\newpagestyle{gnus}%
262{
263{
264\ifodd\count0
265{
266\makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
267}
268\else
269{
270\makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
271}
272\fi
273}
274}
275{
276\ifodd\count0
277\mbox{} \hfill
278\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
279\else
280\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
281\hfill \mbox{}
282\fi
283}
284
285\pagenumbering{roman}
286\pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
287
288@end iflatex
289@end iftex
290
291@iftex
292@iflatex
293
294\begin{titlepage}
295{
296
297%\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
298%\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
299\parindent=0cm
300\addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
301
302\gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
303\rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
304\vfill
305\hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
306\vfill
307\rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308\gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
309\newpage
310}
311
312\mbox{}
313\vfill
314
315\thispagestyle{empty}
316
317@c @insertcopying
318\newpage
319\end{titlepage}
320@end iflatex
321@end iftex
322
0c973505 323@dircategory Emacs network features
4009494e 324@direntry
62e034c2 325* Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
4009494e
GM
326@end direntry
327@iftex
328@finalout
329@end iftex
4009494e
GM
330
331
332@titlepage
7fbf7cae
TZ
333@ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
334@title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
335@end ifset
336@ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
4009494e 337@title Gnus Manual
7fbf7cae 338@end ifclear
4009494e
GM
339
340@author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
341@page
342@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
343@insertcopying
344@end titlepage
345
5dc584b5
KB
346@summarycontents
347@contents
4009494e
GM
348
349@node Top
350@top The Gnus Newsreader
351
352@ifinfo
353
354You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
355can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
356spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
357luck.
358
359@c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
c7ff939a 360This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
4009494e 361
5dc584b5
KB
362@ifnottex
363@insertcopying
364@end ifnottex
365
4009494e
GM
366@end ifinfo
367
368@iftex
369
370@iflatex
371\tableofcontents
372\gnuscleardoublepage
373@end iflatex
374
375Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
376unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
377
378Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
379being accused of plagiarism:
380
381Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
382about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
383you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
384can even read news with it!
385
386Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
387people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
388allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
389like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
390people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
391the program.
392
9b3ebcb6 393@c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
2e4089ab 394This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
9b3ebcb6
MB
395
396@heading Other related manuals
397@itemize
398@item Message manual: Composing messages
399@item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
400@item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
3d439cd1 401@item EasyPG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
2e4089ab 402@item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
9b3ebcb6
MB
403@end itemize
404
4009494e
GM
405@end iftex
406
407@menu
408* Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
409* Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
410* Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
411* Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
412* Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
413* Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
414* Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
8a1cdce5 415* Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
4009494e
GM
416* Various:: General purpose settings.
417* The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
418* Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
419* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
420* Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
421* Key Index:: Key Index.
422
f2a538a2
GM
423@c Doesn't work right in html.
424@c FIXME Do this in a more standard way.
425@ifinfo
4009494e
GM
426Other related manuals
427
428* Message:(message). Composing messages.
429* Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
430* Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
3d439cd1 431* EasyPG:(epa). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
01c52d31 432* SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
f2a538a2 433@end ifinfo
4009494e
GM
434
435@detailmenu
436 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
437
438Starting Gnus
439
440* Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
4009494e
GM
441* The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
442* Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
443* Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
444* New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
445* Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
446* Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
447* Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
448* The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
449* Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
450
451New Groups
452
453* Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
454* Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
455* Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
456
457Group Buffer
458
459* Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
460* Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
461* Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
462* Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
463* Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
464* Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
465* Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
466* Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
467* Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
468* Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
469* Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
470* Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
471* Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
472* Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
473* Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
474* Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
01c52d31 475* Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
4009494e
GM
476* Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
477
478Group Buffer Format
479
480* Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
481* Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
482* Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
483
484Group Topics
485
486* Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
487* Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
488* Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
489* Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
490* Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
491
492Misc Group Stuff
493
494* Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
495* Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
496* Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
497* File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
498* Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
499
500Summary Buffer
501
502* Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
503* Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
504* Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
505* Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
506* Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
507* Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
508* Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
509* Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
510* Threading:: How threads are made.
511* Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
512* Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
513* Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
514* Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
01c52d31 515* Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4009494e
GM
516* Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
517* Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
518* Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
519* Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
520* MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
521* Charsets:: Character set issues.
522* Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
523* Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
524* Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
525* Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
526* Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
527* Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
528* Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
529* Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
530 or reselecting the current group.
531* Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
532* Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
533* Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
534* Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
535
536Summary Buffer Format
537
538* Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
539* To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
540* Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
541* Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
542
543Choosing Articles
544
545* Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
546* Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
547
548Reply, Followup and Post
549
550* Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
551* Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
552* Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
553* Canceling and Superseding::
554
555Marking Articles
556
557* Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
558* Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
559* Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
560* Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
561* Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
562* Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
563
564Threading
565
566* Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
567* Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
568
569Customizing Threading
570
571* Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
572* Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
573* More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
574* Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
575
576Decoding Articles
577
578* Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
579* Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
580* PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
581* Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
582* Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
583* Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
584
585Decoding Variables
586
587* Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
588* Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
589* Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
590
591Article Treatment
592
593* Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
594* Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
595* Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
596* Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
597* Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
598* Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
599* Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
600* Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
61b1af82 601* Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
4009494e
GM
602* Article Signature:: What is a signature?
603* Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
604
605Alternative Approaches
606
607* Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
608* Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
609
610Various Summary Stuff
611
612* Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
613* Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
614* Summary Generation Commands::
615* Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
616
617Article Buffer
618
619* Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
620* Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
621* Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
622* Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
623* Misc Article:: Other stuff.
624
625Composing Messages
626
627* Mail:: Mailing and replying.
628* Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
629* POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
630* Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
631* Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
632* Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
633* Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
634* Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
635* Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
636
637Select Methods
638
639* Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
640* Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
229b59da 641* Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
4009494e
GM
642* Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
643* Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
c4d82de8 644* Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
4009494e
GM
645* Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
646* Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
647* Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
648
649Server Buffer
650
651* Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
652* Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
653* Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
654* Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
655* Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
656* Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
657* Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
658
659Getting News
660
661* NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
662* News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
663
664@acronym{NNTP}
665
666* Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
667* Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
668* Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
669
670Getting Mail
671
672* Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
673* Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
674* Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
675* Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
676* Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
677* Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
678* Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
679* Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
680* Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
681* Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
682* Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
683* Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
684* Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
685
686Mail Sources
687
688* Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
689* Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
690* Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
691
692Choosing a Mail Back End
693
694* Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
bc79f9ab 695* Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
4009494e
GM
696* Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
697* MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
698* Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
699* Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
700* Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
701
702Browsing the Web
703
704* Archiving Mail::
705* Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
4009494e
GM
706* RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
707* Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
708
4009494e
GM
709Other Sources
710
711* Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
712* Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
713* Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
4009494e 714* Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
c5ecc769 715* The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
4009494e
GM
716
717Document Groups
718
719* Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
720
4009494e
GM
721Combined Groups
722
723* Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
4009494e
GM
724
725Email Based Diary
726
727* The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
728* The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
729* Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
730
731The NNDiary Back End
732
733* Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
734* Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
735* Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
736
737The Gnus Diary Library
738
739* Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
740* Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
741* Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
742* Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
743
744Gnus Unplugged
745
746* Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
747* Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
748* Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
749* Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
750* Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
751* Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
752* Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
01c52d31 753* Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
4009494e
GM
754* Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
755* Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
756* Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
757* Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
758* Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
759* Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
760
761Agent Categories
762
763* Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
764* Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
765* Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
766
767Agent Commands
768
769* Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
770* Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
771* Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
772
773Scoring
774
775* Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
776* Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
777* Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
778* Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
779* Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
780* Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
781* Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
782* Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
783* Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
784* Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
785* Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
786* Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
787* Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
788* Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
4009494e
GM
789* Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
790* Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
791
4009494e
GM
792Advanced Scoring
793
794* Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
795* Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
796* Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
797
8a1cdce5
AC
798Searching
799
800* nnir:: Searching with various engines.
801* nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
802
803nnir
804
156e3f9c 805* What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
8a1cdce5
AC
806* Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
807* Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
808
809Setting up nnir
810
811* Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
812
4009494e
GM
813Various
814
815* Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
816* Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
817* Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
818* Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
819* Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
820* Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
4009494e
GM
821* Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
822* Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
4009494e 823* Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
4009494e
GM
824* Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
825* Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
826* Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
827* Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
828* Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
829* Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
830* Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
64763fe3 831* The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
4009494e
GM
832* Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
833* Various Various:: Things that are really various.
834
835Formatting Variables
836
837* Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
838* Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
839* Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
840* User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
841* Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
842* Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
843* Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
844* Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
845
846Image Enhancements
847
848* X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
849* Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
850* Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
851 meant to be shown.
852* Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
fcf2d385 853* Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
4009494e
GM
854* XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
855
856Thwarting Email Spam
857
858* The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
859* Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
860* SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
861* Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
862
863Spam Package
864
865* Spam Package Introduction::
866* Filtering Incoming Mail::
867* Detecting Spam in Groups::
868* Spam and Ham Processors::
869* Spam Package Configuration Examples::
870* Spam Back Ends::
871* Extending the Spam package::
872* Spam Statistics Package::
873
874Spam Statistics Package
875
876* Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
877* Splitting mail using spam-stat::
878* Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
879
880Appendices
881
882* XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
883* History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
884* On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
885* Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
886* Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
887* Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
888* Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
889* Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
890* Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
891
892History
893
894* Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
4009494e
GM
895* Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
896* Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
897* Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
898* Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
899* Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
900* Contributors:: Oodles of people.
901* New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
902
903New Features
904
905* ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
906* September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
907* Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
908* Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
909* Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
910* Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
89b163db
G
911* No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13
912* Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
4009494e
GM
913
914Customization
915
916* Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
917* Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
918* Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
919* Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
920
921Gnus Reference Guide
922
923* Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
924* Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
925* Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
926* Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
927* Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
928* Group Info:: The group info format.
929* Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
930* Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
931* Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
932
933Back End Interface
934
935* Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
936* Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
937* Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
938* Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
939* Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
940* Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
941
942Various File Formats
943
944* Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
945* Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
946
947Emacs for Heathens
948
949* Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
950* Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
951
952@end detailmenu
953@end menu
954
955@node Starting Up
956@chapter Starting Gnus
957@cindex starting up
958
959If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
960Heathens} first.
961
962@kindex M-x gnus
963@findex gnus
964If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
965and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
966your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
967@code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
968minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
969@code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
970
971@findex gnus-other-frame
972@kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
973If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
974@kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
975
976If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
977variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
978@file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
979
980If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
981terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
982
983@menu
984* Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
4009494e
GM
985* The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
986* Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
987* New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
988* Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
989* Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
990* Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
991* The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
992* Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
993@end menu
994
995
996@node Finding the News
997@section Finding the News
998@cindex finding news
999
357e2d8e
KY
1000First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
1001@code{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
1002press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
1003you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1004serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1005a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
fe3c5669 1006do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
357e2d8e
KY
1007@xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1008
4009494e
GM
1009@vindex gnus-select-method
1010@c @head
1011The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1012news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1013@dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1014native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
0afb49a1 1015secondary or foreign groups.
4009494e
GM
1016
1017For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1018you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1019
1020@lisp
1021(setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1022@end lisp
1023
1024If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1025
1026@lisp
1027(setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1028@end lisp
1029
1030If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1031certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1032server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1033server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1034
1035@vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1036@cindex NNTPSERVER
1037@cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1038If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1039@env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1040Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1041(@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1042If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1043as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1044
4009494e
GM
1045@findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1046@kindex B (Group)
1047However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1048interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1049better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1050let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1051to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1052maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1053
1054@vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1055@c @head
1056A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1057@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1058listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1059@code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1060files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1061appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1062groups are.
1063
1064For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1065you would typically set this variable to
1066
1067@lisp
1068(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1069@end lisp
1070
01c52d31 1071
4009494e 1072
4009494e
GM
1073@node The Server is Down
1074@section The Server is Down
1075@cindex server errors
1076
1077If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1078problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1079the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1080
1081Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1082without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1083will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1084given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1085for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1086groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1087buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1088
1089@findex gnus-no-server
1090@kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1091@c @head
1092If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1093your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1094@code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1095if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1096your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
10971 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1098levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1099
1100
1101@node Slave Gnusae
1102@section Slave Gnusae
1103@cindex slave
1104
1105You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1106same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1107are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1108that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1109
1110The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1111@file{.newsrc} file.
1112
1113To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1114Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1115@dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1116taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1117conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1118me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1119Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1120
1121@findex gnus-slave
1122Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1123however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1124@kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1125files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1126on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1127starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1128information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1129they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1130
1131Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1132information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1133
1134If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1135slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1136file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1137incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1138messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1139
1140
1141
1142@node New Groups
1143@section New Groups
1144@cindex new groups
1145@cindex subscription
1146
1147@vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1148If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1149you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1150also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1151@code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1152@kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1153is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1154@code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1155when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1156
1157@menu
1158* Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1159* Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1160* Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1161@end menu
1162
1163
1164@node Checking New Groups
1165@subsection Checking New Groups
1166
cd865a33 1167Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
7d1738f1
LMI
1168the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1169subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1170If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1171ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1172faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1173of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
cd865a33
G
1174@code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1175at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1176this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1177command.
4009494e
GM
1178
1179I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1180server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1181fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1182@code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1183few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1184work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1185supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1186You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1187whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1188it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1189@samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1190
1191This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1192issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1193subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1194if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1195that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1196Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1197
1198
1199@node Subscription Methods
1200@subsection Subscription Methods
1201
1202@vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1203What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1204@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1205
1206This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1207with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1208
1209Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1210
1211@table @code
1212
1213@item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1214@vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
cd865a33
G
1215Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1216default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1217kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1218(with @kbd{u}).
4009494e
GM
1219
1220@item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221@vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1222Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1223new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1224
1225@item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226@vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1227Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1228
1229@item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230@vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1231Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1232function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1233@code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1234alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1235hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1236@samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1237up. Or something like that.
1238
1239@item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240@vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1241Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1242you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1243to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1244
1245@item gnus-subscribe-killed
1246@vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1247Kill all new groups.
1248
1249@item gnus-subscribe-topics
1250@vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1251Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1252parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1253topic parameter that looks like
1254
1255@example
77ae8989 1256"nnml"
4009494e
GM
1257@end example
1258
1259will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1260that topic.
1261
1262If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1263top-level topic.
1264
1265@end table
1266
1267@vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1268A closely related variable is
1269@code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1270mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1271hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1272will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1273hierarchy or not.
1274
1275One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1276(@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1277@code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1278will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1279
1280
1281@node Filtering New Groups
1282@subsection Filtering New Groups
1283
1284A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1285subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1286the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1287
1288@example
1289options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1290@end example
1291
1292@vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1293This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1294person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1295groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1296be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1297be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1298subscribing these groups.
1299@code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1300variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1301
0c502747 1302The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
f99f1641 1303that is supports: you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
0c502747
LMI
1304deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1305
4009494e
GM
1306@vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1307@vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1308If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1309set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1310@code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1311same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1312and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1313subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1314
1315@vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1316Yet another variable that meddles here is
1317@code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1318@code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1319but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1320more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1321used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1322groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
7410c270
G
1323@code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1324@code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1325variable to @code{nil}.
1326
1327@vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1328As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
22bcf204 1329allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
7410c270
G
1330category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1331post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1332should be subscribed automatically.
1333
1334New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
4009494e
GM
1335@code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1336
1337
1338@node Changing Servers
1339@section Changing Servers
1340@cindex changing servers
1341
1342Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1343This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1344very flaky and you want to use another.
1345
1346Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1347@code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1348
1349@emph{Wrong!}
1350
1351Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1352@acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1353you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1354change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1355worthless.
1356
4009494e
GM
1357@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1358@findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
f02566ce
KY
1359You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1360command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1361Use with caution.
4009494e
GM
1362
1363@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1364@findex gnus-group-clear-data
1365Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1366list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1367
1368After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1369since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1370affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1371@code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1372to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1373can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1374cache for all groups).
1375
1376
1377@node Startup Files
1378@section Startup Files
1379@cindex startup files
1380@cindex .newsrc
1381@cindex .newsrc.el
1382@cindex .newsrc.eld
1383
1384Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1385@file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1386groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1387read.
1388
1389Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1390keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1391@file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1392the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1393the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1394files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1395@sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1396
1397That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1398@file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1399@file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1400recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1401never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1402not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1403
1404@vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1405@vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1406You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1407@code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1408the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1409However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1410Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1411@code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1412@file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1413convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1414want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1415news reader.
1416
1417@vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1418If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1419will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1420save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1421will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1422so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1423You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1424@code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1425Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1426the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1427saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1428several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1429
1430@vindex gnus-startup-file
1431@vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1432@vindex version-control
1433The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1434The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1435file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
cd865a33 1436If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
4009494e
GM
1437@code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1438@code{version-control} variable.
1439
1440@vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1441@vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1442@vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1443@code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1444files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1445saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1446@code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1447@file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1448control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1449startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1450
1451@lisp
1452(defun turn-off-backup ()
1453 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1454
1455(add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1456(add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1457@end lisp
1458
1459@vindex gnus-init-file
1460@vindex gnus-site-init-file
1461When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1462(@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1463(@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1464and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1465@file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1466with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1467suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1468@file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1469and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1470the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1471Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1472@code{gnus-init-file}.
1473
1474
1475@node Auto Save
1476@section Auto Save
1477@cindex dribble file
1478@cindex auto-save
1479
1480Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1481catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1482special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1483Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1484@file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1485this file.
1486
1487If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1488read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1489saved.
1490
1491@vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1492If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1493maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1494
1495@vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1496Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1497this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1498into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1499normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1500file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1501
1502@vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1503If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1504read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1505
1506
1507@node The Active File
1508@section The Active File
1509@cindex active file
1510@cindex ignored groups
1511
1512When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1513articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1514file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1515
1516@vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1517Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1518regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1519any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1520ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1521recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1522Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1523
1524@c This variable is
1525@c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1526@c if you set it to anything else.
1527
1528@vindex gnus-read-active-file
1529@c @head
1530The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1531can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1532reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1533
1534Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1535you actually subscribe to.
1536
1537Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1538variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1539present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1540considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1541
1542This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1543attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1544servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1545support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1546at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1547is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1548
1549Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1550instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1551servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1552variable.
1553
1554If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1555lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1556@acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1557read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1558performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1559@code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1560
1561If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1562different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1563
1564In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1565kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1566
1567Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1568secondary select methods.
1569
1570
1571@node Startup Variables
1572@section Startup Variables
1573
1574@table @code
1575
1576@item gnus-load-hook
1577@vindex gnus-load-hook
1578A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1579normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1580times you start Gnus.
1581
1582@item gnus-before-startup-hook
1583@vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
e3e955fe 1584A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
4009494e 1585
5b4d7e52
SS
1586@item gnus-before-resume-hook
1587@vindex gnus-before-resume-hook
1588A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is resumed after a suspend.
1589
4009494e
GM
1590@item gnus-startup-hook
1591@vindex gnus-startup-hook
1592A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1593
1594@item gnus-started-hook
1595@vindex gnus-started-hook
1596A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1597successfully.
1598
1599@item gnus-setup-news-hook
1600@vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1601A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1602generating the group buffer.
1603
1604@item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1605@vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1606If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1607startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1608@file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1609bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1610best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1611in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1612
1613@item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1614@vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1615If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1616your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1617of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1618@file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1619
1620@item gnus-no-groups-message
1621@vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1622Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1623
b1ae92ba
G
1624@item gnus-use-backend-marks
1625@vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1626If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1627@file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1628group operation some.
1629
4009494e
GM
1630@end table
1631
1632
1633@node Group Buffer
1634@chapter Group Buffer
1635@cindex group buffer
1636
1637@c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1638@c
1639@c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1640@c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1641@c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1642@c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1643@c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1644@c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1645@c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1646@c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1647@c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1648@c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1649@c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1650@c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1651@c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1652@c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1653@c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1654@c human rights at 9...
1655
1656
1657The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1658is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1659long as Gnus is active.
1660
1661@iftex
1662@iflatex
1663\gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1664\put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1665\put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1666\put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1667\put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1668\put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1669\put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1670\put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1671}
1672@end iflatex
1673@end iftex
1674
1675@menu
1676* Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1677* Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1678* Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1679* Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1680* Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1681* Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1682* Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1683* Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1684* Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1685* Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1686* Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1687* Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1688* Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1689* Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1690* Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1691* Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
01c52d31 1692* Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
4009494e
GM
1693* Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1694@end menu
1695
1696
1697@node Group Buffer Format
1698@section Group Buffer Format
1699
1700@menu
1701* Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1702* Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1703* Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1704@end menu
1705
1706You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1707customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1708available in Emacs.
1709
1710The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1711cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1712slower. You can disable this via the variable
1713@code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1714Emacs version.
1715
1716@node Group Line Specification
1717@subsection Group Line Specification
1718@cindex group buffer format
1719
1720The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1721make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1722
1723Here's a couple of example group lines:
1724
1725@example
1726 25: news.announce.newusers
1727 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1728@end example
1729
1730Quite simple, huh?
1731
1732You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1733@samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1734ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1735asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1736
1737@vindex gnus-group-line-format
1738You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1739@code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1740lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1df7defd 1741a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C@.
4009494e
GM
1742@xref{Formatting Variables}.
1743
1744@samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1745
1746There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1747the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1748Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1749displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1750Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1751
1752(Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1753layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1754instead of wasting time reading news.)
1755
1756Here's a list of all available format characters:
1757
1758@table @samp
1759
1760@item M
1761An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1762
1763@item S
1764Whether the group is subscribed.
1765
1766@item L
1767Level of subscribedness.
1768
1769@item N
1770Number of unread articles.
1771
1772@item I
1773Number of dormant articles.
1774
1775@item T
1776Number of ticked articles.
1777
1778@item R
1779Number of read articles.
1780
1781@item U
1782Number of unseen articles.
1783
1784@item t
1785Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1786minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1787
1788Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1789efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1790the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1791hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1792unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1793interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
01c52d31
MB
1794end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1795
1796The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1797compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1798renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1799getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1800future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1801date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1802server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
4009494e
GM
1803
1804@item y
1805Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1806
1807@item i
1808Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1809
1810@item g
1811Full group name.
1812
1813@item G
1814Group name.
1815
1816@item C
1817Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1818comment element in the group parameters.
1819
1820@item D
1821Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1822before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1823@code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1824command.
1825
1826@item o
1827@samp{m} if moderated.
1828
1829@item O
1830@samp{(m)} if moderated.
1831
1832@item s
1833Select method.
1834
1835@item B
1836If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1837
1838@item n
1839Select from where.
1840
1841@item z
1842A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1843used.
1844
1845@item P
1846Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1847
1848@item c
1849@vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1850Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1851variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1852The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1853@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1854
1855@item m
1856@vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1857@cindex %
1858@samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1859the group lately.
1860
1861@item p
1862@samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1863
1864@item d
1865A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1866Timestamp}).
1867
01c52d31
MB
1868@item F
1869The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1870agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1871megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1872of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1873
4009494e
GM
1874@item u
1875User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1876be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1877@code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1878following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1879parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1880be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1881specifier.
1882@end table
1883
1884@cindex *
1885All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1886if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1887group, or a bogus native group.
1888
1889
1890@node Group Mode Line Specification
1891@subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1892@cindex group mode line
1893
1894@vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1895The mode line can be changed by setting
1896@code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1897doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1898
1899@table @samp
1900@item S
1901The native news server.
1902@item M
1903The native select method.
1904@end table
1905
1906
1907@node Group Highlighting
1908@subsection Group Highlighting
1909@cindex highlighting
1910@cindex group highlighting
1911
1912@vindex gnus-group-highlight
1913Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1914@code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1915that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1916something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1917
1918Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1919background is dark:
1920
1921@lisp
1922(cond (window-system
1923 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1924 (defface my-group-face-1
1925 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1926 (defface my-group-face-2
1927 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1928 "Second group face")
1929 (defface my-group-face-3
1930 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1931 (defface my-group-face-4
1932 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1933 (defface my-group-face-5
1934 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1935
1936(setq gnus-group-highlight
1937 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1938 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1939 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1940 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1941 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1942@end lisp
1943
1944Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1945
1946Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1947include:
1948
1949@table @code
1950@item group
1951The group name.
1952@item unread
1953The number of unread articles in the group.
1954@item method
1955The select method.
1956@item mailp
1957Whether the group is a mail group.
1958@item level
1959The level of the group.
1960@item score
1961The score of the group.
1962@item ticked
1963The number of ticked articles in the group.
1964@item total
1965The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1966@var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1967@item topic
1968When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1969topic being inserted.
1970@end table
1971
1972When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1973of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1974functions for snarfing info on the group.
1975
1976@vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1977@findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1978@code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
b069e5a6 1979It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4009494e
GM
1980
1981
1982@node Group Maneuvering
1983@section Group Maneuvering
1984@cindex group movement
1985
1986All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1987expected, hopefully.
1988
1989@table @kbd
1990
1991@item n
1992@kindex n (Group)
1993@findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1994Go to the next group that has unread articles
1995(@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1996
1997@item p
1998@itemx DEL
1999@kindex DEL (Group)
2000@kindex p (Group)
2001@findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2002Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2003(@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2004
2005@item N
2006@kindex N (Group)
2007@findex gnus-group-next-group
2008Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2009
2010@item P
2011@kindex P (Group)
2012@findex gnus-group-prev-group
2013Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2014
2015@item M-n
2016@kindex M-n (Group)
2017@findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2018Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2019(@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2020
2021@item M-p
2022@kindex M-p (Group)
2023@findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2024Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2025(@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2026@end table
2027
2028Three commands for jumping to groups:
2029
2030@table @kbd
2031
2032@item j
2033@kindex j (Group)
2034@findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2035Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2036(@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2037like living groups.
2038
2039@item ,
2040@kindex , (Group)
2041@findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2042Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2043(@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2044
2045@item .
2046@kindex . (Group)
2047@findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2048Jump to the first group with unread articles
2049(@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2050@end table
2051
2052@vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2053If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2054commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2055the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2056is @code{t}.
2057
01c52d31
MB
2058@vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2059If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2060exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2061Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2062@code{t}.
4009494e
GM
2063
2064@node Selecting a Group
2065@section Selecting a Group
2066@cindex group selection
2067
2068@table @kbd
2069
2070@item SPACE
2071@kindex SPACE (Group)
2072@findex gnus-group-read-group
2073Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2074first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2075unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2076this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2077group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2078determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2079positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2080negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2081
2082Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2083articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2084- 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2085
2086When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2087@kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2088ones.
2089
2090@item RET
2091@kindex RET (Group)
2092@findex gnus-group-select-group
2093Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2094(@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2095@code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2096does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2097entry.
2098
2099@item M-RET
2100@kindex M-RET (Group)
2101@findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2102This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2103minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2104scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2105expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2106enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2107(i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2108which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2109summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2110
2111@item M-SPACE
2112@kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2113@findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2114This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2115command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2116(@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2117
2118@item C-M-RET
2119@kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2120@findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2121Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2122doing any processing of its contents
2123(@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2124turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2125manner will have no permanent effects.
2126
2127@end table
2128
2129@vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2130The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2131consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2132considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2133(unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2134before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2135articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2136negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2137fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2138most recently will be fetched.
2139
2140@vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2141@code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2142@code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2143newsgroups.
2144
4b70e299 2145@vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
4009494e
GM
2146In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2147very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2148such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2149for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
f99f1641 2150are actually only the articles 1--10 and 29999900--30000000, Gnus doesn't
4009494e
GM
2151know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2152it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2153stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
4b70e299
MB
2154variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2155The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2156latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
f99f1641 2157get only the articles 29990001--30000000 (if the latest article number is
4b70e299
MB
215830000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2159prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2160variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2161means Gnus never ignores old articles.
4009494e
GM
2162
2163@vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2164@vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2165@vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2166If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2167automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
867d4bb3 2168Which article this is controlled by the
4009494e
GM
2169@code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2170variable are:
2171
2172@table @code
2173
2174@item unread
2175Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2176
2177@item first
2178Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2179
2180@item unseen
2181Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2182
2183@item unseen-or-unread
2184Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2185there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2186unread article.
2187
2188@item best
2189Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2190
2191@end table
2192
2193This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2194will be called to place point on a subject line.
2195
2196If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2197binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2198@code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2199@code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2200selected.
2201
2202
2203@node Subscription Commands
2204@section Subscription Commands
2205@cindex subscription
2206
280f417b
G
2207The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2208Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2209more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2210server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2211commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2212
4009494e
GM
2213@table @kbd
2214
2215@item S t
2216@itemx u
2217@kindex S t (Group)
2218@kindex u (Group)
2219@findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2220@c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2221Toggle subscription to the current group
2222(@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2223
2224@item S s
2225@itemx U
2226@kindex S s (Group)
2227@kindex U (Group)
2228@findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2229Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2230subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2231(@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2232
2233@item S k
2234@itemx C-k
2235@kindex S k (Group)
2236@kindex C-k (Group)
2237@findex gnus-group-kill-group
2238@c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2239Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2240
2241@item S y
2242@itemx C-y
2243@kindex S y (Group)
2244@kindex C-y (Group)
2245@findex gnus-group-yank-group
2246Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2247
2248@item C-x C-t
2249@kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2250@findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2251Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2252really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2253kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2254
2255@item S w
2256@itemx C-w
2257@kindex S w (Group)
2258@kindex C-w (Group)
2259@findex gnus-group-kill-region
2260Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2261
2262@item S z
2263@kindex S z (Group)
2264@findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2265Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2266
2267@item S C-k
2268@kindex S C-k (Group)
2269@findex gnus-group-kill-level
2270Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2271These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2272be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2273really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2274groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2275kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2276@file{.newsrc} file.
2277
2278@end table
2279
2280Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2281
2282
2283@node Group Data
2284@section Group Data
2285
2286@table @kbd
2287
2288@item c
2289@kindex c (Group)
2290@findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2291@vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2292@c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2293Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2294(@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2295@code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2296the group buffer.
2297
2298@item C
2299@kindex C (Group)
2300@findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2301Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2302(@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2303
2304@item M-c
2305@kindex M-c (Group)
2306@findex gnus-group-clear-data
2307Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2308read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2309
2310@item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2311@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2312@findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2313If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2314and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2315clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2316caution.
2317
2318@end table
2319
2320
2321@node Group Levels
2322@section Group Levels
2323@cindex group level
2324@cindex level
2325
2326All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2327group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2328can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2329(@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2330a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2331
2332Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2333
2334@table @kbd
2335
2336@item S l
2337@kindex S l (Group)
2338@findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2339Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2340next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2341prompted for a level.
2342@end table
2343
2344@vindex gnus-level-killed
2345@vindex gnus-level-zombie
2346@vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2347@vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2348Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2349@code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2350@code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2351@code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2352unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2353(default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2354(default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
65e7ca35
PE
2355same, but zombie and killed groups store no information on what articles
2356you have read, etc. This distinction between dead and living
4009494e
GM
2357groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2358reasons of efficiency.
2359
2360It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
1df7defd 2361low levels (e.g., 1 or 2).
4009494e
GM
2362
2363Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2364understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2365subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2366empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2367go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2368groups are hidden, in a way.
2369
cd865a33 2370@cindex zombie groups
4009494e
GM
2371Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2372are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2373unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2374information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2375and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2376aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2377
2378Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2379a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2380group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2381but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2382the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2383list of killed groups.)
2384
2385If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2386Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2387them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2388
2389@vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2390@vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2391Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2392(default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2393which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2394(un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2395relevant valid ranges.
2396
2397@vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2398If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2399will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2400particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2401will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2402handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2403rest.
2404
2405If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2406one with the best level.
2407
2408@vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2409All groups with a level less than or equal to
2410@code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2411by default.
11a5db4a
JD
2412This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2413be called and the result will be used as value.
2414
4009494e
GM
2415
2416@vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2417If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2418groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2419@code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2420listed.
2421
2422@vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2423If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2424give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2425use this level as the ``work'' level.
2426
2427@vindex gnus-activate-level
1df7defd 2428Gnus will normally just activate (i.e., query the server about) groups
4009494e
GM
2429on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2430activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2431to 5. The default is 6.
2432
2433
2434@node Group Score
2435@section Group Score
2436@cindex group score
2437@cindex group rank
2438@cindex rank
2439
2440You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2441is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2442group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2443reason?
2444
2445This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2446to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2447the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2448score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2449called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2450a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2451of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2452least significant part.))
2453
2454@findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2455If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2456read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2457the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2458sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2459action after each summary exit, you can add
2460@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2461@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2462slow things down somewhat.
2463
2464
2465@node Marking Groups
2466@section Marking Groups
2467@cindex marking groups
2468
2469If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2470subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2471numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2472bidding on those groups.
2473
2474However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2475perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2476with the process mark and then execute the command.
2477
2478@table @kbd
2479
2480@item #
2481@kindex # (Group)
2482@itemx M m
2483@kindex M m (Group)
2484@findex gnus-group-mark-group
2485Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2486
2487@item M-#
2488@kindex M-# (Group)
2489@itemx M u
2490@kindex M u (Group)
2491@findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2492Remove the mark from the current group
2493(@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2494
2495@item M U
2496@kindex M U (Group)
2497@findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2498Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2499
2500@item M w
2501@kindex M w (Group)
2502@findex gnus-group-mark-region
2503Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2504
2505@item M b
2506@kindex M b (Group)
2507@findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2508Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2509
2510@item M r
2511@kindex M r (Group)
2512@findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2513Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2514(@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2515@end table
2516
2517Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2518
2519@findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2520If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2521with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2522(@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2523the command to be executed.
2524
2525
2526@node Foreign Groups
2527@section Foreign Groups
2528@cindex foreign groups
2529
549c9aed
G
2530If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2531you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2532@code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2533what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2534approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2535they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2536configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2537@file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2538
4009494e
GM
2539Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2540groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2541special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2542groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2543consulted.
2544
2545Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2546@file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2547variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2548
2549@table @kbd
2550
2551@item G m
2552@kindex G m (Group)
2553@findex gnus-group-make-group
2554@cindex making groups
2555Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2556for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2557to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2558
2559@item G M
2560@kindex G M (Group)
2561@findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2562Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2563will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2564
2565@item G r
2566@kindex G r (Group)
2567@findex gnus-group-rename-group
2568@cindex renaming groups
2569Rename the current group to something else
2570(@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2571groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2572on some back ends.
2573
2574@item G c
2575@kindex G c (Group)
2576@cindex customizing
2577@findex gnus-group-customize
2578Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2579
2580@item G e
2581@kindex G e (Group)
2582@findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2583@cindex renaming groups
2584Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2585group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2586
2587@item G p
2588@kindex G p (Group)
2589@findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2590Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2591(@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2592
2593@item G E
2594@kindex G E (Group)
2595@findex gnus-group-edit-group
2596Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2597(@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2598
2599@item G d
2600@kindex G d (Group)
2601@findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2602@cindex nndir
2603Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2604for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2605
2606@item G h
2607@kindex G h (Group)
2608@cindex help group
2609@findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2610Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2611
4009494e
GM
2612@item G D
2613@kindex G D (Group)
2614@findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2615@cindex nneething
2616Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2617@code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2618@xref{Anything Groups}.
2619
2620@item G f
2621@kindex G f (Group)
2622@findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2623@cindex ClariNet Briefs
2624@cindex nndoc
2625Make a group based on some file or other
2626(@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2627command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2628Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2629@code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2630@code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2631@code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2632@code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2633you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2634type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2635
2636@item G u
2637@kindex G u (Group)
2638@vindex gnus-useful-groups
2639@findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2640Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2641(@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2642
2643@item G w
2644@kindex G w (Group)
2645@findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2646@cindex Google
2647@cindex nnweb
2648@cindex gmane
2649Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2650(@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2651command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2652search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2653include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2654@xref{Web Searches}.
2655
2656If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2657to a particular group by using a match string like
2658@samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2659
2660@item G R
2661@kindex G R (Group)
2662@findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2663Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
1df7defd 2664(@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL@.
4009494e
GM
2665@xref{RSS}.
2666
2667@item G DEL
2668@kindex G DEL (Group)
2669@findex gnus-group-delete-group
2670This function will delete the current group
2671(@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2672actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2673group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2674absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2675read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2676
2677@item G V
2678@kindex G V (Group)
2679@findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2680Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2681(@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2682
2683@item G v
2684@kindex G v (Group)
2685@findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2686Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2687(@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2688@end table
2689
2690@xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2691methods.
2692
2693@vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2694If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2695Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2696This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2697groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2698@code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2699newsgroups.
2700
2701
9b3ebcb6
MB
2702The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2703only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2704
2705@table @code
2706@item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2707@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2708@vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2709Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2710HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2711Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2712the article range.
2713
2714@item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2715@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2716This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2717the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
1df7defd 2718given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include:
f2a538a2
GM
2719@indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2720@indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2721@indicateurl{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2722@indicateurl{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2723@indicateurl{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
9b3ebcb6
MB
2724
2725@item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2726@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2727Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2728bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2729specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2730
2731@item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2732@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2733Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2734@code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2735@end table
2736
2737Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2738Buttons}.
2739
2740Here is an example:
2741@lisp
2742(require 'gnus-art)
2743(add-to-list
2744 'gnus-button-alist
2745 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2746 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2747 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2748@end lisp
2749
2750
4009494e
GM
2751@node Group Parameters
2752@section Group Parameters
2753@cindex group parameters
2754
2755The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
87035689
MB
2756
2757Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2758group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2759presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2760silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2761parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2762Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2763@code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2764
4009494e
GM
2765Here's an example group parameter list:
2766
2767@example
2768((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2769 (auto-expire . t))
2770@end example
2771
2772We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2773the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2774parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2775not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2776
2777Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2778is an alist of regexps and values.
2779
2780The following group parameters can be used:
2781
2782@table @code
2783@item to-address
2784@cindex to-address
2785Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2786
2787@example
2788(to-address . "some@@where.com")
2789@end example
2790
2791This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2792lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2793the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2794ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2795that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2796
2797Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2798or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2799@samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2800the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2801group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2802list address instead.
2803
2804See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2805
2806@item to-list
2807@cindex to-list
2808Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2809
2810@example
2811(to-list . "some@@where.com")
2812@end example
2813
2814It is totally ignored
2815when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2816you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2817
2818If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2819@code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2820then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2821sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2822@vindex gnus-add-to-list
2823
2824@findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2825@cindex mail list groups
2826If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2827entering summary buffer.
2828
2829See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2830
2831@anchor{subscribed}
2832@item subscribed
2833@cindex subscribed
2834@cindex Mail-Followup-To
2835@findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2836If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2837to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2838mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2839(only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2840headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2841following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2842
2843@lisp
2844(setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2845 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2846@end lisp
2847
2848@xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2849a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2850
2851@item visible
2852@cindex visible
2853If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2854that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2855of whether it has any unread articles.
2856
2857This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2858@code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2859
2860@item broken-reply-to
2861@cindex broken-reply-to
2862Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2863headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2864if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2865can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2866has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2867itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2868
2869@item to-group
2870@cindex to-group
2871Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2872posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2873
2874@item newsgroup
2875@cindex newsgroup
2876If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2877will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2878This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2879news group.
2880
2881@item gcc-self
2882@cindex gcc-self
2883If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2884composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2885@code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2886generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2887be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2888precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
89b163db 2889(@pxref{Archived Messages}), with the exception for messages to resend.
4009494e
GM
2890
2891@strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2892@code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2893doesn't accept articles.
2894
2895@item auto-expire
2896@cindex auto-expire
2897@cindex expiring mail
2898If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2899. t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2900alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2901
2902See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2903
2904@item total-expire
2905@cindex total-expire
2906@cindex expiring mail
2907If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2908@code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2909expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2910caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2911expiry.
2912
2913See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2914
2915@item expiry-wait
2916@cindex expiry-wait
2917@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2918If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2919@code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2920@code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2921(@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2922can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2923symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2924
2925@item expiry-target
2926@cindex expiry-target
2927Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2928@code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2929
2930@item score-file
2931@cindex score file group parameter
2932Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2933@file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2934interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2935
2936@item adapt-file
2937@cindex adapt file group parameter
2938Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2939@file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2940All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2941
2942@item admin-address
2943@cindex admin-address
2944When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2945unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2946messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2947put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2948
2949@item display
2950@cindex display
2951Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2952display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2953
2954@table @code
2955@item all
2956Display all articles, both read and unread.
2957
2958@item an integer
2959Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2960entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2961
2962@item default
2963Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2964ticked articles.
2965
2966@item an array
2967Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2968
2969Here are some examples:
2970
2971@table @code
2972@item [unread]
2973Display only unread articles.
2974
2975@item [not expire]
2976Display everything except expirable articles.
2977
2978@item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2979Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2980responded to.
2981@end table
2982
2983The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2984Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2985@code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2986@code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
e21bac42 2987@code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
4009494e
GM
2988
2989@end table
2990
2991The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2992the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2993command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2994
2995@item comment
2996@cindex comment
2997Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2998arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2999group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
3000
3001@item charset
3002@cindex charset
3003Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3004@code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3005used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3006
3007See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3008
3009@item ignored-charsets
3010@cindex ignored-charset
3011Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3012will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3013default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3014
3015See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3016
3017@item posting-style
3018@cindex posting-style
3019You can store additional posting style information for this group
3020here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3021@code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3022the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3023take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3024
3025For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3026instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3027like this in the group parameters:
3028
3029@example
3030(posting-style
3031 (name "Funky Name")
89b163db 3032 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
4009494e
GM
3033 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3034 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3035@end example
3036
01c52d31
MB
3037If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3038(@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3039the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3040groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3041group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3042entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3043to.
3044
3045
4009494e
GM
3046@item post-method
3047@cindex post-method
3048If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3049instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3050
a1da1e37
MB
3051@item mail-source
3052@cindex mail-source
3053If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3054@code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3055mail source for this group.
3056
4009494e
GM
3057@item banner
3058@cindex banner
3059An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3060that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3061@var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3062last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3063@code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3064
3065@item sieve
3066@cindex sieve
3067This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3068that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3069Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3070condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3071
3072For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3073address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3074translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3075Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3076
3077@example
01c52d31
MB
3078if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3079 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3080@}
3081@end example
3082
3083To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3084like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3085When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3086like the following is generated:
3087
3088@example
3089if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3090 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
4009494e
GM
3091@}
3092@end example
3093
6ed7a66a
G
3094You can also use regexp expansions in the rules:
3095
3096@example
3097(sieve header :regex "list-id" "<c++std-\\1.accu.org>")
3098@end example
3099
01c52d31
MB
3100See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3101interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3102
4009494e
GM
3103The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3104Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3105
3106@item (agent parameters)
88dbda51
JB
3107If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3108control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
4009494e
GM
3109Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3110agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3111minimize the configuration effort.
3112
3113@item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3114You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3115are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3116you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3117that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3118in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3119@code{eval}ed there.
3120
e3e955fe
MB
3121Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3122if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3123only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3124variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3125form needs to be set to it.
3126
4009494e
GM
3127But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3128message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3129message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3130question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3131Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3132parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
e6d2d263 3133@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e
GM
3134
3135@lisp
3136(add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3137@end lisp
3138
3139@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3140A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
1df7defd 3141the subject fields of articles. E.g., if the news group
4009494e
GM
3142
3143@example
3144nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3145@end example
3146
3147has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3148tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3149the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3150into the group parameters for the group.
3151
3152This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3153hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
e3e955fe
MB
3154@code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3155@code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3156(meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
4009494e
GM
3157
3158Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3159pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3160following is added to a group parameter
3161
3162@lisp
3163(gnus-summary-prepared-hook
d1069532 3164 (lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
4009494e
GM
3165@end lisp
3166
3167when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3168expired.
3169
3170@end table
3171
4009494e
GM
3172@vindex gnus-parameters
3173Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3174But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3175case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3176For example:
3177
3178@lisp
3179(setq gnus-parameters
3180 '(("mail\\..*"
3181 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3182 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3183 (gnus-summary-line-format
3184 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3185 (gcc-self . t)
3186 (display . all))
3187
3188 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3189 (to-group . "\\1"))
3190
3191 ("mail\\.me"
e7719ea1 3192 (gnus-use-scoring t))
4009494e
GM
3193
3194 ("list\\..*"
3195 (total-expire . t)
3196 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3197@end lisp
3198
e7719ea1
G
3199All clauses that matches the group name will be used, but the last
3200setting ``wins''. So if you have two clauses that both match the
3201group name, and both set, say @code{display}, the last setting will
3202override the first.
9937bef4
G
3203
3204Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3205as the @code{to-group} example shows.
4009494e
GM
3206
3207@vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3208By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3209specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3210or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3211@code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3212value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3213example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3214applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3215group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3216value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3217@code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3218always in a case-insensitive manner.
3219
01c52d31
MB
3220You can define different sorting to different groups via
3221@code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3222group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3223@acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3224Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3225news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3226weekly news RSS feed
3227@url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3228@xref{RSS}.
3229
3230@lisp
3231(setq
3232 gnus-parameters
3233 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3234 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3235 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3236 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3237 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3238 ("nnrss.*debian"
3239 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3240 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3241 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3242 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3243 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3244 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3245@end lisp
3246
4009494e
GM
3247
3248@node Listing Groups
3249@section Listing Groups
3250@cindex group listing
3251
3252These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3253
3254@table @kbd
3255
3256@item l
3257@itemx A s
3258@kindex A s (Group)
3259@kindex l (Group)
3260@findex gnus-group-list-groups
3261List all groups that have unread articles
3262(@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3263command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3264only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3265@code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3266groups).
3267
3268@item L
3269@itemx A u
3270@kindex A u (Group)
3271@kindex L (Group)
3272@findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3273List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3274(@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3275this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3276it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3277unsubscribed groups).
3278
3279@item A l
3280@kindex A l (Group)
3281@findex gnus-group-list-level
3282List all unread groups on a specific level
3283(@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3284with no unread articles.
3285
3286@item A k
3287@kindex A k (Group)
3288@findex gnus-group-list-killed
3289List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3290prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3291currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3292from the server.
3293
3294@item A z
3295@kindex A z (Group)
3296@findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3297List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3298
3299@item A m
3300@kindex A m (Group)
3301@findex gnus-group-list-matching
3302List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3303(@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3304
3305@item A M
3306@kindex A M (Group)
3307@findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3308List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3309
3310@item A A
3311@kindex A A (Group)
3312@findex gnus-group-list-active
3313List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3314server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3315might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3316to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3317thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3318don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3319Take the output with some grains of salt.
3320
3321@item A a
3322@kindex A a (Group)
3323@findex gnus-group-apropos
3324List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3325(@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3326
3327@item A d
3328@kindex A d (Group)
3329@findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3330List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3331(@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3332
3333@item A c
3334@kindex A c (Group)
3335@findex gnus-group-list-cached
3336List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3337
3338@item A ?
3339@kindex A ? (Group)
3340@findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3341List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3342
a5954fa5
G
3343@item A !
3344@kindex A ! (Group)
3345@findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3346List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3347
4009494e
GM
3348@item A /
3349@kindex A / (Group)
3350@findex gnus-group-list-limit
0afb49a1
LMI
3351Further limit groups within the current selection
3352(@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3353with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3354@kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3355giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3356articles.
4009494e
GM
3357
3358@item A f
3359@kindex A f (Group)
3360@findex gnus-group-list-flush
3361Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3362
3363@item A p
3364@kindex A p (Group)
3365@findex gnus-group-list-plus
3366List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3367
3368@end table
3369
3370@vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3371@cindex visible group parameter
3372Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3373always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3374add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3375get the same effect.
3376
3377@vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3378Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3379group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3380@code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3381groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3382
3383
3384@node Sorting Groups
3385@section Sorting Groups
3386@cindex sorting groups
3387
3388@kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3389@findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3390@vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3391The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3392group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3393@code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3394include:
3395
3396@table @code
3397
3398@item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3399@findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3400Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3401
3402@item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3403@findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3404Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3405
3406@item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3407@findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3408Sort by group level.
3409
3410@item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3411@findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3412Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3413
3414@item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3415@findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3416Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3417are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3418
3419@item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3420@findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3421Sort by number of unread articles.
3422
3423@item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3424@findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3425Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3426
3427@item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3428@findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3429Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3430
3431
3432@end table
3433
3434@code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3435functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3436the last one.
3437
3438
3439There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3440some sorting criteria:
3441
3442@table @kbd
3443@item G S a
3444@kindex G S a (Group)
3445@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3446Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3447(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3448
3449@item G S u
3450@kindex G S u (Group)
3451@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3452Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3453(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3454
3455@item G S l
3456@kindex G S l (Group)
3457@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3458Sort the group buffer by group level
3459(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3460
3461@item G S v
3462@kindex G S v (Group)
3463@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3464Sort the group buffer by group score
3465(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3466
3467@item G S r
3468@kindex G S r (Group)
3469@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3470Sort the group buffer by group rank
3471(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3472
3473@item G S m
3474@kindex G S m (Group)
3475@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3476Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3477(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3478
3479@item G S n
3480@kindex G S n (Group)
3481@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3482Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3483(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3484
3485@end table
3486
3487All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3488(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3489
3490When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3491commands will sort in reverse order.
3492
3493You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3494
3495@table @kbd
3496@item G P a
3497@kindex G P a (Group)
3498@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3499Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3500(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3501
3502@item G P u
3503@kindex G P u (Group)
3504@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3505Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3506(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3507
3508@item G P l
3509@kindex G P l (Group)
3510@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3511Sort the groups by group level
3512(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3513
3514@item G P v
3515@kindex G P v (Group)
3516@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3517Sort the groups by group score
3518(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3519
3520@item G P r
3521@kindex G P r (Group)
3522@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3523Sort the groups by group rank
3524(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3525
3526@item G P m
3527@kindex G P m (Group)
3528@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3529Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3530(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3531
3532@item G P n
3533@kindex G P n (Group)
3534@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3535Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3536(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3537
3538@item G P s
3539@kindex G P s (Group)
3540@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3541Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3542
3543@end table
3544
3545And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3546move groups around.
3547
3548
3549@node Group Maintenance
3550@section Group Maintenance
3551@cindex bogus groups
3552
3553@table @kbd
3554@item b
3555@kindex b (Group)
3556@findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3557Find bogus groups and delete them
3558(@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3559
3560@item F
3561@kindex F (Group)
3562@findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3563Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3564With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3565for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3566to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3567zombies.
3568
3569@item C-c C-x
3570@kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3571@findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3572@cindex expiring mail
3573Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3574process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3575all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3576(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3577
3578@item C-c C-M-x
3579@kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3580@findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3581@cindex expiring mail
3582Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3583(@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3584
3585@end table
3586
3587
3588@node Browse Foreign Server
3589@section Browse Foreign Server
3590@cindex foreign servers
3591@cindex browsing servers
3592
3593@table @kbd
3594@item B
3595@kindex B (Group)
3596@findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3597You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3598then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3599(@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3600@end table
3601
3602@findex gnus-browse-mode
3603A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3604will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3605a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3606
3607Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3608
3609@table @kbd
3610@item n
3611@kindex n (Browse)
3612@findex gnus-group-next-group
3613Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3614
3615@item p
3616@kindex p (Browse)
3617@findex gnus-group-prev-group
3618Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3619
3620@item SPACE
3621@kindex SPACE (Browse)
3622@findex gnus-browse-read-group
3623Enter the current group and display the first article
3624(@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3625
3626@item RET
3627@kindex RET (Browse)
3628@findex gnus-browse-select-group
3629Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3630
3631@item u
3632@kindex u (Browse)
3633@findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
8ccbef23 3634@vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
4009494e 3635Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
8ccbef23
G
3636subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3637can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3638using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3639@pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
4009494e
GM
3640
3641@item l
3642@itemx q
3643@kindex q (Browse)
3644@kindex l (Browse)
3645@findex gnus-browse-exit
3646Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3647
3648@item d
3649@kindex d (Browse)
3650@findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3651Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3652
3653@item ?
3654@kindex ? (Browse)
3655@findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3656Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3657there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
61bbede6
LI
3658
3659@item DEL
3660@kindex DEL (Browse)
3661@findex gnus-browse-delete-group
3662This function will delete the current group
3663(@code{gnus-browse-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function
3664will actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly
3665remove the group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only
3666if you are absolutely sure of what you are doing.
4009494e
GM
3667@end table
3668
3669
3670@node Exiting Gnus
3671@section Exiting Gnus
3672@cindex exiting Gnus
3673
3674Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3675
3676@table @kbd
3677@item z
3678@kindex z (Group)
3679@findex gnus-group-suspend
3680Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3681but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3682is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3683
3684@item q
3685@kindex q (Group)
3686@findex gnus-group-exit
3687@c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3688Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3689
3690@item Q
3691@kindex Q (Group)
3692@findex gnus-group-quit
3693Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3694The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3695@end table
3696
3697@vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3698@vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3699@vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3700@code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3701@code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3702@code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3703exiting Gnus.
3704
3705Note:
3706
3707@quotation
3708Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3709numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3710behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3711plastic chair.
3712@end quotation
3713
3714
3715@node Group Topics
3716@section Group Topics
3717@cindex topics
3718
3719If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3720them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3721here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3722you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3723even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3724groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3725
3726@iftex
3727@iflatex
3728\gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3729\put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3730}
3731@end iflatex
3732@end iftex
3733
3734Here's an example:
3735
3736@example
3737Gnus
3738 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3739 3: comp.emacs
3740 2: alt.religion.emacs
3741 Naughty Emacs
3742 452: alt.sex.emacs
3743 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3744 Misc
3745 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3746 13: comp.sources.unix
3747@end example
3748
3749@findex gnus-topic-mode
3750@kindex t (Group)
3751To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3752@code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3753is a toggling command.)
3754
3755Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3756dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3757Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3758under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3759Hot and bothered?
3760
3761If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3762the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3763@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3764
3765@lisp
3766(add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3767@end lisp
3768
3769@menu
3770* Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3771* Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3772* Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3773* Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3774* Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3775@end menu
3776
3777
3778@node Topic Commands
3779@subsection Topic Commands
3780@cindex topic commands
3781
3782When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3783available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3784definitions slightly.
3785
3786In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3787First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3788groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3789like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3790shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3791groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3792
3793Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3794the way you like.
3795
3796@table @kbd
3797
3798@item T n
3799@kindex T n (Topic)
3800@findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3801Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3802(@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3803
3804@item T TAB
3805@itemx TAB
3806@kindex T TAB (Topic)
3807@kindex TAB (Topic)
3808@findex gnus-topic-indent
3809``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3810previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3811``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3812
3813@item M-TAB
3814@kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3815@findex gnus-topic-unindent
3816``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3817parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3818
3819@end table
3820
3821The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3822They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3823@kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3824kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3825
3826@table @kbd
3827
3828@item C-k
3829@kindex C-k (Topic)
3830@findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3831Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3832topic will be removed along with the topic.
3833
3834@item C-y
3835@kindex C-y (Topic)
3836@findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3837Yank the previously killed group or topic
3838(@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3839before all groups.
3840
3841So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3842@kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3843move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3844topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
f99f1641 3845paste. Like I said---E-Z.
4009494e
GM
3846
3847You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3848you can move topics around as well as groups.
3849
3850@end table
3851
3852After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3853hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3854key.
3855
3856@table @kbd
3857
3858@item RET
3859@kindex RET (Topic)
3860@findex gnus-topic-select-group
3861@itemx SPACE
3862Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3863When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3864usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3865visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3866toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3867prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3868
3869@end table
3870
3871Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3872
3873@table @kbd
3874
3875@item T m
3876@kindex T m (Topic)
3877@findex gnus-topic-move-group
3878Move the current group to some other topic
3879(@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3880convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3881
3882@item T j
3883@kindex T j (Topic)
3884@findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3885Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3886
3887@item T c
3888@kindex T c (Topic)
3889@findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3890Copy the current group to some other topic
3891(@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3892convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3893
3894@item T h
3895@kindex T h (Topic)
3896@findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3897Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3898a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3899
3900@item T s
3901@kindex T s (Topic)
3902@findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3903Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3904a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3905
3906@item T D
3907@kindex T D (Topic)
3908@findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3909Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3910This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3911topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3912remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3913the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3914(which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3915topic.
3916
3917This command uses the process/prefix convention
3918(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3919
3920@item T M
3921@kindex T M (Topic)
3922@findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3923Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3924(@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3925
3926@item T C
3927@kindex T C (Topic)
3928@findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3929Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3930(@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3931
3932@item T H
3933@kindex T H (Topic)
3934@findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3935Toggle hiding empty topics
3936(@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3937
3938@item T #
3939@kindex T # (Topic)
3940@findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3941Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3942(@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3943sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3944
3945@item T M-#
3946@kindex T M-# (Topic)
3947@findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3948Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3949(@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3950sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3951
3952@item C-c C-x
3953@kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3954@findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3955@cindex expiring mail
3956Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3957expiry process (if any)
3958(@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3959
3960@item T r
3961@kindex T r (Topic)
3962@findex gnus-topic-rename
3963Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3964
3965@item T DEL
3966@kindex T DEL (Topic)
3967@findex gnus-topic-delete
3968Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3969
3970@item A T
3971@kindex A T (Topic)
3972@findex gnus-topic-list-active
3973List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3974(@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3975
3976@item T M-n
3977@kindex T M-n (Topic)
3978@findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3979Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3980
3981@item T M-p
3982@kindex T M-p (Topic)
3983@findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
01c52d31 3984Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
4009494e
GM
3985
3986@item G p
3987@kindex G p (Topic)
3988@findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3989@cindex group parameters
3990@cindex topic parameters
3991@cindex parameters
3992Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3993@xref{Topic Parameters}.
3994
3995@end table
3996
3997
3998@node Topic Variables
3999@subsection Topic Variables
4000@cindex topic variables
4001
4002The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
4003This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
4004
4005@vindex gnus-topic-line-format
4006The topic lines themselves are created according to the
4007@code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4008Valid elements are:
4009
4010@table @samp
4011@item i
4012Indentation.
4013@item n
4014Topic name.
4015@item v
4016Visibility.
4017@item l
4018Level.
4019@item g
4020Number of groups in the topic.
4021@item a
4022Number of unread articles in the topic.
4023@item A
4024Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4025@end table
4026
4027@vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4028Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4029@code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4030The default is 2.
4031
4032@vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4033@code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4034
4035@vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4036The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4037topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4038
4039
4040@node Topic Sorting
4041@subsection Topic Sorting
4042@cindex topic sorting
4043
4044You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4045commands:
4046
4047
4048@table @kbd
4049@item T S a
4050@kindex T S a (Topic)
4051@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4052Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4053(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4054
4055@item T S u
4056@kindex T S u (Topic)
4057@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4058Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4059(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4060
4061@item T S l
4062@kindex T S l (Topic)
4063@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4064Sort the current topic by group level
4065(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4066
4067@item T S v
4068@kindex T S v (Topic)
4069@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4070Sort the current topic by group score
4071(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4072
4073@item T S r
4074@kindex T S r (Topic)
4075@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4076Sort the current topic by group rank
4077(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4078
4079@item T S m
4080@kindex T S m (Topic)
4081@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4082Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4083(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4084
4085@item T S e
4086@kindex T S e (Topic)
4087@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4088Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4089(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4090
4091@item T S s
4092@kindex T S s (Topic)
4093@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4094Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4095@code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4096(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4097
4098@end table
4099
4100When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4101order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4102sorting.
4103
4104
4105@node Topic Topology
4106@subsection Topic Topology
4107@cindex topic topology
4108@cindex topology
4109
4110So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4111
4112@example
4113@group
4114Gnus
4115 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4116 3: comp.emacs
4117 2: alt.religion.emacs
4118 Naughty Emacs
4119 452: alt.sex.emacs
4120 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4121 Misc
4122 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4123 13: comp.sources.unix
4124@end group
4125@end example
4126
4127So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4128that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4129just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4130follows:
4131
4132@lisp
4133(("Gnus" visible)
4134 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4135 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4136 (("Misc" visible)))
4137@end lisp
4138
4139@vindex gnus-topic-topology
4140This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4141for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4142file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4143to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4144setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4145
4146This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4147and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4148allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4149
4150
4151@node Topic Parameters
4152@subsection Topic Parameters
4153@cindex topic parameters
4154
4155All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4156(and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4157topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4158enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4159Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4160
4161In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4162parameters:
4163
4164@table @code
4165@item subscribe
4166When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4167@code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4168value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4169topic.
4170
4171@item subscribe-level
4172When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4173the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4174@code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4175
4176@end table
4177
4178Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4179parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4180know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4181verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4182
4183@example
4184@group
4185Gnus
4186 Emacs
4187 3: comp.emacs
4188 2: alt.religion.emacs
4189 452: alt.sex.emacs
4190 Relief
4191 452: alt.sex.emacs
4192 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4193 Misc
4194 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4195 13: comp.sources.unix
4196 452: alt.sex.emacs
4197@end group
4198@end example
4199
4200The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4201. "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4202@code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4203topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4204@* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4205. "religion.SCORE")}.
4206
4207Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4208will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4209group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4210score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4211get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4212
4213This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4214there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4215parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4216@code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4217gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4218of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4219happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4220happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4221
4222
01c52d31
MB
4223@node Non-ASCII Group Names
4224@section Accessing groups of non-English names
4225@cindex non-ascii group names
4226
4227There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4228expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4229certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4230spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4231course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4232supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4233back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4234back end.
4235
4236Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4237side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4238charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4239Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4240article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4241with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4242non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4243the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4244
4245@table @code
4246@item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4247@vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4248An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4249@code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4250method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4251
4252@lisp
4253(setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4254 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4255@end lisp
4256
4257Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4258ones specified for the same groups with the
4259@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4260
4261A select method can be very long, like:
4262
4263@lisp
4264(nntp "gmane"
4265 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4266 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4267 (nntp-open-connection-function
4268 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4269 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4270 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4271 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4272 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4273@end lisp
4274
4275In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4276variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4277the server name.
4278
4279@item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4280@cindex UTF-8 group names
4281@vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4282An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4283@code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4284otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4285
4286@lisp
4287(setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4288 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4289 (".*" . utf-8)))
4290@end lisp
4291
4292Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4293@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4294@end table
4295
4296Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4297and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4298other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4299you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4300all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4301@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4302
4303There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
26b9f88d 4304names:
01c52d31
MB
4305
4306@table @code
4307@item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
26b9f88d
MB
4308@vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4309The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4310default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4311named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4312@code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4313
89b163db
G
4314The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the agent, and
4315the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4316directories. This variable overrides the value of
4317@code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4318when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
01c52d31
MB
4319
4320In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4321is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
26b9f88d 4322file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
01c52d31 4323@code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
26b9f88d
MB
4324is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4325@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4326
4327Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4328@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4329to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4330to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
01c52d31
MB
4331
4332The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4333does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4334@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4335@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4336
26b9f88d
MB
4337If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4338initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4339want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4340typical case where you have to customize
4341@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4342a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4343system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4344may be initialized to an appropriate value.
01c52d31
MB
4345@end table
4346
4347Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4348group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4349names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4350header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4351
4352
8a1cdce5
AC
4353@node Misc Group Stuff
4354@section Misc Group Stuff
e6d2d263
MB
4355
4356@menu
8a1cdce5
AC
4357* Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4358* Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4359* Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4360* File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4361* Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
e6d2d263
MB
4362@end menu
4363
8a1cdce5 4364@table @kbd
e6d2d263 4365
8a1cdce5
AC
4366@item v
4367@kindex v (Group)
4368@cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4369The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4370command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
e6d2d263 4371
8a1cdce5
AC
4372@lisp
4373(define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4374 (lambda ()
4375 (interactive)
4376 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4377@end lisp
e6d2d263 4378
8a1cdce5
AC
4379On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4380@xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
e6d2d263 4381
8a1cdce5
AC
4382@item ^
4383@kindex ^ (Group)
4384@findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4385Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4386@xref{Server Buffer}.
e6d2d263 4387
8a1cdce5
AC
4388@item a
4389@kindex a (Group)
4390@findex gnus-group-post-news
4391Start composing a message (a news by default)
4392(@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4393under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4394Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4395article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4396with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
e6d2d263 4397
8a1cdce5
AC
4398@item m
4399@kindex m (Group)
4400@findex gnus-group-mail
4401Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4402use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4403prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4404@xref{Composing Messages}.
e6d2d263 4405
8a1cdce5
AC
4406@item i
4407@kindex i (Group)
4408@findex gnus-group-news
4409Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4410post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4411for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
e6d2d263 4412
8a1cdce5
AC
4413This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4414This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4415sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4416in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4417for this to work though.
e6d2d263 4418
8a1cdce5
AC
4419@item G z
4420@kindex G z (Group)
4421@findex gnus-group-compact-group
e6d2d263 4422
8a1cdce5
AC
4423Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4424Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4425gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4426count.
e6d2d263 4427
8a1cdce5 4428@end table
e6d2d263 4429
8a1cdce5 4430Variables for the group buffer:
e6d2d263 4431
8a1cdce5 4432@table @code
e6d2d263 4433
8a1cdce5
AC
4434@item gnus-group-mode-hook
4435@vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4436is called after the group buffer has been
4437created.
e6d2d263 4438
8a1cdce5
AC
4439@item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4440@vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4441is called after the group buffer is
4442generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4443unnatural way.
e6d2d263 4444
8a1cdce5
AC
4445@item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4446@vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4447is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4448generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
e6d2d263 4449
8a1cdce5
AC
4450@item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4451@vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4452Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4453whether they are empty or not.
e6d2d263 4454
8a1cdce5 4455@end table
e6d2d263 4456
8a1cdce5
AC
4457@node Scanning New Messages
4458@subsection Scanning New Messages
4459@cindex new messages
4460@cindex scanning new news
e6d2d263 4461
8a1cdce5 4462@table @kbd
e6d2d263 4463
8a1cdce5
AC
4464@item g
4465@kindex g (Group)
4466@findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4467@c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4468Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4469this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4470(@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4471command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4472back end(s).
e6d2d263 4473
8a1cdce5
AC
4474@item M-g
4475@kindex M-g (Group)
4476@findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4477@vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4478@c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4479Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4480(@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4481@code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4482to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
e6d2d263 4483
8a1cdce5
AC
4484@findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4485@cindex activating groups
4486@item C-c M-g
4487@kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4488Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
e6d2d263 4489
8a1cdce5
AC
4490@item R
4491@kindex R (Group)
4492@cindex restarting
4493@findex gnus-group-restart
4494Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4495file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4496Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
e6d2d263 4497
8a1cdce5 4498@end table
e6d2d263 4499
8a1cdce5
AC
4500@vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4501@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
e6d2d263 4502
8a1cdce5
AC
4503@vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4504@code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4505news.
e6d2d263 4506
e6d2d263 4507
8a1cdce5
AC
4508@node Group Information
4509@subsection Group Information
4510@cindex group information
4511@cindex information on groups
e6d2d263 4512
8a1cdce5 4513@table @kbd
e6d2d263 4514
e6d2d263 4515
8a1cdce5
AC
4516@item H d
4517@itemx C-c C-d
4518@c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4519@kindex H d (Group)
4520@kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4521@cindex describing groups
4522@cindex group description
4523@findex gnus-group-describe-group
4524Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4525a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
2b968687 4526
8a1cdce5
AC
4527@item M-d
4528@kindex M-d (Group)
4529@findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4530Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4531prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
2b968687 4532
8a1cdce5
AC
4533@item H v
4534@itemx V
4535@kindex V (Group)
4536@kindex H v (Group)
4537@cindex version
4538@findex gnus-version
4539Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
2b968687 4540
8a1cdce5
AC
4541@item ?
4542@kindex ? (Group)
4543@findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4544Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
2b968687 4545
8a1cdce5
AC
4546@item C-c C-i
4547@kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4548@cindex info
4549@cindex manual
4550@findex gnus-info-find-node
4551Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4552@end table
e6d2d263 4553
e6d2d263 4554
8a1cdce5
AC
4555@node Group Timestamp
4556@subsection Group Timestamp
4557@cindex timestamps
4558@cindex group timestamps
e6d2d263 4559
8a1cdce5
AC
4560It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4561group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4562@code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
e6d2d263 4563
8a1cdce5
AC
4564@lisp
4565(add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4566@end lisp
e6d2d263 4567
8a1cdce5 4568After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
e6d2d263 4569
8a1cdce5
AC
4570This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4571use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
e6d2d263 4572
8a1cdce5
AC
4573@lisp
4574(setq gnus-group-line-format
4575 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4576@end lisp
e6d2d263 4577
8a1cdce5 4578This will result in lines looking like:
e6d2d263 4579
8a1cdce5
AC
4580@example
4581* 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4582 0: custom 19961002T012713
4583@end example
e6d2d263 4584
8a1cdce5
AC
4585As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4586may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4587something like:
e6d2d263 4588
8a1cdce5
AC
4589@lisp
4590(setq gnus-group-line-format
4591 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4592@end lisp
e6d2d263 4593
8a1cdce5
AC
4594If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4595user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4596trick:
e6d2d263 4597
8a1cdce5
AC
4598@lisp
4599(setq gnus-group-line-format
4600 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4601(defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4602 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4603 (if time
4604 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4605 "")))
4606@end lisp
e6d2d263 4607
71cca84d
G
4608To see what variables are dynamically bound (like
4609@code{gnus-tmp-group}), you have to look at the source code. The
4610variable names aren't guaranteed to be stable over Gnus versions,
4611either.
4612
e6d2d263 4613
8a1cdce5
AC
4614@node File Commands
4615@subsection File Commands
4616@cindex file commands
e6d2d263 4617
8a1cdce5 4618@table @kbd
e6d2d263 4619
8a1cdce5
AC
4620@item r
4621@kindex r (Group)
4622@findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4623@vindex gnus-init-file
4624@cindex reading init file
4625Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4626@file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
e6d2d263 4627
8a1cdce5
AC
4628@item s
4629@kindex s (Group)
4630@findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4631@cindex saving .newsrc
4632Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4633(@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4634file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
e6d2d263 4635
8a1cdce5
AC
4636@c @item Z
4637@c @kindex Z (Group)
4638@c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4639@c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
e6d2d263 4640
8a1cdce5 4641@end table
e6d2d263 4642
e6d2d263 4643
8a1cdce5
AC
4644@node Sieve Commands
4645@subsection Sieve Commands
4646@cindex group sieve commands
e6d2d263 4647
8a1cdce5
AC
4648Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4649the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4650sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4651commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
333f9019 4652script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
e6d2d263 4653
8a1cdce5
AC
4654@vindex gnus-sieve-file
4655@vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4656@vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4657The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4658default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4659between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4660@code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4661outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4662regenerate the Sieve script.
e6d2d263 4663
8a1cdce5
AC
4664@vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4665The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4666is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4667placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4668is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4669example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4670"owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4671code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4672@code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4673except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
e6d2d263 4674
8a1cdce5
AC
4675@example
4676if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4677 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4678 stop;
4679@}
4680@end example
e6d2d263 4681
8a1cdce5 4682@xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
e6d2d263
MB
4683
4684@table @kbd
4685
8a1cdce5
AC
4686@item D g
4687@kindex D g (Group)
4688@findex gnus-sieve-generate
4689@vindex gnus-sieve-file
4690@cindex generating sieve script
4691Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4692put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
e6d2d263 4693
8a1cdce5
AC
4694@item D u
4695@kindex D u (Group)
4696@findex gnus-sieve-update
4697@vindex gnus-sieve-file
4698@cindex updating sieve script
4699Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4700@code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4701server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
e6d2d263
MB
4702
4703@end table
4704
e6d2d263 4705
8a1cdce5
AC
4706@node Summary Buffer
4707@chapter Summary Buffer
4708@cindex summary buffer
e6d2d263 4709
8a1cdce5
AC
4710A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4711move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
e6d2d263 4712
8a1cdce5
AC
4713The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4714group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
e6d2d263 4715
8a1cdce5 4716You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
e6d2d263 4717
8a1cdce5
AC
4718You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4719customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4720available in Emacs.
e6d2d263 4721
8a1cdce5
AC
4722@kindex v (Summary)
4723@cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4724The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4725command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4726@lisp
4727(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4728@end lisp
e6d2d263 4729
8a1cdce5
AC
4730@menu
4731* Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4732* Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4733* Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4734* Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4735* Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4736* Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4737* Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4738* Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4739* Threading:: How threads are made.
4740* Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4741* Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4742* Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4743* Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4744* Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4745* Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4746* Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4747* Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4748* Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4749* MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4750* Charsets:: Character set issues.
4751* Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4752* Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4753* Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4754* Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4755* Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4756* Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4757* Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4758* Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4759 or reselecting the current group.
4760* Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4761* Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4762* Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4763* Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4764@end menu
e6d2d263 4765
e6d2d263 4766
8a1cdce5
AC
4767@node Summary Buffer Format
4768@section Summary Buffer Format
4769@cindex summary buffer format
e6d2d263 4770
8a1cdce5
AC
4771@iftex
4772@iflatex
4773\gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4774\put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4775\put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4776}
4777@end iflatex
4778@end iftex
e6d2d263 4779
8a1cdce5
AC
4780@menu
4781* Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4782* To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4783* Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4784* Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4785@end menu
e6d2d263 4786
8a1cdce5
AC
4787@findex mail-extract-address-components
4788@findex gnus-extract-address-components
4789@vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4790Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4791variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4792@code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4793@code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4794fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4795@code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4796slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4797cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
e6d2d263
MB
4798
4799@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
4800(setq gnus-extract-address-components
4801 'mail-extract-address-components)
e6d2d263
MB
4802@end lisp
4803
8a1cdce5
AC
4804@vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4805@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4806article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4807with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
e6d2d263 4808
e6d2d263 4809
8a1cdce5
AC
4810@node Summary Buffer Lines
4811@subsection Summary Buffer Lines
e6d2d263 4812
8a1cdce5
AC
4813@vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4814You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4815the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4816lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4817(@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
e6d2d263 4818
8a1cdce5
AC
4819There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4820the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4821performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4822possible to change this. Just write a new function
4823@code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4824@xref{Positioning Point}.
e6d2d263 4825
8a1cdce5 4826The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
e6d2d263 4827
8a1cdce5
AC
4828The following format specification characters and extended format
4829specification(s) are understood:
e6d2d263 4830
8a1cdce5
AC
4831@table @samp
4832@item N
4833Article number.
4834@item S
4835Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4836@code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4837@item s
4838Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4839had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4840(@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4841@item F
4842Full @code{From} header.
4843@item n
4844The name (from the @code{From} header).
4845@item f
4846The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4847From Newsgroups}).
4848@item a
4849The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4850spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4851@code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4852may be more thorough.
4853@item A
4854The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4855the @code{a} spec.
4856@item L
4857Number of lines in the article.
4858@item c
4859Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4860in some methods (like nnfolder).
4861@item k
4862Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4863for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4864@item I
4865Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4866@item B
4867A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4868lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
e6d2d263 4869
8a1cdce5
AC
4870@example
4871>
4872+->
4873| +->
4874| | \->
4875| | \->
4876| \->
4877+->
4878\->
4879@end example
e6d2d263 4880
8a1cdce5
AC
4881You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4882that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4883replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4884line-drawing glyphs.
4885@table @code
4886@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4887@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4888Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4889instead. The default is @samp{> }.
e6d2d263 4890
8a1cdce5
AC
4891@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4892@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4893Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4894@code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
e6d2d263 4895
8a1cdce5
AC
4896@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4897@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4898Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4899instead. The default is @samp{}.
030cca00 4900
8a1cdce5
AC
4901@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4902@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4903Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
030cca00 4904
8a1cdce5
AC
4905@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4906@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4907Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
e6d2d263 4908
8a1cdce5
AC
4909@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4910@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4911Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
e6d2d263 4912
8a1cdce5
AC
4913@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4914@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4915Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
e6d2d263 4916
8a1cdce5 4917@end table
030cca00 4918
8a1cdce5
AC
4919@item T
4920Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4921pushes everything after it off the screen).
4922@item [
4923Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4924for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4925@item ]
4926Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4927for adopted articles.
4928@item >
4929One space for each thread level.
4930@item <
4931Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4932@item U
4933Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
e6d2d263 4934
8a1cdce5
AC
4935@item R
4936This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4937mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4938or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
e6d2d263 4939
8a1cdce5
AC
4940@item i
4941Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4942@item z
4943@vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4944Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4945default level. If the difference between
4946@code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4947@code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4948@item V
4949Total thread score.
4950@item x
4951@code{Xref}.
4952@item D
4953@code{Date}.
4954@item d
4955The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4956@item o
4957The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4958@item M
4959@code{Message-ID}.
4960@item r
4961@code{References}.
4962@item t
4963Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4964down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4965@item e
4966An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4967article has any children.
4968@item P
4969The line number.
4970@item O
4971Download mark.
4972@item *
4973Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4974@item &user-date;
4975Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
c2f51e23 4976@code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
8a1cdce5
AC
4977@item u
4978User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4979be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4980@code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4981following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4982argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4983into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4984@end table
e6d2d263 4985
8a1cdce5
AC
4986Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4987@code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4988There can only be one such area.
e6d2d263 4989
8a1cdce5
AC
4990The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4991have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4992compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4993that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4994variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4995buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
e6d2d263 4996
8a1cdce5
AC
4997The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4998(Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
e6d2d263 4999
8a1cdce5 5000This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
e6d2d263 5001
4009494e 5002
8a1cdce5
AC
5003@node To From Newsgroups
5004@subsection To From Newsgroups
5005@cindex To
5006@cindex Newsgroups
4009494e 5007
8a1cdce5
AC
5008In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
5009isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
5010you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
5011headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
5012gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4009494e 5013
8a1cdce5
AC
5014@enumerate
5015@item
5016@vindex gnus-extra-headers
5017The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
5018@code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5019instance:
4009494e
GM
5020
5021@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
5022(setq gnus-extra-headers
5023 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4009494e
GM
5024@end lisp
5025
8a1cdce5
AC
5026This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5027storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4009494e 5028
8a1cdce5
AC
5029@item
5030@findex gnus-extra-header
5031The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5032@code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5033access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4009494e 5034
8a1cdce5
AC
5035@example
5036"%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5037@end example
4009494e 5038
8a1cdce5
AC
5039@item
5040@vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5041The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5042summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5043@code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5044@code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5045headers are used instead.
4009494e 5046
8a1cdce5
AC
5047To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5048has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5049@code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5050@samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5051customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5052@code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
4009494e 5053
8a1cdce5 5054@end enumerate
4009494e 5055
8a1cdce5
AC
5056@vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5057A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5058to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5059If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5060changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
1df7defd 5061and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g., nnml) to cause
8a1cdce5 5062regeneration.
01c52d31 5063
8a1cdce5
AC
5064@vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5065You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5066@code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5067@code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
01c52d31 5068
8a1cdce5
AC
5069In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5070@file{~/.gnus.el}:
4009494e 5071
8a1cdce5
AC
5072@lisp
5073(setq gnus-extra-headers
5074 '(To Newsgroups))
5075(setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5076(setq gnus-summary-line-format
5077 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5078(setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5079 "Your Name Here")
5080@end lisp
4009494e 5081
8a1cdce5
AC
5082(The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5083to fit your needs.)
4009494e 5084
8a1cdce5
AC
5085A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5086convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5087support:
4009494e 5088
8a1cdce5
AC
5089The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5090the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5091nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4009494e 5092
8a1cdce5
AC
5093@example
5094Newsgroups:full
5095@end example
4009494e 5096
8a1cdce5
AC
5097to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5098as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4009494e 5099
4009494e 5100
8a1cdce5
AC
5101@node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5102@subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4009494e 5103
8a1cdce5
AC
5104@vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5105You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5106Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5107like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5108
5109Here are the elements you can play with:
4009494e 5110
8a1cdce5
AC
5111@table @samp
5112@item G
5113Group name.
5114@item p
5115Unprefixed group name.
5116@item A
5117Current article number.
5118@item z
5119Current article score.
5120@item V
5121Gnus version.
5122@item U
5123Number of unread articles in this group.
5124@item e
5125Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5126summary buffer.
5127@item Z
5128A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5129either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5130articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5131and no unselected ones.
4009494e 5132@item g
8a1cdce5
AC
5133Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5134shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5135@item S
5136Subject of the current article.
5137@item u
5138User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5139@item s
5140Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5141@item d
5142Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5143@item t
5144Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5145@item r
5146Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5147@item E
5148Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5149@end table
4009494e 5150
4009494e 5151
8a1cdce5
AC
5152@node Summary Highlighting
5153@subsection Summary Highlighting
4009494e 5154
8a1cdce5
AC
5155@table @code
5156
5157@item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5158@vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5159This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5160highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5161@code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5162
5163@item gnus-summary-update-hook
5164@vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5165This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5166@code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5167
5168@item gnus-summary-selected-face
5169@vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5170This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5171highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4009494e 5172
8a1cdce5
AC
5173@item gnus-summary-highlight
5174@vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5175Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5176list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5177. @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5178italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5179to something like
5180@lisp
5181(((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5182 ((> score default) . bold))
5183@end lisp
5184As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5185@var{face} will be applied to the line.
4009494e
GM
5186@end table
5187
4009494e 5188
8a1cdce5
AC
5189@node Summary Maneuvering
5190@section Summary Maneuvering
5191@cindex summary movement
4009494e 5192
8a1cdce5
AC
5193All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5194behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4009494e 5195
8a1cdce5 5196None of these commands select articles.
4009494e
GM
5197
5198@table @kbd
8a1cdce5
AC
5199@item G M-n
5200@itemx M-n
5201@kindex M-n (Summary)
5202@kindex G M-n (Summary)
5203@findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5204Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5205(@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4009494e 5206
8a1cdce5
AC
5207@item G M-p
5208@itemx M-p
5209@kindex M-p (Summary)
5210@kindex G M-p (Summary)
5211@findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5212Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5213(@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4009494e 5214
8a1cdce5
AC
5215@item G g
5216@kindex G g (Summary)
5217@findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5218Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5219without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5220@end table
4009494e 5221
8a1cdce5
AC
5222If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5223can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5224buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5225to the group buffer.
4009494e 5226
8a1cdce5 5227Variables related to summary movement:
4009494e 5228
8a1cdce5 5229@table @code
4009494e 5230
8a1cdce5
AC
5231@vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5232@item gnus-auto-select-next
5233If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5234no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5235the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5236empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5237this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5238next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5239is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5240confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5241will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5242Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5243command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5244@pxref{Group Levels}.
4009494e 5245
8a1cdce5
AC
5246@item gnus-auto-select-same
5247@vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5248If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5249article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5250mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5251for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5252articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4009494e 5253
8a1cdce5 5254This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4009494e 5255
8a1cdce5
AC
5256@item gnus-summary-check-current
5257@vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5258If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5259to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5260Instead, they will choose the current article.
4009494e 5261
8a1cdce5
AC
5262@item gnus-auto-center-summary
5263@vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5264If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5265centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5266slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5267set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5268action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5269buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5270threads.
4009494e 5271
8a1cdce5
AC
5272This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5273the given number of lines from the top.
4009494e 5274
8a1cdce5
AC
5275@item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5276@vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5277If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5278@kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
4009494e 5279
8a1cdce5 5280@end table
4009494e 5281
4009494e 5282
8a1cdce5
AC
5283@node Choosing Articles
5284@section Choosing Articles
5285@cindex selecting articles
4009494e 5286
8a1cdce5
AC
5287@menu
5288* Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5289* Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5290@end menu
4009494e 5291
4009494e 5292
8a1cdce5
AC
5293@node Choosing Commands
5294@subsection Choosing Commands
4009494e 5295
8a1cdce5
AC
5296None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5297and they all select and display an article.
4009494e 5298
8a1cdce5
AC
5299If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5300@ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4009494e 5301
8a1cdce5
AC
5302@table @kbd
5303@item SPACE
5304@kindex SPACE (Summary)
5305@findex gnus-summary-next-page
5306Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5307unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4009494e 5308
8a1cdce5
AC
5309If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5310again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5311@kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
4009494e 5312
8a1cdce5
AC
5313@item G n
5314@itemx n
5315@kindex n (Summary)
5316@kindex G n (Summary)
5317@findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5318@c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5319Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
4009494e 5320
8a1cdce5
AC
5321@item G p
5322@itemx p
5323@kindex p (Summary)
5324@findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5325@c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5326Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
4009494e 5327
8a1cdce5
AC
5328@item G N
5329@itemx N
5330@kindex N (Summary)
5331@kindex G N (Summary)
5332@findex gnus-summary-next-article
5333Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
4009494e 5334
8a1cdce5
AC
5335@item G P
5336@itemx P
5337@kindex P (Summary)
5338@kindex G P (Summary)
5339@findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5340Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
4009494e 5341
8a1cdce5
AC
5342@item G C-n
5343@kindex G C-n (Summary)
5344@findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5345Go to the next article with the same subject
5346(@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
4009494e 5347
8a1cdce5
AC
5348@item G C-p
5349@kindex G C-p (Summary)
5350@findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5351Go to the previous article with the same subject
5352(@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
4009494e 5353
8a1cdce5
AC
5354@item G f
5355@itemx .
5356@kindex G f (Summary)
5357@kindex . (Summary)
5358@findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5359Go to the first unread article
5360(@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
4009494e 5361
8a1cdce5
AC
5362@item G b
5363@itemx ,
5364@kindex G b (Summary)
5365@kindex , (Summary)
5366@findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5367Go to the unread article with the highest score
5368(@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5369go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
4009494e 5370
8a1cdce5
AC
5371@item G l
5372@itemx l
5373@kindex l (Summary)
5374@kindex G l (Summary)
5375@findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5376Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
4009494e 5377
8a1cdce5
AC
5378@item G o
5379@kindex G o (Summary)
5380@findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5381@cindex history
5382@cindex article history
5383Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5384(@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5385command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5386history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5387For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5388@pxref{Article Backlog}.
4009494e 5389
8a1cdce5
AC
5390@item G j
5391@itemx j
5392@kindex j (Summary)
5393@kindex G j (Summary)
5394@findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5395Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5396article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
4009494e 5397
8a1cdce5 5398@end table
4009494e 5399
4009494e 5400
8a1cdce5
AC
5401@node Choosing Variables
5402@subsection Choosing Variables
4009494e 5403
8a1cdce5 5404Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
4009494e 5405
8a1cdce5
AC
5406@table @code
5407@item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5408@vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5409All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5410article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5411this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5412the server and display it in the article buffer.
4009494e 5413
8a1cdce5
AC
5414@item gnus-select-article-hook
5415@vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5416This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5417@code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5418you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5419hook will do so.
4009494e 5420
8a1cdce5
AC
5421@item gnus-mark-article-hook
5422@vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5423@findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5424@findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5425@findex gnus-unread-mark
5426This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5427be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5428@code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5429mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5430articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5431expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5432marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5433instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5434@code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
4009494e 5435
8a1cdce5 5436@end table
4009494e 5437
4009494e 5438
8a1cdce5
AC
5439@node Paging the Article
5440@section Scrolling the Article
5441@cindex article scrolling
4009494e 5442
8a1cdce5 5443@table @kbd
4009494e 5444
8a1cdce5
AC
5445@item SPACE
5446@kindex SPACE (Summary)
5447@findex gnus-summary-next-page
5448Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5449or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5450next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4009494e 5451
8a1cdce5
AC
5452@vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5453@vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5454If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5455the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5456skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5457what is considered uninteresting with
5458@code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5459pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
4009494e 5460
8a1cdce5
AC
5461@item DEL
5462@kindex DEL (Summary)
5463@findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5464Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
4009494e 5465
8a1cdce5
AC
5466@item RET
5467@kindex RET (Summary)
5468@findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5469Scroll the current article one line forward
5470(@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
4009494e 5471
8a1cdce5
AC
5472@item M-RET
5473@kindex M-RET (Summary)
5474@findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5475Scroll the current article one line backward
5476(@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
4009494e 5477
8a1cdce5
AC
5478@item A g
5479@itemx g
5480@kindex A g (Summary)
5481@kindex g (Summary)
5482@findex gnus-summary-show-article
5483@vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5484(Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5485given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5486came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5487g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5488treatment functions.
4009494e 5489
8a1cdce5
AC
5490@cindex charset, view article with different charset
5491If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5492@kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5493encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
4009494e
GM
5494
5495@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
5496(setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5497 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5498 (2 . big5)))
4009494e
GM
5499@end lisp
5500
8a1cdce5 5501then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
4009494e 5502
8a1cdce5
AC
5503@item A <
5504@itemx <
5505@kindex < (Summary)
5506@kindex A < (Summary)
5507@findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5508Scroll to the beginning of the article
5509(@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
4009494e 5510
8a1cdce5
AC
5511@item A >
5512@itemx >
5513@kindex > (Summary)
5514@kindex A > (Summary)
5515@findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5516Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
4009494e 5517
8a1cdce5
AC
5518@item A s
5519@itemx s
5520@kindex A s (Summary)
5521@kindex s (Summary)
5522@findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5523Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5524(@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
4009494e 5525
8a1cdce5
AC
5526@item h
5527@kindex h (Summary)
5528@findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5529Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
4009494e 5530
8a1cdce5 5531@end table
4009494e 5532
4009494e 5533
8a1cdce5
AC
5534@node Reply Followup and Post
5535@section Reply, Followup and Post
4009494e 5536
8a1cdce5
AC
5537@menu
5538* Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5539* Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5540* Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5541* Canceling and Superseding::
5542@end menu
4009494e 5543
4009494e 5544
8a1cdce5
AC
5545@node Summary Mail Commands
5546@subsection Summary Mail Commands
5547@cindex mail
5548@cindex composing mail
4009494e 5549
8a1cdce5 5550Commands for composing a mail message:
4009494e 5551
8a1cdce5 5552@table @kbd
4009494e 5553
8a1cdce5
AC
5554@item S r
5555@itemx r
5556@kindex S r (Summary)
5557@kindex r (Summary)
5558@findex gnus-summary-reply
5559@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5560@c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5561Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5562(@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
4009494e 5563
8a1cdce5
AC
5564@item S R
5565@itemx R
5566@kindex R (Summary)
5567@kindex S R (Summary)
5568@findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5569@c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5570Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5571original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5572command uses the process/prefix convention.
4009494e 5573
8a1cdce5
AC
5574@item S w
5575@kindex S w (Summary)
5576@findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5577Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5578(@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5579goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5580@code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5581present, that's used instead.
4009494e 5582
8a1cdce5
AC
5583@item S W
5584@kindex S W (Summary)
5585@findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5586Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5587message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5588the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5589first article to determine the recipients.
5590
60a0884e
G
5591@item S L
5592@kindex S L (Summary)
5593@findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5594When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5595message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5596(@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5597
8a1cdce5
AC
5598@item S v
5599@kindex S v (Summary)
5600@findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5601Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5602(@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5603that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5604@code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5605articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5606
5607@item S V
5608@kindex S V (Summary)
5609@findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5610Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5611original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5612command uses the process/prefix convention.
5613
5614@item S B r
5615@kindex S B r (Summary)
5616@findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5617Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5618@code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5619If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5620@code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5621the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5622correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5623
5624@item S B R
5625@kindex S B R (Summary)
5626@findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5627Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5628original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5629(@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5630
5631@item S o m
5632@itemx C-c C-f
5633@kindex S o m (Summary)
5634@kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5635@findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5636@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5637Forward the current article to some other person
5638(@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5639is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5640and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5641message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5642as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5643forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5644directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5645but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5646default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5647section.
5648
5649@item S m
5650@itemx m
5651@kindex m (Summary)
5652@kindex S m (Summary)
5653@findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5654@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5655Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5656the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5657If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5658
5659@item S i
5660@kindex S i (Summary)
5661@findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5662Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5663post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5664prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5665
5666This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5667This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5668sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5669in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5670for this to work though.
5671
5672@item S D b
5673@kindex S D b (Summary)
5674@findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5675@cindex bouncing mail
5676If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5677reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5678resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5679will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5680sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5681the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5682that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5683very well fail, though.
5684
5685@item S D r
5686@kindex S D r (Summary)
5687@findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5688Not to be confused with the previous command,
5689@code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5690send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5691headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5692@code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5693means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5694header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5695So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5696
5697This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5698ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5699@code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5700to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5701@code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5702
5703This command understands the process/prefix convention
5704(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5705
5706@item S D e
5707@kindex S D e (Summary)
5708@findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5709
5710Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5711if it were a new message before resending.
5712
5713@item S O m
5714@kindex S O m (Summary)
5715@findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5716Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5717result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5718uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5719
5720@item S M-c
5721@kindex S M-c (Summary)
5722@findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5723@cindex crossposting
5724@cindex excessive crossposting
5725Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5726current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5727
5728@findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5729This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5730crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5731using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5732command understands the process/prefix convention
5733(@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
4009494e 5734
4009494e
GM
5735@end table
5736
8a1cdce5
AC
5737Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5738Manual}, for more information.
4009494e 5739
4009494e 5740
8a1cdce5
AC
5741@node Summary Post Commands
5742@subsection Summary Post Commands
5743@cindex post
5744@cindex composing news
4009494e 5745
8a1cdce5 5746Commands for posting a news article:
4009494e 5747
8a1cdce5
AC
5748@table @kbd
5749@item S p
5750@itemx a
5751@kindex a (Summary)
5752@kindex S p (Summary)
5753@findex gnus-summary-post-news
5754@c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5755Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5756default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5757If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
4009494e 5758
8a1cdce5
AC
5759@item S f
5760@itemx f
5761@kindex f (Summary)
5762@kindex S f (Summary)
5763@findex gnus-summary-followup
5764@c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5765Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
4009494e 5766
8a1cdce5
AC
5767@item S F
5768@itemx F
5769@kindex S F (Summary)
5770@kindex F (Summary)
5771@c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5772@findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5773Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5774(@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5775process/prefix convention.
4009494e 5776
8a1cdce5
AC
5777@item S n
5778@kindex S n (Summary)
5779@findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5780Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5781message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5782
5783@item S N
5784@kindex S N (Summary)
5785@findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5786Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5787message through mail and include the original message
5788(@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5789the process/prefix convention.
5790
5791@item S o p
5792@kindex S o p (Summary)
5793@findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5794Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5795(@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5796 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5797of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5798(@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5799message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5800as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5801forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5802directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5803but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5804default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
4009494e 5805
8a1cdce5
AC
5806@item S O p
5807@kindex S O p (Summary)
5808@findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5809@cindex digests
5810@cindex making digests
5811Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5812(@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5813process/prefix convention.
4009494e 5814
8a1cdce5
AC
5815@item S u
5816@kindex S u (Summary)
5817@findex gnus-uu-post-news
5818@c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5819Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5820(@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5821@end table
4009494e 5822
8a1cdce5
AC
5823Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5824Manual}, for more information.
4009494e 5825
4009494e 5826
8a1cdce5
AC
5827@node Summary Message Commands
5828@subsection Summary Message Commands
4009494e 5829
8a1cdce5
AC
5830@table @kbd
5831@item S y
5832@kindex S y (Summary)
5833@findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5834Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5835buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5836what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5837process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
01c52d31 5838
8a1cdce5 5839@end table
4009494e 5840
4009494e 5841
8a1cdce5
AC
5842@node Canceling and Superseding
5843@subsection Canceling Articles
5844@cindex canceling articles
5845@cindex superseding articles
4009494e 5846
8a1cdce5
AC
5847Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5848really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
4009494e 5849
8a1cdce5 5850Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
4009494e 5851
8a1cdce5
AC
5852@findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5853@kindex C (Summary)
5854@c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5855Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5856articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5857c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5858canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5859This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 5860
8a1cdce5
AC
5861Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5862live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5863question.
4009494e 5864
8a1cdce5
AC
5865Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5866want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5867prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
4009494e 5868
8a1cdce5
AC
5869Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5870@code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5871message, Message Manual}).
4009494e 5872
8a1cdce5
AC
5873If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5874corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5875your original article.
4009494e 5876
8a1cdce5
AC
5877@findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5878@kindex S (Summary)
5879Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5880(@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5881where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5882usual way.
4009494e 5883
8a1cdce5
AC
5884The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5885sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5886have posted almost the same article twice.
4009494e 5887
8a1cdce5
AC
5888If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5889there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5890waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5891to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5892find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5893the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5894header by substituting one of those words for the word
5895@code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5896you would do normally. The previous article will be
5897canceled/superseded.
4009494e 5898
8a1cdce5 5899Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
4009494e 5900
8a1cdce5
AC
5901@node Delayed Articles
5902@section Delayed Articles
5903@cindex delayed sending
5904@cindex send delayed
5905
5906Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5907example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5908to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5909there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
4009494e 5910
8a1cdce5
AC
5911@lisp
5912(gnus-delay-initialize)
5913@end lisp
4009494e 5914
8a1cdce5
AC
5915@findex gnus-delay-article
5916Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5917Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5918(@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5919message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
4009494e 5920
8a1cdce5
AC
5921@itemize @bullet
5922@item
5923A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5924@code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5925(minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5926(months) and @code{Y} (years).
4009494e 5927
8a1cdce5
AC
5928@item
5929A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5930delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5931See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
4009494e 5932
8a1cdce5
AC
5933@item
5934A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5935stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5936already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5937o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5938is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5939that means a time tomorrow.
5940@end itemize
4009494e 5941
8a1cdce5
AC
5942The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5943couple of variables:
4009494e 5944
8a1cdce5
AC
5945@table @code
5946@item gnus-delay-default-hour
5947@vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5948When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5949on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
4009494e 5950
8a1cdce5
AC
5951@item gnus-delay-default-delay
5952@vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5953This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5954formats described above.
4009494e 5955
8a1cdce5
AC
5956@item gnus-delay-group
5957@vindex gnus-delay-group
5958Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5959they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5960value is @code{"delayed"}.
4009494e 5961
8a1cdce5
AC
5962@item gnus-delay-header
5963@vindex gnus-delay-header
5964The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5965is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5966change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5967@end table
4009494e 5968
8a1cdce5
AC
5969The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5970@code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5971calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5972@code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5973@code{nndraft:delayed} group.
4009494e 5974
8a1cdce5
AC
5975@findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5976And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5977which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5978function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5979@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5980Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5981execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
4009494e 5982
8a1cdce5
AC
5983@table @code
5984@item gnus-delay-initialize
5985@findex gnus-delay-initialize
5986By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5987@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5988argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5989@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5990argument is ignored.
4009494e 5991
8a1cdce5
AC
5992For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5993Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5994Just don't forget to set that up :-)
4009494e
GM
5995@end table
5996
8a1cdce5
AC
5997When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
5998automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
5999many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
6000time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
6001@code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
4009494e 6002
4009494e 6003
8a1cdce5
AC
6004@node Marking Articles
6005@section Marking Articles
6006@cindex article marking
6007@cindex article ticking
6008@cindex marks
4009494e 6009
8a1cdce5 6010There are several marks you can set on an article.
4009494e 6011
8a1cdce5
AC
6012You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
6013neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
6014@dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
4009494e 6015
8a1cdce5 6016In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
4009494e 6017
8a1cdce5
AC
6018@ifinfo
6019There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6020@end ifinfo
4009494e 6021
8a1cdce5
AC
6022@menu
6023* Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6024* Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6025* Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6026* Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6027* Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6028* Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6029@end menu
4009494e 6030
4009494e 6031
8a1cdce5
AC
6032@node Unread Articles
6033@subsection Unread Articles
85115796 6034
8a1cdce5
AC
6035The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6036other.
4009494e 6037
8a1cdce5
AC
6038@table @samp
6039@item !
6040@vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6041Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
4009494e 6042
8a1cdce5
AC
6043@dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6044you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6045reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6046tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6047news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6048you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6049(@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
4009494e 6050
8a1cdce5
AC
6051@item ?
6052@vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6053Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
4009494e 6054
8a1cdce5
AC
6055@dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6056are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6057followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6058Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6059messages.
4009494e 6060
8a1cdce5
AC
6061@item SPACE
6062@vindex gnus-unread-mark
6063Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
4009494e 6064
8a1cdce5
AC
6065@dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6066@end table
4009494e 6067
4009494e 6068
8a1cdce5
AC
6069@node Read Articles
6070@subsection Read Articles
6071@cindex expirable mark
4009494e 6072
8a1cdce5 6073All the following marks mark articles as read.
4009494e 6074
8a1cdce5 6075@table @samp
4009494e 6076
8a1cdce5
AC
6077@item r
6078@vindex gnus-del-mark
6079These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6080command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
4009494e 6081
8a1cdce5
AC
6082@item R
6083@vindex gnus-read-mark
6084Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
4009494e 6085
8a1cdce5
AC
6086@item O
6087@vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6088Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6089@dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
4009494e 6090
8a1cdce5
AC
6091@item K
6092@vindex gnus-killed-mark
6093Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
4009494e 6094
8a1cdce5
AC
6095@item X
6096@vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6097Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
4009494e 6098
8a1cdce5
AC
6099@item Y
6100@vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6101Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
4009494e 6102
8a1cdce5
AC
6103@item C
6104@vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6105Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
4009494e 6106
8a1cdce5
AC
6107@item G
6108@vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6109Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
4009494e 6110
8a1cdce5
AC
6111@item Q
6112@vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6113Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6114Threading}.
4009494e 6115
8a1cdce5
AC
6116@item M
6117@vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6118Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6119(@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
4009494e
GM
6120
6121@end table
6122
8a1cdce5
AC
6123All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6124They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
4009494e 6125
8a1cdce5 6126One more special mark, though:
4009494e 6127
8a1cdce5
AC
6128@table @samp
6129@item E
6130@vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6131Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
4009494e 6132
8a1cdce5
AC
6133Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6134automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6135control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6136articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6137any time.
6138@end table
4009494e 6139
4009494e 6140
8a1cdce5
AC
6141@node Other Marks
6142@subsection Other Marks
6143@cindex process mark
6144@cindex bookmarks
4009494e 6145
8a1cdce5
AC
6146There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6147read or not.
4009494e 6148
8a1cdce5 6149@itemize @bullet
4009494e 6150
8a1cdce5
AC
6151@item
6152You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6153long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6154before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6155in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6156encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
4009494e 6157
8a1cdce5
AC
6158@item
6159@vindex gnus-replied-mark
6160All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6161answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6162(@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
4009494e 6163
8a1cdce5
AC
6164@item
6165@vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6166All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6167the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
4009494e 6168
8a1cdce5
AC
6169@item
6170@vindex gnus-cached-mark
6171Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6172the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
4009494e 6173
8a1cdce5
AC
6174@item
6175@vindex gnus-saved-mark
6176Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6177religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6178(@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
4009494e 6179
8a1cdce5
AC
6180@item
6181@vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6182Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6183with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
4009494e 6184
8a1cdce5
AC
6185@item
6186@vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6187When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6188downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6189@samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6190(The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6191use.)
4009494e 6192
8a1cdce5
AC
6193@item
6194@vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6195When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6196not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6197are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6198articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6199@code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
4009494e 6200
8a1cdce5
AC
6201@item
6202@vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6203The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6204automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6205download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6206explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6207(The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6208use.)
4009494e 6209
8a1cdce5
AC
6210@item
6211@vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6212@vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6213If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6214marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6215@code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
4009494e 6216
8a1cdce5
AC
6217@item
6218@vindex gnus-process-mark
6219Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6220variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6221instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6222all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6223marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
4009494e 6224
8a1cdce5 6225@end itemize
4009494e 6226
8a1cdce5
AC
6227You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6228appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6229replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
4009494e 6230
8a1cdce5
AC
6231Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6232replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6233you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
4009494e 6234
4009494e 6235
8a1cdce5
AC
6236@node Setting Marks
6237@subsection Setting Marks
6238@cindex setting marks
6239
6240All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
4009494e 6241
8a1cdce5
AC
6242@table @kbd
6243@item M c
6244@itemx M-u
6245@kindex M c (Summary)
6246@kindex M-u (Summary)
6247@findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6248@cindex mark as unread
6249Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6250(@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6251article as unread.
4009494e 6252
8a1cdce5
AC
6253@item M t
6254@itemx !
6255@kindex ! (Summary)
6256@kindex M t (Summary)
6257@findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6258Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6259@xref{Article Caching}.
4009494e 6260
8a1cdce5
AC
6261@item M ?
6262@itemx ?
6263@kindex ? (Summary)
6264@kindex M ? (Summary)
6265@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6266Mark the current article as dormant
6267(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
4009494e 6268
8a1cdce5
AC
6269@item M d
6270@itemx d
6271@kindex M d (Summary)
6272@kindex d (Summary)
6273@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6274Mark the current article as read
6275(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
4009494e 6276
8a1cdce5
AC
6277@item D
6278@kindex D (Summary)
6279@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6280Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6281(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
4009494e 6282
8a1cdce5
AC
6283@item M k
6284@itemx k
6285@kindex k (Summary)
6286@kindex M k (Summary)
6287@findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6288Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6289and then select the next unread article
6290(@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
4009494e 6291
8a1cdce5
AC
6292@item M K
6293@itemx C-k
6294@kindex M K (Summary)
6295@kindex C-k (Summary)
6296@findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6297Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6298(@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
4009494e 6299
8a1cdce5
AC
6300@item M C
6301@kindex M C (Summary)
6302@findex gnus-summary-catchup
6303@c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6304Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
4009494e 6305
8a1cdce5
AC
6306@item M C-c
6307@kindex M C-c (Summary)
6308@findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6309Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6310articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
4009494e 6311
8a1cdce5
AC
6312@item M H
6313@kindex M H (Summary)
6314@findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6315Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6316(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
4009494e 6317
8a1cdce5
AC
6318@item M h
6319@kindex M h (Summary)
6320@findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6321Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6322(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
4009494e 6323
8a1cdce5
AC
6324@item C-w
6325@kindex C-w (Summary)
6326@findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6327Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6328(@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
4009494e 6329
8a1cdce5
AC
6330@item M V k
6331@kindex M V k (Summary)
6332@findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6333Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6334numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
4009494e 6335
8a1cdce5
AC
6336@item M e
6337@itemx E
6338@kindex M e (Summary)
6339@kindex E (Summary)
6340@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6341Mark the current article as expirable
6342(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
4009494e 6343
8a1cdce5
AC
6344@item M b
6345@kindex M b (Summary)
6346@findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6347Set a bookmark in the current article
6348(@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
4009494e 6349
8a1cdce5
AC
6350@item M B
6351@kindex M B (Summary)
6352@findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6353Remove the bookmark from the current article
6354(@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
4009494e 6355
8a1cdce5
AC
6356@item M V c
6357@kindex M V c (Summary)
6358@findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6359Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6360over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
4009494e 6361
8a1cdce5
AC
6362@item M V u
6363@kindex M V u (Summary)
6364@findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6365Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6366numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
4009494e 6367
8a1cdce5
AC
6368@item M V m
6369@kindex M V m (Summary)
6370@findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6371Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6372score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6373(@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6374@end table
4009494e 6375
8a1cdce5
AC
6376@vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6377The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6378be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6379the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6380one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6381@code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6382@kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6383The default is @code{t}.
4009494e 6384
4009494e 6385
8a1cdce5
AC
6386@node Generic Marking Commands
6387@subsection Generic Marking Commands
4009494e 6388
6ed7a66a
G
6389Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) to
6390go to the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6391article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article.
6392And even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
8a1cdce5
AC
6393previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6394well.
4009494e 6395
8a1cdce5
AC
6396Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6397you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6398command should do.
4009494e 6399
8a1cdce5
AC
6400To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6401different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6402buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6403to list in this manual.
4009494e 6404
8a1cdce5
AC
6405While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6406altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6407@kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6408article, you could say something like:
4009494e 6409
8a1cdce5
AC
6410@lisp
6411@group
6412(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6413(defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6414 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6415@end group
6416@end lisp
4009494e 6417
8a1cdce5
AC
6418@noindent
6419or
4009494e 6420
8a1cdce5
AC
6421@lisp
6422(defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6423 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6424@end lisp
4009494e
GM
6425
6426
8a1cdce5
AC
6427@node Setting Process Marks
6428@subsection Setting Process Marks
6429@cindex setting process marks
4009494e 6430
8a1cdce5
AC
6431Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6432used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6433process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6434articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6435articles into the cache. For more information,
6436@pxref{Process/Prefix}.
4009494e
GM
6437
6438@table @kbd
4009494e 6439
8a1cdce5
AC
6440@item M P p
6441@itemx #
6442@kindex # (Summary)
6443@kindex M P p (Summary)
6444@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6445Mark the current article with the process mark
6446(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6447@findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
4009494e 6448
8a1cdce5
AC
6449@item M P u
6450@itemx M-#
6451@kindex M P u (Summary)
6452@kindex M-# (Summary)
6453Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6454(@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
4009494e 6455
8a1cdce5
AC
6456@item M P U
6457@kindex M P U (Summary)
6458@findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6459Remove the process mark from all articles
6460(@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
4009494e 6461
8a1cdce5
AC
6462@item M P i
6463@kindex M P i (Summary)
6464@findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6465Invert the list of process marked articles
6466(@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
4009494e 6467
8a1cdce5
AC
6468@item M P R
6469@kindex M P R (Summary)
6470@findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6471Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6472expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
4009494e 6473
8a1cdce5
AC
6474@item M P G
6475@kindex M P G (Summary)
6476@findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6477Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6478expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
4009494e 6479
8a1cdce5
AC
6480@item M P r
6481@kindex M P r (Summary)
6482@findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6483Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
4009494e 6484
8a1cdce5
AC
6485@item M P g
6486@kindex M P g (Summary)
6487@findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6488Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
4009494e 6489
8a1cdce5
AC
6490@item M P t
6491@kindex M P t (Summary)
6492@findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6493Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6494(@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
4009494e 6495
8a1cdce5
AC
6496@item M P T
6497@kindex M P T (Summary)
6498@findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6499Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6500(@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
4009494e 6501
8a1cdce5
AC
6502@item M P v
6503@kindex M P v (Summary)
6504@findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6505Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6506(@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
4009494e 6507
8a1cdce5
AC
6508@item M P s
6509@kindex M P s (Summary)
6510@findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6511Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
4009494e 6512
8a1cdce5
AC
6513@item M P S
6514@kindex M P S (Summary)
6515@findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6516Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6517(@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
4009494e 6518
8a1cdce5
AC
6519@item M P a
6520@kindex M P a (Summary)
6521@findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6522Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6523
6524@item M P b
6525@kindex M P b (Summary)
6526@findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6527Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6528(@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6529
6530@item M P k
6531@kindex M P k (Summary)
6532@findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6533Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6534(@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6535
6536@item M P y
6537@kindex M P y (Summary)
6538@findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6539Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6540(@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
4009494e 6541
8a1cdce5
AC
6542@item M P w
6543@kindex M P w (Summary)
6544@findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6545Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6546(@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
4009494e 6547
8a1cdce5 6548@end table
4009494e 6549
8a1cdce5
AC
6550Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6551set process marks based on article body contents.
4009494e 6552
4009494e 6553
8a1cdce5
AC
6554@node Limiting
6555@section Limiting
6556@cindex limiting
4009494e 6557
8a1cdce5
AC
6558It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6559subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6560commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6561buffer.
4009494e 6562
8a1cdce5
AC
6563Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6564the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6565articles.
4009494e 6566
8a1cdce5 6567@table @kbd
4009494e 6568
8a1cdce5
AC
6569@item / /
6570@itemx / s
6571@kindex / / (Summary)
6572@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6573Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6574(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6575matching articles.
4009494e 6576
8a1cdce5
AC
6577@item / a
6578@kindex / a (Summary)
6579@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6580Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6581(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6582matching articles.
4009494e 6583
8a1cdce5
AC
6584@item / R
6585@kindex / R (Summary)
6586@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6587Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6588(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6589matching articles.
4009494e 6590
8a1cdce5
AC
6591@item / A
6592@kindex / A (Summary)
6593@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6594Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6595header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6596given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
4009494e 6597
8a1cdce5
AC
6598@item / S
6599@kindex / S (Summary)
6600@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6601Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6602threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6603limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
4009494e 6604
8a1cdce5
AC
6605@item / x
6606@kindex / x (Summary)
6607@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6608Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6609headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6610(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6611matching articles.
4009494e 6612
8a1cdce5
AC
6613@item / u
6614@itemx x
6615@kindex / u (Summary)
6616@kindex x (Summary)
6617@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6618Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6619(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6620buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6621dormant articles will also be excluded.
4009494e 6622
8a1cdce5
AC
6623@item / m
6624@kindex / m (Summary)
6625@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6626Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6627with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
4009494e 6628
8a1cdce5
AC
6629@item / t
6630@kindex / t (Summary)
6631@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6632Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6633(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6634articles younger than that number of days.
4009494e 6635
8a1cdce5
AC
6636@item / n
6637@kindex / n (Summary)
6638@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6639With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6640articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6641instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
4009494e 6642
8a1cdce5
AC
6643@item / w
6644@kindex / w (Summary)
6645@findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6646Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6647(@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6648the stack.
4009494e 6649
8a1cdce5
AC
6650@item / .
6651@kindex / . (Summary)
6652@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6653Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6654(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
4009494e 6655
8a1cdce5
AC
6656@item / v
6657@kindex / v (Summary)
6658@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6659Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6660score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
4009494e 6661
8a1cdce5
AC
6662@item / p
6663@kindex / p (Summary)
6664@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6665Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6666group parameter predicate
6667(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6668Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
4009494e 6669
8a1cdce5
AC
6670@item / r
6671@kindex / r (Summary)
6672@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6673Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6674(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6675replied articles.
4009494e 6676
8a1cdce5
AC
6677@item / E
6678@itemx M S
6679@kindex M S (Summary)
6680@kindex / E (Summary)
6681@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6682Include all expunged articles in the limit
6683(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
4009494e 6684
8a1cdce5
AC
6685@item / D
6686@kindex / D (Summary)
6687@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6688Include all dormant articles in the limit
6689(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
4009494e 6690
8a1cdce5
AC
6691@item / *
6692@kindex / * (Summary)
6693@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6694Include all cached articles in the limit
6695(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
4009494e 6696
8a1cdce5
AC
6697@item / d
6698@kindex / d (Summary)
6699@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6700Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6701(@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
4009494e 6702
8a1cdce5
AC
6703@item / M
6704@kindex / M (Summary)
6705@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6706Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
e7842e69 6707
8a1cdce5
AC
6708@item / T
6709@kindex / T (Summary)
6710@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6711Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
4009494e 6712
8a1cdce5
AC
6713@item / c
6714@kindex / c (Summary)
6715@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6716Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6717(@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
4009494e 6718
8a1cdce5
AC
6719@item / C
6720@kindex / C (Summary)
6721@findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6722Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6723(@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6724also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
4009494e 6725
8a1cdce5
AC
6726@item / b
6727@kindex / b (Summary)
6728@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6729Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6730certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6731prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6732requires selecting each article to find the matches.
4009494e 6733
8a1cdce5
AC
6734@item / h
6735@kindex / h (Summary)
6736@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6737Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6738(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
4009494e 6739
8a1cdce5 6740@end table
4009494e 6741
4009494e 6742
8a1cdce5
AC
6743The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6744prefix as well.
4009494e 6745
8a1cdce5
AC
6746@table @kbd
6747@item / N
6748@kindex / N (Summary)
6749@findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6750Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6751if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
4009494e 6752
8a1cdce5
AC
6753@item / o
6754@kindex / o (Summary)
6755@findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6756Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6757prefix, fetch this number of articles.
4009494e 6758
8a1cdce5 6759@end table
4009494e 6760
4009494e 6761
8a1cdce5
AC
6762@node Threading
6763@section Threading
6764@cindex threading
6765@cindex article threading
4009494e 6766
8a1cdce5
AC
6767Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6768to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6769hierarchical fashion.
4009494e 6770
8a1cdce5
AC
6771Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6772articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6773trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6774or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6775so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6776plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6777@ref{Customizing Threading}.
4009494e 6778
8a1cdce5 6779First, a quick overview of the concepts:
4009494e 6780
8a1cdce5
AC
6781@table @dfn
6782@item root
6783The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
4009494e 6784
8a1cdce5
AC
6785@item thread
6786A tree-like article structure.
4009494e 6787
8a1cdce5
AC
6788@item sub-thread
6789A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
4009494e 6790
8a1cdce5
AC
6791@item loose threads
6792Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6793already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6794summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6795belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6796called loose threads.
4009494e 6797
8a1cdce5
AC
6798@item thread gathering
6799An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
4009494e 6800
8a1cdce5
AC
6801@item sparse threads
6802A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6803displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
4009494e 6804
8a1cdce5 6805@end table
4009494e 6806
4009494e 6807
8a1cdce5
AC
6808@menu
6809* Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6810* Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6811@end menu
4009494e 6812
4009494e 6813
8a1cdce5
AC
6814@node Customizing Threading
6815@subsection Customizing Threading
6816@cindex customizing threading
4009494e 6817
8a1cdce5
AC
6818@menu
6819* Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6820* Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6821* More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6822* Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6823@end menu
4009494e 6824
4009494e 6825
8a1cdce5
AC
6826@node Loose Threads
6827@subsubsection Loose Threads
6828@cindex <
6829@cindex >
6830@cindex loose threads
4009494e 6831
8a1cdce5
AC
6832@table @code
6833@item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6834@vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6835If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6836and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6837Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6838read or killed the root in a previous session.
4009494e 6839
8a1cdce5
AC
6840When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6841something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6842There are four possible values:
4009494e 6843
8a1cdce5
AC
6844@iftex
6845@iflatex
6846\gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6847\put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6848\put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6849\put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6850\put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6851}
6852@end iflatex
6853@end iftex
4009494e 6854
8a1cdce5 6855@cindex adopting articles
4009494e 6856
8a1cdce5 6857@table @code
4009494e 6858
8a1cdce5
AC
6859@item adopt
6860Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6861parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6862marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6863square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
4009494e 6864
8a1cdce5
AC
6865@item dummy
6866@vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6867@vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6868Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6869parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6870selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6871article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6872format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6873which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6874If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6875ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
4009494e 6876
8a1cdce5
AC
6877@item empty
6878Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6879subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6880use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6881Buffer Format}).)
4009494e 6882
8a1cdce5
AC
6883@item none
6884Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6885display them after one another.
4009494e 6886
8a1cdce5
AC
6887@item nil
6888Don't gather loose threads.
6889@end table
4009494e 6890
8a1cdce5
AC
6891@item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6892@vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6893Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6894variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6895subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6896super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6897presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6898you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6899first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6900variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6901everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
4009494e 6902
8a1cdce5
AC
6903@cindex fuzzy article gathering
6904If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6905use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6906Matching}).
4009494e 6907
8a1cdce5
AC
6908@item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6909@vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6910This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6911that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6912simplification is used.
4009494e 6913
8a1cdce5
AC
6914@item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6915@vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6916If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6917as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
4009494e 6918
8a1cdce5
AC
6919@c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6920@lisp
6921(setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6922 (concat
6923 "\\`\\[?\\("
6924 (mapconcat
6925 'identity
6926 '("looking"
6927 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6928 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6929 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6930 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6931 ;; ...
6932 )
6933 "\\|")
6934 "\\)\\s *\\("
6935 (mapconcat 'identity
6936 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6937 "\\|")
6938 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6939@end lisp
4009494e 6940
8a1cdce5
AC
6941All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6942subjects.
4009494e 6943
8a1cdce5
AC
6944@item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6945@vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6946If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6947@code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6948list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6949arrive at the simplified version of the string.
4009494e 6950
8a1cdce5 6951Useful functions to put in this list include:
4009494e 6952
8a1cdce5
AC
6953@table @code
6954@item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6955@findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6956Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
4009494e 6957
8a1cdce5
AC
6958@item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6959@findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6960Simplify fuzzily.
4009494e 6961
8a1cdce5
AC
6962@item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6963@findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6964Remove excessive whitespace.
4009494e 6965
8a1cdce5
AC
6966@item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6967@findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6968Remove all whitespace.
6969@end table
4009494e 6970
8a1cdce5 6971You may also write your own functions, of course.
4009494e 6972
4009494e 6973
8a1cdce5
AC
6974@item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6975@vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6976Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6977to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6978@samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6979you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6980what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6981The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
4009494e 6982
8a1cdce5
AC
6983@item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6984@vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6985Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6986that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6987is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6988@code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6989This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6990articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6991newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6992cholera:
4009494e 6993
8a1cdce5
AC
6994@table @code
6995@item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6996@findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6997This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6998@code{Subject}s exclusively.
4009494e 6999
8a1cdce5
AC
7000@item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7001@findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7002This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
7003@end table
4009494e 7004
8a1cdce5
AC
7005If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
7006something like:
4009494e 7007
8a1cdce5
AC
7008@lisp
7009(setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7010 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
7011@end lisp
4009494e 7012
8a1cdce5 7013@end table
4009494e 7014
4009494e 7015
8a1cdce5
AC
7016@node Filling In Threads
7017@subsubsection Filling In Threads
4009494e 7018
8a1cdce5
AC
7019@table @code
7020@item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7021@vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7022If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7023more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7024like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7025many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7026@code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7027number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7028old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7029files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7030@code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7031the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7032do about that.
4009494e 7033
8a1cdce5
AC
7034This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7035visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7036(@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
4009494e 7037
8a1cdce5 7038The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
4009494e 7039
8a1cdce5
AC
7040@cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7041This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7042cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7043that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7044slow summary generation.
4009494e 7045
8a1cdce5
AC
7046@item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7047@vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7048Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7049newsgroups.
4009494e 7050
8a1cdce5
AC
7051@item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7052@vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7053Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7054gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7055the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7056together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7057@dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7058is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7059lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7060question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7061``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7062thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7063off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7064@code{nil} by default.
4009494e 7065
8a1cdce5
AC
7066@item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7067@vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7068This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7069intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7070quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7071go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7072web-based groups.
4009494e 7073
8a1cdce5
AC
7074If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7075@code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7076that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
4009494e 7077
8a1cdce5 7078@end table
4009494e 7079
4009494e 7080
8a1cdce5
AC
7081@node More Threading
7082@subsubsection More Threading
4009494e 7083
8a1cdce5
AC
7084@table @code
7085@item gnus-show-threads
7086@vindex gnus-show-threads
7087If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7088the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7089off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7090slower and more awkward.
4009494e 7091
8a1cdce5
AC
7092@item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7093@vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7094If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7095generated.
4009494e 7096
8a1cdce5
AC
7097This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7098Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7099@code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
4009494e 7100
8a1cdce5 7101Here's an example:
4009494e 7102
8a1cdce5
AC
7103@lisp
7104(setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7105 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7106 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7107@end lisp
4009494e 7108
8a1cdce5
AC
7109(It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7110unread, but you get my drift.)
4009494e 7111
4009494e 7112
8a1cdce5
AC
7113@item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7114@vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7115All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7116@code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7117expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7118threads are expunged.
4009494e 7119
8a1cdce5
AC
7120@item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7121@vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7122if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7123will be hidden.
4009494e 7124
8a1cdce5
AC
7125@item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7126@vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7127Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7128this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7129change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7130result in a new thread.
4009494e 7131
8a1cdce5
AC
7132@item gnus-thread-indent-level
7133@vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7134This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7135The default is 4.
4009494e 7136
8a1cdce5
AC
7137@item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7138@vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7139Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7140arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7141arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7142using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7143up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7144Setting this variable to an alternate value
1df7defd
PE
7145(e.g., @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7146appropriate hook (e.g., @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
8a1cdce5 7147more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
4009494e 7148
8a1cdce5 7149@end table
4009494e 7150
4009494e 7151
8a1cdce5
AC
7152@node Low-Level Threading
7153@subsubsection Low-Level Threading
4009494e 7154
8a1cdce5 7155@table @code
4009494e 7156
8a1cdce5
AC
7157@item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7158@vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7159Hook run before parsing any headers.
4009494e 7160
8a1cdce5
AC
7161@item gnus-alter-header-function
7162@vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7163If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7164article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7165the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7166if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7167in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7168variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7169meaningful. Here's one example:
4009494e 7170
8a1cdce5
AC
7171@lisp
7172(setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7173
7174(defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7175 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7176 (when (string-match
7177 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7178 (mail-header-set-id
7179 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7180 header))))
7181@end lisp
4009494e 7182
8a1cdce5 7183@end table
4009494e 7184
4009494e 7185
8a1cdce5
AC
7186@node Thread Commands
7187@subsection Thread Commands
7188@cindex thread commands
4009494e 7189
8a1cdce5 7190@table @kbd
4009494e 7191
8a1cdce5
AC
7192@item T k
7193@itemx C-M-k
7194@kindex T k (Summary)
7195@kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7196@findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7197Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7198(@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7199remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7200articles instead.
4009494e 7201
8a1cdce5
AC
7202@item T l
7203@itemx C-M-l
7204@kindex T l (Summary)
7205@kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7206@findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7207Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7208(@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7209
7210@item T i
7211@kindex T i (Summary)
7212@findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7213Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7214(@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7215
7216@item T #
7217@kindex T # (Summary)
4009494e 7218@findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
8a1cdce5 7219Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
4009494e
GM
7220(@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7221
8a1cdce5
AC
7222@item T M-#
7223@kindex T M-# (Summary)
4009494e 7224@findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
8a1cdce5 7225Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
4009494e
GM
7226(@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7227
8a1cdce5
AC
7228@item T T
7229@kindex T T (Summary)
7230@findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7231Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
4009494e 7232
8a1cdce5
AC
7233@item T s
7234@kindex T s (Summary)
7235@findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7236Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7237(@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
4009494e 7238
8a1cdce5
AC
7239@item T h
7240@kindex T h (Summary)
7241@findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7242Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
4009494e 7243
8a1cdce5
AC
7244@item T S
7245@kindex T S (Summary)
7246@findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7247Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
4009494e 7248
8a1cdce5
AC
7249@item T H
7250@kindex T H (Summary)
7251@findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7252Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
4009494e 7253
8a1cdce5
AC
7254@item T t
7255@kindex T t (Summary)
7256@findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7257Re-thread the current article's thread
7258(@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7259summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
4009494e 7260
8a1cdce5
AC
7261@item T ^
7262@kindex T ^ (Summary)
7263@findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7264Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7265(@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
4009494e 7266
8a1cdce5
AC
7267@item T M-^
7268@kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7269@findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7270Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7271(@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
4009494e
GM
7272
7273@end table
7274
8a1cdce5
AC
7275The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7276understand the numeric prefix.
4009494e
GM
7277
7278@table @kbd
7279
8a1cdce5
AC
7280@item T n
7281@kindex T n (Summary)
7282@itemx C-M-f
7283@kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7284@itemx M-down
7285@kindex M-down (Summary)
7286@findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7287Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
01c52d31 7288
8a1cdce5
AC
7289@item T p
7290@kindex T p (Summary)
7291@itemx C-M-b
7292@kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7293@itemx M-up
7294@kindex M-up (Summary)
7295@findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7296Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
01c52d31 7297
8a1cdce5
AC
7298@item T d
7299@kindex T d (Summary)
7300@findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7301Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
4009494e 7302
8a1cdce5
AC
7303@item T u
7304@kindex T u (Summary)
7305@findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7306Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
4009494e 7307
8a1cdce5
AC
7308@item T o
7309@kindex T o (Summary)
7310@findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7311Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7312@end table
4009494e 7313
8a1cdce5
AC
7314@vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7315If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7316threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7317a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7318wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7319have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7320you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7321is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7322when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7323the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7324operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7325that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7326Matching}).
4009494e 7327
4009494e 7328
8a1cdce5
AC
7329@node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7330@section Sorting the Summary Buffer
4009494e 7331
8a1cdce5
AC
7332@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7333@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7334@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7335@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7336@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7337@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7338@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7339@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7340@vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7341@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7342@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7343If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7344setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7345function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7346@code{(not some-function)} elements.
4009494e 7347
8a1cdce5
AC
7348By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7349predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7350@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7351@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7352@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7353@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7354@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7355@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7356@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7357@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
4009494e 7358
8a1cdce5
AC
7359Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7360thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
c2f51e23
G
7361normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7362to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7363@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
4009494e 7364
8a1cdce5
AC
7365If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7366last function in the list. You should probably always include
7367@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7368functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7369equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7370ascending article order.
01c52d31 7371
8a1cdce5
AC
7372If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7373by number, you could do something like:
4009494e 7374
8a1cdce5
AC
7375@lisp
7376(setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7377 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7378 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7379 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7380@end lisp
4009494e 7381
8a1cdce5
AC
7382The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7383summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7384alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7385subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7386which the articles arrived.
4009494e 7387
8a1cdce5
AC
7388If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7389say something like:
4009494e 7390
8a1cdce5
AC
7391@lisp
7392(setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7393 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7394 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7395@end lisp
4009494e 7396
13afd560
TH
7397By default, threads are sorted recursively, that is, first the roots,
7398then all subthreads, and so on. If you feel more like sorting only
7399the roots, so that inside a thread the original chronological order is
7400retained, you can set @code{gnus-sort-threads-recursively} to nil.
7401
8a1cdce5
AC
7402@vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7403The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7404@code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7405functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7406tickles your fancy.
4009494e 7407
8a1cdce5
AC
7408@findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7409@findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7410@findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7411@findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7412@findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7413@findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7414@findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7415@findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7416@findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7417If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7418other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7419variable. It is very similar to the
7420@code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7421different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7422predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7423@code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7424@code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7425@code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7426@code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
4009494e 7427
8a1cdce5
AC
7428If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7429say something like:
4009494e 7430
8a1cdce5
AC
7431@lisp
7432(setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7433 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7434 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7435@end lisp
01c52d31 7436
8a1cdce5
AC
7437You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7438@xref{Group Parameters}.
01c52d31 7439
4009494e 7440
8a1cdce5
AC
7441@node Asynchronous Fetching
7442@section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7443@cindex asynchronous article fetching
7444@cindex article pre-fetch
7445@cindex pre-fetch
4009494e 7446
8a1cdce5
AC
7447If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7448network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7449for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7450article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7451while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
26b9f88d 7452
8a1cdce5
AC
7453First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7454article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
26b9f88d 7455
8a1cdce5
AC
7456Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7457quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7458know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7459article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7460connection is blocked.
26b9f88d 7461
8a1cdce5
AC
7462To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7463connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7464thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7465extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
26b9f88d 7466
8a1cdce5
AC
7467Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7468the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7469loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7470also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7471extra connection.
26b9f88d 7472
8a1cdce5
AC
7473Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7474you really want to.
4009494e 7475
8a1cdce5
AC
7476@vindex gnus-asynchronous
7477Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7478happen automatically.
4009494e 7479
8a1cdce5
AC
7480@vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7481You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7482@code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7483that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7484the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7485pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7486@code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7487
7488@vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7489@findex gnus-async-unread-p
7490There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7491articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7492variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7493function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7494to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7495returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7496article data structure as the only parameter.
4009494e 7497
8a1cdce5
AC
7498If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7499than 100 lines, you could say something like:
4009494e 7500
8a1cdce5
AC
7501@lisp
7502(defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7503 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7504 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7505 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7506 100)))
4009494e 7507
8a1cdce5
AC
7508(setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7509@end lisp
4009494e 7510
8a1cdce5
AC
7511These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7512preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7513It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
4009494e 7514
8a1cdce5
AC
7515@vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7516@findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7517After an article has been prefetched, this
7518@code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7519be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7520value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7521and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7522wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7523for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
4009494e 7524
8a1cdce5
AC
7525@vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7526Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7527@code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7528articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
4009494e 7529
8a1cdce5
AC
7530@table @code
7531@item read
7532Remove articles when they are read.
4009494e 7533
8a1cdce5
AC
7534@item exit
7535Remove articles when exiting the group.
4009494e
GM
7536@end table
7537
8a1cdce5 7538The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
4009494e 7539
8a1cdce5
AC
7540@c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7541@c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7542@c from the next group.
4009494e 7543
4009494e 7544
8a1cdce5
AC
7545@node Article Caching
7546@section Article Caching
7547@cindex article caching
7548@cindex caching
4009494e 7549
8a1cdce5
AC
7550If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7551consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7552locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7553potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7554your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
4009494e 7555
8a1cdce5 7556Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
4009494e 7557
8a1cdce5
AC
7558@vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7559@vindex gnus-cache-directory
7560@vindex gnus-use-cache
7561To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7562all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7563over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7564cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7565@code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
4009494e 7566
8a1cdce5
AC
7567When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7568cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7569expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7570keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7571as dormant, and don't worry.
4009494e 7572
8a1cdce5 7573When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
4009494e 7574
8a1cdce5
AC
7575@vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7576@vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7577The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7578@code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7579variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7580dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7581put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7582articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7583symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7584@code{unread} and @code{read}.
4009494e 7585
8a1cdce5
AC
7586@findex gnus-jog-cache
7587So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7588picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7589subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7590store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7591command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7592really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7593Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7594to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7595not then be downloaded by this command.
4009494e 7596
8a1cdce5
AC
7597@vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7598@vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7599It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7600if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7601sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7602feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
4009494e 7603
8a1cdce5
AC
7604To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7605regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7606@code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7607Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7608variables, the group is not cached.
4009494e 7609
8a1cdce5
AC
7610@findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7611@findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7612@vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7613The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7614file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7615of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7616offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7617gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7618files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7619file.
4009494e 7620
8a1cdce5
AC
7621@findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7622@code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7623@code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7624where, isn't that cool?
4009494e 7625
8a1cdce5
AC
7626@node Persistent Articles
7627@section Persistent Articles
7628@cindex persistent articles
4009494e 7629
8a1cdce5
AC
7630Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7631In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7632useful in my opinion.
4009494e 7633
8a1cdce5
AC
7634Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7635that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7636(using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7637that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7638the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7639the expiry going on at the news server.
4009494e 7640
8a1cdce5
AC
7641This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7642be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7643you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
4009494e 7644
8a1cdce5 7645@table @kbd
4009494e 7646
8a1cdce5
AC
7647@item *
7648@kindex * (Summary)
7649@findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7650Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7651
7652@item M-*
7653@kindex M-* (Summary)
7654@findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7655Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7656(@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7657article.
7658@end table
7659
7660Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7661
7662To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7663you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7664interested in persistent articles:
7665
7666@lisp
7667(setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
4009494e
GM
7668@end lisp
7669
8a1cdce5
AC
7670@node Sticky Articles
7671@section Sticky Articles
7672@cindex sticky articles
4009494e 7673
8a1cdce5
AC
7674When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7675according to the value of the variable
7676@code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7677default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7678has its own article buffer.
4009494e 7679
8a1cdce5
AC
7680This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7681in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7682latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
da6062e6 7683your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
4009494e 7684
8a1cdce5
AC
7685That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7686basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7687select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
4009494e 7688
8a1cdce5
AC
7689@table @kbd
7690@item A S
7691@kindex A S (Summary)
7692@findex gnus-sticky-article
7693Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7694name for this sticky article buffer.
7695@end table
4009494e 7696
8a1cdce5 7697To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
4009494e 7698
8a1cdce5
AC
7699@table @kbd
7700@item q
7701@kindex q (Article)
7702@findex bury-buffer
7703Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7704
7705@item k
7706@kindex k (Article)
7707@findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7708Kills this sticky article buffer.
4009494e
GM
7709@end table
7710
8a1cdce5 7711To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
4009494e 7712
8a1cdce5
AC
7713@defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7714Kill all sticky article buffers.
7715If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7716@end defun
4009494e 7717
8a1cdce5
AC
7718@node Article Backlog
7719@section Article Backlog
7720@cindex backlog
7721@cindex article backlog
4009494e 7722
8a1cdce5
AC
7723If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7724unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7725by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7726already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7727you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7728re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7729that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7730increase memory usage some.
4009494e 7731
8a1cdce5
AC
7732@vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7733If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7734at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7735variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7736@emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7737bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7738that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
4009494e 7739
8a1cdce5 7740The default value is 20.
4009494e 7741
4009494e 7742
8a1cdce5
AC
7743@node Saving Articles
7744@section Saving Articles
7745@cindex saving articles
4009494e 7746
8a1cdce5
AC
7747Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7748for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7749processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7750approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7751(@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
4009494e 7752
8a1cdce5
AC
7753For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7754save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7755command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
4009494e 7756
8a1cdce5
AC
7757@vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7758If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7759unwanted headers before saving the article.
4009494e 7760
8a1cdce5
AC
7761@vindex gnus-saved-headers
7762If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7763@code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7764deleted before saving.
4009494e 7765
8a1cdce5 7766@table @kbd
4009494e 7767
8a1cdce5
AC
7768@item O o
7769@itemx o
7770@kindex O o (Summary)
7771@kindex o (Summary)
7772@findex gnus-summary-save-article
7773@c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7774Save the current article using the default article saver
7775(@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
f394fa25 7776
8a1cdce5
AC
7777@item O m
7778@kindex O m (Summary)
7779@findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7780Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7781(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
f394fa25 7782
8a1cdce5
AC
7783@item O r
7784@kindex O r (Summary)
7785@findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7786Save the current article in Rmail format
7787(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7788Babyl in older versions.
4009494e 7789
8a1cdce5
AC
7790@item O f
7791@kindex O f (Summary)
7792@findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7793@c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7794Save the current article in plain file format
7795(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
4009494e 7796
8a1cdce5
AC
7797@item O F
7798@kindex O F (Summary)
7799@findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7800Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7801file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7802
7803@item O b
7804@kindex O b (Summary)
7805@findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7806Save the current article body in plain file format
7807(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7808
7809@item O h
7810@kindex O h (Summary)
7811@findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7812Save the current article in mh folder format
7813(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7814
7815@item O v
7816@kindex O v (Summary)
7817@findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7818Save the current article in a VM folder
7819(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7820
7821@item O p
7822@itemx |
7823@kindex O p (Summary)
7824@kindex | (Summary)
7825@findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7826@vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7827Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7828the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7829If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7830complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7831special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7832The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7833to a string containing the default command and options (default
7834@code{nil}).
4009494e 7835
8a1cdce5
AC
7836@item O P
7837@kindex O P (Summary)
7838@findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7839@vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7840Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7841external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7842Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7843variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7844(@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
4009494e
GM
7845
7846@end table
7847
8a1cdce5
AC
7848@vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7849All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7850(@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7851functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7852and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7853the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7854default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7855loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7856just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7857have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7858to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7859save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7860files.
7861
4009494e 7862
8a1cdce5
AC
7863@vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7864You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7865Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7866functions below, or you can create your own.
4009494e
GM
7867
7868@table @code
4009494e 7869
8a1cdce5
AC
7870@item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7871@findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7872@vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7873@findex gnus-plain-save-name
7874This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
787523, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7876@dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7877Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7878of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7879@code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7880article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
4009494e 7881
8a1cdce5
AC
7882@item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7883@findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7884@vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7885Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7886@code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7887article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
4009494e 7888
8a1cdce5
AC
7889@item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7890@findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7891@vindex gnus-file-save-name
7892@findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7893Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7894the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7895article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
4009494e 7896
8a1cdce5
AC
7897@item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7898@findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7899Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7900overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7901@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7902article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
4009494e 7903
8a1cdce5
AC
7904@item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7905@findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7906Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7907@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7908article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
4009494e 7909
8a1cdce5
AC
7910@item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7911@findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7912Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7913overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7914@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7915article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
4009494e 7916
8a1cdce5
AC
7917@item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7918@findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7919@findex gnus-folder-save-name
7920@findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7921@vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7922@cindex rcvstore
7923@cindex MH folders
7924Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7925library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7926to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7927@code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7928@code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
4009494e 7929
8a1cdce5
AC
7930@item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7931@findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7932Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7933reader to use this setting.
4009494e 7934
8a1cdce5
AC
7935@item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7936@findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7937Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
1df7defd 7938arguments COMMAND and RAW@. Valid values for COMMAND include:
4009494e 7939
8a1cdce5
AC
7940@itemize @bullet
7941@item a string@*
7942The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7943@item @code{nil}@*
7944You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7945@item the symbol @code{default}@*
7946It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7947@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7948last used for saving.
7949@end itemize
4009494e 7950
8a1cdce5
AC
7951Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7952@code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7953headers will be piped.
4009494e
GM
7954@end table
7955
8a1cdce5 7956The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
4009494e
GM
7957
7958@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
7959@item :decode
7960The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7961meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7962@code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7963@code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7964@code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7965@code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
4009494e 7966
8a1cdce5
AC
7967@item :function
7968The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7969overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7970articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7971@code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7972meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7973@code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
4009494e 7974
8a1cdce5
AC
7975@item :headers
7976The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7977specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7978@code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7979headers should be saved.
4009494e
GM
7980@end table
7981
8a1cdce5
AC
7982@vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7983All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7984in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7985@env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7986default.
4009494e 7987
8a1cdce5
AC
7988As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7989suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7990available functions that generate names:
4009494e 7991
8a1cdce5 7992@table @code
4009494e 7993
8a1cdce5
AC
7994@item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7995@findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7996File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
4009494e 7997
8a1cdce5
AC
7998@item gnus-numeric-save-name
7999@findex gnus-numeric-save-name
8000File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
4009494e 8001
8a1cdce5
AC
8002@item gnus-Plain-save-name
8003@findex gnus-Plain-save-name
8004File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
4009494e 8005
8a1cdce5
AC
8006@item gnus-plain-save-name
8007@findex gnus-plain-save-name
8008File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
4009494e 8009
8a1cdce5
AC
8010@item gnus-sender-save-name
8011@findex gnus-sender-save-name
8012File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
8013@end table
4009494e 8014
8a1cdce5
AC
8015@vindex gnus-split-methods
8016You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
8017the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
8018save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
8019related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
8020like:
4009494e 8021
8a1cdce5
AC
8022@lisp
8023(("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8024 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8025 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8026 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8027@end lisp
4009494e 8028
8a1cdce5
AC
8029We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8030elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8031a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8032head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8033group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8034@code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8035the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8036result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8037called returns a string or a list of strings.
01c52d31 8038
8a1cdce5
AC
8039You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8040saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8041then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8042name completion over the results from applying this variable.
4009494e 8043
8a1cdce5
AC
8044This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8045means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8046@code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8047name.
4009494e 8048
8a1cdce5
AC
8049Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8050lots of mail groups called things like
8051@samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8052these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8053following will do just that:
4009494e 8054
8a1cdce5
AC
8055@lisp
8056(defun my-save-name (group)
8057 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8058 (substring group (match-end 0))))
4009494e 8059
8a1cdce5
AC
8060(setq gnus-split-methods
8061 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8062 (my-save-name)))
8063@end lisp
4009494e 8064
4009494e 8065
8a1cdce5
AC
8066@vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8067Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8068@code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8069(@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8070the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8071all the files in the top level directory
8072(@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8073@file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8074on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8075Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
4009494e 8076
8a1cdce5
AC
8077This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8078is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8079names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8080@code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8081contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8082for kill files.
4009494e 8083
8a1cdce5
AC
8084If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8085a spool, you could
4009494e 8086
8a1cdce5
AC
8087@lisp
8088(setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8089(setq gnus-default-article-saver
8090 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8091@end lisp
4009494e 8092
8a1cdce5
AC
8093Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8094ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8095the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8096around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
4009494e 8097
4009494e 8098
8a1cdce5
AC
8099@node Decoding Articles
8100@section Decoding Articles
8101@cindex decoding articles
4009494e 8102
8a1cdce5
AC
8103Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8104encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
4009494e 8105
8a1cdce5
AC
8106@menu
8107* Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8108* Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8109* PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8110* Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8111* Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8112* Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8113@end menu
4009494e 8114
8a1cdce5
AC
8115@cindex series
8116@cindex article series
8117All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8118(@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8119the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8120can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8121articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
4009494e 8122
8a1cdce5
AC
8123Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8124simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8125last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
4009494e 8126
8a1cdce5
AC
8127For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8128will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8129([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
4009494e 8130
8a1cdce5
AC
8131Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8132series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8133commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
4009494e 8134
4009494e 8135
8a1cdce5
AC
8136@node Uuencoded Articles
8137@subsection Uuencoded Articles
8138@cindex uudecode
8139@cindex uuencoded articles
4009494e 8140
8a1cdce5 8141@table @kbd
4009494e 8142
8a1cdce5
AC
8143@item X u
8144@kindex X u (Summary)
8145@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8146@c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8147Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
4009494e 8148
8a1cdce5
AC
8149@item X U
8150@kindex X U (Summary)
8151@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8152Uudecodes and saves the current series
8153(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
4009494e 8154
8a1cdce5
AC
8155@item X v u
8156@kindex X v u (Summary)
8157@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8158Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
4009494e 8159
8a1cdce5
AC
8160@item X v U
8161@kindex X v U (Summary)
8162@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8163Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8164(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
4009494e 8165
8a1cdce5 8166@end table
4009494e 8167
8a1cdce5
AC
8168Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8169the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8170entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8171(@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8172(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
4009494e 8173
8a1cdce5
AC
8174All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8175@sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8176the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8177articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8178@kbd{X u}.
4009494e 8179
8a1cdce5
AC
8180@vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8181Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8182@code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8183@samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8184automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8185you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8186off.
4009494e 8187
4009494e 8188
8a1cdce5
AC
8189@node Shell Archives
8190@subsection Shell Archives
8191@cindex unshar
8192@cindex shell archives
8193@cindex shared articles
4009494e 8194
8a1cdce5
AC
8195Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8196sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8197some commands to deal with these:
4009494e 8198
8a1cdce5 8199@table @kbd
4009494e 8200
8a1cdce5
AC
8201@item X s
8202@kindex X s (Summary)
8203@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8204Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
4009494e 8205
8a1cdce5
AC
8206@item X S
8207@kindex X S (Summary)
8208@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8209Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
4009494e 8210
8a1cdce5
AC
8211@item X v s
8212@kindex X v s (Summary)
8213@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8214Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
4009494e 8215
8a1cdce5
AC
8216@item X v S
8217@kindex X v S (Summary)
8218@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8219Unshars, views and saves the current series
8220(@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8221@end table
4009494e 8222
4009494e 8223
8a1cdce5
AC
8224@node PostScript Files
8225@subsection PostScript Files
8226@cindex PostScript
4009494e 8227
8a1cdce5 8228@table @kbd
85115796 8229
8a1cdce5
AC
8230@item X p
8231@kindex X p (Summary)
8232@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8233Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
4009494e 8234
8a1cdce5
AC
8235@item X P
8236@kindex X P (Summary)
8237@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8238Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8239(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
4009494e 8240
8a1cdce5
AC
8241@item X v p
8242@kindex X v p (Summary)
8243@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8244View the current PostScript series
8245(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
4009494e 8246
8a1cdce5
AC
8247@item X v P
8248@kindex X v P (Summary)
8249@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8250View and save the current PostScript series
8251(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8252@end table
4009494e 8253
4009494e 8254
8a1cdce5
AC
8255@node Other Files
8256@subsection Other Files
4009494e 8257
8a1cdce5
AC
8258@table @kbd
8259@item X o
8260@kindex X o (Summary)
8261@findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8262Save the current series
8263(@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
4009494e 8264
8a1cdce5
AC
8265@item X b
8266@kindex X b (Summary)
8267@findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8268Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8269doesn't really work yet.
4009494e 8270
8a1cdce5
AC
8271@item X Y
8272@kindex X Y (Summary)
8273@findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8274yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8275@end table
4009494e 8276
4009494e 8277
8a1cdce5
AC
8278@node Decoding Variables
8279@subsection Decoding Variables
4009494e 8280
8a1cdce5 8281Adjective, not verb.
4009494e 8282
8a1cdce5
AC
8283@menu
8284* Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8285* Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8286* Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8287@end menu
4009494e 8288
4009494e 8289
8a1cdce5
AC
8290@node Rule Variables
8291@subsubsection Rule Variables
8292@cindex rule variables
4009494e 8293
8a1cdce5
AC
8294Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8295variables are of the form
4009494e 8296
8a1cdce5
AC
8297@lisp
8298 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8299 '(regexp2 command2)
8300 ...)
8301@end lisp
4009494e 8302
8a1cdce5 8303@table @code
4009494e 8304
8a1cdce5
AC
8305@item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8306@vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8307@cindex sox
8308This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8309for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8310say something like:
8311@lisp
8312(setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8313 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8314@end lisp
4009494e 8315
8a1cdce5
AC
8316@item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8317@vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8318This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8319user and default view rules.
4009494e 8320
8a1cdce5
AC
8321@item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8322@vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8323This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8324archives.
8325@end table
4009494e 8326
4009494e 8327
8a1cdce5
AC
8328@node Other Decode Variables
8329@subsubsection Other Decode Variables
4009494e 8330
8a1cdce5
AC
8331@table @code
8332@vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
4009494e 8333
8a1cdce5
AC
8334@item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8335All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8336successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8337and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8338anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
4009494e 8339
8a1cdce5 8340@table @code
4009494e 8341
8a1cdce5
AC
8342@item gnus-uu-grab-view
8343@findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8344View the file.
4009494e 8345
8a1cdce5
AC
8346@item gnus-uu-grab-move
8347@findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8348Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8349@end table
4009494e 8350
8a1cdce5
AC
8351@item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8352@vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8353Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8354@code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8355that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8356time.
01c52d31 8357
8a1cdce5
AC
8358@item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8359@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8360Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
01c52d31 8361
8a1cdce5
AC
8362@item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8363@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8364Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8365Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8366@code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
333f9019 8367kludgy.
01c52d31 8368
8a1cdce5
AC
8369@item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8370@vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8371Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
01c52d31 8372
8a1cdce5
AC
8373@item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8374@vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8375Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8376looking for files to display.
01c52d31 8377
8a1cdce5
AC
8378@item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8379@vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8380Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8381after viewing it.
01c52d31 8382
8a1cdce5
AC
8383@item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8384@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8385Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8386rules.
01c52d31 8387
8a1cdce5
AC
8388@item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8389@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8390Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8391unpacking commands.
01c52d31 8392
8a1cdce5
AC
8393@item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8394@vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8395Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8396from articles.
01c52d31 8397
8a1cdce5
AC
8398@item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8399@vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8400Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8401decoded articles as unread.
4009494e 8402
8a1cdce5
AC
8403@item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8404@vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8405Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8406uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
4009494e 8407
8a1cdce5
AC
8408@item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8409@vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8410Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
4009494e 8411
8a1cdce5
AC
8412@item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8413@vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8414@cindex metamail
8415Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8416commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8417content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8418@code{metamail} for viewing.
4009494e 8419
8a1cdce5
AC
8420@item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8421@vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8422Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8423decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8424@code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8425embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8426to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8427simply dropped them.
4009494e 8428
8a1cdce5 8429@end table
4009494e 8430
4009494e 8431
8a1cdce5
AC
8432@node Uuencoding and Posting
8433@subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
4009494e 8434
8a1cdce5 8435@table @code
4009494e 8436
8a1cdce5
AC
8437@item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8438@vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8439Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8440before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8441either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8442for you when you post the article.
4009494e 8443
8a1cdce5
AC
8444@item gnus-uu-post-length
8445@vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8446Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8447many articles it takes to post the entire file.
4009494e 8448
8a1cdce5
AC
8449@item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8450@vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8451Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8452thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8453to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8454seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8455think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 8456
8a1cdce5
AC
8457@item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8458@vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8459Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8460article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8461variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8462at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8463Default is @code{t}.
4009494e 8464
8a1cdce5 8465@end table
4009494e 8466
4009494e 8467
8a1cdce5
AC
8468@node Viewing Files
8469@subsection Viewing Files
8470@cindex viewing files
8471@cindex pseudo-articles
4009494e 8472
8a1cdce5
AC
8473After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8474to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8475viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8476containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8477uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8478This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8479of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
4009494e 8480
8a1cdce5
AC
8481Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8482extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8483``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8484will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
4009494e 8485
8a1cdce5
AC
8486@vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8487If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8488until the viewing is done before proceeding.
4009494e 8489
8a1cdce5
AC
8490@vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8491If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8492the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8493immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8494be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
4009494e 8495
8a1cdce5
AC
8496@vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8497If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8498pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8499@code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8500a list of parameters to that command.
4009494e 8501
8a1cdce5
AC
8502@vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8503If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8504pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
4009494e 8505
8a1cdce5
AC
8506So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8507@emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8508Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
4009494e 8509
4009494e 8510
8a1cdce5
AC
8511@node Article Treatment
8512@section Article Treatment
4009494e 8513
8a1cdce5
AC
8514Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8515object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8516written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8517writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8518these articles easier.
4009494e 8519
8a1cdce5
AC
8520@menu
8521* Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8522* Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8523* Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8524* Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8525* Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8526* Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8527* Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8528* Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8529* Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8530 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8531* Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8532* Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8533@end menu
4009494e 8534
4009494e 8535
8a1cdce5
AC
8536@node Article Highlighting
8537@subsection Article Highlighting
8538@cindex highlighting
4009494e 8539
8a1cdce5
AC
8540Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8541you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
4009494e 8542
8a1cdce5 8543@table @kbd
4009494e 8544
8a1cdce5
AC
8545@item W H a
8546@kindex W H a (Summary)
8547@findex gnus-article-highlight
8548@findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8549Do much highlighting of the current article
8550(@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8551text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
4009494e 8552
8a1cdce5
AC
8553@item W H h
8554@kindex W H h (Summary)
8555@findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8556@vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8557Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8558highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8559variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8560@code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8561@var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8562header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8563(@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8564the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8565@var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
4009494e 8566
8a1cdce5
AC
8567@item W H c
8568@kindex W H c (Summary)
8569@findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8570Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
4009494e 8571
8a1cdce5 8572Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
89167438 8573
8a1cdce5
AC
8574@table @code
8575@vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
d62672f3 8576
8a1cdce5
AC
8577@item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8578If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
857925000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
d62672f3 8580
8a1cdce5
AC
8581@item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8582@vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8583Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
4009494e 8584
8a1cdce5
AC
8585@item gnus-cite-face-list
8586@vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8587List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8588When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8589Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8590This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
4009494e 8591
8a1cdce5
AC
8592@item gnus-supercite-regexp
8593@vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8594Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
4009494e 8595
8a1cdce5
AC
8596@item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8597@vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8598Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
4009494e 8599
8a1cdce5
AC
8600@item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8601@vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8602Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8603that it's a citation.
4009494e 8604
8a1cdce5
AC
8605@item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8606@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8607Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
4009494e 8608
8a1cdce5
AC
8609@item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8610@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8611Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
4009494e 8612
8a1cdce5
AC
8613@item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8614@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8615Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8616cited text belonging to the attribution.
4009494e 8617
8a1cdce5
AC
8618@item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8619@vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8620If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8621beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8622in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8623is @code{t}.
4009494e 8624
8a1cdce5 8625@end table
4009494e 8626
4009494e 8627
8a1cdce5
AC
8628@item W H s
8629@kindex W H s (Summary)
8630@vindex gnus-signature-separator
8631@vindex gnus-signature-face
8632@findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8633Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8634Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8635Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8636highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8637default.
4009494e 8638
4009494e
GM
8639@end table
8640
8a1cdce5 8641@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
4009494e 8642
4009494e 8643
8a1cdce5
AC
8644@node Article Fontisizing
8645@subsection Article Fontisizing
8646@cindex emphasis
8647@cindex article emphasis
4009494e 8648
8a1cdce5
AC
8649@findex gnus-article-emphasize
8650@kindex W e (Summary)
8651People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8652like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8653this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8654(@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
4009494e 8655
8a1cdce5
AC
8656@vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8657How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8658@code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8659element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8660that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8661emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8662should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8663groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8664highlighting.
4009494e
GM
8665
8666@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
8667(setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8668 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8669 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
4009494e
GM
8670@end lisp
8671
8a1cdce5
AC
8672@cindex slash
8673@cindex asterisk
8674@cindex underline
8675@cindex /
8676@cindex *
4009494e 8677
8a1cdce5
AC
8678@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8679@vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8680@vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8681@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8682@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8683@vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8684@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8685By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8686@code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8687@code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8688@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8689@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8690@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
4009494e 8691
8a1cdce5
AC
8692If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8693customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8694to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8695say something like:
4009494e
GM
8696
8697@lisp
8a1cdce5 8698(copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
4009494e
GM
8699@end lisp
8700
8a1cdce5 8701@vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
4009494e 8702
8a1cdce5
AC
8703If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8704@code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8705syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8706parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
4009494e 8707
8a1cdce5 8708@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
4009494e 8709
4009494e 8710
8a1cdce5
AC
8711@node Article Hiding
8712@subsection Article Hiding
8713@cindex article hiding
4009494e 8714
8a1cdce5
AC
8715Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8716too much cruft in most articles.
4009494e 8717
8a1cdce5 8718@table @kbd
4009494e 8719
8a1cdce5
AC
8720@item W W a
8721@kindex W W a (Summary)
8722@findex gnus-article-hide
8723Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8724(@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8725headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
4009494e 8726
8a1cdce5
AC
8727@item W W h
8728@kindex W W h (Summary)
8729@findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8730Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8731Headers}.
4009494e 8732
8a1cdce5
AC
8733@item W W b
8734@kindex W W b (Summary)
8735@findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8736Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8737(@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
4009494e 8738
8a1cdce5
AC
8739@item W W s
8740@kindex W W s (Summary)
8741@findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8742Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8743Signature}.
4009494e 8744
8a1cdce5
AC
8745@item W W l
8746@kindex W W l (Summary)
8747@findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8748@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8749Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8750are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8751@code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8752@samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8753may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
4009494e 8754
8a1cdce5 8755@table @code
4009494e 8756
8a1cdce5
AC
8757@item gnus-list-identifiers
8758@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8759A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8760subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
4009494e 8761
8a1cdce5 8762@end table
4009494e 8763
8a1cdce5
AC
8764@item W W P
8765@kindex W W P (Summary)
8766@findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8767Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8768(@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
4009494e 8769
8a1cdce5
AC
8770@item W W B
8771@kindex W W B (Summary)
8772@findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8773@vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8774@vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8775@cindex banner
8776@cindex OneList
8777@cindex stripping advertisements
8778@cindex advertisements
8779Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8780(@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8781annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8782groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8783the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8784group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8785which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8786removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8787signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8788corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8789used.
4009494e 8790
8a1cdce5 8791For instance:
4009494e 8792
8a1cdce5
AC
8793@lisp
8794(setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8795 ((googleGroups .
8796 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8797@end lisp
4009494e 8798
8a1cdce5
AC
8799Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8800the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8801@code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
4009494e 8802
8a1cdce5 8803@table @code
4009494e 8804
8a1cdce5
AC
8805@item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8806@vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8807Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8808@code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8809matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8810symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8811a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8812address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8813sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8814banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8815sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
4009494e 8816
8a1cdce5
AC
8817@lisp
8818("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8819 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8820@end lisp
4009494e 8821
8a1cdce5 8822@end table
4009494e 8823
8a1cdce5
AC
8824@item W W c
8825@kindex W W c (Summary)
8826@findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8827Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8828customizing the hiding:
4009494e 8829
8a1cdce5 8830@table @code
4009494e 8831
8a1cdce5
AC
8832@item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8833@itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8834@vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8835@vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8836Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8837allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8838by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8839specs are valid:
4009494e 8840
8a1cdce5
AC
8841@table @samp
8842@item b
8843Starting point of the hidden text.
8844@item e
8845Ending point of the hidden text.
8846@item l
8847Number of characters in the hidden region.
8848@item n
8849Number of lines of hidden text.
4009494e
GM
8850@end table
8851
8a1cdce5
AC
8852@item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8853@vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8854The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8855shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8856and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
4009494e 8857
8a1cdce5 8858@end table
4009494e 8859
8a1cdce5
AC
8860@item W W C-c
8861@kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8862@findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
4009494e 8863
8a1cdce5
AC
8864Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8865following two variables:
4009494e 8866
8a1cdce5
AC
8867@table @code
8868@item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8869@vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8870If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
887150), hide the cited text.
4009494e 8872
8a1cdce5
AC
8873@item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8874@vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8875The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8876is hidden.
4009494e
GM
8877@end table
8878
8a1cdce5
AC
8879@item W W C
8880@kindex W W C (Summary)
8881@findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8882Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8883(@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8884useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8885have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
4009494e 8886
8a1cdce5 8887@end table
4009494e 8888
8a1cdce5
AC
8889All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8890prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8891hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
b890d447 8892
8a1cdce5
AC
8893Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8894citation customization.
4009494e 8895
8a1cdce5
AC
8896@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8897automatically.
4009494e 8898
4009494e 8899
8a1cdce5
AC
8900@node Article Washing
8901@subsection Article Washing
8902@cindex washing
8903@cindex article washing
4009494e 8904
8a1cdce5
AC
8905We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8906@kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
4009494e 8907
8a1cdce5
AC
8908@dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8909something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8910Cleaner, perhaps.
4009494e 8911
8a1cdce5
AC
8912@xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8913articles by default.
4009494e 8914
8a1cdce5 8915@table @kbd
4009494e 8916
8a1cdce5
AC
8917@item C-u g
8918This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8919you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8920the server.
4009494e 8921
8a1cdce5
AC
8922@item g
8923Force redisplaying of the current article
8924(@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8925If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8926interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8927(@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
4009494e 8928
8a1cdce5
AC
8929@item W l
8930@kindex W l (Summary)
8931@findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8932Remove page breaks from the current article
8933(@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8934delimiters.
4009494e 8935
8a1cdce5
AC
8936@item W r
8937@kindex W r (Summary)
8938@findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8939@c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8940Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8941(@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8942Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8943(Typically offensive jokes and such.)
4009494e 8944
8a1cdce5 8945It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
1df7defd 8946positions in the alphabet, e.g., @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8a1cdce5
AC
8947#15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8948is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
4009494e 8949
8a1cdce5
AC
8950@item W m
8951@kindex W m (Summary)
8952@findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8953Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
4009494e 8954
8a1cdce5
AC
8955@item W i
8956@kindex W i (Summary)
8957@findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8958Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8959encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8960unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8961string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8962(@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8963to work.
4009494e 8964
8a1cdce5
AC
8965@item W t
8966@item t
8967@kindex W t (Summary)
8968@kindex t (Summary)
8969@findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8970Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8971(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
4009494e 8972
8a1cdce5
AC
8973@item W v
8974@kindex W v (Summary)
8975@findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8976Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8977(@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
4009494e 8978
8a1cdce5
AC
8979@item W o
8980@kindex W o (Summary)
8981@findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8982Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
4009494e 8983
8a1cdce5
AC
8984@item W d
8985@kindex W d (Summary)
8986@findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8987@vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8988@cindex Smartquotes
8989@cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8990@cindex Latin 1
8991Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8992@code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8993(@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8994whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8995interactively.
4009494e 8996
8a1cdce5
AC
8997Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8998an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8999like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
9000apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
4009494e 9001
8a1cdce5
AC
9002@item W U
9003@kindex W U (Summary)
9004@findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
9005@cindex Unicode
9006@cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
9007Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
9008@acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
9009This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
fe7a3057 9010and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
89b163db 9011like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
4009494e 9012
8a1cdce5
AC
9013@item W Y f
9014@kindex W Y f (Summary)
9015@findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
9016@cindex Outlook Express
9017Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
9018unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
9019(@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
4009494e 9020
8a1cdce5
AC
9021@item W Y u
9022@kindex W Y u (Summary)
9023@findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9024@vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9025@vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9026Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9027what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9028@code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9029@code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9030maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9031(@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
4009494e 9032
8a1cdce5
AC
9033@item W Y a
9034@kindex W Y a (Summary)
9035@findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9036Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9037(@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
4009494e 9038
8a1cdce5
AC
9039@item W Y c
9040@kindex W Y c (Summary)
9041@findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9042Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9043(@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
4009494e 9044
8a1cdce5
AC
9045@item W w
9046@kindex W w (Summary)
9047@findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9048Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
4009494e 9049
8a1cdce5
AC
9050You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9051when filling.
4009494e 9052
8a1cdce5
AC
9053@item W Q
9054@kindex W Q (Summary)
9055@findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9056Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
4009494e 9057
8a1cdce5
AC
9058@item W C
9059@kindex W C (Summary)
9060@findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9061Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9062(@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
4009494e 9063
8a1cdce5
AC
9064@item W c
9065@kindex W c (Summary)
9066@findex gnus-article-remove-cr
1df7defd 9067Translate CRLF pairs (i.e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8a1cdce5
AC
9068(this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9069CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9070(@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
4009494e 9071
8a1cdce5
AC
9072@item W q
9073@kindex W q (Summary)
9074@findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9075Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9076Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9077sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9078makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9079which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9080done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9081@code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9082has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
4009494e 9083
8a1cdce5
AC
9084@item W 6
9085@kindex W 6 (Summary)
9086@findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9087Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9088one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9089non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9090usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9091@code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9092has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
4009494e 9093
8a1cdce5
AC
9094@item W Z
9095@kindex W Z (Summary)
9096@findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9097Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9098common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9099makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
4009494e 9100
8a1cdce5
AC
9101@item W A
9102@kindex W A (Summary)
9103@findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9104@cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9105Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9106extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9107sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
4009494e 9108
8a1cdce5
AC
9109@item W u
9110@kindex W u (Summary)
9111@findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9112Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9113outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9114split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9115the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
4009494e 9116
8a1cdce5
AC
9117@item W h
9118@kindex W h (Summary)
9119@findex gnus-article-wash-html
9120Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9121usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9122@code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
4009494e 9123
8a1cdce5
AC
9124If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9125the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9126(@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9127
9128The default is to use the function specified by
9129@code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9130Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9131@acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
4009494e
GM
9132
9133@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
9134@item shr
9135Use Gnus simple html renderer.
4009494e 9136
8a1cdce5
AC
9137@item gnus-w3m
9138Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
4009494e 9139
8a1cdce5
AC
9140@item w3
9141Use Emacs/W3.
4009494e 9142
8a1cdce5
AC
9143@item w3m
9144Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
4009494e 9145
8a1cdce5
AC
9146@item w3m-standalone
9147Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
4009494e 9148
8a1cdce5
AC
9149@item links
9150Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
4009494e 9151
8a1cdce5
AC
9152@item lynx
9153Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
4009494e 9154
8a1cdce5
AC
9155@item html2text
9156Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
4009494e 9157
8a1cdce5 9158@end table
4009494e 9159
8a1cdce5
AC
9160@item W b
9161@kindex W b (Summary)
9162@findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9163Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9164@xref{Article Buttons}.
4009494e 9165
8a1cdce5
AC
9166@item W B
9167@kindex W B (Summary)
9168@findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9169Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9170(@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
4009494e 9171
8a1cdce5
AC
9172@item W p
9173@kindex W p (Summary)
9174@findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9175Verify a signed control message
9176(@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9177@code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9178hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9179the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9180message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9181available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
4009494e 9182
8a1cdce5
AC
9183@item W s
9184@kindex W s (Summary)
9185@findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9186Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9187@acronym{S/MIME}) message
9188(@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
4009494e 9189
8a1cdce5
AC
9190@item W a
9191@kindex W a (Summary)
9192@findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9193Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9194article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
4009494e 9195
8a1cdce5
AC
9196@item W E l
9197@kindex W E l (Summary)
9198@findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9199Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9200(@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
4009494e 9201
8a1cdce5
AC
9202@item W E m
9203@kindex W E m (Summary)
9204@findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9205Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9206lines with a single empty line.
9207(@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
4009494e 9208
8a1cdce5
AC
9209@item W E t
9210@kindex W E t (Summary)
9211@findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9212Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9213(@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
4009494e 9214
8a1cdce5
AC
9215@item W E a
9216@kindex W E a (Summary)
9217@findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9218Do all the three commands above
9219(@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
4009494e 9220
8a1cdce5
AC
9221@item W E A
9222@kindex W E A (Summary)
9223@findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9224Remove all blank lines
9225(@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9226
9227@item W E s
9228@kindex W E s (Summary)
9229@findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9230Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9231body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
4009494e 9232
8a1cdce5
AC
9233@item W E e
9234@kindex W E e (Summary)
9235@findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9236Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9237body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
4009494e 9238
8a1cdce5 9239@end table
4009494e 9240
8a1cdce5 9241@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
4009494e 9242
4009494e 9243
8a1cdce5
AC
9244@node Article Header
9245@subsection Article Header
4009494e 9246
8a1cdce5 9247These commands perform various transformations of article header.
4009494e 9248
8a1cdce5 9249@table @kbd
4009494e 9250
8a1cdce5
AC
9251@item W G u
9252@kindex W G u (Summary)
9253@findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9254Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
4009494e 9255
8a1cdce5
AC
9256@item W G n
9257@kindex W G n (Summary)
9258@findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9259Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9260(@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
4009494e 9261
8a1cdce5
AC
9262@item W G f
9263@kindex W G f (Summary)
9264@findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9265Fold all the message headers
9266(@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
4009494e 9267
8a1cdce5
AC
9268@item W E w
9269@kindex W E w (Summary)
9270@findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9271Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9272(@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
4009494e 9273
8a1cdce5 9274@end table
4009494e 9275
4009494e 9276
8a1cdce5
AC
9277@node Article Buttons
9278@subsection Article Buttons
9279@cindex buttons
4009494e 9280
8a1cdce5
AC
9281People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9282be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9283with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9284button on these references.
4009494e 9285
8a1cdce5
AC
9286@vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9287Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9288Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9289Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9290one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
4009494e 9291
8a1cdce5 9292@table @code
4009494e 9293
8a1cdce5
AC
9294@item gnus-button-alist
9295@vindex gnus-button-alist
9296This is an alist where each entry has this form:
4009494e 9297
8a1cdce5
AC
9298@lisp
9299(@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9300@end lisp
4009494e 9301
8a1cdce5 9302@table @var
4009494e 9303
8a1cdce5
AC
9304@item regexp
9305All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9306considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9307embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9308variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9309@code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
4009494e 9310
8a1cdce5
AC
9311@item button-par
9312Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9313is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9314highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
4009494e 9315
8a1cdce5
AC
9316@item use-p
9317This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9318this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9319avoid false matches. Often variables named
9320@code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9321Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
4009494e 9322
8a1cdce5 9323@c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
4009494e 9324
8a1cdce5
AC
9325@item function
9326This function will be called when you click on this button.
4009494e 9327
8a1cdce5
AC
9328@item data-par
9329As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9330says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
4009494e 9331
8a1cdce5 9332@end table
4009494e 9333
8a1cdce5 9334So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
4009494e
GM
9335
9336@lisp
8a1cdce5 9337("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
4009494e
GM
9338@end lisp
9339
8a1cdce5
AC
9340@item gnus-header-button-alist
9341@vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9342This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9343article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9344used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
4009494e
GM
9345
9346@lisp
8a1cdce5 9347(@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
4009494e
GM
9348@end lisp
9349
8a1cdce5
AC
9350@var{header} is a regular expression.
9351@end table
4009494e 9352
8a1cdce5 9353@subsubsection Related variables and functions
4009494e 9354
8a1cdce5
AC
9355@table @code
9356@item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9357@xref{Article Button Levels}.
4009494e 9358
8a1cdce5 9359@c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
4009494e 9360
8a1cdce5
AC
9361@item gnus-button-url-regexp
9362@vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9363A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9364default values of the variables above.
4009494e 9365
8a1cdce5 9366@c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
4009494e 9367
8a1cdce5
AC
9368@item gnus-button-man-handler
9369@vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9370The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9371argument with a string naming the man page.
4009494e 9372
8a1cdce5
AC
9373@c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9374
9375@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9376@vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9377Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
4009494e 9378
8a1cdce5
AC
9379@item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9380@vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9381This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9382@samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9383message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9384@code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9385a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9386@code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9387function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9388function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9389@code{ask}. The default value is the function
9390@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
4009494e 9391
8a1cdce5
AC
9392@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9393@findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9394Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9395address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9396it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9397string is invalid.
4009494e 9398
8a1cdce5
AC
9399@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9400@vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9401An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9402@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
4009494e 9403
8a1cdce5 9404@c Misc stuff
4009494e 9405
8a1cdce5
AC
9406@item gnus-article-button-face
9407@vindex gnus-article-button-face
9408Face used on buttons.
4009494e 9409
8a1cdce5
AC
9410@item gnus-article-mouse-face
9411@vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9412Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
4009494e
GM
9413
9414@end table
9415
8a1cdce5 9416@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
4009494e 9417
4009494e 9418
8a1cdce5
AC
9419@node Article Button Levels
9420@subsection Article button levels
9421@cindex button levels
9422The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9423the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9424buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9425already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9426more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9427you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9428specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9429variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
a3f57c41
G
9430
9431@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
9432;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9433(setq gnus-parameters
9434 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9435 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9436 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
a3f57c41
G
9437@end lisp
9438
4009494e
GM
9439@table @code
9440
8a1cdce5
AC
9441@item gnus-button-browse-level
9442@vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9443Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9444news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9445@code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9446@code{browse-url-browser-function}.
4009494e 9447
8a1cdce5
AC
9448@item gnus-button-emacs-level
9449@vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9450Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9451@code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9452@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9453@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9454@code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9455@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9456@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9457@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9458@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9459@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9460@code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9461
9462@item gnus-button-man-level
9463@vindex gnus-button-man-level
9464Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9465See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9466
9467@item gnus-button-message-level
9468@vindex gnus-button-message-level
9469Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9470Related variables and functions include
9471@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9472@code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9473@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9474@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
4009494e
GM
9475
9476@end table
9477
4009494e 9478
8a1cdce5
AC
9479@node Article Date
9480@subsection Article Date
4009494e 9481
8a1cdce5
AC
9482The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9483heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9484when the article was sent.
4009494e 9485
8a1cdce5 9486@table @kbd
4009494e 9487
8a1cdce5
AC
9488@item W T u
9489@kindex W T u (Summary)
9490@findex gnus-article-date-ut
9491Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9492(@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
4009494e 9493
8a1cdce5
AC
9494@item W T i
9495@kindex W T i (Summary)
9496@findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9497@cindex ISO 8601
9498Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9499(@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
4009494e 9500
8a1cdce5
AC
9501@item W T l
9502@kindex W T l (Summary)
9503@findex gnus-article-date-local
9504Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
4009494e 9505
8a1cdce5
AC
9506@item W T p
9507@kindex W T p (Summary)
9508@findex gnus-article-date-english
9509Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9510(@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
4009494e 9511
8a1cdce5
AC
9512@item W T s
9513@kindex W T s (Summary)
9514@vindex gnus-article-time-format
9515@findex gnus-article-date-user
9516@findex format-time-string
9517Display the date using a user-defined format
9518(@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9519@code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9520to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9521for a list of possible format specs.
4009494e 9522
8a1cdce5
AC
9523@item W T e
9524@kindex W T e (Summary)
9525@findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9526@findex gnus-start-date-timer
9527@findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9528Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9529(@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9530
9531@example
12e3ca0a 9532Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
8a1cdce5
AC
9533@end example
9534
cdebc6dd
KY
9535To make this line updated continually, set the
9536@code{gnus-article-update-date-headers} variable to the frequency in
9537seconds (the default is @code{nil}).
4009494e 9538
8a1cdce5
AC
9539@item W T o
9540@kindex W T o (Summary)
9541@findex gnus-article-date-original
9542Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9543be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9544worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9545that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9546@emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
4009494e 9547
8a1cdce5 9548@end table
4009494e 9549
8a1cdce5
AC
9550@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9551preferred format automatically.
4009494e 9552
4009494e 9553
8a1cdce5
AC
9554@node Article Display
9555@subsection Article Display
9556@cindex picons
9557@cindex x-face
9558@cindex smileys
9559@cindex gravatars
4009494e 9560
8a1cdce5
AC
9561These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9562buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
4009494e 9563
8a1cdce5
AC
9564@code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9565message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
4009494e 9566
8a1cdce5
AC
9567@code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9568headers (@pxref{Face}).
4009494e 9569
8a1cdce5
AC
9570Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9571their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
4009494e 9572
8a1cdce5
AC
9573Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9574try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
4009494e 9575
8a1cdce5
AC
9576Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9577@uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
4009494e 9578
8a1cdce5
AC
9579All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9580they'll be removed.
4009494e 9581
8a1cdce5
AC
9582@table @kbd
9583@item W D x
9584@kindex W D x (Summary)
9585@findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9586Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9587(@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
4009494e 9588
8a1cdce5
AC
9589@item W D d
9590@kindex W D d (Summary)
9591@findex gnus-article-display-face
9592Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9593(@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
4009494e 9594
8a1cdce5
AC
9595@item W D s
9596@kindex W D s (Summary)
9597@findex gnus-treat-smiley
9598Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
01c52d31 9599
8a1cdce5
AC
9600@item W D f
9601@kindex W D f (Summary)
9602@findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9603Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
4009494e 9604
8a1cdce5
AC
9605@item W D m
9606@kindex W D m (Summary)
9607@findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
1df7defd 9608Piconify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
8a1cdce5 9609(@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
4009494e 9610
8a1cdce5
AC
9611@item W D n
9612@kindex W D n (Summary)
9613@findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
1df7defd 9614Piconify all news headers (i.e., @code{Newsgroups} and
8a1cdce5 9615@code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
4009494e 9616
8a1cdce5
AC
9617@item W D g
9618@kindex W D g (Summary)
9619@findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9620Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
4009494e 9621
8a1cdce5
AC
9622@item W D h
9623@kindex W D h (Summary)
9624@findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
1df7defd 9625Gravatarify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
8a1cdce5 9626(@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
4009494e 9627
8a1cdce5
AC
9628@item W D D
9629@kindex W D D (Summary)
9630@findex gnus-article-remove-images
9631Remove all images from the article buffer
9632(@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
be3c11b3 9633
8a1cdce5
AC
9634@item W D W
9635@kindex W D W (Summary)
9636@findex gnus-html-show-images
9637If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9638@code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9639the buffer with this command.
9640(@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
4009494e 9641
8a1cdce5 9642@end table
4009494e 9643
4009494e 9644
4009494e 9645
8a1cdce5
AC
9646@node Article Signature
9647@subsection Article Signature
9648@cindex signatures
9649@cindex article signature
4009494e 9650
8a1cdce5
AC
9651@vindex gnus-signature-separator
9652Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9653body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9654that says what is to be considered a signature is
9655@code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9656@samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9657non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9658of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9659from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
4009494e 9660
8a1cdce5
AC
9661@lisp
9662(setq gnus-signature-separator
9663 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9664 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9665 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9666 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9667 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9668 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9669 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9670@end lisp
4009494e 9671
8a1cdce5
AC
9672The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9673positives.
4009494e 9674
8a1cdce5
AC
9675@vindex gnus-signature-limit
9676@code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9677signature when displaying articles.
4009494e 9678
8a1cdce5
AC
9679@enumerate
9680@item
9681If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9682that integer.
9683@item
9684If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9685than that number.
9686@item
9687If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9688and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9689@item
9690If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9691in question is not a signature.
9692@end enumerate
4009494e 9693
8a1cdce5
AC
9694This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9695listed above. Here's an example:
4009494e 9696
8a1cdce5
AC
9697@lisp
9698(setq gnus-signature-limit
9699 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9700@end lisp
4009494e 9701
8a1cdce5
AC
9702This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9703separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9704the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9705signature after all.
01c52d31 9706
4009494e 9707
8a1cdce5
AC
9708@node Article Miscellanea
9709@subsection Article Miscellanea
4009494e 9710
8a1cdce5
AC
9711@table @kbd
9712@item A t
9713@kindex A t (Summary)
9714@findex gnus-article-babel
9715Translate the article from one language to another
9716(@code{gnus-article-babel}).
4009494e 9717
8a1cdce5 9718@end table
4009494e 9719
36d3245f 9720
8a1cdce5
AC
9721@node MIME Commands
9722@section MIME Commands
9723@cindex MIME decoding
9724@cindex attachments
9725@cindex viewing attachments
0e6b7ca0 9726
8a1cdce5
AC
9727The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9728instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
4009494e 9729
8a1cdce5
AC
9730@table @kbd
9731@item b
9732@itemx K v
9733@kindex b (Summary)
9734@kindex K v (Summary)
9735View the @acronym{MIME} part.
4009494e 9736
8a1cdce5
AC
9737@item K o
9738@kindex K o (Summary)
9739Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
4009494e 9740
8a1cdce5
AC
9741@item K O
9742@kindex K O (Summary)
9743Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9744from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9745via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
4009494e 9746
8a1cdce5
AC
9747@item K r
9748@kindex K r (Summary)
9749Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
4009494e 9750
8a1cdce5
AC
9751@item K d
9752@kindex K d (Summary)
9753Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9754removed part.
4009494e 9755
8a1cdce5
AC
9756@item K c
9757@kindex K c (Summary)
9758Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
4009494e 9759
8a1cdce5
AC
9760@item K e
9761@kindex K e (Summary)
9762View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
4009494e 9763
8a1cdce5
AC
9764@item K i
9765@kindex K i (Summary)
9766View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
4009494e 9767
8a1cdce5
AC
9768@item K |
9769@kindex K | (Summary)
9770Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9771@end table
4009494e 9772
8a1cdce5
AC
9773The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9774the same manner:
4009494e 9775
8a1cdce5
AC
9776@table @kbd
9777@item K H
9778@kindex K H (Summary)
9779@findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9780View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9781Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9782are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9783message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9784unless the prefix argument is given.
4009494e 9785
8a1cdce5
AC
9786Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9787@acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9788this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9789eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9790trusted senders.
4009494e 9791
8a1cdce5
AC
9792If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9793@code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
4009494e 9794
8a1cdce5
AC
9795This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9796including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9797the group (if you want).
4009494e 9798
8a1cdce5
AC
9799@item K b
9800@kindex K b (Summary)
9801Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9802mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9803parts.
4009494e 9804
8a1cdce5
AC
9805@item K m
9806@kindex K m (Summary)
9807@findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9808Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9809This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9810be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9811(@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
4009494e 9812
8a1cdce5
AC
9813@item X m
9814@kindex X m (Summary)
9815@findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9816Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9817(@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9818convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 9819
8a1cdce5
AC
9820@item M-t
9821@kindex M-t (Summary)
9822@findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9823Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9824(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
4009494e 9825
8a1cdce5
AC
9826@item W M w
9827@kindex W M w (Summary)
9828@findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9829Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9830(@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
4009494e 9831
8a1cdce5
AC
9832@item W M c
9833@kindex W M c (Summary)
9834@findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9835Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9836(@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
4009494e 9837
8a1cdce5
AC
9838This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9839charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9840prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9841groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9842include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9843parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
4009494e 9844
8a1cdce5
AC
9845@item W M v
9846@kindex W M v (Summary)
9847@findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9848View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9849(@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
4009494e 9850
8a1cdce5 9851@end table
4009494e 9852
8a1cdce5 9853Relevant variables:
4009494e 9854
8a1cdce5
AC
9855@table @code
9856@item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9857@vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9858This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9859this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9860@code{nil}.
4009494e 9861
8a1cdce5 9862To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
4009494e 9863
8a1cdce5
AC
9864@lisp
9865(setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9866 '("text/x-vcard"))
9867@end lisp
4009494e 9868
8a1cdce5
AC
9869@item gnus-article-loose-mime
9870@vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9871If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9872before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9873when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9874default is @code{t}.
4009494e 9875
8a1cdce5
AC
9876@item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9877@vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9878@cindex uuencode
9879@cindex yEnc
9880There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9881is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9882this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9883see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9884Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9885single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9886for encoding in Gnus.
4009494e 9887
8a1cdce5
AC
9888@item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9889@vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9890This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9891this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9892displayed or this variable is overridden by
9893@code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9894@code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9895@code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
4009494e 9896
8a1cdce5
AC
9897@item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9898@vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9899This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9900this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9901displayed. This variable overrides
9902@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9903This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9904is @code{nil}.
4009494e 9905
1df7defd 9906E.g., to see security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
8a1cdce5
AC
9907variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9908@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
4009494e 9909
8a1cdce5
AC
9910You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9911display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9912those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9913(@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9914Emacs MIME Manual}).
4009494e 9915
8a1cdce5
AC
9916@item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9917@vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9918If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9919default value is @code{nil}.
4009494e 9920
8a1cdce5
AC
9921@item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9922@vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9923For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9924handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
1df7defd
PE
9925users to gather information from the article (e.g., add Vcard info to
9926the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e.g., automatically
8a1cdce5
AC
9927save all jpegs into some directory).
9928
9929Here's an example function the does the latter:
4009494e
GM
9930
9931@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
9932(defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9933 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9934 (with-temp-buffer
9935 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9936 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9937 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9938(setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9939 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
4009494e
GM
9940@end lisp
9941
8a1cdce5
AC
9942@vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9943@item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9944Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
4009494e 9945
8a1cdce5
AC
9946@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9947@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9948Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
4009494e 9949
8a1cdce5
AC
9950@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9951@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9952Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
4009494e 9953
8a1cdce5
AC
9954If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9955@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9956"multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9957@code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9958emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
4009494e 9959
8a1cdce5
AC
9960@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9961@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9962Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9963overrides @code{nil} values of
9964@code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9965@code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
4009494e 9966
8a1cdce5
AC
9967@vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9968@item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9969List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9970Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
4009494e 9971
8a1cdce5
AC
9972Ready-made functions include@*
9973@code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9974@code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9975@code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9976@code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9977the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9978whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9979is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9980@findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9981@findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9982@findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9983@findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9984@vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
4009494e 9985
8a1cdce5
AC
9986The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9987@code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
4009494e 9988
8a1cdce5
AC
9989Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9990except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9991such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
4009494e
GM
9992
9993@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
9994(setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9995 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9996 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9997 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
4009494e
GM
9998@end lisp
9999
8a1cdce5
AC
10000@noindent
10001to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
4009494e 10002
4009494e
GM
10003@end table
10004
4009494e 10005
8a1cdce5
AC
10006@node Charsets
10007@section Charsets
10008@cindex charsets
4009494e 10009
8a1cdce5
AC
10010People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
10011charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
10012newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
10013just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
10014help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10015what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10016hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
4009494e 10017
8a1cdce5
AC
10018@vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10019This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10020variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10021group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
4009494e 10022
8a1cdce5
AC
10023@vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10024In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10025aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10026even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10027@code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10028charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10029set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10030Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10031which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
4009494e 10032
8a1cdce5
AC
10033@vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10034When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10035determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10036encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10037quoted-printable header encoding.
4009494e 10038
8a1cdce5
AC
10039This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10040for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10041header body-list}@code{)}, where:
4009494e 10042
8a1cdce5
AC
10043@table @var
10044@item test
10045is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10046variable to query,
10047@item header
10048is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10049means encode all charsets),
10050@item body-list
10051is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10052encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10053encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10054@end table
4009494e 10055
8a1cdce5
AC
10056@cindex Russian
10057@cindex koi8-r
10058@cindex koi8-u
10059@cindex iso-8859-5
10060@cindex coding system aliases
10061@cindex preferred charset
4009494e 10062
8a1cdce5
AC
10063@xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10064The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10065MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
4009494e 10066
8a1cdce5 10067Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
4009494e 10068
8a1cdce5
AC
10069If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10070charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
4009494e 10071
8a1cdce5
AC
10072@lisp
10073(put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10074 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10075@end lisp
4009494e 10076
8a1cdce5
AC
10077This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10078the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
4009494e 10079
8a1cdce5 10080If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
4009494e 10081
8a1cdce5
AC
10082@lisp
10083(define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10084@end lisp
4009494e 10085
8a1cdce5 10086This will almost do the right thing.
4009494e 10087
8a1cdce5
AC
10088And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10089something like
4009494e
GM
10090
10091@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
10092(codepage-setup 1251)
10093(define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
4009494e
GM
10094@end lisp
10095
4009494e 10096
8a1cdce5
AC
10097@node Article Commands
10098@section Article Commands
4009494e 10099
8a1cdce5 10100@table @kbd
4009494e 10101
8a1cdce5
AC
10102@item A P
10103@cindex PostScript
10104@cindex printing
10105@kindex A P (Summary)
10106@vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10107@findex gnus-summary-print-article
10108Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10109(@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10110be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10111article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
4009494e 10112
8a1cdce5
AC
10113@item A C
10114@vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10115@findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10116If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10117fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10118it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10119partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10120the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10121do so.
4009494e 10122
4009494e
GM
10123@end table
10124
10125
8a1cdce5
AC
10126@node Summary Sorting
10127@section Summary Sorting
10128@cindex summary sorting
4009494e 10129
8a1cdce5
AC
10130You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10131can't really see why you'd want that.
4009494e
GM
10132
10133@table @kbd
10134
8a1cdce5
AC
10135@item C-c C-s C-n
10136@kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10137@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10138Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
4009494e 10139
8a1cdce5
AC
10140@item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10141@kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10142@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10143Sort by most recent article number
10144(@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
4009494e 10145
8a1cdce5
AC
10146@item C-c C-s C-a
10147@kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10148@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10149Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
4009494e 10150
8a1cdce5
AC
10151@item C-c C-s C-t
10152@kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10153@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10154Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
4009494e 10155
8a1cdce5
AC
10156@item C-c C-s C-s
10157@kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10158@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10159Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
4009494e 10160
8a1cdce5
AC
10161@item C-c C-s C-d
10162@kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10163@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10164Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
4009494e 10165
8a1cdce5
AC
10166@item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10167@kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10168@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10169Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
4009494e 10170
8a1cdce5
AC
10171@item C-c C-s C-l
10172@kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10173@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10174Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
4009494e 10175
8a1cdce5
AC
10176@item C-c C-s C-c
10177@kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10178@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10179Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
4009494e 10180
8a1cdce5
AC
10181@item C-c C-s C-i
10182@kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10183@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10184Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
4009494e 10185
8a1cdce5
AC
10186@item C-c C-s C-r
10187@kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10188@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10189Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
4009494e 10190
8a1cdce5
AC
10191@item C-c C-s C-o
10192@kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10193@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10194Sort using the default sorting method
10195(@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
4009494e
GM
10196@end table
10197
8a1cdce5
AC
10198These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10199use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10200line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10201root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10202toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10203Commands}).
4009494e 10204
8a1cdce5 10205If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
4009494e 10206
4009494e 10207
8a1cdce5
AC
10208@node Finding the Parent
10209@section Finding the Parent
10210@cindex parent articles
10211@cindex referring articles
4009494e 10212
8a1cdce5
AC
10213@table @kbd
10214@item ^
10215@kindex ^ (Summary)
10216@findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10217If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10218displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10219if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10220and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10221can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10222(@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10223you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10224summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
4009494e 10225
8a1cdce5
AC
10226If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10227the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10228ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10229grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10230@kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10231article.
4009494e 10232
8a1cdce5
AC
10233@item A R (Summary)
10234@findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10235@kindex A R (Summary)
10236Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10237article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
4009494e 10238
8a1cdce5
AC
10239@item A T (Summary)
10240@findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10241@kindex A T (Summary)
10242Display the full thread where the current article appears
10243(@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10244headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10245you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10246to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10247visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10248faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
4009494e 10249
8a1cdce5 10250@vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
1df7defd 10251The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i.e.,
8a1cdce5
AC
10252articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10253fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10254the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10255by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
61b1af82 10256
8a1cdce5
AC
10257@item M-^ (Summary)
10258@findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10259@kindex M-^ (Summary)
10260@cindex Message-ID
10261@cindex fetching by Message-ID
10262You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10263belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10264for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10265thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10266You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
4009494e 10267
8a1cdce5
AC
10268Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10269been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10270@code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10271@end table
4009494e 10272
8a1cdce5
AC
10273@vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10274If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10275support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10276you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10277would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10278updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10279necessary.
4009494e 10280
8a1cdce5
AC
10281It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10282@code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10283is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10284match.
4009494e 10285
8a1cdce5
AC
10286Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10287then ask Google if that fails:
4009494e 10288
8a1cdce5
AC
10289@lisp
10290(setq gnus-refer-article-method
10291 '(current
10292 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10293@end lisp
4009494e 10294
8a1cdce5
AC
10295Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10296do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10297@code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10298articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10299only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10300group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
4009494e 10301
8a1cdce5
AC
10302Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10303articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10304Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10305registry}).
61b1af82 10306
8a1cdce5
AC
10307@node Alternative Approaches
10308@section Alternative Approaches
61b1af82 10309
8a1cdce5
AC
10310Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10311Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
4009494e 10312
8a1cdce5
AC
10313@menu
10314* Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10315* Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10316@end menu
25f28806 10317
4009494e 10318
8a1cdce5
AC
10319@node Pick and Read
10320@subsection Pick and Read
10321@cindex pick and read
10322
10323Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10324a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10325buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10326articles with just an article buffer displayed.
4009494e 10327
8a1cdce5
AC
10328@findex gnus-pick-mode
10329@kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10330Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10331this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10332mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10333it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
4009494e 10334
8a1cdce5 10335Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
4009494e 10336
8a1cdce5
AC
10337@table @kbd
10338@item .
10339@kindex . (Pick)
10340@findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10341Pick the article or thread on the current line
10342(@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10343@code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10344entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10345it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10346thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10347at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
4009494e 10348
8a1cdce5
AC
10349@item SPACE
10350@kindex SPACE (Pick)
10351@findex gnus-pick-next-page
10352Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10353at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
4009494e 10354
8a1cdce5
AC
10355@item u
10356@kindex u (Pick)
10357@findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10358Unpick the thread or article
10359(@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10360@code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10361thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10362just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10363the thread or article at that line.
4009494e 10364
8a1cdce5
AC
10365@item RET
10366@kindex RET (Pick)
10367@findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10368@vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10369Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10370given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10371@code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10372will still be visible when you are reading.
4009494e 10373
8a1cdce5 10374@end table
4009494e 10375
8a1cdce5
AC
10376All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10377pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10378which is mapped to the same function
10379@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10380
10381If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
4009494e
GM
10382
10383@lisp
8a1cdce5 10384(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
4009494e
GM
10385@end lisp
10386
8a1cdce5
AC
10387@vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10388@code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
4009494e 10389
8a1cdce5
AC
10390@vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10391If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10392all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 10393
8a1cdce5
AC
10394@vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10395The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10396standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10397displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10398@code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10399Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10400@code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
4009494e 10401
4009494e 10402
8a1cdce5
AC
10403@node Binary Groups
10404@subsection Binary Groups
10405@cindex binary groups
4009494e 10406
8a1cdce5
AC
10407@findex gnus-binary-mode
10408@kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10409If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10410@kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10411is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10412selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10413instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
4009494e 10414
8a1cdce5
AC
10415@kindex g (Binary)
10416@findex gnus-binary-show-article
10417The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10418command, when you have turned on this mode
10419(@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
4009494e 10420
8a1cdce5
AC
10421@vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10422@code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
4009494e 10423
4009494e 10424
8a1cdce5
AC
10425@node Tree Display
10426@section Tree Display
10427@cindex trees
01c52d31 10428
8a1cdce5
AC
10429@vindex gnus-use-trees
10430If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10431@code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10432additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10433in the tree buffer.
01c52d31 10434
8a1cdce5 10435There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
01c52d31 10436
8a1cdce5
AC
10437@table @code
10438@item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10439@vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10440A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
4009494e 10441
8a1cdce5
AC
10442@item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10443@vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10444A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10445Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10446of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
4009494e 10447
8a1cdce5
AC
10448@item gnus-selected-tree-face
10449@vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10450Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10451default is @code{modeline}.
4009494e 10452
8a1cdce5
AC
10453@item gnus-tree-line-format
10454@vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10455A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10456though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10457is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10458the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10459length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
4009494e 10460
8a1cdce5 10461Valid specs are:
4009494e 10462
8a1cdce5
AC
10463@table @samp
10464@item n
10465The name of the poster.
10466@item f
10467The @code{From} header.
10468@item N
10469The number of the article.
10470@item [
10471The opening bracket.
10472@item ]
10473The closing bracket.
10474@item s
10475The subject.
10476@end table
9b3ebcb6 10477
8a1cdce5 10478@xref{Formatting Variables}.
9b3ebcb6 10479
8a1cdce5 10480Variables related to the display are:
9b3ebcb6 10481
8a1cdce5
AC
10482@table @code
10483@item gnus-tree-brackets
10484@vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10485This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10486``sparse'' articles. The format is
10487@example
10488((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10489 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10490 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10491@end example
10492and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
1d4d7664 10493
8a1cdce5
AC
10494@item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10495@vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10496This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10497nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
4009494e 10498
8a1cdce5 10499@end table
4009494e 10500
8a1cdce5
AC
10501@item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10502@vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10503If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10504buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10505windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10506higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10507have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10508buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10509other windows displayed next to it.
4009494e 10510
8a1cdce5
AC
10511You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10512at all times:
4009494e 10513
8a1cdce5
AC
10514@lisp
10515(add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10516 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10517@end lisp
4009494e 10518
8a1cdce5
AC
10519@item gnus-generate-tree-function
10520@vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10521@findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10522@findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10523The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10524functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10525@code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
4009494e 10526
8a1cdce5 10527@end table
4009494e 10528
8a1cdce5 10529Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
4009494e 10530
8a1cdce5
AC
10531@example
10532@{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10533 | \[Jan]
10534 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10535 | \(***)-[Eri]
10536 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10537 \[Bjo]
10538 \[Gun]
10539 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10540@end example
4009494e 10541
8a1cdce5 10542Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
4009494e 10543
8a1cdce5
AC
10544@example
10545@group
10546@{***@}
10547 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10548(***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10549 |--\-----\-----\ |
10550[odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10551 | | |--\
10552[Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10553 |
10554 [Paa]
10555@end group
10556@end example
4009494e 10557
8a1cdce5
AC
10558If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10559side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10560following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e
GM
10561
10562@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
10563(setq gnus-use-trees t
10564 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10565 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10566(gnus-add-configuration
10567 '(article
10568 (vertical 1.0
10569 (horizontal 0.25
10570 (summary 0.75 point)
10571 (tree 1.0))
10572 (article 1.0))))
4009494e
GM
10573@end lisp
10574
8a1cdce5 10575@xref{Window Layout}.
4009494e 10576
4009494e 10577
8a1cdce5
AC
10578@node Mail Group Commands
10579@section Mail Group Commands
10580@cindex mail group commands
4009494e 10581
8a1cdce5
AC
10582Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10583invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
4009494e 10584
8a1cdce5
AC
10585All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10586process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 10587
8a1cdce5 10588@table @kbd
4009494e 10589
8a1cdce5
AC
10590@item B e
10591@kindex B e (Summary)
10592@findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10593@cindex expiring mail
10594Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10595process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10596expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10597(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
4009494e 10598
8a1cdce5
AC
10599@item B C-M-e
10600@kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10601@findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10602@cindex expiring mail
10603Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10604(@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10605articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10606disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
4009494e 10607
8a1cdce5
AC
10608@item B DEL
10609@kindex B DEL (Summary)
10610@cindex deleting mail
10611@findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10612@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10613Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10614disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10615(@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
4009494e 10616
8a1cdce5
AC
10617@item B m
10618@kindex B m (Summary)
10619@cindex move mail
10620@findex gnus-summary-move-article
10621@vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10622Move the article from one mail group to another
10623(@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10624@code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
4009494e 10625
8a1cdce5
AC
10626@item B c
10627@kindex B c (Summary)
10628@cindex copy mail
10629@findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10630@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10631Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10632(@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10633@code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
4009494e 10634
8a1cdce5
AC
10635@item B B
10636@kindex B B (Summary)
10637@cindex crosspost mail
10638@findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10639Crosspost the current article to some other group
10640(@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10641the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10642be properly updated.
4009494e 10643
8a1cdce5
AC
10644@item B i
10645@kindex B i (Summary)
10646@findex gnus-summary-import-article
10647Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10648(@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10649name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10650
10651@item B I
10652@kindex B I (Summary)
10653@findex gnus-summary-create-article
10654Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10655(@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10656@code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10657
10658@item B r
10659@kindex B r (Summary)
10660@findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10661@vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10662Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10663@code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10664select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10665which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10666Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10667(which is the default).
10668
10669@item B w
10670@itemx e
10671@kindex B w (Summary)
10672@kindex e (Summary)
10673@findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10674@kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10675@findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10676Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10677editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10678(@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10679@kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
4009494e 10680
8a1cdce5
AC
10681@item B q
10682@kindex B q (Summary)
10683@findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10684If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10685the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10686will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
4009494e 10687
8a1cdce5
AC
10688@item B t
10689@kindex B t (Summary)
10690@findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10691Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10692when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
4009494e 10693
8a1cdce5
AC
10694@item B p
10695@kindex B p (Summary)
10696@findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10697Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10698follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10699@code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10700(@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10701article from your news server (or rather, from
10702@code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10703report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10704it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10705propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10706just not have arrived yet.
4009494e 10707
8a1cdce5
AC
10708@item K E
10709@kindex K E (Summary)
10710@findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10711@vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10712Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10713The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10714variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
4009494e 10715
8a1cdce5 10716@end table
4009494e 10717
8a1cdce5
AC
10718@vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10719@cindex moving articles
10720If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10721suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10722variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10723(@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10724suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10725@code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10726@code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
4009494e
GM
10727
10728@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
10729(setq gnus-move-split-methods
10730 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10731 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10732 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
4009494e
GM
10733@end lisp
10734
4009494e 10735
8a1cdce5
AC
10736@node Various Summary Stuff
10737@section Various Summary Stuff
4009494e 10738
8a1cdce5
AC
10739@menu
10740* Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10741* Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10742* Summary Generation Commands::
10743* Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10744@end menu
4009494e 10745
8a1cdce5
AC
10746@table @code
10747@vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10748@item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10749If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10750built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10751If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10752lines. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 10753
8a1cdce5
AC
10754@vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10755@item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10756If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10757current article.
4009494e 10758
8a1cdce5
AC
10759@vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10760@item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10761This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
4009494e 10762
8a1cdce5
AC
10763@vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10764@item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10765This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10766generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10767the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10768is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10769have been set.
4009494e 10770
8a1cdce5
AC
10771@vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10772@item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10773It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10774it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10775some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
4009494e 10776
8a1cdce5
AC
10777@vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10778@item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10779A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10780generated.
4009494e 10781
8a1cdce5
AC
10782@vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10783@item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10784When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10785it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10786same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10787sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10788If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10789@code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10790any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10791article---it'll be as if it never existed.
4009494e 10792
8a1cdce5
AC
10793@vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10794@item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10795This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10796of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10797list of articles to be selected.
4009494e 10798
8a1cdce5
AC
10799For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10800the list in one particular group:
4009494e
GM
10801
10802@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
10803(defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10804 (if (string= group "some.group")
10805 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10806 articles))
4009494e
GM
10807@end lisp
10808
8a1cdce5
AC
10809@vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10810@item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10811A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10812variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10813values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10814buffer is active.
4009494e 10815
8a1cdce5
AC
10816Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10817@code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10818assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10819that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10820variable will be used instead.
10821
10822These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10823while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10824buffers. For example:
4009494e
GM
10825
10826@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
10827(setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10828 '(message-use-followup-to
10829 (gnus-visible-headers .
10830 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
4009494e
GM
10831@end lisp
10832
8a1cdce5 10833Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
4009494e 10834
8a1cdce5 10835@end table
4009494e
GM
10836
10837
8a1cdce5
AC
10838@node Summary Group Information
10839@subsection Summary Group Information
4009494e
GM
10840
10841@table @kbd
10842
8a1cdce5
AC
10843@item H d
10844@kindex H d (Summary)
10845@findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10846Give a brief description of the current group
10847(@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10848rereading the description from the server.
4009494e 10849
8a1cdce5
AC
10850@item H h
10851@kindex H h (Summary)
10852@findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10853Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10854keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
8ccbef23 10855
8a1cdce5
AC
10856@item H i
10857@kindex H i (Summary)
10858@findex gnus-info-find-node
10859Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4009494e
GM
10860@end table
10861
10862
8a1cdce5
AC
10863@node Searching for Articles
10864@subsection Searching for Articles
4009494e
GM
10865
10866@table @kbd
10867
8a1cdce5
AC
10868@item M-s
10869@kindex M-s (Summary)
10870@findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10871Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10872(@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
4009494e 10873
8a1cdce5
AC
10874@item M-r
10875@kindex M-r (Summary)
10876@findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10877Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10878(@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
6ecfe5c2 10879
8a1cdce5
AC
10880@item M-S
10881@kindex M-S (Summary)
10882@findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10883Repeat the previous search forwards
10884(@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
4009494e 10885
8a1cdce5
AC
10886@item M-R
10887@kindex M-R (Summary)
10888@findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10889Repeat the previous search backwards
10890(@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
01c52d31 10891
8a1cdce5
AC
10892@item &
10893@kindex & (Summary)
10894@findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10895This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10896on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10897(@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10898string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10899search backward instead.
4009494e 10900
8a1cdce5
AC
10901For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10902all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
4009494e 10903
8a1cdce5
AC
10904@item M-&
10905@kindex M-& (Summary)
10906@findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10907Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10908the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10909@end table
6ecfe5c2 10910
8a1cdce5
AC
10911@node Summary Generation Commands
10912@subsection Summary Generation Commands
4009494e 10913
8a1cdce5 10914@table @kbd
4009494e 10915
8a1cdce5
AC
10916@item Y g
10917@kindex Y g (Summary)
10918@findex gnus-summary-prepare
10919Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
4009494e 10920
8a1cdce5
AC
10921@item Y c
10922@kindex Y c (Summary)
10923@findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10924Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10925(@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
4009494e 10926
8a1cdce5
AC
10927@item Y d
10928@kindex Y d (Summary)
10929@findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10930Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10931(@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
4009494e 10932
8a1cdce5
AC
10933@item Y t
10934@kindex Y t (Summary)
10935@findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10936Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10937(@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
4009494e 10938
8a1cdce5 10939@end table
6ecfe5c2 10940
4009494e 10941
8a1cdce5
AC
10942@node Really Various Summary Commands
10943@subsection Really Various Summary Commands
4009494e
GM
10944
10945@table @kbd
4009494e 10946
8a1cdce5
AC
10947@item A D
10948@itemx C-d
10949@kindex C-d (Summary)
10950@kindex A D (Summary)
10951@findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10952If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10953a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10954article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10955guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10956to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10957whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10958some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10959fashion.
4009494e 10960
8a1cdce5
AC
10961@vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10962The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10963article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10964include:
4009494e 10965
8a1cdce5
AC
10966@table @code
10967@item next
10968Select the next article.
4009494e 10969
8a1cdce5
AC
10970@item next-unread
10971Select the next unread article.
4009494e 10972
8a1cdce5
AC
10973@item next-noselect
10974Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
4009494e 10975
8a1cdce5
AC
10976@item next-unread-noselect
10977Move the cursor to the next unread article.
4009494e
GM
10978@end table
10979
8a1cdce5
AC
10980If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10981article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
4009494e 10982
8a1cdce5
AC
10983@item C-M-d
10984@kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10985@findex gnus-summary-read-document
10986This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10987several documents into one biiig group
10988(@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10989@code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10990@code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10991command understands the process/prefix convention
10992(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 10993
8a1cdce5
AC
10994@item C-t
10995@kindex C-t (Summary)
10996@findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10997Toggle truncation of summary lines
10998(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10999line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
11000to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
4009494e 11001
8a1cdce5
AC
11002@item =
11003@kindex = (Summary)
11004@findex gnus-summary-expand-window
11005Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
11006If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
4009494e 11007
8a1cdce5
AC
11008@item C-M-e
11009@kindex C-M-e (Summary)
11010@findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
11011Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11012group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
4009494e 11013
8a1cdce5
AC
11014@item C-M-a
11015@kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11016@findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11017Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11018group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
4009494e 11019
8a1cdce5 11020@end table
4009494e 11021
4009494e 11022
8a1cdce5
AC
11023@node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11024@section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11025@cindex summary exit
11026@cindex exiting groups
4009494e 11027
8a1cdce5
AC
11028Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11029group and return you to the group buffer.
4009494e 11030
8a1cdce5 11031@table @kbd
4009494e 11032
8a1cdce5
AC
11033@item Z Z
11034@itemx Z Q
11035@itemx q
11036@kindex Z Z (Summary)
11037@kindex Z Q (Summary)
11038@kindex q (Summary)
11039@findex gnus-summary-exit
11040@vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11041@vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11042@vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11043@c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11044Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11045(@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11046called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11047@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11048@code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11049process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11050group mode having no more (unread) groups.
4009494e 11051
8a1cdce5
AC
11052@item Z E
11053@itemx Q
11054@kindex Z E (Summary)
11055@kindex Q (Summary)
11056@findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11057Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11058(@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
4009494e 11059
8a1cdce5
AC
11060@item Z c
11061@itemx c
11062@kindex Z c (Summary)
11063@kindex c (Summary)
11064@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11065@c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11066Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11067(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
4009494e 11068
8a1cdce5
AC
11069@item Z C
11070@kindex Z C (Summary)
11071@findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11072Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11073(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
4009494e 11074
8a1cdce5
AC
11075@item Z n
11076@kindex Z n (Summary)
11077@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11078Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11079(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
4009494e 11080
8a1cdce5
AC
11081@item Z p
11082@kindex Z p (Summary)
11083@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11084Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11085(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
4009494e 11086
8a1cdce5
AC
11087@item Z R
11088@itemx C-x C-s
11089@kindex Z R (Summary)
11090@kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11091@findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11092Exit this group, and then enter it again
11093(@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11094all articles, both read and unread.
4009494e 11095
8a1cdce5
AC
11096@item Z G
11097@itemx M-g
11098@kindex Z G (Summary)
11099@kindex M-g (Summary)
11100@findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11101@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11102Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11103group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11104articles, both read and unread.
4009494e 11105
8a1cdce5
AC
11106@item Z N
11107@kindex Z N (Summary)
11108@findex gnus-summary-next-group
11109Exit the group and go to the next group
11110(@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
4009494e 11111
8a1cdce5
AC
11112@item Z P
11113@kindex Z P (Summary)
11114@findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11115Exit the group and go to the previous group
11116(@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
4009494e 11117
8a1cdce5
AC
11118@item Z s
11119@kindex Z s (Summary)
11120@findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11121Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11122and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11123given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11124command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11125@end table
4009494e 11126
8a1cdce5
AC
11127@vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11128@code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11129with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11130(@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
4009494e 11131
8a1cdce5
AC
11132@findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11133@findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11134@vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11135If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11136about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11137If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11138(Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11139something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11140called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11141buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11142@code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11143summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
4009494e 11144
8a1cdce5 11145There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
4009494e 11146
8a1cdce5
AC
11147@vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11148The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
65e7ca35 11149read, which articles you have replied to, etc.)@: when you exit the
8a1cdce5
AC
11150summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11151@code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11152this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11153other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11154neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11155both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
4009494e 11156
4009494e 11157
8a1cdce5
AC
11158@node Crosspost Handling
11159@section Crosspost Handling
4009494e 11160
8a1cdce5
AC
11161@cindex velveeta
11162@cindex spamming
11163Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11164read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11165posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11166several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11167by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11168heinous crime.
4009494e 11169
8a1cdce5
AC
11170Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11171separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11172@dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11173@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11174excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
4009494e 11175
8a1cdce5
AC
11176@cindex cross-posting
11177@cindex Xref
11178@cindex @acronym{NOV}
11179One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11180correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11181(which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11182does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11183Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11184even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11185articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11186them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11187the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11188the cross reference mechanism.
4009494e 11189
8a1cdce5
AC
11190@cindex LIST overview.fmt
11191@cindex overview.fmt
11192To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11193in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11194@samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11195overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11196get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11197your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11198overview files.
4009494e 11199
8a1cdce5
AC
11200If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11201set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11202considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
4009494e 11203
8a1cdce5 11204C'est la vie.
4009494e 11205
8a1cdce5 11206For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
4009494e 11207
4009494e 11208
8a1cdce5
AC
11209@node Duplicate Suppression
11210@section Duplicate Suppression
4009494e 11211
8a1cdce5
AC
11212By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11213article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11214(@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11215approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11216reasons.
4009494e 11217
8a1cdce5
AC
11218@enumerate
11219@item
11220The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11221is evil and not very common.
4009494e 11222
8a1cdce5
AC
11223@item
11224The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11225@file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
4009494e 11226
8a1cdce5
AC
11227@item
11228You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11229different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
4009494e 11230
8a1cdce5
AC
11231@item
11232You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11233@end enumerate
4009494e 11234
8a1cdce5
AC
11235I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11236well, but these four are the most common situations.
4009494e 11237
8a1cdce5
AC
11238If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11239consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11240will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11241otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11242all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11243mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11244so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11245once.
4009494e 11246
8a1cdce5
AC
11247Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11248sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11249fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11250to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11251article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11252saw the article in.
4009494e 11253
8a1cdce5
AC
11254@table @code
11255@item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11256@vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11257If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
4009494e 11258
8a1cdce5
AC
11259@item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11260@vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11261If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11262make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11263However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11264session are suppressed.
4009494e 11265
8a1cdce5
AC
11266@item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11267@vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11268This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11269suppression list. The default is 10000.
4009494e 11270
8a1cdce5
AC
11271@item gnus-duplicate-file
11272@vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11273The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11274default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
4009494e
GM
11275@end table
11276
8a1cdce5
AC
11277If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11278@code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11279you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11280the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11281so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11282@code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11283to you to figure out, I think.
4009494e 11284
8a1cdce5
AC
11285@node Security
11286@section Security
4009494e 11287
8a1cdce5
AC
11288Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11289The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11290and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11291things to work:
4009494e 11292
8a1cdce5
AC
11293@enumerate
11294@item
11295To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
1df7defd 11296install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG@. The Lisp interface
8a1cdce5
AC
11297to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11298epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11299PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
4009494e 11300
8a1cdce5 11301@item
1df7defd 11302To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL@. OpenSSL 0.9.6
8a1cdce5 11303or newer is recommended.
4009494e 11304
8a1cdce5 11305@end enumerate
4009494e 11306
8a1cdce5
AC
11307The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11308messages include:
11309
11310@table @code
11311@item mm-verify-option
11312@vindex mm-verify-option
11313Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11314@code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11315protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
4009494e 11316
8a1cdce5
AC
11317@item mm-decrypt-option
11318@vindex mm-decrypt-option
11319Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11320@code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11321protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
4009494e 11322
8a1cdce5
AC
11323@item mm-sign-option
11324@vindex mm-sign-option
11325Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11326keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
4009494e 11327
8a1cdce5
AC
11328@item mm-encrypt-option
11329@vindex mm-encrypt-option
11330Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11331public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11332@code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
4009494e 11333
8a1cdce5
AC
11334@item mml1991-use
11335@vindex mml1991-use
11336Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11337@acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11338and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11339deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11340this order.
4009494e 11341
8a1cdce5
AC
11342@item mml2015-use
11343@vindex mml2015-use
11344Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11345@acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11346@code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11347although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11348interface in this order.
4009494e 11349
8a1cdce5 11350@end table
4009494e 11351
8a1cdce5
AC
11352By default the buttons that display security information are not
11353shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11354@kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11355@code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11356@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11357permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11358how to customize these variables to always display security
11359information.
4009494e 11360
8a1cdce5
AC
11361@cindex snarfing keys
11362@cindex importing PGP keys
11363@cindex PGP key ring import
11364Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11365key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11366rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11367allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11368through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11369@file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11370Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11371Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11372(@pxref{Using MIME}).
4009494e 11373
8a1cdce5
AC
11374@example
11375application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11376@end example
11377@noindent
11378This happens to also be the default action defined in
11379@code{mailcap-mime-data}.
4009494e 11380
8a1cdce5
AC
11381More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11382encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11383(@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
4009494e 11384
8a1cdce5
AC
11385@node Mailing List
11386@section Mailing List
11387@cindex mailing list
11388@cindex RFC 2396
4009494e 11389
8a1cdce5
AC
11390@kindex A M (summary)
11391@findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11392Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11393add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11394possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11395summary buffer.
4009494e 11396
8a1cdce5 11397That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
4009494e 11398
8a1cdce5 11399@table @kbd
4009494e 11400
8a1cdce5
AC
11401@item C-c C-n h
11402@kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11403@findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11404Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
4009494e 11405
8a1cdce5
AC
11406@item C-c C-n s
11407@kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11408@findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11409Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
4009494e 11410
8a1cdce5
AC
11411@item C-c C-n u
11412@kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11413@findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11414Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11415field exists.
4009494e 11416
8a1cdce5
AC
11417@item C-c C-n p
11418@kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11419@findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11420Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
4009494e 11421
8a1cdce5
AC
11422@item C-c C-n o
11423@kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11424@findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11425Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
4009494e 11426
8a1cdce5
AC
11427@item C-c C-n a
11428@kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11429@findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11430Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
4009494e 11431
8a1cdce5 11432@end table
4009494e 11433
4009494e 11434
8a1cdce5
AC
11435@node Article Buffer
11436@chapter Article Buffer
11437@cindex article buffer
4009494e 11438
8a1cdce5
AC
11439The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11440one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11441tell Gnus otherwise.
4009494e
GM
11442
11443@menu
8a1cdce5
AC
11444* Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11445* Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11446* HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11447* Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11448* Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11449* Misc Article:: Other stuff.
4009494e
GM
11450@end menu
11451
4009494e 11452
8a1cdce5
AC
11453@node Hiding Headers
11454@section Hiding Headers
11455@cindex hiding headers
11456@cindex deleting headers
4009494e 11457
8a1cdce5
AC
11458The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11459@dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
4009494e 11460
8a1cdce5
AC
11461@vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11462There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11463who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11464article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11465most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11466through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11467@code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11468of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11469article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
4009494e 11470
8a1cdce5 11471Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
4009494e 11472
8a1cdce5 11473@table @code
4009494e 11474
8a1cdce5
AC
11475@item gnus-visible-headers
11476@vindex gnus-visible-headers
11477If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11478that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11479headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
4009494e 11480
8a1cdce5
AC
11481For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11482the article and the subject, you'd say:
4009494e
GM
11483
11484@lisp
8a1cdce5 11485(setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
4009494e
GM
11486@end lisp
11487
8a1cdce5
AC
11488This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11489remain visible.
4009494e 11490
8a1cdce5
AC
11491@item gnus-ignored-headers
11492@vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11493This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11494variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11495should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11496hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
4009494e 11497
8a1cdce5
AC
11498For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11499and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
4009494e
GM
11500
11501@lisp
8a1cdce5 11502(setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
4009494e
GM
11503@end lisp
11504
8a1cdce5
AC
11505This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11506be removed.
3a23a519 11507
8a1cdce5
AC
11508Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11509variable will have no effect.
3a23a519 11510
4009494e
GM
11511@end table
11512
8a1cdce5
AC
11513@vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11514Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11515can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11516variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11517the headers are to be displayed.
4009494e 11518
8a1cdce5
AC
11519For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11520and then the subject, you might say something like:
4009494e 11521
8a1cdce5
AC
11522@lisp
11523(setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11524@end lisp
4009494e 11525
8a1cdce5
AC
11526Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11527variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
4009494e 11528
8a1cdce5
AC
11529@findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11530@vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11531You can hide further boring headers by setting
11532@code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11533does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11534list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11535lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11536from sight.
4009494e 11537
8a1cdce5
AC
11538These conditions are:
11539@table @code
11540@item empty
11541Remove all empty headers.
11542@item followup-to
11543Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11544@code{Newsgroups} header.
11545@item reply-to
11546Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11547the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11548parameter is set.
11549@item newsgroups
11550Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11551name.
11552@item to-address
11553Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11554the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11555@item to-list
11556Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11557the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11558@item cc-list
11559Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11560the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11561@item date
11562Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11563old.
11564@item long-to
11565Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11566@item many-to
11567Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
4009494e
GM
11568@end table
11569
8a1cdce5 11570To include these three elements, you could say something like:
4009494e 11571
8a1cdce5
AC
11572@lisp
11573(setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11574 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11575@end lisp
4009494e 11576
8a1cdce5 11577This is also the default value for this variable.
4009494e 11578
4009494e 11579
8a1cdce5
AC
11580@node Using MIME
11581@section Using MIME
11582@cindex @acronym{MIME}
4009494e 11583
8a1cdce5
AC
11584Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11585while people stand around yawning.
01c52d31 11586
8a1cdce5
AC
11587@acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11588while all newsreaders die of fear.
01c52d31 11589
8a1cdce5
AC
11590@acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11591of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11592other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
4009494e 11593
8a1cdce5
AC
11594@vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11595@findex gnus-display-mime
11596Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11597to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11598default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11599display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
4009494e 11600
8a1cdce5
AC
11601The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11602@acronym{MIME} button:
11603
11604@table @kbd
11605@findex gnus-article-press-button
11606@item RET (Article)
11607@kindex RET (Article)
11608@itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11609Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11610(@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11611the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11612files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11613object is displayed inline.
11614
11615@findex gnus-mime-view-part
11616@item M-RET (Article)
11617@kindex M-RET (Article)
11618@itemx v (Article)
11619Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11620method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11621
11622@findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11623@item t (Article)
11624@kindex t (Article)
11625View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11626(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11627
11628@findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11629@item C (Article)
11630@kindex C (Article)
11631Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11632charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
4009494e 11633
8a1cdce5
AC
11634@findex gnus-mime-save-part
11635@item o (Article)
11636@kindex o (Article)
11637Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11638(@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
4009494e 11639
8a1cdce5
AC
11640@findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11641@item C-o (Article)
11642@kindex C-o (Article)
11643Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11644the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11645suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11646like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11647message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11648(@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
4009494e 11649
8a1cdce5
AC
11650@findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11651@item r (Article)
11652@kindex r (Article)
11653Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
fac916bf 11654external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
8a1cdce5 11655@acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
4009494e 11656
8a1cdce5
AC
11657@findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11658@item d (Article)
11659@kindex d (Article)
11660Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11661information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11662(@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
4009494e 11663
8a1cdce5 11664@c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
4009494e 11665
8a1cdce5
AC
11666@findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11667@item c (Article)
11668@kindex c (Article)
11669Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11670(@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11671without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11672charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11673@ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11674@file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11675@code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11676Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
01c52d31 11677
8a1cdce5
AC
11678@findex gnus-mime-print-part
11679@item p (Article)
11680@kindex p (Article)
11681Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11682command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11683@file{.mailcap} file.
4009494e 11684
8a1cdce5
AC
11685@findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11686@item i (Article)
11687@kindex i (Article)
11688Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11689(@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11690the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11691do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11692@code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11693Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11694automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11695@code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11696Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
4009494e 11697
8a1cdce5
AC
11698@findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11699@item E (Article)
11700@kindex E (Article)
11701View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11702viewer is available, use an external viewer
11703(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
4009494e 11704
8a1cdce5
AC
11705@findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11706@item e (Article)
11707@kindex e (Article)
11708View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11709(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
4009494e 11710
8a1cdce5
AC
11711@findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11712@item | (Article)
11713@kindex | (Article)
11714Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
4009494e 11715
8a1cdce5
AC
11716@findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11717@item . (Article)
11718@kindex . (Article)
11719Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11720(@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
01c52d31 11721
8a1cdce5 11722@end table
01c52d31 11723
8a1cdce5
AC
11724Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11725determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11726@acronym{MIME} manual.
01c52d31 11727
8a1cdce5
AC
11728It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11729buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11730group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11731decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11732comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11733because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11734try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11735to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11736to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
01c52d31 11737
8a1cdce5 11738Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
01c52d31 11739
8a1cdce5 11740Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
01c52d31 11741
4009494e 11742
8a1cdce5
AC
11743@node HTML
11744@section @acronym{HTML}
11745@cindex @acronym{HTML}
4009494e 11746
8a1cdce5
AC
11747If you have @code{w3m} installed on your system, Gnus can display
11748@acronym{HTML} articles in the article buffer. There are many Gnus
11749add-ons for doing this, using various approaches, but there's one
11750(sort of) built-in method that's used by default.
4009494e 11751
8a1cdce5
AC
11752For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization,
11753,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This
11754section only describes the default method.
4009494e 11755
8a1cdce5
AC
11756@table @code
11757@item mm-text-html-renderer
11758@vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11759If set to @code{gnus-article-html}, Gnus will use the built-in method,
11760that's based on @code{w3m}.
4009494e 11761
8a1cdce5
AC
11762@item gnus-blocked-images
11763@vindex gnus-blocked-images
11764External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11765be fetched and displayed. For instance, do block all @acronym{URL}s
11766that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
4009494e 11767
8a1cdce5
AC
11768@lisp
11769(setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11770@end lisp
4009494e 11771
8a1cdce5
AC
11772This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11773called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11774@code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11775anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11776will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11777web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
4009494e 11778
8a1cdce5 11779Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
4009494e 11780
8a1cdce5
AC
11781@item gnus-html-cache-directory
11782@vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11783Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11784@code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11785this directory.
4009494e 11786
8a1cdce5
AC
11787@item gnus-html-cache-size
11788@vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11789When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11790directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
4009494e 11791
8a1cdce5
AC
11792@item gnus-html-frame-width
11793@vindex gnus-html-frame-width
1df7defd 11794The width to use when rendering HTML@. The default is 70.
4009494e 11795
8a1cdce5
AC
11796@item gnus-max-image-proportion
11797@vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11798How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11799A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
1180070% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11801this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11802fit these criteria.
4009494e 11803
8a1cdce5 11804@end table
4009494e 11805
8a1cdce5
AC
11806To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11807installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
fe3c5669 11808automatically.
4009494e 11809
01c52d31 11810
4009494e 11811
8a1cdce5
AC
11812@node Customizing Articles
11813@section Customizing Articles
11814@cindex article customization
4009494e 11815
8a1cdce5
AC
11816A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11817exist. You can call these functions interactively
11818(@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11819called automatically when you select the articles.
4009494e 11820
8a1cdce5
AC
11821To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11822``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11823@code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11824be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
4009494e 11825
8a1cdce5
AC
11826Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11827for sensible values.
4009494e 11828
8a1cdce5
AC
11829@enumerate
11830@item
11831@code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
4009494e 11832
8a1cdce5
AC
11833@item
11834@code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
4009494e 11835
8a1cdce5
AC
11836@item
11837@code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
4009494e 11838
8a1cdce5
AC
11839@item
11840@code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
4009494e 11841
8a1cdce5
AC
11842@item
11843@code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
4009494e 11844
8a1cdce5
AC
11845@item
11846An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11847than this number.
4009494e 11848
8a1cdce5
AC
11849@item
11850A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11851articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11852regexps in the list.
4009494e 11853
8a1cdce5
AC
11854@item
11855A list where the first element is not a string:
4009494e 11856
8a1cdce5
AC
11857The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11858predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11859@code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
4009494e 11860
8a1cdce5
AC
11861@lisp
11862(or last
11863 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11864@end lisp
4009494e 11865
47cc1156
G
11866@item
11867A function: the function is called with no arguments and should return
11868@code{nil} or non-@code{nil}. The current article is available in the
11869buffer named by @code{gnus-article-buffer}.
11870
8a1cdce5 11871@end enumerate
4009494e 11872
8a1cdce5
AC
11873You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11874to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11875be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11876considered to contain just a single part.
4009494e 11877
8a1cdce5
AC
11878@vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11879Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11880want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11881treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11882variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11883type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11884controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
4009494e 11885
8a1cdce5
AC
11886@ifinfo
11887@c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11888@c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11889@c `i foo-bar'.
11890@vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11891@vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11892@vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11893@vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11894@vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11895@vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11896@vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11897@vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11898@vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11899@vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11900@vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11901@vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
12e3ca0a 11902@vindex gnus-treat-date
8a1cdce5
AC
11903@vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11904@vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11905@vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11906@vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11907@vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11908@vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11909@vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11910@vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11911@vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11912@vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11913@vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11914@vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11915@vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11916@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11917@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11918@vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11919@vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11920@vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11921@vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11922@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11923@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11924@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11925@vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11926@vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11927@vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11928@vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11929@vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11930@vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11931@end ifinfo
4009494e 11932
8a1cdce5
AC
11933The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11934customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11935group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11936possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
4009494e 11937
8a1cdce5
AC
11938@table @code
11939@item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11940@item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
4009494e 11941
8a1cdce5 11942@xref{Article Buttons}.
4009494e 11943
8a1cdce5
AC
11944@item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11945@item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11946@item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11947@item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11948@item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11949@item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11950@item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11951@item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11952@item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11953@item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
4009494e 11954
8a1cdce5 11955@xref{Article Washing}.
4009494e 11956
12e3ca0a
LI
11957@item gnus-treat-date (head)
11958
11959This will transform/add date headers according to the
11960@code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11961headers to display. The formats available are:
11962
11963@table @code
11964@item ut
11965Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11966
11967@item local
11968The user's local time zone.
11969
11970@item english
11971A semi-readable English sentence.
11972
11973@item lapsed
11974The time elapsed since the message was posted.
11975
d76c843e 11976@item combined-lapsed
12e3ca0a
LI
11977Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
11978
11979@item original
11980The original date header.
11981
11982@item iso8601
11983ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
11984
11985@item user-defined
11986A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
11987variable.
11988
11989@end table
4009494e 11990
8a1cdce5 11991@xref{Article Date}.
4009494e 11992
8a1cdce5
AC
11993@item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11994@item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11995@item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
4009494e 11996
8a1cdce5 11997@xref{Picons}.
4009494e 11998
8a1cdce5
AC
11999@item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
12000@item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
4009494e 12001
8a1cdce5 12002@xref{Gravatars}.
4009494e 12003
8a1cdce5 12004@item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
4009494e 12005
8a1cdce5 12006@item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
4009494e 12007
8a1cdce5
AC
12008@vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
12009Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
12010is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
4009494e 12011
8a1cdce5 12012@xref{Smileys}.
4009494e 12013
8a1cdce5
AC
12014@vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12015@item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
4009494e 12016
8a1cdce5 12017@xref{X-Face}.
4009494e 12018
8a1cdce5
AC
12019@vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12020@item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
4009494e 12021
8a1cdce5 12022@xref{Face}.
4009494e 12023
8a1cdce5
AC
12024@vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12025@item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12026@vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12027@item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12028@vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12029@item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12030@vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12031@item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12032@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12033@item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12034@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12035@item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12036@vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12037@item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12038@vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12039@item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12040@vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12041@item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12042@vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12043@item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
4009494e 12044
8a1cdce5 12045@xref{Article Hiding}.
4009494e 12046
8a1cdce5
AC
12047@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12048@item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12049@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12050@item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12051@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12052@item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
4009494e 12053
8a1cdce5 12054@xref{Article Highlighting}.
4146636e 12055
8a1cdce5
AC
12056@vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12057@item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12058@item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12059@vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12060@item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
4146636e 12061
8a1cdce5
AC
12062@vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12063@item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12064@vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12065@item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12066@vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12067@item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12068@vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12069@item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12070
12071@xref{Article Header}.
4009494e 12072
4009494e
GM
12073
12074@end table
12075
8a1cdce5
AC
12076@vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12077You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12078@code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12079part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12080information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12081everything.
4009494e 12082
4009494e 12083
8a1cdce5
AC
12084@node Article Keymap
12085@section Article Keymap
4009494e 12086
8a1cdce5
AC
12087Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12088article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12089buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12090buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12091buffer.
4009494e 12092
8a1cdce5
AC
12093@kindex v (Article)
12094@cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12095The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12096command or better use it as a prefix key.
4009494e 12097
8a1cdce5 12098A few additional keystrokes are available:
4009494e 12099
8a1cdce5
AC
12100@table @kbd
12101
12102@item SPACE
12103@kindex SPACE (Article)
12104@findex gnus-article-next-page
12105Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12106This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12107
12108@item DEL
12109@kindex DEL (Article)
12110@findex gnus-article-prev-page
12111Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12112This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
4009494e 12113
8a1cdce5
AC
12114@item C-c ^
12115@kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12116@findex gnus-article-refer-article
12117If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12118@kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12119(@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
4009494e 12120
8a1cdce5
AC
12121@item C-c C-m
12122@kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12123@findex gnus-article-mail
12124Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12125given a prefix, include the mail.
4009494e 12126
8a1cdce5
AC
12127@item s
12128@kindex s (Article)
12129@findex gnus-article-show-summary
12130Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12131(@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
4009494e 12132
8a1cdce5
AC
12133@item ?
12134@kindex ? (Article)
12135@findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12136Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12137(@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
4009494e 12138
8a1cdce5
AC
12139@item TAB
12140@kindex TAB (Article)
12141@findex gnus-article-next-button
12142Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12143only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
4009494e 12144
8a1cdce5
AC
12145@item M-TAB
12146@kindex M-TAB (Article)
12147@findex gnus-article-prev-button
12148Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
4009494e 12149
8a1cdce5
AC
12150@item R
12151@kindex R (Article)
12152@findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12153Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12154(@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12155only yank the text in the region.
4009494e 12156
8a1cdce5
AC
12157@item S W
12158@kindex S W (Article)
12159@findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12160Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12161(@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12162active, only yank the text in the region.
4009494e 12163
8a1cdce5
AC
12164@item F
12165@kindex F (Article)
12166@findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12167Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12168(@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12169only yank the text in the region.
4009494e 12170
4009494e 12171
8a1cdce5 12172@end table
4009494e 12173
4009494e 12174
8a1cdce5
AC
12175@node Misc Article
12176@section Misc Article
4009494e 12177
8a1cdce5 12178@table @code
4009494e 12179
8a1cdce5
AC
12180@item gnus-single-article-buffer
12181@vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12182@cindex article buffers, several
12183If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12184(This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12185article buffer.
4009494e 12186
8a1cdce5
AC
12187@item gnus-widen-article-window
12188@cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12189If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12190command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
4009494e 12191
8a1cdce5
AC
12192@vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12193@item gnus-article-decode-hook
12194@cindex @acronym{MIME}
12195Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12196@code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
4009494e 12197
8a1cdce5
AC
12198@vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12199@item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12200This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12201article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12202depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12203the contents of the article buffer.
4009494e 12204
8a1cdce5
AC
12205@item gnus-article-mode-hook
12206@vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12207Hook called in article mode buffers.
4009494e 12208
8a1cdce5
AC
12209@item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12210@vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12211Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12212@code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
4009494e 12213
8a1cdce5
AC
12214@vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12215@item gnus-article-over-scroll
12216If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12217no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 12218
8a1cdce5
AC
12219@vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12220@item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12221This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12222@code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12223Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12224with two extensions:
4009494e 12225
8a1cdce5 12226@table @samp
4009494e 12227
8a1cdce5
AC
12228@item w
12229The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12230character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12231performed. The characters and their meaning:
4009494e 12232
8a1cdce5 12233@table @samp
4009494e 12234
8a1cdce5
AC
12235@item c
12236Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
4009494e 12237
8a1cdce5
AC
12238@item h
12239Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
4009494e 12240
8a1cdce5
AC
12241@item p
12242Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12243hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
1df7defd 12244security status, i.e., good or bad signature.)
4009494e 12245
8a1cdce5
AC
12246@item s
12247Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
4009494e 12248
8a1cdce5
AC
12249@item o
12250Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
4009494e 12251
8a1cdce5
AC
12252@item e
12253Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
4009494e 12254
8a1cdce5 12255@end table
4009494e 12256
8a1cdce5
AC
12257@item m
12258The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
4009494e 12259
4009494e
GM
12260@end table
12261
8a1cdce5
AC
12262@vindex gnus-break-pages
12263
12264@item gnus-break-pages
12265Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12266is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12267page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12268paging will not be done.
4009494e 12269
8a1cdce5
AC
12270@item gnus-page-delimiter
12271@vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12272This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12273(formfeed).
4009494e 12274
8a1cdce5
AC
12275@cindex IDNA
12276@cindex internationalized domain names
12277@vindex gnus-use-idna
12278@item gnus-use-idna
12279This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12280internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12281@samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12282for how to compose such messages. This requires
12283@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12284variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
4009494e 12285
8a1cdce5
AC
12286@vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12287@item gnus-inhibit-images
12288If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12289article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12290@acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12291when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12292,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12293@code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
4009494e 12294
8a1cdce5 12295@end table
4009494e 12296
4009494e 12297
8a1cdce5
AC
12298@node Composing Messages
12299@chapter Composing Messages
12300@cindex composing messages
12301@cindex messages
12302@cindex mail
12303@cindex sending mail
12304@cindex reply
12305@cindex followup
12306@cindex post
12307@cindex using gpg
12308@cindex using s/mime
12309@cindex using smime
4009494e 12310
8a1cdce5
AC
12311@kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12312All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12313where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12314article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12315Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12316on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
4009494e 12317
8a1cdce5
AC
12318@menu
12319* Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12320* Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12321* POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12322* Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12323* Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12324* Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12325* Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12326* Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12327* Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12328@end menu
4009494e 12329
8a1cdce5
AC
12330Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12331remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
4009494e 12332
4009494e 12333
8a1cdce5
AC
12334@node Mail
12335@section Mail
4009494e 12336
8a1cdce5 12337Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
4009494e 12338
8a1cdce5
AC
12339@table @code
12340@item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12341@vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12342List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12343headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12344@code{nil} include all headers.
4009494e 12345
8a1cdce5
AC
12346@item gnus-add-to-list
12347@vindex gnus-add-to-list
12348If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12349that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
4009494e 12350
8a1cdce5
AC
12351@item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12352@vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12353If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12354about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12355interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12356receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12357non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12358matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
4009494e 12359
8a1cdce5
AC
12360If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12361press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
01c52d31 12362
8a1cdce5
AC
12363@item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12364@vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12365If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12366@code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12367useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
4009494e 12368
8a1cdce5 12369@end table
01c52d31 12370
4009494e 12371
8a1cdce5
AC
12372@node Posting Server
12373@section Posting Server
4009494e 12374
8a1cdce5
AC
12375When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12376(extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
4009494e 12377
8a1cdce5 12378Thank you for asking. I hate you.
4009494e 12379
8a1cdce5 12380It can be quite complicated.
4009494e 12381
8a1cdce5
AC
12382@vindex gnus-post-method
12383When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12384(@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12385Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12386reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12387groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12388you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12389want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12390fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12391@code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
4009494e 12392
8a1cdce5
AC
12393@lisp
12394(setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12395@end lisp
4009494e 12396
8a1cdce5
AC
12397Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12398this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12399can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12400the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
4009494e 12401
8a1cdce5
AC
12402If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12403Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
4009494e 12404
8a1cdce5
AC
12405You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12406If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12407for posting.
12408
12409Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12410you can set this variable to @code{native}.
4009494e 12411
8a1cdce5
AC
12412@vindex message-send-mail-function
12413When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12414variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12415value suitable for your system.
12416@xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12417information.
4009494e 12418
89b163db 12419
8a1cdce5
AC
12420@node POP before SMTP
12421@section POP before SMTP
12422@cindex pop before smtp
8a1cdce5 12423@findex mail-source-touch-pop
4009494e 12424
89b163db
G
12425Does your @acronym{ISP} use @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12426authentication? This authentication method simply requires you to
12427contact the @acronym{POP} server before sending email. To do that,
12428put the following lines in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e 12429
8a1cdce5 12430@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
12431(add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12432@end lisp
85115796 12433
8a1cdce5 12434@noindent
89b163db
G
12435The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function does @acronym{POP}
12436authentication according to the value of @code{mail-sources} without
12437fetching mails, just before sending a mail. @xref{Mail Sources}.
85115796 12438
8a1cdce5
AC
12439If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12440@code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12441@code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12442used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12443is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12444mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
85115796 12445
8a1cdce5
AC
12446@lisp
12447(setq mail-source-primary-source
12448 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12449 :password "secret"))
12450@end lisp
85115796 12451
8a1cdce5
AC
12452@noindent
12453Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12454@acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
51dee5ef
KY
12455
12456@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
12457(add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12458 (lambda ()
12459 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12460 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12461 :password "secret")))
12462 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
51dee5ef
KY
12463@end lisp
12464
89b163db 12465
8a1cdce5
AC
12466@node Mail and Post
12467@section Mail and Post
51dee5ef 12468
8a1cdce5
AC
12469Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12470posting:
239661c0 12471
8a1cdce5
AC
12472@table @code
12473@item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12474@findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12475@cindex mailing lists
85115796 12476
8a1cdce5
AC
12477If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12478gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12479problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12480One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12481(@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12482@code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12483really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12484lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12485still a pain, though.
85115796 12486
8a1cdce5
AC
12487@item gnus-user-agent
12488@vindex gnus-user-agent
12489@cindex User-Agent
85115796 12490
8a1cdce5
AC
12491This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12492User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12493symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12494version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12495(show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12496configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12497string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
59d09f15 12498
85115796
KY
12499@end table
12500
8a1cdce5
AC
12501You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12502you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12503spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
85115796 12504
8a1cdce5
AC
12505@cindex ispell
12506@findex ispell-message
12507@lisp
12508(add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12509@end lisp
85115796 12510
8a1cdce5
AC
12511If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12512you're in, you could say something like the following:
85115796 12513
8a1cdce5
AC
12514@lisp
12515(add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12516 (lambda ()
12517 (cond
12518 ((string-match
12519 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12520 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12521 (t
12522 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12523@end lisp
4009494e 12524
8a1cdce5 12525Modify to suit your needs.
4009494e 12526
8a1cdce5
AC
12527@vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12528If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
12529citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12530mode buffers.
4009494e 12531
8a1cdce5
AC
12532@node Archived Messages
12533@section Archived Messages
12534@cindex archived messages
12535@cindex sent messages
4009494e 12536
8a1cdce5
AC
12537Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12538send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12539store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
005a89ff
G
12540@code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}. The
12541default is "sent.%Y-%m", which gives you one archive group per month.
4009494e 12542
8a1cdce5
AC
12543For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12544@kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12545Group Commands}).
4009494e 12546
8a1cdce5
AC
12547@vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12548@code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12549use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12550actually being used it is expanded into:
4009494e 12551
8a1cdce5
AC
12552@lisp
12553(nnfolder "archive"
12554 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12555 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12556 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12557 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12558@end lisp
01c52d31 12559
8a1cdce5
AC
12560@quotation
12561@vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12562Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12563so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12564@code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12565@code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12566since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12567even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12568afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12569mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12570saved method to reflect always the value of
12571@code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12572@code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12573value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12574@end quotation
4009494e 12575
8a1cdce5
AC
12576You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12577@code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12578for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12579directory chosen, you could say something like:
4009494e 12580
8a1cdce5
AC
12581@lisp
12582(setq gnus-message-archive-method
12583 '(nnfolder "archive"
12584 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12585 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12586 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12587@end lisp
4009494e 12588
8a1cdce5
AC
12589@vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12590@cindex Gcc
12591Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12592to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12593determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
4009494e 12594
8a1cdce5
AC
12595This variable can be used to do the following:
12596
12597@table @asis
12598@item a string
12599Messages will be saved in that group.
12600
12601Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12602message will not be stored in the select method given by
12603@code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12604by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12605has the default value shown above. Then setting
12606@code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12607messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12608value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12609@samp{nnml:foo}.
4009494e 12610
8a1cdce5
AC
12611@item a list of strings
12612Messages will be saved in all those groups.
4009494e 12613
8a1cdce5
AC
12614@item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12615When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
4009494e 12616
8a1cdce5 12617@item @code{nil}
a5166359 12618No message archiving will take place.
8a1cdce5 12619@end table
4009494e 12620
8a1cdce5 12621Let's illustrate:
4009494e 12622
8a1cdce5
AC
12623Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12624@lisp
12625(setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12626@end lisp
4009494e 12627
8a1cdce5
AC
12628Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12629@lisp
12630(setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12631@end lisp
4009494e 12632
8a1cdce5
AC
12633Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12634@lisp
12635(setq gnus-message-archive-group
12636 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12637 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12638 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12639@end lisp
4009494e 12640
8a1cdce5
AC
12641More complex stuff:
12642@lisp
12643(setq gnus-message-archive-group
12644 '((if (message-news-p)
12645 "misc-news"
12646 "misc-mail")))
12647@end lisp
4009494e 12648
8a1cdce5
AC
12649How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12650messages in one file per month:
4009494e 12651
8a1cdce5
AC
12652@lisp
12653(setq gnus-message-archive-group
12654 '((if (message-news-p)
12655 "misc-news"
12656 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12657@end lisp
4009494e 12658
8a1cdce5
AC
12659Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12660group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12661you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12662archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12663Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12664enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12665group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12666if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12667nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12668continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
4009494e 12669
8a1cdce5
AC
12670@table @code
12671@item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12672@vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12673If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
4009494e 12674
8a1cdce5
AC
12675@item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12676@vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12677If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12678and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12679@code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12680non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12681changed in the future.
61b1af82 12682
89b163db
G
12683@item gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12684@vindex gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12685Like the @code{gcc-self} group parameter, applied only for unmodified
12686messages that @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} (@pxref{Summary Mail
12687Commands}) resends. Non-@code{nil} value of this variable takes
12688precedence over any existing @code{Gcc} header.
12689
12690If this is @code{none}, no @code{Gcc} copy will be made. If this is
12691@code{t}, messages resent will be @code{Gcc} copied to the current
12692group. If this is a string, it specifies a group to which resent
12693messages will be @code{Gcc} copied. If this is @code{nil}, @code{Gcc}
12694will be done according to existing @code{Gcc} header(s), if any. If
12695this is @code{no-gcc-self}, that is the default, resent messages will be
12696@code{Gcc} copied to groups that existing @code{Gcc} header specifies,
12697except for the current group.
12698
12699@item gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12700@vindex gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12701@itemx gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12702@vindex gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12703
12704These hooks are run before/after encoding the message body of the Gcc
12705copy of a sent message. The current buffer (when the hook is run)
12706contains the message including the message header. Changes made to
12707the message will only affect the Gcc copy, but not the original
12708message. You can use these hooks to edit the copy (and influence
1df7defd 12709subsequent transformations), e.g., remove MML secure tags
89b163db
G
12710(@pxref{Signing and encrypting}).
12711
8a1cdce5 12712@end table
61b1af82 12713
4009494e 12714
8a1cdce5
AC
12715@node Posting Styles
12716@section Posting Styles
12717@cindex posting styles
12718@cindex styles
4009494e 12719
8a1cdce5 12720All them variables, they make my head swim.
4009494e 12721
8a1cdce5
AC
12722So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12723on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12724and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12725on?
4009494e 12726
8a1cdce5
AC
12727@vindex gnus-posting-styles
12728One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12729variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12730came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12731a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12732variable:
4009494e 12733
8a1cdce5
AC
12734@lisp
12735((".*"
12736 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12737 (organization "What me?"))
12738 ("^comp"
12739 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12740 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12741 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12742@end lisp
4009494e 12743
8a1cdce5
AC
12744As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12745@dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12746``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12747over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12748applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12749the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12750@samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12751signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
4009494e 12752
8a1cdce5
AC
12753The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12754string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12755If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12756will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12757@var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12758@var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12759replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12760followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12761@code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12762no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12763referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12764any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12765said to @dfn{match}.
4009494e 12766
8a1cdce5
AC
12767Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12768attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12769addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12770form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12771@code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12772contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12773@var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12774name can be one of:
4009494e 12775
8a1cdce5
AC
12776@itemize @bullet
12777@item @code{signature}
12778@item @code{signature-file}
12779@item @code{x-face-file}
12780@item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12781@item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12782@item @code{body}
12783@end itemize
4009494e 12784
8a1cdce5
AC
12785Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12786@code{message-signature-directory}.
4009494e 12787
8a1cdce5
AC
12788The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12789this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12790the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12791name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12792is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
4009494e 12793
8a1cdce5
AC
12794The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12795(the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12796or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12797used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12798message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12799article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12800variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12801from date id references chars lines xref extra.
4009494e 12802
8a1cdce5
AC
12803In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12804expression, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed on
12805the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by the
0fd2c9a3
GM
12806corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing Match,,
12807Replacing the Text that Matched, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
4009494e 12808
8a1cdce5 12809@vindex message-reply-headers
4009494e 12810
8a1cdce5
AC
12811If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12812meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12813of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
4009494e 12814
8a1cdce5
AC
12815@findex message-mail-p
12816@findex message-news-p
4009494e 12817
8a1cdce5 12818So here's a new example:
4009494e 12819
8a1cdce5
AC
12820@lisp
12821(setq gnus-posting-styles
12822 '((".*"
12823 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12824 (name "User Name")
12825 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12826 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12827 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12828 ("^rec.humor"
12829 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12830 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12831 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12832 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12833 (signature my-news-signature))
12834 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12835 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12836 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12837 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12838 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12839 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12840 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12841 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12842 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
89b163db 12843 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
8a1cdce5
AC
12844 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12845 ("nnml:.*"
12846 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12847 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12848 ("^nn.+:"
12849 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12850@end lisp
4009494e 12851
8a1cdce5
AC
12852The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12853@code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12854if you fill many roles.
12855You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12856@xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
4009494e 12857
89b163db
G
12858Of particular interest in the ``work-mail'' style is the
12859@samp{X-Message-SMTP-Method} header. It specifies how to send the
12860outgoing email. You may want to sent certain emails through certain
12861@acronym{SMTP} servers due to company policies, for instance.
12862@xref{Mail Variables, ,Message Variables, message, Message Manual}.
12863
12864
8a1cdce5
AC
12865@node Drafts
12866@section Drafts
12867@cindex drafts
4009494e 12868
8a1cdce5
AC
12869If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12870you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12871craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12872the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12873other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
4009494e 12874
8a1cdce5
AC
12875Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12876some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12877automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12878If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12879article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12880group.)
4009494e 12881
8a1cdce5
AC
12882@cindex nndraft
12883@vindex nndraft-directory
12884The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12885@code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12886@samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12887@code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12888that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12889read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
4009494e 12890
8a1cdce5
AC
12891If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12892to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12893unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12894a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12895behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12896be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12897simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12898Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12899correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
4009494e 12900
8a1cdce5
AC
12901@c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12902@c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12903@c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12904@c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12905@c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12906@c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12907@c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12908@c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12909@c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12910@c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12911@c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12912@c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12913@c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12914@c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12915@c
12916@c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12917@c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12918@c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
4009494e 12919
8a1cdce5
AC
12920@findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12921@kindex D e (Draft)
12922When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12923draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12924that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
4009494e 12925
8a1cdce5
AC
12926Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12927Articles}).
4009494e 12928
8a1cdce5
AC
12929@findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12930@kindex D s (Draft)
12931@findex gnus-draft-send-message
12932@kindex D S (Draft)
12933If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12934doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12935(@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12936process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12937command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12938in the buffer.
4009494e 12939
8a1cdce5
AC
12940@findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12941@kindex D t (Draft)
12942If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12943@kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12944as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
4009494e 12945
8a1cdce5
AC
12946Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12947command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
4009494e 12948
4009494e 12949
8a1cdce5
AC
12950@node Rejected Articles
12951@section Rejected Articles
12952@cindex rejected articles
95838435 12953
8a1cdce5
AC
12954Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12955doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12956@emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12957Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
4009494e 12958
8a1cdce5
AC
12959These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12960(Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12961fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12962you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12963articles until some later time when the server feels better.
4009494e 12964
8a1cdce5
AC
12965The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12966(@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12967typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
4009494e 12968
8a1cdce5
AC
12969@node Signing and encrypting
12970@section Signing and encrypting
12971@cindex using gpg
12972@cindex using s/mime
12973@cindex using smime
4009494e 12974
8a1cdce5
AC
12975Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12976@acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12977decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12978@code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
4009494e 12979
8a1cdce5
AC
12980@vindex gnus-message-replysign
12981@vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12982@vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12983Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12984messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12985are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12986@code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12987@code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12988@code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12989automatically encrypted messages.
4009494e 12990
8a1cdce5
AC
12991Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12992@acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12993signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
4009494e 12994
8a1cdce5 12995@table @kbd
4009494e 12996
8a1cdce5
AC
12997@item C-c C-m s s
12998@kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12999@findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
71e691a5 13000
8a1cdce5 13001Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
4009494e 13002
8a1cdce5
AC
13003@item C-c C-m s o
13004@kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
13005@findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
4009494e 13006
8a1cdce5 13007Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
4009494e 13008
8a1cdce5
AC
13009@item C-c C-m s p
13010@kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
13011@findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
4009494e 13012
8a1cdce5 13013Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
4009494e 13014
8a1cdce5
AC
13015@item C-c C-m c s
13016@kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
13017@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
4009494e 13018
8a1cdce5 13019Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
4009494e 13020
8a1cdce5
AC
13021@item C-c C-m c o
13022@kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13023@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
4009494e 13024
8a1cdce5 13025Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
4009494e 13026
8a1cdce5
AC
13027@item C-c C-m c p
13028@kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13029@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
4009494e 13030
8a1cdce5 13031Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
4009494e 13032
8a1cdce5
AC
13033@item C-c C-m C-n
13034@kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13035@findex mml-unsecure-message
13036Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
4009494e 13037
8a1cdce5 13038@end table
4009494e 13039
8a1cdce5 13040@xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
4009494e 13041
8a1cdce5
AC
13042@node Select Methods
13043@chapter Select Methods
13044@cindex foreign groups
13045@cindex select methods
4009494e 13046
8a1cdce5
AC
13047A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13048default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13049@acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13050personal mail group.
4009494e 13051
8a1cdce5
AC
13052A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13053a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
1df7defd 13054list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g., @code{nntp},
8a1cdce5
AC
13055@code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13056name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13057value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
4009494e 13058
8a1cdce5
AC
13059One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13060we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
4009494e 13061
8a1cdce5
AC
13062The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13063group as.
4009494e 13064
8a1cdce5
AC
13065For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13066@samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13067method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13068@samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13069back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
4009494e 13070
8a1cdce5 13071The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
4009494e 13072
8a1cdce5
AC
13073@menu
13074* Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13075* Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13076* Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13077* Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13078* Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13079* Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13080* Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13081* Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13082* Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13083@end menu
4009494e 13084
239661c0 13085
8a1cdce5
AC
13086@node Server Buffer
13087@section Server Buffer
13088
13089Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13090one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13091connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13092one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13093the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13094back end represents a virtual server.
4009494e 13095
8a1cdce5
AC
13096For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13097different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13098on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13099use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
4009494e 13100
8a1cdce5
AC
13101These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13102complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13103@acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13104hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13105Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13106server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13107select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
4009494e 13108
8a1cdce5
AC
13109To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13110(@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
4009494e
GM
13111
13112@menu
8a1cdce5
AC
13113* Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13114* Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13115* Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13116* Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13117* Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13118* Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13119* Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
4009494e
GM
13120@end menu
13121
8a1cdce5
AC
13122@vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13123@code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13124
13125
13126@node Server Buffer Format
13127@subsection Server Buffer Format
13128@cindex server buffer format
13129
13130@vindex gnus-server-line-format
13131You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13132@code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13133variable, with some simple extensions:
4009494e 13134
8a1cdce5 13135@table @samp
4009494e 13136
8a1cdce5
AC
13137@item h
13138How the news is fetched---the back end name.
4009494e 13139
8a1cdce5
AC
13140@item n
13141The name of this server.
4009494e 13142
8a1cdce5
AC
13143@item w
13144Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
4009494e 13145
8a1cdce5
AC
13146@item s
13147The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
4009494e 13148
8a1cdce5
AC
13149@item a
13150Whether this server is agentized.
13151@end table
4009494e 13152
8a1cdce5
AC
13153@vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13154The mode line can also be customized by using the
13155@code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13156Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
4009494e 13157
8a1cdce5
AC
13158@table @samp
13159@item S
13160Server name.
4009494e 13161
8a1cdce5
AC
13162@item M
13163Server method.
4009494e
GM
13164@end table
13165
8a1cdce5 13166Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
4009494e 13167
4009494e 13168
8a1cdce5
AC
13169@node Server Commands
13170@subsection Server Commands
13171@cindex server commands
4009494e 13172
8a1cdce5 13173@table @kbd
4009494e 13174
8a1cdce5
AC
13175@item v
13176@kindex v (Server)
13177@cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13178The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13179command or better use it as a prefix key.
4009494e 13180
8a1cdce5
AC
13181@item a
13182@kindex a (Server)
13183@findex gnus-server-add-server
13184Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
4009494e 13185
8a1cdce5
AC
13186@item e
13187@kindex e (Server)
13188@findex gnus-server-edit-server
13189Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
4009494e 13190
8a1cdce5
AC
13191@item S
13192@kindex S (Server)
13193@findex gnus-server-show-server
13194Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
4009494e 13195
8a1cdce5
AC
13196@item SPACE
13197@kindex SPACE (Server)
13198@findex gnus-server-read-server
13199Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
4009494e 13200
8a1cdce5
AC
13201@item q
13202@kindex q (Server)
13203@findex gnus-server-exit
13204Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
4009494e 13205
8a1cdce5
AC
13206@item k
13207@kindex k (Server)
13208@findex gnus-server-kill-server
13209Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
4009494e 13210
8a1cdce5
AC
13211@item y
13212@kindex y (Server)
13213@findex gnus-server-yank-server
13214Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
4009494e 13215
8a1cdce5
AC
13216@item c
13217@kindex c (Server)
13218@findex gnus-server-copy-server
13219Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
4009494e 13220
8a1cdce5
AC
13221@item l
13222@kindex l (Server)
13223@findex gnus-server-list-servers
13224List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
4009494e 13225
8a1cdce5
AC
13226@item s
13227@kindex s (Server)
13228@findex gnus-server-scan-server
13229Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13230(@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13231servers.
4009494e 13232
8a1cdce5
AC
13233@item g
13234@kindex g (Server)
13235@findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13236Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13237(@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13238a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
4009494e 13239
8a1cdce5
AC
13240@item z
13241@kindex z (Server)
13242@findex gnus-server-compact-server
4009494e 13243
8a1cdce5
AC
13244Compact all groups in the server under point
13245(@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13246nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13247hence getting a correct total article count.
13248
13249@end table
13250
13251Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13252listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
4009494e 13253
8a1cdce5
AC
13254
13255@node Example Methods
13256@subsection Example Methods
13257
13258Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
4009494e
GM
13259
13260@lisp
8a1cdce5 13261(nntp "news.funet.fi")
4009494e
GM
13262@end lisp
13263
8a1cdce5 13264Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
4009494e 13265
8a1cdce5
AC
13266@lisp
13267(nnspool "")
13268@end lisp
4009494e 13269
8a1cdce5
AC
13270As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13271back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13272will.
4009494e 13273
8a1cdce5
AC
13274After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13275@code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
4009494e 13276
8a1cdce5
AC
13277To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13278port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13279look like then:
4009494e 13280
8a1cdce5
AC
13281@lisp
13282(nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13283@end lisp
4009494e 13284
8a1cdce5
AC
13285You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13286variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
4009494e 13287
8a1cdce5
AC
13288@code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13289you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13290mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13291your private mail:
4009494e 13292
4009494e 13293@lisp
8a1cdce5 13294(nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
4009494e
GM
13295@end lisp
13296
8a1cdce5
AC
13297(This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13298that.)
13299
13300Here's the method for a public spool:
4009494e
GM
13301
13302@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
13303(nnmh "public"
13304 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13305 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
4009494e
GM
13306@end lisp
13307
8a1cdce5
AC
13308@cindex proxy
13309@cindex firewall
4009494e 13310
8a1cdce5
AC
13311If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13312server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13313on the firewall machine and connect with
13314@uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13315@acronym{NNTP} server.
13316Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13317should probably look something like this:
4009494e 13318
8a1cdce5
AC
13319@lisp
13320(nntp "firewall"
13321 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13322 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13323 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13324@end lisp
4009494e 13325
8a1cdce5
AC
13326If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13327compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13328configuration to the example above:
4009494e 13329
8a1cdce5
AC
13330@lisp
13331 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13332@end lisp
4009494e 13333
8a1cdce5
AC
13334See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13335an indirect connection:
4009494e
GM
13336
13337@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
13338(setq gnus-select-method
13339 '(nntp "indirect"
13340 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13341 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13342 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13343 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13344 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13345 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
4009494e
GM
13346@end lisp
13347
8a1cdce5
AC
13348This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13349provide automatic authorization, of course.
01c52d31 13350
8a1cdce5
AC
13351If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13352through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13353netcat connection to the news server as follows:
4009494e
GM
13354
13355@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
13356(nntp "outside"
13357 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13358 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13359 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
4009494e
GM
13360@end lisp
13361
4009494e 13362
8a1cdce5
AC
13363@node Creating a Virtual Server
13364@subsection Creating a Virtual Server
4009494e 13365
8a1cdce5
AC
13366If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13367articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
4009494e 13368
8a1cdce5
AC
13369First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13370would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13371could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
4009494e 13372
8a1cdce5 13373Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
4009494e 13374
8a1cdce5
AC
13375You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13376@samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13377Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13378will contain the following:
4009494e 13379
4009494e 13380@lisp
8a1cdce5 13381(nnml "cache")
4009494e
GM
13382@end lisp
13383
8a1cdce5 13384Change that to:
4009494e 13385
4009494e 13386@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
13387(nnml "cache"
13388 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13389 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
4009494e
GM
13390@end lisp
13391
8a1cdce5
AC
13392Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13393@kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13394buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
4009494e 13395
8a1cdce5
AC
13396
13397@node Server Variables
13398@subsection Server Variables
13399@cindex server variables
13400@cindex server parameters
13401
13402One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13403in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13404variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13405change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13406won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13407
13408This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13409@code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13410directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13411@code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13412new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13413@code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13414variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13415variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13416manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
4009494e
GM
13417
13418@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
13419(nnml "public"
13420 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13421 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13422 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
4009494e
GM
13423@end lisp
13424
8a1cdce5 13425Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
4009494e 13426
8a1cdce5
AC
13427@node Servers and Methods
13428@subsection Servers and Methods
4009494e 13429
8a1cdce5 13430Wherever you would normally use a select method
1df7defd 13431(e.g., @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
8a1cdce5
AC
13432when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13433instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13434over.
13435
13436
13437@node Unavailable Servers
13438@subsection Unavailable Servers
13439
13440If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13441@code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13442with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13443will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13444actually the case or not.
13445
13446That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13447Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13448@samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13449away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13450to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13451attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13452attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13453it will regard that server as ``down''.
13454
13455So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13456How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13457
13458You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13459with the following commands:
4009494e 13460
8a1cdce5 13461@table @kbd
4009494e 13462
8a1cdce5
AC
13463@item O
13464@kindex O (Server)
13465@findex gnus-server-open-server
13466Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13467(@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
4009494e 13468
8a1cdce5
AC
13469@item C
13470@kindex C (Server)
13471@findex gnus-server-close-server
13472Close the connection (if any) to the server
13473(@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
4009494e 13474
8a1cdce5
AC
13475@item D
13476@kindex D (Server)
13477@findex gnus-server-deny-server
13478Mark the current server as unreachable
13479(@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
4009494e 13480
8a1cdce5
AC
13481@item M-o
13482@kindex M-o (Server)
13483@findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13484Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13485(@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
4009494e 13486
8a1cdce5
AC
13487@item M-c
13488@kindex M-c (Server)
13489@findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13490Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13491(@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
4009494e 13492
8a1cdce5
AC
13493@item R
13494@kindex R (Server)
13495@findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13496Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13497(@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
4009494e 13498
8a1cdce5
AC
13499@item c
13500@kindex c (Server)
13501@findex gnus-server-copy-server
13502Copy a server and give it a new name
13503(@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13504complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13505a different (physical) server.
4009494e 13506
8a1cdce5
AC
13507@item L
13508@kindex L (Server)
13509@findex gnus-server-offline-server
13510Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
4009494e 13511
8a1cdce5 13512@end table
4009494e 13513
4009494e 13514
8a1cdce5
AC
13515@node Getting News
13516@section Getting News
13517@cindex reading news
13518@cindex news back ends
4009494e 13519
8a1cdce5
AC
13520A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13521only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13522or it can read from a local spool.
4009494e 13523
8a1cdce5
AC
13524@menu
13525* NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13526* News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13527@end menu
01c52d31 13528
4009494e 13529
8a1cdce5
AC
13530@node NNTP
13531@subsection NNTP
13532@cindex nntp
389b76fa 13533
8a1cdce5
AC
13534Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13535You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13536server as the, uhm, address.
4009494e 13537
8a1cdce5
AC
13538If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13539third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13540to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13541that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
4009494e 13542
8a1cdce5
AC
13543The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13544fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13545you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
4009494e 13546
8a1cdce5
AC
13547The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13548server:
4009494e 13549
8a1cdce5 13550@table @code
4009494e 13551
8a1cdce5
AC
13552@item nntp-server-opened-hook
13553@vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13554@cindex @sc{mode reader}
13555@cindex authinfo
13556@cindex authentication
13557@cindex nntp authentication
13558@findex nntp-send-authinfo
13559@findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13560is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13561commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13562default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13563@code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13564present in this hook.
4009494e 13565
8a1cdce5
AC
13566@item nntp-authinfo-function
13567@vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13568@findex nntp-send-authinfo
13569@vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13570This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13571server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13572through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13573@code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13574are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13575format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13576@code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13577manual page, but here are the salient facts:
4009494e 13578
8a1cdce5
AC
13579@enumerate
13580@item
13581The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
4009494e 13582
8a1cdce5
AC
13583@item
13584Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
4009494e 13585
8a1cdce5
AC
13586The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13587@samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13588in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13589@samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13590deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13591indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13592@samp{force} is explained below.
4009494e 13593
8a1cdce5 13594@end enumerate
4009494e 13595
8a1cdce5 13596Here's an example file:
4009494e 13597
8a1cdce5
AC
13598@example
13599machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13600machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13601@end example
4009494e 13602
8a1cdce5
AC
13603The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13604have to be first, for instance.
4009494e 13605
8a1cdce5
AC
13606In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13607former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13608user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13609@samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13610@var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13611@samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13612until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
4009494e 13613
8a1cdce5
AC
13614You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13615that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
4009494e 13616
8a1cdce5
AC
13617@example
13618default force yes
13619@end example
4009494e 13620
8a1cdce5
AC
13621This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13622previously mentioned.
598451ed 13623
8a1cdce5 13624Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
4009494e 13625
8a1cdce5
AC
13626@item nntp-server-action-alist
13627@vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13628This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13629taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13630every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
4009494e 13631
8a1cdce5
AC
13632@lisp
13633(setq nntp-server-action-alist
13634 '(("innd" (ding))))
13635@end lisp
4009494e 13636
8a1cdce5 13637You probably don't want to do that, though.
4009494e 13638
8a1cdce5 13639The default value is
4009494e 13640
8a1cdce5
AC
13641@lisp
13642'(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13643 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13644 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13645@end lisp
4009494e 13646
8a1cdce5
AC
13647This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13648nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
4009494e 13649
8a1cdce5
AC
13650@item nntp-maximum-request
13651@vindex nntp-maximum-request
13652If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13653will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13654speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13655waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13656by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13657your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
4009494e 13658
8a1cdce5
AC
13659@item nntp-connection-timeout
13660@vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13661If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13662regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13663responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13664time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13665somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13666that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13667connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13668no timeouts are done.
4009494e 13669
8a1cdce5
AC
13670@item nntp-nov-is-evil
13671@vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13672If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13673variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13674can be used.
4009494e 13675
8a1cdce5
AC
13676@item nntp-xover-commands
13677@vindex nntp-xover-commands
13678@cindex @acronym{NOV}
13679@cindex XOVER
13680List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13681server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13682"XOVERVIEW")}.
4009494e 13683
8a1cdce5
AC
13684@item nntp-nov-gap
13685@vindex nntp-nov-gap
13686@code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13687the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
f99f1641 13688if you have read articles 2--5000 in the group, and only want to read
8a1cdce5
AC
13689article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13690lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13691big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13692@code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13693network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13694that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13695@code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
4009494e 13696
8a1cdce5
AC
13697@item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13698@vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13699When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13700specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13701current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13702command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13703returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13704in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13705refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13706current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13707some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13708having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13709between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13710@code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13711to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13712you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13713value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
4009494e 13714
8a1cdce5
AC
13715@lisp
13716(setq gnus-select-method
13717 '(nntp "newszilla"
13718 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13719 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13720 @dots{}))
13721@end lisp
4009494e 13722
8a1cdce5 13723The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
4009494e 13724
8a1cdce5
AC
13725@item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13726@vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13727A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
4009494e 13728
8a1cdce5
AC
13729@item nntp-record-commands
13730@vindex nntp-record-commands
13731If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13732@acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13733buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13734that doesn't seem to work.
4009494e 13735
8a1cdce5
AC
13736@item nntp-open-connection-function
13737@vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13738It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13739be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13740parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13741Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13742in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13743indirect ones (three pre-made).
13744
13745@item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13746@vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13747Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13748reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13749to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13750@code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13751example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13752@code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13753overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13754
13755@item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13756@vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13757List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13758you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13759not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13760@code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13761default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
4009494e 13762
8a1cdce5
AC
13763@item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13764@vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13765A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13766@code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13767recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13768hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13769inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
4009494e 13770
8a1cdce5
AC
13771@lisp
13772(add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13773@end lisp
4009494e 13774
1df7defd 13775Note that not all servers support the recommended ID@. This works for
8a1cdce5 13776INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
4009494e 13777
8a1cdce5
AC
13778@item nntp-server-list-active-group
13779If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13780ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13781don't update their active files often, this can help.
4009494e 13782
4009494e
GM
13783
13784@end table
13785
8a1cdce5
AC
13786@menu
13787* Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13788* Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13789* Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
8a1cdce5 13790@end menu
4009494e 13791
4009494e 13792
8a1cdce5
AC
13793@node Direct Functions
13794@subsubsection Direct Functions
13795@cindex direct connection functions
4009494e 13796
8a1cdce5
AC
13797These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13798between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13799functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13800(@pxref{Common Variables}).
4009494e 13801
8a1cdce5
AC
13802@table @code
13803@findex nntp-open-network-stream
13804@item nntp-open-network-stream
13805This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13806remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13807connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13808connection automatically.
4009494e 13809
8a1cdce5
AC
13810@item network-only
13811The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
4009494e 13812
8a1cdce5
AC
13813@findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13814@item nntp-open-tls-stream
13815Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
321decc8 13816this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
8a1cdce5 13817installed. You then define a server as follows:
4009494e 13818
8a1cdce5
AC
13819@lisp
13820;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13821;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13822;;
13823(nntp "snews.bar.com"
13824 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13825 (nntp-port-number 563)
13826 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13827@end lisp
4009494e 13828
8a1cdce5
AC
13829@findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13830@item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13831Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
f2a538a2
GM
13832this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL}
13833@ignore
13834@c Defunct URL, ancient package, so don't mention it.
13835or @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay}
13836@end ignore
13837installed. You then define a server as follows:
4009494e 13838
8a1cdce5
AC
13839@lisp
13840;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13841;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13842;;
13843(nntp "snews.bar.com"
13844 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13845 (nntp-port-number 563)
13846 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13847@end lisp
4009494e 13848
8a1cdce5
AC
13849@findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13850@item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13851Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13852program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13853the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13854of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13855connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13856@code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
4009494e 13857
8a1cdce5
AC
13858@lisp
13859(nntp "socksified"
13860 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13861 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13862 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13863@end lisp
4009494e 13864
8a1cdce5
AC
13865With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13866session, which is not a good idea.
4009494e 13867
8a1cdce5
AC
13868@findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13869@item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13870Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13871@code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13872like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13873not available. The previous example would turn into:
4009494e 13874
8a1cdce5
AC
13875@lisp
13876(nntp "socksified"
13877 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13878 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13879 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13880 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13881@end lisp
13882@end table
4009494e
GM
13883
13884
8a1cdce5
AC
13885@node Indirect Functions
13886@subsubsection Indirect Functions
13887@cindex indirect connection functions
4009494e 13888
8a1cdce5
AC
13889These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13890intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13891All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13892the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13893things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13894commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
4009494e 13895
8a1cdce5
AC
13896@table @code
13897@item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13898@findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13899Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13900to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13901you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
4009494e 13902
8a1cdce5 13903@code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
4009494e 13904
8a1cdce5
AC
13905@table @code
13906@item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13907@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13908Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13909@samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
4009494e 13910
8a1cdce5
AC
13911@item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13912@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13913List of strings to be used as the switches to
13914@code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13915@samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13916@samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13917@end table
4009494e 13918
8a1cdce5
AC
13919@item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13920@findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13921Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13922to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13923@code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13924line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
4009494e 13925
8a1cdce5 13926@code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
4009494e 13927
8a1cdce5
AC
13928@table @code
13929@item nntp-telnet-command
13930@vindex nntp-telnet-command
13931Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13932intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
4009494e 13933
8a1cdce5
AC
13934@item nntp-telnet-switches
13935@vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13936List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13937@code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
4009494e 13938
8a1cdce5
AC
13939@item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13940@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13941Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13942@samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
4009494e 13943
8a1cdce5
AC
13944@item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13945@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13946List of strings to be used as the switches to
13947@code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13948this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13949the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13950host. The default is @code{nil}.
13951@end table
4009494e 13952
8a1cdce5
AC
13953Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13954to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
4009494e 13955
8a1cdce5
AC
13956@item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13957@findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13958Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13959@samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
4009494e 13960
8a1cdce5 13961@code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
4009494e 13962
8a1cdce5
AC
13963@table @code
13964@item nntp-via-telnet-command
13965@vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13966Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13967@samp{telnet}.
4009494e 13968
8a1cdce5
AC
13969@item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13970@vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13971List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13972@code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
4009494e 13973
8a1cdce5
AC
13974@item nntp-via-user-password
13975@vindex nntp-via-user-password
13976Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
4009494e 13977
8a1cdce5
AC
13978@item nntp-via-envuser
13979@vindex nntp-via-envuser
13980If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13981server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13982login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
59e75882 13983
8a1cdce5
AC
13984@item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13985@vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13986Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13987is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
4009494e 13988
8a1cdce5 13989@end table
4009494e 13990
8a1cdce5
AC
13991Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13992to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13993@end table
4009494e 13994
4009494e 13995
8a1cdce5
AC
13996Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13997functions:
4009494e 13998
8a1cdce5 13999@table @code
4009494e 14000
8a1cdce5
AC
14001@item nntp-via-user-name
14002@vindex nntp-via-user-name
14003User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
4009494e 14004
8a1cdce5
AC
14005@item nntp-via-address
14006@vindex nntp-via-address
14007Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
4009494e 14008
8a1cdce5 14009@end table
01c52d31 14010
01c52d31 14011
8a1cdce5
AC
14012@node Common Variables
14013@subsubsection Common Variables
4009494e 14014
8a1cdce5
AC
14015The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
14016pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
14017affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
14018default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
14019variables individually).
516aa569 14020
8a1cdce5 14021@table @code
4009494e 14022
8a1cdce5
AC
14023@item nntp-pre-command
14024@vindex nntp-pre-command
14025A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14026connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14027@code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14028where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
4009494e 14029
8a1cdce5
AC
14030@item nntp-address
14031@vindex nntp-address
14032The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
4009494e 14033
8a1cdce5
AC
14034@item nntp-port-number
14035@vindex nntp-port-number
14036Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14037@samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14038@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
65e7ca35 14039than named ports (i.e., use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
8a1cdce5
AC
14040@samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14041not work with named ports.
4009494e 14042
8a1cdce5
AC
14043@item nntp-end-of-line
14044@vindex nntp-end-of-line
14045String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14046server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14047using a non native telnet connection function.
4009494e 14048
8a1cdce5
AC
14049@item nntp-netcat-command
14050@vindex nntp-netcat-command
14051Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14052@samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14053just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14054@samp{nc}.
4009494e 14055
8a1cdce5
AC
14056@item nntp-netcat-switches
14057@vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14058A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14059is @samp{()}.
4009494e 14060
8a1cdce5 14061@end table
4009494e 14062
8a1cdce5
AC
14063@node News Spool
14064@subsection News Spool
14065@cindex nnspool
14066@cindex news spool
4009494e 14067
8a1cdce5
AC
14068Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14069and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14070contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14071instance.
4009494e 14072
8a1cdce5
AC
14073Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14074anything else) as the address.
fbcbb58c 14075
8a1cdce5
AC
14076If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14077native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14078than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14079You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
4009494e 14080
8a1cdce5 14081@table @code
fbcbb58c 14082
8a1cdce5
AC
14083@item nnspool-inews-program
14084@vindex nnspool-inews-program
14085Program used to post an article.
4009494e 14086
8a1cdce5
AC
14087@item nnspool-inews-switches
14088@vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14089Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
4009494e 14090
8a1cdce5
AC
14091@item nnspool-spool-directory
14092@vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14093Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14094@file{/usr/spool/news/}.
4009494e 14095
8a1cdce5
AC
14096@item nnspool-nov-directory
14097@vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14098Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14099@file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
4009494e 14100
8a1cdce5
AC
14101@item nnspool-lib-dir
14102@vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14103Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
4009494e 14104
8a1cdce5
AC
14105@item nnspool-active-file
14106@vindex nnspool-active-file
14107The name of the active file.
4009494e 14108
8a1cdce5
AC
14109@item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14110@vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14111The name of the group descriptions file.
4009494e 14112
8a1cdce5
AC
14113@item nnspool-history-file
14114@vindex nnspool-history-file
14115The name of the news history file.
4009494e 14116
8a1cdce5
AC
14117@item nnspool-active-times-file
14118@vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14119The name of the active date file.
4009494e 14120
8a1cdce5
AC
14121@item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14122@vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14123If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14124that it finds.
4009494e 14125
8a1cdce5
AC
14126@item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14127@vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14128@cindex sed
14129If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14130relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14131@code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14132there.
4009494e 14133
8a1cdce5 14134@end table
4009494e
GM
14135
14136
8a1cdce5
AC
14137@node Using IMAP
14138@section Using IMAP
14139@cindex imap
4009494e 14140
8a1cdce5
AC
14141The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14142provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14143store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14144This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14145from different locations, or with different user agents.
4009494e 14146
8a1cdce5
AC
14147@menu
14148* Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14149* Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14150* Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14151@end menu
4009494e 14152
4009494e 14153
8a1cdce5
AC
14154@node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14155@subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
4009494e 14156
8a1cdce5
AC
14157Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14158group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14159something like:
4009494e 14160
8a1cdce5
AC
14161@example
14162(setq gnus-select-method
14163 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14164@end example
4009494e 14165
8a1cdce5
AC
14166You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14167that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
4009494e 14168
8a1cdce5
AC
14169@example
14170machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14171@end example
4009494e 14172
8a1cdce5 14173That should basically be it for most users.
4009494e 14174
4009494e 14175
8a1cdce5
AC
14176@node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14177@subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
4009494e 14178
8a1cdce5 14179Here's an example method that's more complex:
4009494e 14180
8a1cdce5
AC
14181@example
14182(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14183 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14184 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14185 (nnimap-expunge t)
14186 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14187@end example
4009494e 14188
8a1cdce5
AC
14189@table @code
14190@item nnimap-address
14191The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
4009494e 14192
8a1cdce5
AC
14193@item nnimap-server-port
14194If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14195typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
4009494e 14196
8a1cdce5
AC
14197@item nnimap-stream
14198How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
4009494e 14199
8a1cdce5
AC
14200@table @code
14201@item undecided
14202This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14203then tries the @code{network} setting.
4009494e 14204
8a1cdce5
AC
14205@item ssl
14206This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
4009494e 14207
8a1cdce5
AC
14208@item network
14209Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14210to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14211supports it.
4009494e 14212
8a1cdce5
AC
14213@item starttls
14214Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
8ccbef23 14215
8a1cdce5
AC
14216@item shell
14217If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14218can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14219what you need.
4009494e
GM
14220
14221@end table
14222
8a1cdce5
AC
14223@item nnimap-authenticator
14224Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
45dd6480
LI
14225this should be set to @code{anonymous}. If this variable isn't set,
14226the normal login methods will be used. If you wish to specify a
14227specific login method to be used, you can set this variable to either
14228@code{login} (the traditional @acronym{IMAP} login method),
14229@code{plain} or @code{cram-md5}.
4009494e 14230
8a1cdce5
AC
14231@item nnimap-expunge
14232If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14233if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14234servers that doesn't support that command.
4009494e 14235
8a1cdce5 14236@item nnimap-streaming
3d2af193
LI
14237Virtually all @acronym{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data.
14238If you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to
14239@code{nil}.
4009494e 14240
8a1cdce5
AC
14241@item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14242If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14243a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14244matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14245fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
4009494e 14246
3d2af193
LI
14247@item nnimap-record-commands
14248If non-@code{nil}, record all @acronym{IMAP} commands in the
14249@samp{"*imap log*"} buffer.
14250
8a1cdce5 14251@end table
4009494e 14252
4009494e 14253
8a1cdce5
AC
14254@node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14255@subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
4009494e 14256
8a1cdce5
AC
14257Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14258boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14259download the mail they're not all that interested in.
4009494e 14260
8a1cdce5
AC
14261If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14262variables are relevant:
4009494e
GM
14263
14264@table @code
8a1cdce5 14265@item nnimap-inbox
eaa610c3
KY
14266This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new
14267mail. This can also be a list of mail box names.
4009494e 14268
8a1cdce5
AC
14269@item nnimap-split-methods
14270Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14271Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14272use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
4009494e 14273
8a1cdce5
AC
14274@item nnimap-split-fancy
14275Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
4009494e 14276
8a1cdce5
AC
14277@item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14278List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14279articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14280The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
4009494e 14281
8a1cdce5 14282@end table
4009494e 14283
fe72c8fa
LI
14284Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14285``fancy'' splitting method:
14286
14287@example
14288(nnimap "imap.example.com"
14289 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14290 (nnimap-split-methods
14291 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14292 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14293 "undecided")))
14294@end example
14295
4009494e 14296
8a1cdce5
AC
14297@node Getting Mail
14298@section Getting Mail
14299@cindex reading mail
14300@cindex mail
4009494e 14301
1df7defd 14302Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD@? But of
8a1cdce5 14303course.
4009494e 14304
8a1cdce5
AC
14305@menu
14306* Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14307* Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14308* Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14309* Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14310* Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14311* Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14312* Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14313* Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14314* Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14315* Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14316* Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14317* Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14318* Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14319@end menu
4009494e 14320
4009494e 14321
8a1cdce5
AC
14322@node Mail in a Newsreader
14323@subsection Mail in a Newsreader
4009494e 14324
8a1cdce5
AC
14325If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14326to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14327of a culture shock.
4009494e 14328
8a1cdce5
AC
14329Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14330it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
4009494e 14331
8a1cdce5
AC
14332Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14333approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14334messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14335you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
4009494e 14336
8a1cdce5 14337In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
4009494e 14338
8a1cdce5
AC
14339Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14340deleted? How awful!
4009494e 14341
8a1cdce5
AC
14342But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14343scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14344the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14345you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14346Mail}.
4009494e 14347
8a1cdce5
AC
14348What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14349mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14350they want to treat a message.
4009494e 14351
8a1cdce5
AC
14352Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14353via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14354answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14355need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14356archived somewhere else.
4009494e 14357
8a1cdce5
AC
14358Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14359These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14360to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14361order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14362to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
4009494e 14363
8a1cdce5
AC
14364The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14365but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14366or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
4009494e 14367
8a1cdce5
AC
14368Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14369like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14370differently.
4009494e 14371
8a1cdce5
AC
14372Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14373that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14374to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14375not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14376instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
4009494e 14377
8a1cdce5
AC
14378I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14379may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14380you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14381guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14382Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14383Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14384You Do.)
4009494e 14385
4009494e 14386
8a1cdce5
AC
14387@node Getting Started Reading Mail
14388@subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14389
14390It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14391mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14392and things will happen automatically.
14393
14394For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14395mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14396
14397@lisp
14398(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14399@end lisp
14400
14401Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14402articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14403directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14404be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14405like any other group.
4009494e 14406
8a1cdce5 14407You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
4009494e
GM
14408
14409@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
14410(setq nnmail-split-methods
14411 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14412 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14413 ("other" "")))
4009494e
GM
14414@end lisp
14415
8a1cdce5
AC
14416This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14417@samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14418mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14419last group.
4009494e 14420
8a1cdce5
AC
14421This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14422give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14423Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
4009494e 14424
4009494e 14425
8a1cdce5
AC
14426@node Splitting Mail
14427@subsection Splitting Mail
14428@cindex splitting mail
14429@cindex mail splitting
14430@cindex mail filtering (splitting)
4009494e 14431
8a1cdce5
AC
14432@vindex nnmail-split-methods
14433The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14434to be split into groups.
4009494e 14435
8a1cdce5
AC
14436@lisp
14437(setq nnmail-split-methods
14438 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14439 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14440 ("mail.other" "")))
14441@end lisp
4009494e 14442
8a1cdce5
AC
14443This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14444these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14445something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14446element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14447determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14448contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14449insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
4009494e
GM
14450
14451@lisp
8a1cdce5 14452("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
4009494e
GM
14453@end lisp
14454
8a1cdce5
AC
14455@noindent
14456In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14457the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
4009494e 14458
8a1cdce5
AC
14459The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14460called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14461argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14462mail belongs in that group.
6b958814 14463
8a1cdce5
AC
14464@cindex @samp{bogus} group
14465The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14466expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14467that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14468processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14469to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14470that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14471will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14472splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14473see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
6b958814 14474
8a1cdce5
AC
14475If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14476function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14477arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14478message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14479thinks should carry this mail message.
4009494e 14480
8a1cdce5
AC
14481This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14482see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
4009494e 14483
8a1cdce5
AC
14484Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14485incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14486some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14487@code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
4009494e 14488
8a1cdce5
AC
14489@vindex nnmail-crosspost
14490The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14491the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14492@code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14493that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
4009494e 14494
8a1cdce5
AC
14495@vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14496@cindex crosspost
14497@cindex links
14498@code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14499the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14500links. If that's the case for you, set
14501@code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14502variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
4009494e 14503
8a1cdce5
AC
14504@kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14505@findex nnmail-split-history
14506If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14507can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14508where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14509@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14510Group Commands}).
4009494e 14511
8a1cdce5
AC
14512@vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14513Header lines longer than the value of
14514@code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14515function.
3b84b005 14516
8a1cdce5
AC
14517@vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14518@vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14519By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14520non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14521articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14522@code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14523In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14524variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14525@code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14526value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14527string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14528charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14529
14530@vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14531By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14532specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14533(@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14534@emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14535@code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14536splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14537other kinds of entries.)
14538
14539Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14540yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14541all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14542unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14543boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14544that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14545come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14546you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14547month's rent money.
14548
14549
14550@node Mail Sources
14551@subsection Mail Sources
14552
14553Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14554a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14555maildir, for instance.
14556
14557@menu
14558* Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
2fce4cd8 14559* Mail Source Functions::
8a1cdce5
AC
14560* Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14561* Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14562@end menu
4009494e 14563
4009494e 14564
8a1cdce5
AC
14565@node Mail Source Specifiers
14566@subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14567@cindex POP
14568@cindex mail server
14569@cindex procmail
14570@cindex mail spool
14571@cindex mail source
4009494e 14572
8a1cdce5
AC
14573You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14574(@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
4009494e 14575
8a1cdce5 14576Here's an example:
4009494e
GM
14577
14578@lisp
8a1cdce5 14579(pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
4009494e
GM
14580@end lisp
14581
8a1cdce5
AC
14582As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14583element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14584@dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14585default values.
31fe2b00 14586
8a1cdce5
AC
14587The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14588an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14589@code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14590@code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14591a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14592typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14593group might look like this:
31fe2b00
SM
14594
14595@lisp
8a1cdce5 14596(mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
31fe2b00 14597@end lisp
4009494e 14598
8a1cdce5
AC
14599This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14600fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
4009494e 14601
8a1cdce5 14602The following mail source types are available:
4009494e
GM
14603
14604@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
14605@item file
14606Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
4009494e 14607
8a1cdce5 14608Keywords:
4009494e
GM
14609
14610@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
14611@item :path
14612The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14613environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14614(usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
4009494e 14615
8a1cdce5
AC
14616@item :prescript
14617@itemx :postscript
14618Script run before/after fetching mail.
4009494e
GM
14619@end table
14620
8a1cdce5 14621An example file mail source:
01c52d31 14622
8a1cdce5
AC
14623@lisp
14624(file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14625@end lisp
01c52d31 14626
8a1cdce5 14627Or using the default file name:
01c52d31 14628
8a1cdce5
AC
14629@lisp
14630(file)
14631@end lisp
31fe2b00 14632
8a1cdce5
AC
14633If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14634to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14635You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14636mail spool while moving the mail.
4009494e 14637
8a1cdce5 14638If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
4009494e 14639
8a1cdce5
AC
14640@lisp
14641(setq mail-sources
14642 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14643@end lisp
4009494e 14644
8a1cdce5 14645The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
4009494e 14646
8a1cdce5
AC
14647@example
14648#!/bin/sh
14649# getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14650# flu@@iki.fi
4009494e 14651
8a1cdce5
AC
14652MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14653TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14654rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14655@end example
4009494e 14656
8a1cdce5
AC
14657Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14658file you want to use.
4009494e 14659
4009494e 14660
8a1cdce5
AC
14661@item directory
14662@vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14663Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14664when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14665That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14666directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14667will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14668to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14669@code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14670Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14671if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
4009494e 14672
8a1cdce5
AC
14673@vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14674There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14675that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14676applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
4009494e 14677
8a1cdce5 14678Keywords:
4009494e
GM
14679
14680@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
14681@item :path
14682The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14683value.
4009494e 14684
8a1cdce5
AC
14685@item :suffix
14686Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14687@samp{.spool}.
4009494e 14688
8a1cdce5
AC
14689@item :predicate
14690Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14691The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14692filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14693predicate are considered.
4009494e 14694
8a1cdce5
AC
14695@item :prescript
14696@itemx :postscript
14697Script run before/after fetching mail.
4009494e 14698
8a1cdce5 14699@end table
4009494e 14700
8a1cdce5 14701An example directory mail source:
4009494e 14702
8a1cdce5
AC
14703@lisp
14704(directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14705 :suffix ".prcml")
14706@end lisp
4009494e 14707
8a1cdce5
AC
14708@item pop
14709Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
4009494e 14710
8a1cdce5 14711Keywords:
4009494e 14712
8a1cdce5
AC
14713@table @code
14714@item :server
14715The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14716@env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
4009494e 14717
8a1cdce5 14718@item :port
1df7defd
PE
14719The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (e.g.,
14720@samp{:port 1234}) or a string (e.g., @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
8a1cdce5
AC
14721string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14722Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14723need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
01c52d31 14724
8a1cdce5
AC
14725@item :user
14726The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14727name.
01c52d31 14728
8a1cdce5
AC
14729@item :password
14730The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14731the user is prompted.
01c52d31 14732
8a1cdce5
AC
14733@item :program
14734The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14735should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
01c52d31 14736
8a1cdce5
AC
14737@example
14738fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14739@end example
01c52d31 14740
8a1cdce5 14741The valid format specifier characters are:
01c52d31 14742
8a1cdce5
AC
14743@table @samp
14744@item t
14745The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14746included in this string.
01c52d31 14747
8a1cdce5
AC
14748@item s
14749The name of the server.
01c52d31 14750
8a1cdce5
AC
14751@item P
14752The port number of the server.
01c52d31 14753
8a1cdce5
AC
14754@item u
14755The user name to use.
01c52d31 14756
8a1cdce5
AC
14757@item p
14758The password to use.
14759@end table
4009494e 14760
8a1cdce5
AC
14761The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14762corresponding keywords.
4009494e 14763
8a1cdce5
AC
14764@item :prescript
14765A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14766the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
4009494e 14767
7c4bbb69
LI
14768One popular way to use this is to set up an SSH tunnel to access the
14769@acronym{POP} server. Here's an example:
14770
14771@lisp
14772(pop :server "127.0.0.1"
14773 :port 1234
14774 :user "foo"
14775 :password "secret"
14776 :prescript
14777 "nohup ssh -f -L 1234:pop.server:110 remote.host sleep 3600 &")
14778@end lisp
14779
8a1cdce5
AC
14780@item :postscript
14781A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14782the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
4009494e 14783
8a1cdce5
AC
14784@item :function
14785The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14786function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14787mail should be moved to.
4009494e 14788
8a1cdce5
AC
14789@item :authentication
14790This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14791and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14792@code{password}.
4009494e 14793
a71e2379
G
14794@item :leave
14795Non-@code{nil} if the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14796after fetching. Mails once fetched will never be fetched again by the
14797@acronym{UIDL} control. Only the built-in @code{pop3-movemail} program
14798(the default) supports this keyword.
14799
14800If this is neither @code{nil} nor a number, all mails will be left on
14801the server. If this is a number, leave mails on the server for this
14802many days since you first checked new mails. If this is @code{nil}
14803(the default), mails will be deleted on the server right after fetching.
14804
14805@vindex pop3-uidl-file
14806The @code{pop3-uidl-file} variable specifies the file to which the
14807@acronym{UIDL} data are locally stored. The default value is
14808@file{~/.pop3-uidl}.
14809
14810Note that @acronym{POP} servers maintain no state information between
14811sessions, so what the client believes is there and what is actually
14812there may not match up. If they do not, then you may get duplicate
14813mails or the whole thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt
14814mailbox.
14815
8a1cdce5 14816@end table
4009494e 14817
a71e2379 14818@findex pop3-movemail
8a1cdce5
AC
14819@vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14820If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
a71e2379 14821@code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
4009494e 14822
8a1cdce5 14823Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
a71e2379 14824
8a1cdce5
AC
14825Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14826name, and default fetcher:
4009494e 14827
8a1cdce5
AC
14828@lisp
14829(pop)
14830@end lisp
4009494e 14831
8a1cdce5 14832Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
4009494e 14833
8a1cdce5
AC
14834@lisp
14835(pop :server "my.pop.server"
14836 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14837@end lisp
4009494e 14838
a71e2379
G
14839Leave mails on the server for 14 days:
14840
14841@lisp
14842(pop :server "my.pop.server"
14843 :user "user-name" :password "secret"
14844 :leave 14)
14845@end lisp
14846
8a1cdce5 14847Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
4009494e 14848
8a1cdce5
AC
14849@lisp
14850(pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14851@end lisp
4009494e 14852
8a1cdce5
AC
14853@item maildir
14854Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14855at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14856contains exactly one mail.
4009494e 14857
8a1cdce5 14858Keywords:
4009494e 14859
8a1cdce5
AC
14860@table @code
14861@item :path
14862The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14863taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14864@file{~/Maildir/}.
14865@item :subdirs
14866The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14867@samp{("new" "cur")}.
4009494e 14868
8a1cdce5
AC
14869@c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14870@c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14871@c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14872@c below.
4009494e 14873
8a1cdce5
AC
14874You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14875from locking problems).
4009494e 14876
8a1cdce5 14877@end table
8ccbef23 14878
8a1cdce5 14879Two example maildir mail sources:
8ccbef23 14880
8a1cdce5
AC
14881@lisp
14882(maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14883 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14884@end lisp
8ccbef23 14885
8a1cdce5
AC
14886@lisp
14887(maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14888 :subdirs ("new"))
14889@end lisp
8ccbef23 14890
8a1cdce5
AC
14891@item imap
14892Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
1df7defd 14893@acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (i.e.,
8a1cdce5
AC
14894with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14895to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14896@acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
8ccbef23 14897
8a1cdce5 14898Keywords:
8ccbef23 14899
8a1cdce5
AC
14900@table @code
14901@item :server
14902The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14903@env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
8ccbef23 14904
8a1cdce5
AC
14905@item :port
14906The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14907@samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
8ccbef23 14908
8a1cdce5
AC
14909@item :user
14910The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14911name.
8ccbef23 14912
8a1cdce5
AC
14913@item :password
14914The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14915prompted.
8ccbef23 14916
8a1cdce5
AC
14917@item :stream
14918What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14919symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14920@samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14921@samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
8ccbef23 14922
8a1cdce5
AC
14923@item :authentication
14924Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14925one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14926this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14927@samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
8ccbef23 14928
8a1cdce5
AC
14929@item :program
14930When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
14931mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14932@code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
8ccbef23
G
14933
14934@example
8a1cdce5 14935ssh %s imapd
8ccbef23
G
14936@end example
14937
8a1cdce5
AC
14938Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
14939don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
14940specifier characters are:
8ccbef23 14941
8a1cdce5
AC
14942@table @samp
14943@item s
14944The name of the server.
8ccbef23 14945
8a1cdce5
AC
14946@item l
14947User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
8ccbef23 14948
8a1cdce5
AC
14949@item p
14950The port number of the server.
14951@end table
ed797193 14952
8a1cdce5
AC
14953The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14954corresponding keywords.
8ccbef23 14955
8a1cdce5
AC
14956@item :mailbox
14957The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
14958which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
8ccbef23 14959
8a1cdce5
AC
14960@item :predicate
14961The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
14962UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
14963sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
14964articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
14965Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
14966complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
8ccbef23 14967
8a1cdce5
AC
14968@item :fetchflag
14969How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
14970will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
14971would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
14972but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
8ccbef23 14973
8a1cdce5
AC
14974@item :dontexpunge
14975If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
14976mailbox after finishing the fetch.
8ccbef23 14977
8a1cdce5 14978@end table
8ccbef23 14979
8a1cdce5 14980An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
181cb5fb 14981
8a1cdce5
AC
14982@lisp
14983(imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
14984 :stream kerberos4
14985 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
14986@end lisp
8ccbef23 14987
8a1cdce5
AC
14988@item group
14989Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
14990@xref{Group Parameters}.
229b59da 14991
8ccbef23
G
14992@end table
14993
8a1cdce5
AC
14994@table @dfn
14995@item Common Keywords
14996Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
8ccbef23 14997
8a1cdce5 14998Keywords:
8ccbef23
G
14999
15000@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
15001@item :plugged
15002If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
15003use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
15004example:
8ccbef23 15005
8a1cdce5
AC
15006@lisp
15007(setq mail-sources
15008 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
15009 :suffix ""
15010 :plugged t)))
15011@end lisp
6b958814 15012
8a1cdce5
AC
15013Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
15014useful when you use local mail and news.
99e65b2d 15015
8a1cdce5 15016@end table
8ccbef23
G
15017@end table
15018
2fce4cd8 15019@node Mail Source Functions
8a1cdce5 15020@subsubsection Function Interface
8ccbef23 15021
8a1cdce5
AC
15022Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
15023For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
15024the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
15025consider the following mail-source setting:
4009494e 15026
8a1cdce5
AC
15027@lisp
15028(setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
15029 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
15030@end lisp
4009494e 15031
8a1cdce5
AC
15032While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
15033is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
15034@code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
15035@code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
15036and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
4009494e 15037
8a1cdce5 15038See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
4009494e 15039
4009494e 15040
8a1cdce5
AC
15041@node Mail Source Customization
15042@subsubsection Mail Source Customization
4009494e 15043
8a1cdce5
AC
15044The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
15045fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
15046variables.
4009494e 15047
8a1cdce5
AC
15048@table @code
15049@item mail-source-crash-box
15050@vindex mail-source-crash-box
15051File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15052@file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
4009494e 15053
8a1cdce5
AC
15054@cindex Incoming*
15055@item mail-source-delete-incoming
15056@vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15057If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15058@code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15059files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15060(the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15061set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15062@code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15063@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15064and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
4009494e 15065
8a1cdce5
AC
15066@item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15067@vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15068If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15069files. This variable only applies when
15070@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
4009494e 15071
8a1cdce5
AC
15072@item mail-source-ignore-errors
15073@vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15074If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15075
15076@item mail-source-directory
15077@vindex mail-source-directory
15078Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15079default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15080is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15081@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
4009494e 15082
8a1cdce5
AC
15083@item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15084@vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15085Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15086@file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15087@file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15088relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15089number.
4009494e 15090
8a1cdce5
AC
15091@item mail-source-default-file-modes
15092@vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
8d80ef01 15093All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
4009494e 15094
8a1cdce5
AC
15095@item mail-source-movemail-program
15096@vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15097If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15098@code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
4009494e 15099
8a1cdce5 15100@end table
4009494e 15101
4009494e 15102
8a1cdce5
AC
15103@node Fetching Mail
15104@subsubsection Fetching Mail
4009494e 15105
8a1cdce5
AC
15106@vindex mail-sources
15107The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15108@code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15109(@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
4009494e 15110
8a1cdce5
AC
15111If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15112fetch mail by themselves.
4009494e 15113
8a1cdce5
AC
15114If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15115@acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
4009494e 15116
8a1cdce5
AC
15117@lisp
15118(setq mail-sources
15119 '((file)
15120 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15121 :password "secret")))
15122@end lisp
4009494e 15123
8a1cdce5 15124Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
4009494e
GM
15125
15126@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15127(setq mail-sources
15128 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15129 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15130 :user "user-name"
15131 :port "pop3"
15132 :password "secret")))
4009494e
GM
15133@end lisp
15134
4009494e 15135
8a1cdce5
AC
15136When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15137inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15138mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15139invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15140pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15141shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
4009494e 15142
4009494e 15143
4009494e 15144
8a1cdce5
AC
15145@node Mail Back End Variables
15146@subsection Mail Back End Variables
4009494e 15147
8a1cdce5
AC
15148These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15149mail back ends.
4009494e 15150
8a1cdce5
AC
15151@table @code
15152@vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15153@item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15154The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15155use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
4009494e 15156
8a1cdce5
AC
15157@vindex nnmail-split-hook
15158@item nnmail-split-hook
15159@findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15160@cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15161@cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15162Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15163just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15164free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15165is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15166in the buffer will show up in any files.
15167@code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15168to this hook.
15169
15170@vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15171@vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15172@item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15173@itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15174These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15175mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15176starting to handle the new mail) and
15177@code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15178is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15179default file modes the new mail files get:
4009494e
GM
15180
15181@lisp
8a1cdce5 15182(add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
8d80ef01 15183 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
8a1cdce5
AC
15184
15185(add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
8d80ef01 15186 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
4009494e
GM
15187@end lisp
15188
8a1cdce5
AC
15189@item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15190@vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15191If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15192names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15193(assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15194@code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15195the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
4009494e 15196
8a1cdce5
AC
15197@item nnmail-delete-file-function
15198@vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15199@findex delete-file
15200Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
4009494e 15201
8a1cdce5
AC
15202@item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15203@vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15204If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15205the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15206discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 15207
8a1cdce5
AC
15208@item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15209@vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15210This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15211Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15212recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
4009494e 15213
8a1cdce5
AC
15214This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15215(@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15216@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
4009494e 15217
8a1cdce5 15218@end table
4009494e 15219
a3f57c41 15220
8a1cdce5
AC
15221@node Fancy Mail Splitting
15222@subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15223@cindex mail splitting
15224@cindex fancy mail splitting
15225
15226@vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15227@findex nnmail-split-fancy
15228If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15229doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15230@code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15231play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15232
15233Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15234
15235@lisp
15236;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15237;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15238;; @r{from real errors.}
15239(| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15240 "mail.misc"))
15241 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15242 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15243 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15244 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15245 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15246 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15247 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15248 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15249 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15250 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15251 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15252 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15253 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15254 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15255 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15256 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15257 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15258 "misc.misc")
15259@end lisp
15260
15261This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15262(possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15263splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
4009494e 15264
8a1cdce5 15265@table @code
4009494e 15266
8a1cdce5
AC
15267@item group
15268If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15269regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
4009494e 15270
8a1cdce5
AC
15271@c Don't fold this line.
15272@item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15273The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15274first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15275@var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15276@var{split}.
4009494e 15277
8a1cdce5
AC
15278If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15279@var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15280@var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15281@var{split} is processed.
4009494e 15282
8a1cdce5
AC
15283The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15284non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15285variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15286be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
4009494e 15287
8a1cdce5
AC
15288@item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15289If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15290bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15291@var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15292stored in one or more groups.
4009494e 15293
8a1cdce5
AC
15294@item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15295If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15296process all @var{split}s in the list.
4009494e 15297
8a1cdce5
AC
15298@item junk
15299If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15300this message. Use with extreme caution.
4009494e 15301
8a1cdce5
AC
15302@item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15303If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15304second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15305arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
4009494e 15306
8a1cdce5
AC
15307@cindex body split
15308For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15309body of the messages:
4009494e 15310
8a1cdce5
AC
15311@lisp
15312(defun split-on-body ()
15313 (save-excursion
15314 (save-restriction
15315 (widen)
15316 (goto-char (point-min))
15317 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15318 "string.group"))))
15319@end lisp
4009494e 15320
8a1cdce5
AC
15321The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15322@var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15323after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15324above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15325not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15326@code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15327(@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
4009494e 15328
8a1cdce5
AC
15329@item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15330If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15331@var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15332function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15333should return a split.
4009494e 15334
8a1cdce5
AC
15335@item nil
15336If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
4009494e 15337
8a1cdce5 15338@end table
4009494e 15339
8a1cdce5 15340In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
4009494e 15341
8a1cdce5
AC
15342Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15343according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15344@var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15345which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15346for example,
4009494e 15347
8a1cdce5
AC
15348@example
15349(any "joe" "joemail")
15350@end example
a1da1e37 15351
8a1cdce5
AC
15352@noindent
15353messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15354in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15355of the following three ways:
a1da1e37 15356
8a1cdce5
AC
15357@enumerate
15358@item
15359@vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15360You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15361to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15362match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15363words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15364@code{nil}.
a1da1e37 15365
8a1cdce5 15366Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
4009494e 15367
8a1cdce5
AC
15368@item
15369@var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15370a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15371in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15372@code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15373@code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
4009494e 15374
8a1cdce5
AC
15375@item
15376You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15377@samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15378section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15379are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15380@code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15381ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15382non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15383@end enumerate
4009494e 15384
8a1cdce5
AC
15385@vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15386@var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15387they are expanded as specified by the variable
15388@code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15389where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15390contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15391@code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
4009494e 15392
8a1cdce5
AC
15393@table @code
15394@item from
15395Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15396@item to
15397Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15398@samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15399@item any
15400Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
4009494e
GM
15401@end table
15402
8a1cdce5
AC
15403@vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15404@code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15405when all this splitting is performed.
4009494e 15406
8a1cdce5
AC
15407If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15408information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15409substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
4009494e 15410
8a1cdce5
AC
15411@example
15412(any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15413@end example
4009494e 15414
8a1cdce5
AC
15415In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15416will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
4009494e 15417
172f73b1 15418If the string contains the element @samp{\\&}, then the previously
8a1cdce5
AC
15419matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15420up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15421groupings 1 through 9.
4009494e 15422
8a1cdce5
AC
15423@vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15424Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15425lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15426Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15427groups when users send to an address using different case
1df7defd 15428(i.e., mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
8a1cdce5
AC
15429is @code{t}.
15430
15431@findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15432@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15433split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15434you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15435boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15436working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15437string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15438messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15439it once per thread.
4009494e 15440
8a1cdce5
AC
15441To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15442and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15443value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15444using the colon feature, like so:
4009494e 15445@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15446(setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15447 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15448 nnmail-split-fancy
15449 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15450 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15451 ))
4009494e
GM
15452@end lisp
15453
8a1cdce5
AC
15454This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15455non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15456in the file specified by the variable
15457@code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15458(the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15459invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15460at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15461and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15462for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15463corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15464@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15465recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15466somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15467still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15468300 kBytes in size.)
15469@vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15470When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15471also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15472messages goes into the new group.
4009494e 15473
8a1cdce5
AC
15474Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15475want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15476outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15477@code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15478Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15479``outgoing'' group.
4009494e
GM
15480
15481
8a1cdce5
AC
15482@node Group Mail Splitting
15483@subsection Group Mail Splitting
15484@cindex mail splitting
15485@cindex group mail splitting
4009494e 15486
8a1cdce5
AC
15487@findex gnus-group-split
15488If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15489maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15490You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15491parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15492@code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15493for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15494from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15495@code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
4009494e 15496
8a1cdce5
AC
15497Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15498splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15499parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15500rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
4009494e 15501
8a1cdce5
AC
15502All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15503@code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15504the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15505@code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15506matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15507group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15508@code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
4009494e 15509
8a1cdce5
AC
15510If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15511parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15512parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15513this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15514@code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15515@code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15516@code{gnus-group-split}.
4009494e 15517
8a1cdce5
AC
15518@vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15519@code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15520by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15521group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15522group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15523some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15524that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15525often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15526complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15527may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15528personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15529element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15530with the rules extracted from group parameters.
4009494e 15531
8a1cdce5
AC
15532It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15533been defined:
4009494e 15534
8a1cdce5
AC
15535@example
15536nnml:mail.bar:
15537((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15538 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15539nnml:mail.foo:
15540((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15541 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15542 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15543 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15544nnml:mail.others:
15545((split-spec . catch-all))
15546@end example
4009494e 15547
8a1cdce5
AC
15548Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15549behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15550@code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
4009494e
GM
15551
15552@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15553(| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15554 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15555 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15556 "mail.others")
4009494e
GM
15557@end lisp
15558
8a1cdce5
AC
15559@findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15560If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15561may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15562splits like this:
4009494e 15563
8a1cdce5
AC
15564@lisp
15565(: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15566@end lisp
4009494e 15567
8a1cdce5
AC
15568@var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15569parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15570@var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15571single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15572fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15573If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15574empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15575Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15576this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
4009494e 15577
8a1cdce5
AC
15578@findex gnus-group-split-setup
15579Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15580slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15581But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15582used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15583sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15584@code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15585@code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15586scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
4009494e 15587
8a1cdce5
AC
15588@findex gnus-group-split-update
15589However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15590@code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15591@code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15592automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15593you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4009494e 15594
8a1cdce5
AC
15595@lisp
15596(gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15597@end lisp
4009494e 15598
8a1cdce5
AC
15599If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15600will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15601have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15602don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15603@code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15604value.
4009494e 15605
8a1cdce5
AC
15606@vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15607Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15608by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15609@code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
4009494e 15610
8a1cdce5
AC
15611@node Incorporating Old Mail
15612@subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15613@cindex incorporating old mail
15614@cindex import old mail
4009494e 15615
8a1cdce5
AC
15616Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15617you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15618back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15619your mail groups.
4009494e 15620
8a1cdce5 15621Doing so can be quite easy.
4009494e 15622
8a1cdce5
AC
15623To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15624(@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15625satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15626file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15627your @code{nnml} groups.
4009494e 15628
8a1cdce5 15629Here's how:
4009494e 15630
8a1cdce5
AC
15631@enumerate
15632@item
15633Go to the group buffer.
4009494e 15634
8a1cdce5
AC
15635@item
15636Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15637@code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
4009494e 15638
8a1cdce5
AC
15639@item
15640Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
4009494e 15641
8a1cdce5
AC
15642@item
15643Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15644(@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
4009494e 15645
8a1cdce5
AC
15646@item
15647Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15648@samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15649@end enumerate
4009494e 15650
8a1cdce5
AC
15651All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15652all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15653have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15654deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15655sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
4009494e 15656
8a1cdce5
AC
15657Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15658back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15659using the new mail back end.
4009494e 15660
4009494e 15661
8a1cdce5
AC
15662@node Expiring Mail
15663@subsection Expiring Mail
15664@cindex article expiry
15665@cindex expiring mail
4009494e 15666
8a1cdce5
AC
15667Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15668you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15669different approach to mail reading.
4009494e 15670
8a1cdce5
AC
15671Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15672a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15673actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15674mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15675fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15676Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15677course.
4009494e 15678
8a1cdce5
AC
15679To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15680articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15681that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15682will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15683deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15684more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15685will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15686repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15687NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
4009494e 15688
d30dd079 15689@vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
8a1cdce5
AC
15690You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15691two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15692with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15693for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15694considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15695the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
d30dd079
G
15696@samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15697expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15698these marks.
4009494e 15699
8a1cdce5
AC
15700When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15701who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15702and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15703(@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15704into its own group.)
4009494e 15705
8a1cdce5
AC
15706Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15707answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15708advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15709the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15710between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15711only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15712total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15713Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15714scoring.
4009494e 15715
8a1cdce5
AC
15716@vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15717Groups that match the regular expression
15718@code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15719read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15720expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
4009494e 15721
8a1cdce5
AC
15722By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15723articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15724before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15725automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15726@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e 15727
8a1cdce5 15728@vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
4009494e 15729@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15730(remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15731 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15732(add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
4009494e
GM
15733@end lisp
15734
8a1cdce5
AC
15735Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15736articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15737will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15738articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15739mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15740
15741Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15742articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15743
4009494e 15744@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15745(setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15746 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
4009494e
GM
15747@end lisp
15748
8a1cdce5
AC
15749Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15750@code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
4009494e 15751
8a1cdce5
AC
15752If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15753auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15754don't really mix very well.
4009494e 15755
8a1cdce5
AC
15756@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15757The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15758expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15759message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15760days.
4009494e 15761
8a1cdce5
AC
15762Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15763are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15764have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15765expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15766everywhere else:
4009494e 15767
8a1cdce5
AC
15768@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15769@lisp
15770(setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15771 (lambda (group)
15772 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15773 31)
15774 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15775 1)
15776 ((string= group "important")
15777 'never)
15778 (t
15779 6))))
15780@end lisp
4009494e 15781
8a1cdce5
AC
15782The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15783names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
4009494e 15784
8a1cdce5
AC
15785The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15786@code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15787necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15788@code{never}.
4009494e 15789
8a1cdce5
AC
15790You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15791change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
4009494e 15792
8a1cdce5
AC
15793@vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15794The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15795However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15796to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15797@code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15798parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15799all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15800parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15801string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15802moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15803the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15804from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15805name or @code{delete}.
15806
15807Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15808@lisp
15809(setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15810@end lisp
15811
15812@findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15813@vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15814Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15815expire mail to groups according to the variable
15816@code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
4009494e 15817
8a1cdce5
AC
15818@lisp
15819 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15820 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15821 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15822 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15823 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15824@end lisp
4009494e 15825
8a1cdce5
AC
15826With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15827header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15828get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15829From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15830to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15831@code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
4009494e 15832
8a1cdce5
AC
15833@vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15834If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15835expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15836easier for procmail users.
4009494e 15837
8a1cdce5
AC
15838@vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15839By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15840articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15841parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15842articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15843caution. Even more dangerous is the
15844@code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15845this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15846which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15847will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15848crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15849wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15850@emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15851with! So there!
4009494e 15852
8a1cdce5 15853Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
4009494e 15854
8a1cdce5
AC
15855@vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15856If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15857commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15858auto-expire turned on.
4009494e 15859
8a1cdce5
AC
15860@vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15861The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15862them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15863preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15864hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15865articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15866when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15867will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15868marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15869articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15870don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15871into auto-expire groups, you can set
15872@code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15873non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15874be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15875group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
4009494e 15876
4009494e 15877
8a1cdce5
AC
15878@node Washing Mail
15879@subsection Washing Mail
15880@cindex mail washing
15881@cindex list server brain damage
15882@cindex incoming mail treatment
4009494e 15883
8a1cdce5
AC
15884Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15885really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15886prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15887end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15888Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15889considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
4009494e 15890
8a1cdce5
AC
15891Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15892} to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15893be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15894laugh.
4009494e 15895
8a1cdce5
AC
15896Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15897displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15898storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15899various functions that can be put in these hooks.
4009494e 15900
8a1cdce5
AC
15901@table @code
15902@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15903@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15904This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15905grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15906the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
4009494e 15907
8a1cdce5
AC
15908@table @code
15909@item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15910@findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15911Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15912Emacs running on MS machines.
a1da1e37 15913
4009494e
GM
15914@end table
15915
8a1cdce5
AC
15916@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15917@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15918This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15919cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
4009494e
GM
15920
15921@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
15922@item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15923@findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15924Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15925headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
4009494e 15926
8a1cdce5
AC
15927(Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15928messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15929of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15930rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15931into a feature by documenting it.)
4009494e 15932
8a1cdce5
AC
15933@item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15934@findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15935Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
15936beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
15937people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
15938strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
15939also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
15940@code{\\(..\\)}.
4009494e 15941
8a1cdce5
AC
15942For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
15943@samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
4009494e
GM
15944
15945@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
15946(setq nnmail-list-identifiers
15947 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
4009494e
GM
15948@end lisp
15949
8a1cdce5
AC
15950This can also be done non-destructively with
15951@code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
4009494e 15952
8a1cdce5
AC
15953@item nnmail-remove-tabs
15954@findex nnmail-remove-tabs
15955Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
4009494e 15956
8a1cdce5
AC
15957@item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15958@findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15959@c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
15960@cindex Eudora
15961@cindex Pegasus
1df7defd 15962Some mail user agents (e.g., Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
8a1cdce5
AC
15963@code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
15964function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
15965contain a line matching the regular expression
15966@code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
4009494e 15967
8a1cdce5 15968@end table
4009494e 15969
8a1cdce5
AC
15970@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15971@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15972This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
15973include:
4009494e
GM
15974
15975@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
15976@item article-de-quoted-unreadable
15977@findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
15978Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
4009494e 15979
8a1cdce5
AC
15980@end table
15981@end table
4009494e 15982
4009494e 15983
8a1cdce5
AC
15984@node Duplicates
15985@subsection Duplicates
15986
15987@vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15988@vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15989@vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15990@cindex duplicate mails
15991If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15992receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15993@code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
f99f1641 15994this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s:
8a1cdce5
AC
15995@code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
15996default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
15997there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
15998variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
15999stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
16000@code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
16001default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
16002will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
16003that this is a duplicate of a different message.
16004
16005This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
16006will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
16007the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
16008@code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
4009494e 16009
8a1cdce5
AC
16010You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
16011@code{nil}.
4009494e 16012
8a1cdce5
AC
16013If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
16014@dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
16015methods:
4009494e 16016
8a1cdce5
AC
16017@lisp
16018(setq nnmail-split-fancy
16019 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
16020 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
16021 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
16022 (any mail "mail.misc")
16023 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16024 [...] ))
16025@end lisp
16026@noindent
16027Or something like:
16028@lisp
16029(setq nnmail-split-methods
16030 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
16031 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16032 [...]))
16033@end lisp
4009494e 16034
8a1cdce5
AC
16035Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
16036with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
16037@code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
16038using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
16039received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
4009494e 16040
4009494e 16041
8a1cdce5
AC
16042@node Not Reading Mail
16043@subsection Not Reading Mail
4009494e 16044
8a1cdce5
AC
16045If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
16046habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
16047be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
4009494e 16048
8a1cdce5
AC
16049If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16050@code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16051mail, which should help.
4009494e 16052
8a1cdce5
AC
16053@vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16054@vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16055@vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16056@vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16057@vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16058This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16059happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
1606023) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16061variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16062the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16063group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
4009494e 16064
8a1cdce5
AC
16065All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16066narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16067incoming mail.
4009494e 16068
4009494e 16069
8a1cdce5
AC
16070@node Choosing a Mail Back End
16071@subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
4009494e 16072
8a1cdce5
AC
16073Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16074file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16075depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
4009494e 16076
8a1cdce5
AC
16077There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16078back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16079(because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16080Spool}).
4009494e 16081
8a1cdce5
AC
16082@menu
16083* Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16084* Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16085* Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16086* MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16087* Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
2fce4cd8
PE
16088* nnmaildir Group Parameters::
16089* Article Identification::
16090* NOV Data::
16091* Article Marks::
8a1cdce5
AC
16092* Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16093* Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16094@end menu
4009494e
GM
16095
16096
16097
8a1cdce5
AC
16098@node Unix Mail Box
16099@subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16100@cindex nnmbox
16101@cindex unix mail box
4009494e 16102
8a1cdce5
AC
16103@vindex nnmbox-active-file
16104@vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16105The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16106mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16107which group it belongs in.
4009494e 16108
8a1cdce5 16109Virtual server settings:
4009494e 16110
8a1cdce5
AC
16111@table @code
16112@item nnmbox-mbox-file
16113@vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16114The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16115@file{~/mbox}.
4009494e 16116
8a1cdce5
AC
16117@item nnmbox-active-file
16118@vindex nnmbox-active-file
16119The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16120@file{~/.mbox-active}.
4009494e 16121
8a1cdce5
AC
16122@item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16123@vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16124If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16125into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16126@end table
4009494e 16127
4009494e 16128
8a1cdce5
AC
16129@node Babyl
16130@subsubsection Babyl
16131@cindex nnbabyl
4009494e 16132
8a1cdce5
AC
16133@vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16134@vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16135The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16136@code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16137group it belongs in.
4009494e 16138
8a1cdce5 16139Virtual server settings:
4009494e 16140
8a1cdce5
AC
16141@table @code
16142@item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16143@vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16144The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
4009494e 16145
8a1cdce5
AC
16146@item nnbabyl-active-file
16147@vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16148The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16149@file{~/.rmail-active}
4009494e 16150
8a1cdce5
AC
16151@item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16152@vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16153If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16154@code{t}
4009494e
GM
16155@end table
16156
16157
8a1cdce5
AC
16158@node Mail Spool
16159@subsubsection Mail Spool
16160@cindex nnml
16161@cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16162
16163The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16164format. It should be used with some caution.
16165
16166@vindex nnml-directory
16167If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16168one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16169directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16170variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16171
16172You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16173care of all that.
16174
16175If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16176in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16177own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16178weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16179having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16180shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16181know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16182to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
4009494e 16183
8a1cdce5
AC
16184@code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16185splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16186@acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16187fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
4009494e 16188
8a1cdce5 16189Virtual server settings:
4009494e
GM
16190
16191@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
16192@item nnml-directory
16193@vindex nnml-directory
16194All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16195default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16196is @file{~/Mail}).
4009494e 16197
8a1cdce5
AC
16198@item nnml-active-file
16199@vindex nnml-active-file
16200The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16201@file{~/Mail/active}.
4009494e 16202
8a1cdce5
AC
16203@item nnml-newsgroups-file
16204@vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16205The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16206Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
4009494e 16207
8a1cdce5
AC
16208@item nnml-get-new-mail
16209@vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16210If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16211@code{t}.
4009494e 16212
8a1cdce5
AC
16213@item nnml-nov-is-evil
16214@vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16215If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16216default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 16217
8a1cdce5
AC
16218@item nnml-nov-file-name
16219@vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16220The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
4009494e 16221
8a1cdce5
AC
16222@item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16223@vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16224Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
4009494e 16225
8a1cdce5
AC
16226@item nnml-use-compressed-files
16227@vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16228If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16229files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16230(@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16231If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16232as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16233to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16234equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
4009494e 16235
8a1cdce5
AC
16236@item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16237@vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16238Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16239bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16240if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
4009494e 16241
8a1cdce5 16242@end table
4009494e 16243
8a1cdce5
AC
16244@findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16245If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16246whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16247nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16248entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16249might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16250functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16251Commands}).
4009494e 16252
4009494e 16253
8a1cdce5
AC
16254@node MH Spool
16255@subsubsection MH Spool
16256@cindex nnmh
16257@cindex mh-e mail spool
4009494e 16258
8a1cdce5
AC
16259@code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16260@acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16261file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16262@code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16263for.
4009494e 16264
8a1cdce5 16265Virtual server settings:
4009494e 16266
8a1cdce5
AC
16267@table @code
16268@item nnmh-directory
16269@vindex nnmh-directory
16270All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16271default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16272@file{~/Mail})
4009494e 16273
8a1cdce5
AC
16274@item nnmh-get-new-mail
16275@vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16276If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16277@code{t}.
4009494e 16278
8a1cdce5
AC
16279@item nnmh-be-safe
16280@vindex nnmh-be-safe
16281If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16282sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16283they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16284setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16285use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16286have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16287@end table
4009494e 16288
4009494e 16289
8a1cdce5
AC
16290@node Maildir
16291@subsubsection Maildir
16292@cindex nnmaildir
16293@cindex maildir
4009494e 16294
8a1cdce5
AC
16295@code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16296corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16297@uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16298@uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16299also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16300within a maildir.
16301
16302Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16303reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16304your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16305configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16306can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16307configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16308that appear as group in Gnus.
4009494e 16309
8a1cdce5
AC
16310@code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16311never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16312corrupt its data in the filesystem.
4009494e 16313
8a1cdce5
AC
16314@code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16315maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16316another, and you will keep your marks.
4009494e 16317
8a1cdce5 16318Virtual server settings:
4009494e 16319
8a1cdce5
AC
16320@table @code
16321@item directory
16322For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16323you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16324it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16325choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16326will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16327filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16328in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16329scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16330the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16331@code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
4009494e 16332
8a1cdce5
AC
16333The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16334which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16335the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16336only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16337server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16338don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16339optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16340@code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16341use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16342if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16343value.
4009494e 16344
8a1cdce5
AC
16345@item target-prefix
16346This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16347@code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16348server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16349closed.
4009494e 16350
8a1cdce5
AC
16351When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16352created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16353pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16354So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16355@code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16356the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16357@file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16358@file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16359@file{../maildirs/foo}.
4009494e 16360
8a1cdce5
AC
16361You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16362create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16363this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16364with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16365symlinks pointing to them will be).
4009494e 16366
8a1cdce5
AC
16367As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16368then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16369@code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16370cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16371@code{force} argument.
4009494e 16372
8a1cdce5
AC
16373@item directory-files
16374This should be a function with the same interface as
16375@code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16376used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16377parameter is optional; the default is
16378@code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16379@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16380@code{directory-files} otherwise.
16381(@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16382server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16383scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
4009494e 16384
8a1cdce5
AC
16385@item get-new-mail
16386If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16387maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16388the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16389@code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16390value is @code{nil}.
4009494e 16391
8a1cdce5
AC
16392Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16393an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16394that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16395different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16396remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16397@end table
4009494e 16398
2fce4cd8 16399@node nnmaildir Group Parameters
8a1cdce5 16400@subsubsection Group parameters
4009494e 16401
8a1cdce5
AC
16402@code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16403all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16404default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16405one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16406functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16407you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16408another back end.
4009494e 16409
8a1cdce5
AC
16410If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16411is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16412original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16413evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16414different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16415back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16416numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16417@code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16418quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
4009494e 16419
8a1cdce5
AC
16420@table @code
16421@item expire-age
16422An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16423before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16424articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16425@code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16426@code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16427@code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16428and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16429wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
1643060 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16431An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16432modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16433delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16434article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
4009494e 16435
8a1cdce5
AC
16436@item expire-group
16437If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16438@example
16439"backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16440@end example
16441and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16442to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16443before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16444group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16445was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16446destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16447the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16448you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16449article. So that form can refer to
16450@code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16451article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16452does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16453@code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
4009494e 16454
8a1cdce5
AC
16455@item read-only
16456If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16457in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16458from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16459@file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16460cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16461@file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16462containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16463maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16464a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16465have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16466contain extra copies of the articles.
4009494e 16467
8a1cdce5
AC
16468@item directory-files
16469A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16470used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16471group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16472server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
4009494e 16473
8a1cdce5
AC
16474@item distrust-Lines:
16475If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16476article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16477@code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
4009494e 16478
8a1cdce5
AC
16479@item always-marks
16480A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16481Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16482say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16483marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16484feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16485in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
4009494e 16486
8a1cdce5
AC
16487@item never-marks
16488A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16489Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16490say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16491stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16492@code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16493probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16494abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
4009494e 16495
8a1cdce5
AC
16496@item nov-cache-size
16497An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16498speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16499for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16500worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16501parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16502the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16503The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16504and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16505that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16506that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16507@code{read}, plus a little extra.
16508@end table
4009494e 16509
2fce4cd8 16510@node Article Identification
8a1cdce5
AC
16511@subsubsection Article identification
16512Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16513Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16514contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16515@code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16516the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16517identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16518@file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16519about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16520available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16521request the article in the summary buffer.
4009494e 16522
2fce4cd8 16523@node NOV Data
8a1cdce5
AC
16524@subsubsection NOV data
16525An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16526to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16527@code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16528@code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16529need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16530when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16531force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16532single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16533file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16534assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16535with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
4009494e 16536
2fce4cd8 16537@node Article Marks
8a1cdce5
AC
16538@subsubsection Article marks
16539An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16540@code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16541When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16542looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16543asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16544creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16545rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16546links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
4009494e 16547
8a1cdce5
AC
16548You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16549@file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16550your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16551remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16552this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16553it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16554type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16555@kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16556pick up the changes, and might undo them.
4009494e 16557
4009494e 16558
8a1cdce5
AC
16559@node Mail Folders
16560@subsubsection Mail Folders
16561@cindex nnfolder
16562@cindex mbox folders
16563@cindex mail folders
4009494e 16564
8a1cdce5
AC
16565@code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16566separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16567@code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16568numbers and arrival dates.
4009494e 16569
8a1cdce5 16570Virtual server settings:
4009494e 16571
8a1cdce5
AC
16572@table @code
16573@item nnfolder-directory
16574@vindex nnfolder-directory
16575All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16576directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16577(whose default is @file{~/Mail})
4009494e 16578
8a1cdce5
AC
16579@item nnfolder-active-file
16580@vindex nnfolder-active-file
16581The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
4009494e 16582
8a1cdce5
AC
16583@item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16584@vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16585The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16586Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
4009494e 16587
8a1cdce5
AC
16588@item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16589@vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16590If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16591default is @code{t}
4009494e 16592
8a1cdce5
AC
16593@item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16594@vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16595@cindex backup files
16596Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16597backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16598you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16599following in your @file{.emacs} file:
4009494e 16600
8a1cdce5
AC
16601@lisp
16602(defun turn-off-backup ()
16603 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
4009494e 16604
8a1cdce5
AC
16605(add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16606@end lisp
4009494e 16607
8a1cdce5
AC
16608@item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16609@vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16610Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16611This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16612extract some information from it before removing it.
4009494e 16613
8a1cdce5
AC
16614@item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16615@vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16616If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16617default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 16618
8a1cdce5
AC
16619@item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16620@vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16621The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
4009494e 16622
8a1cdce5
AC
16623@item nnfolder-nov-directory
16624@vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16625The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16626@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
4009494e 16627
8a1cdce5 16628@end table
4009494e 16629
4009494e 16630
8a1cdce5
AC
16631@findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16632@kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16633If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16634@code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16635command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16636@code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16637though.
4009494e 16638
8a1cdce5
AC
16639@node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16640@subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
4009494e 16641
8a1cdce5
AC
16642First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16643low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16644is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16645and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16646mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
4009494e 16647
8a1cdce5
AC
16648The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16649typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16650in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16651articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16652access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16653area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16654@code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16655actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16656via NFS).
4009494e 16657
8a1cdce5
AC
16658The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16659simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16660format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16661future. Here are some high and low points on each:
4009494e 16662
8a1cdce5
AC
16663@table @code
16664@item nnmbox
4009494e 16665
f99f1641
PE
16666UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-defined
16667format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
8a1cdce5
AC
16668they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16669@samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16670to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16671@samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16672historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16673mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16674this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16675area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16676(appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16677to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16678fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16679what's where.
4009494e 16680
8a1cdce5 16681@item nnbabyl
4009494e 16682
8a1cdce5
AC
16683Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16684systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16685reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16686was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16687format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16688spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16689headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
44e97401 16690Rmail was Emacs's first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
8a1cdce5
AC
16691and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16692to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16693VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16694perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16695headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16696course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16697uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
4009494e 16698
8a1cdce5
AC
16699Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16700file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16701look at your mail.
4009494e 16702
8a1cdce5 16703@item nnml
4009494e 16704
8a1cdce5
AC
16705@code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16706actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16707fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16708lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16709and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16710Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16711CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16712or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16713@dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16714@acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16715due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16716file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16717extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16718provided by the active file and overviews.
4009494e 16719
8a1cdce5
AC
16720@code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16721resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16722files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16723tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16724the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16725wins big.
4009494e 16726
8a1cdce5
AC
16727It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16728FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16729tiny files.
4009494e 16730
8a1cdce5 16731@item nnmh
4009494e 16732
8a1cdce5
AC
16733The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16734long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16735individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16736is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16737active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16738one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16739slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
4009494e 16740
8a1cdce5 16741@item nnfolder
4009494e 16742
8a1cdce5
AC
16743Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16744method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16745itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16746little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16747a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16748can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16749format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16750it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16751out how many messages there are in each separate group.
4009494e 16752
8a1cdce5
AC
16753If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16754messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16755only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16756friendly mail back end all over.
16757
16758@item nnmaildir
4009494e 16759
8a1cdce5
AC
16760For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16761incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16762mail back ends.
4009494e 16763
8a1cdce5
AC
16764@code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16765differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16766filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16767also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16768per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16769(Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16770slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16771file system.
4009494e 16772
8a1cdce5
AC
16773Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16774as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16775This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16776organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16777entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16778require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16779thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16780whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16781@code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16782@code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16783undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
4009494e 16784
8a1cdce5
AC
16785@code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16786corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16787them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
89b163db 16788else, and still have your marks.
4009494e 16789
8a1cdce5
AC
16790@code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16791(It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16792and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16793is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16794parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16795would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16796removed in the future.
4009494e 16797
8a1cdce5
AC
16798Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16799back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16800on your file system.
4009494e 16801
8a1cdce5
AC
16802@code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16803to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
4009494e 16804
8a1cdce5 16805@end table
b0b63450 16806
4009494e 16807
8a1cdce5
AC
16808@node Browsing the Web
16809@section Browsing the Web
16810@cindex web
16811@cindex browsing the web
16812@cindex www
16813@cindex http
4009494e 16814
8a1cdce5
AC
16815Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16816subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16817eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16818is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16819and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16820go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16821even know what a news group is.
4009494e 16822
8a1cdce5
AC
16823The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16824being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16825they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16826not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16827you mad in the end.
4009494e 16828
8a1cdce5
AC
16829So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16830to do it instead?
4009494e 16831
8a1cdce5
AC
16832Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16833interfaces to these sources.
4009494e 16834
8a1cdce5
AC
16835@menu
16836* Archiving Mail::
16837* Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16838* RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16839* Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
16840@end menu
4009494e 16841
8a1cdce5
AC
16842All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
16843alternatives to work.
4009494e 16844
8a1cdce5
AC
16845The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16846work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16847is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16848will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16849though, you should be ok.
4009494e 16850
8a1cdce5
AC
16851One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16852are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16853cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16854Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16855leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
4009494e 16856
8a1cdce5
AC
16857@node Archiving Mail
16858@subsection Archiving Mail
16859@cindex archiving mail
16860@cindex backup of mail
4009494e 16861
8a1cdce5
AC
16862Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16863@code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16864For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16865marks is fairly simple.
4009494e 16866
8a1cdce5
AC
16867(Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16868requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16869though.)
4009494e 16870
8a1cdce5
AC
16871To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16872server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16873to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16874similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16875adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16876@ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16877might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16878before you restore the data.
4009494e 16879
8a1cdce5
AC
16880@node Web Searches
16881@subsection Web Searches
16882@cindex nnweb
16883@cindex Google
16884@cindex dejanews
16885@cindex gmane
16886@cindex Usenet searches
16887@cindex searching the Usenet
4009494e 16888
8a1cdce5
AC
16889It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16890string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16891those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16892the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16893searches without having to use a browser.
4009494e 16894
8a1cdce5
AC
16895The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16896engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16897then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16898group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16899Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
4009494e 16900
8a1cdce5
AC
16901@code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16902groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16903each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16904pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16905manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16906Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16907@code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16908engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16909of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16910header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16911group as read.
4009494e 16912
8a1cdce5
AC
16913If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16914won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16915providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
16916make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16917community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16918might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
4009494e 16919
8a1cdce5
AC
16920You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
16921(try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
16922installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
4009494e 16923
8a1cdce5 16924Virtual server variables:
4009494e 16925
8a1cdce5
AC
16926@table @code
16927@item nnweb-type
16928@vindex nnweb-type
16929What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16930are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16931@code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
4009494e 16932
8a1cdce5
AC
16933@item nnweb-search
16934@vindex nnweb-search
16935The search string to feed to the search engine.
4009494e 16936
8a1cdce5
AC
16937@item nnweb-max-hits
16938@vindex nnweb-max-hits
16939Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16940999.
4009494e 16941
8a1cdce5
AC
16942@item nnweb-type-definition
16943@vindex nnweb-type-definition
16944Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16945with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16946present:
4009494e 16947
8a1cdce5
AC
16948@table @code
16949@item article
16950Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16951understands.
4009494e 16952
8a1cdce5
AC
16953@item map
16954Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
4009494e 16955
8a1cdce5
AC
16956@item search
16957Function to send the search string to the search engine.
4009494e 16958
8a1cdce5
AC
16959@item address
16960The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16961to.
4009494e 16962
8a1cdce5
AC
16963@item id
16964Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16965@end table
4009494e 16966
8a1cdce5 16967@end table
4009494e 16968
4009494e 16969
8a1cdce5
AC
16970@node RSS
16971@subsection RSS
16972@cindex nnrss
16973@cindex RSS
4009494e 16974
8a1cdce5
AC
16975Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16976@acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16977sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16978presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
f2a538a2 16979changes to a wiki (e.g., @url{http://cliki.net/site/recent-changes}).
4009494e 16980
8a1cdce5
AC
16981@acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16982possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
4009494e 16983
8a1cdce5
AC
16984Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16985system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16986text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16987group names.
4009494e 16988
8a1cdce5
AC
16989@kindex G R (Group)
16990Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16991prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16992The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16993and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
4009494e 16994
8a1cdce5
AC
16995An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16996the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16997subscribe to groups.
4009494e 16998
8a1cdce5
AC
16999The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
17000@code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
17001names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
17002coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
17003variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
17004information.
4009494e 17005
8a1cdce5
AC
17006The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
17007@acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
17008and a @samp{text/html} part.
4009494e 17009
8a1cdce5
AC
17010@cindex OPML
17011You can also use the following commands to import and export your
17012subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
17013Markup Language).
8ccbef23 17014
8a1cdce5
AC
17015@defun nnrss-opml-import file
17016Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
17017file.
17018@end defun
4009494e 17019
8a1cdce5
AC
17020@defun nnrss-opml-export
17021Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
17022@acronym{OPML} format.
17023@end defun
4009494e 17024
8a1cdce5 17025The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
4009494e
GM
17026
17027@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
17028@item nnrss-directory
17029@vindex nnrss-directory
17030The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
17031@file{~/News/rss/}.
4009494e 17032
8a1cdce5
AC
17033@item nnrss-file-coding-system
17034@vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
17035The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
17036data files. The default is the value of
17037@code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17038in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
4009494e 17039
8a1cdce5
AC
17040@item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17041@vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17042Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
1df7defd 17043e.g., to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
8a1cdce5
AC
17044a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17045is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17046variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17047@code{'(slash:comments)}.
4009494e 17048
8a1cdce5
AC
17049@item nnrss-use-local
17050@vindex nnrss-use-local
17051@findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17052If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17053the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17054the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17055download script using @command{wget}.
17056@end table
4009494e 17057
8a1cdce5
AC
17058The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17059the summary buffer.
4009494e 17060
8a1cdce5
AC
17061@lisp
17062(add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17063(setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
4009494e 17064
8a1cdce5
AC
17065(defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17066 (let ((descr
17067 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17068 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17069@end lisp
4009494e 17070
8a1cdce5
AC
17071The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17072summary buffer.
4009494e 17073
8a1cdce5
AC
17074@lisp
17075(require 'browse-url)
4009494e 17076
8a1cdce5
AC
17077(defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17078 (interactive "p")
17079 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17080 (mail-header-extra
17081 (gnus-data-header
17082 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17083 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17084 (if url
17085 (progn
17086 (browse-url (cdr url))
17087 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17088 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
4009494e 17089
8a1cdce5
AC
17090(eval-after-load "gnus"
17091 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17092 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17093(add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17094@end lisp
4009494e 17095
8a1cdce5
AC
17096Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17097@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17098Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17099Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17100more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17101@samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17102@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17103Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17104@code{nnrss} groups:
4009494e 17105
8a1cdce5
AC
17106@lisp
17107;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17108(eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17109 '(add-to-list
17110 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17111 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17112 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
4009494e 17113
8a1cdce5
AC
17114;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17115(add-to-list
17116 'gnus-parameters
17117 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17118@end lisp
4009494e 17119
4009494e 17120
8a1cdce5
AC
17121@node Customizing W3
17122@subsection Customizing W3
17123@cindex W3
17124@cindex html
17125@cindex url
17126@cindex Netscape
4009494e 17127
8a1cdce5
AC
17128Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17129alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17130manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17131users.
4009494e 17132
8a1cdce5
AC
17133For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17134using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17135browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
4009494e 17136
8a1cdce5
AC
17137@lisp
17138(eval-after-load "w3"
17139 '(progn
17140 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17141 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17142 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17143 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17144 (browse-url url)
17145 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17146@end lisp
4009494e 17147
8a1cdce5
AC
17148Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17149@acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17150follow the link.
4009494e 17151
4009494e 17152
8a1cdce5
AC
17153@node Other Sources
17154@section Other Sources
4009494e 17155
8a1cdce5
AC
17156Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17157below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17158newsgroups.
4009494e 17159
8a1cdce5
AC
17160@menu
17161* Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17162* Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17163* Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17164* Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
c5ecc769 17165* The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
8a1cdce5 17166@end menu
4009494e 17167
4009494e 17168
8a1cdce5
AC
17169@node Directory Groups
17170@subsection Directory Groups
17171@cindex nndir
17172@cindex directory groups
4009494e 17173
8a1cdce5
AC
17174If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17175it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17176names, of course.
4009494e 17177
8a1cdce5
AC
17178This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17179successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17180packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17181back end to read directories. Big deal.
4009494e 17182
8a1cdce5
AC
17183@code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17184enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17185@file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17186@code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17187directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
01c52d31 17188
8a1cdce5 17189@code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
4009494e 17190
8a1cdce5
AC
17191@code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17192articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17193whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17194methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
4009494e 17195
4009494e 17196
8a1cdce5
AC
17197@node Anything Groups
17198@subsection Anything Groups
17199@cindex nneething
4009494e 17200
8a1cdce5
AC
17201From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17202directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17203pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17204true.
4009494e 17205
8a1cdce5
AC
17206When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17207directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17208a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17209After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17210@code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17211file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17212few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
1df7defd 17213just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g., a C source file),
8a1cdce5
AC
17214@code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17215file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17216elements.
4009494e 17217
8a1cdce5
AC
17218All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17219with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17220newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17221in the article buffer, just as usual.
4009494e 17222
8a1cdce5
AC
17223If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17224a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17225traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17226Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
4009494e 17227
8a1cdce5
AC
17228There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17229doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17230will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17231are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17232normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17233article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17234other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17235be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
4009494e 17236
8a1cdce5 17237Some variables:
4009494e 17238
8a1cdce5
AC
17239@table @code
17240@item nneething-map-file-directory
17241@vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17242All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17243in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
4009494e 17244
8a1cdce5
AC
17245@item nneething-exclude-files
17246@vindex nneething-exclude-files
17247All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17248auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
4009494e 17249
8a1cdce5
AC
17250@item nneething-include-files
17251@vindex nneething-include-files
17252Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17253non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
4009494e 17254
8a1cdce5
AC
17255@item nneething-map-file
17256@vindex nneething-map-file
17257Name of the map files.
17258@end table
4009494e 17259
4009494e 17260
8a1cdce5
AC
17261@node Document Groups
17262@subsection Document Groups
17263@cindex nndoc
17264@cindex documentation group
17265@cindex help group
4009494e 17266
8a1cdce5
AC
17267@code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17268as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
4009494e
GM
17269
17270@table @code
8a1cdce5
AC
17271@cindex Babyl
17272@item babyl
17273The Babyl format.
4009494e 17274
8a1cdce5
AC
17275@cindex mbox
17276@cindex Unix mbox
17277@item mbox
17278The standard Unix mbox file.
4009494e 17279
8a1cdce5
AC
17280@cindex MMDF mail box
17281@item mmdf
17282The MMDF mail box format.
4009494e 17283
8a1cdce5
AC
17284@item news
17285Several news articles appended into a file.
4009494e 17286
8a1cdce5
AC
17287@cindex rnews batch files
17288@item rnews
17289The rnews batch transport format.
4009494e 17290
8a1cdce5
AC
17291@item nsmail
17292Netscape mail boxes.
4009494e 17293
8a1cdce5
AC
17294@item mime-parts
17295@acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
4009494e 17296
8a1cdce5
AC
17297@item standard-digest
17298The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
4009494e 17299
8a1cdce5
AC
17300@item mime-digest
17301A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
4009494e 17302
8a1cdce5
AC
17303@item lanl-gov-announce
17304Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
4009494e 17305
8a1cdce5
AC
17306@cindex git commit messages
17307@item git
17308@code{git} commit messages.
4009494e 17309
8a1cdce5
AC
17310@cindex forwarded messages
17311@item rfc822-forward
17312A message forwarded according to RFC822.
4009494e 17313
8a1cdce5
AC
17314@item outlook
17315The Outlook mail box.
4009494e 17316
8a1cdce5
AC
17317@item oe-dbx
17318The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
4009494e 17319
8a1cdce5
AC
17320@item exim-bounce
17321A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
4009494e 17322
8a1cdce5
AC
17323@item forward
17324A message forwarded according to informal rules.
4009494e 17325
8a1cdce5
AC
17326@item rfc934
17327An RFC934-forwarded message.
4009494e 17328
8a1cdce5
AC
17329@item mailman
17330A mailman digest.
4009494e 17331
8a1cdce5
AC
17332@item clari-briefs
17333A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
4009494e 17334
8a1cdce5
AC
17335@item slack-digest
17336Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17337
17338@item mail-in-mail
17339The last resort.
4009494e
GM
17340@end table
17341
8a1cdce5
AC
17342You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17343that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17344@code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17345file is.
4009494e 17346
8a1cdce5
AC
17347@code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17348it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17349group. And that's it.
4009494e 17350
8a1cdce5
AC
17351If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17352new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17353that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17354to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17355@code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17356(@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17357the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17358using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17359file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17360delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
4009494e 17361
8a1cdce5 17362Virtual server variables:
4009494e 17363
8a1cdce5
AC
17364@table @code
17365@item nndoc-article-type
17366@vindex nndoc-article-type
17367This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17368@code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17369@code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17370@code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17371@code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
4009494e 17372
8a1cdce5
AC
17373@item nndoc-post-type
17374@vindex nndoc-post-type
17375This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17376a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17377and @code{news}.
17378@end table
4009494e 17379
8a1cdce5
AC
17380@menu
17381* Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17382@end menu
4009494e 17383
4009494e 17384
8a1cdce5
AC
17385@node Document Server Internals
17386@subsubsection Document Server Internals
4009494e 17387
8a1cdce5
AC
17388Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17389difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17390looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17391and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
4009494e 17392
8a1cdce5 17393First, here's an example document type definition:
4009494e 17394
8a1cdce5
AC
17395@example
17396(mmdf
17397 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17398 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17399@end example
4009494e 17400
8a1cdce5
AC
17401The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17402regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17403variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17404types can be defined with very few settings:
4009494e 17405
8a1cdce5
AC
17406@table @code
17407@item first-article
17408If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17409something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17410totally ignored.
4009494e 17411
8a1cdce5
AC
17412@item article-begin
17413This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17414says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17415complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17416use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
4009494e 17417
8a1cdce5
AC
17418@item article-begin-function
17419If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17420of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
4009494e 17421
8a1cdce5
AC
17422@item head-begin
17423If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17424article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17425simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
4009494e 17426
8a1cdce5
AC
17427@item head-begin-function
17428If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17429the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
4009494e 17430
8a1cdce5
AC
17431@item head-end
17432This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17433@samp{^$}---the empty line.
4009494e 17434
8a1cdce5
AC
17435@item body-begin
17436This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17437to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17438a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
4009494e 17439
8a1cdce5
AC
17440@item body-begin-function
17441If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17442of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
4009494e 17443
8a1cdce5
AC
17444@item body-end
17445If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17446more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17447can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
4009494e 17448
8a1cdce5
AC
17449@item body-end-function
17450If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17451the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17452
17453@item file-begin
17454If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17455before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17456
17457@item file-end
17458If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17459regexp will be totally ignored.
4009494e
GM
17460
17461@end table
17462
8a1cdce5
AC
17463So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17464file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17465few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17466news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17467something that's palatable for Gnus:
4009494e 17468
8a1cdce5
AC
17469@table @code
17470@item prepare-body-function
17471If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17472will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17473document has encoded some parts of its contents.
4009494e 17474
8a1cdce5
AC
17475@item article-transform-function
17476If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17477meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17478body of the article.
4009494e 17479
8a1cdce5
AC
17480@item generate-head-function
17481If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17482understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17483expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17484called when requesting the headers of all articles.
4009494e 17485
8a1cdce5
AC
17486@item generate-article-function
17487If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17488Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17489parameter when requesting all articles.
4009494e 17490
8a1cdce5
AC
17491@item dissection-function
17492If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17493overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17494@code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17495@code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17496@code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17497@code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
4009494e 17498
8a1cdce5 17499@end table
4009494e 17500
8a1cdce5
AC
17501Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17502digests:
4009494e 17503
8a1cdce5
AC
17504@example
17505(standard-digest
17506 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17507 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17508 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17509 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17510 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17511 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17512 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17513 (subtype digest guess))
17514@end example
4009494e 17515
8a1cdce5
AC
17516We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17517text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17518each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17519the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17520run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
4009494e 17521
8a1cdce5
AC
17522To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17523@code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17524is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17525where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17526The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17527@code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17528So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17529@code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17530@code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17531is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17532correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17533means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
4009494e 17534
4009494e 17535
8a1cdce5
AC
17536@node Mail-To-News Gateways
17537@subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17538@cindex mail-to-news gateways
17539@cindex gateways
4009494e 17540
8a1cdce5
AC
17541If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17542or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17543The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
4009494e 17544
8a1cdce5
AC
17545Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17546used to post with.
4009494e 17547
8a1cdce5 17548Server variables:
4009494e 17549
8a1cdce5
AC
17550@table @code
17551@item nngateway-address
17552@vindex nngateway-address
17553This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
4009494e 17554
8a1cdce5
AC
17555@item nngateway-header-transformation
17556@vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17557News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17558for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17559transformation should be called, and defaults to
17560@code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17561narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17562gateway address.
4009494e 17563
8a1cdce5
AC
17564This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17565@code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17566For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
4009494e 17567
8a1cdce5
AC
17568@example
17569Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17570@end example
4009494e 17571
8a1cdce5 17572will get this @code{To} header inserted:
4009494e 17573
8a1cdce5
AC
17574@example
17575To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17576@end example
4009494e 17577
8a1cdce5 17578The following pre-defined functions exist:
4009494e 17579
8a1cdce5
AC
17580@findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17581@table @code
4009494e 17582
8a1cdce5
AC
17583@item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17584Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17585@var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
4009494e 17586
8a1cdce5 17587@findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
4009494e 17588
8a1cdce5
AC
17589@item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17590Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17591@code{nngateway-address}.
17592@end table
4009494e
GM
17593
17594@end table
17595
8a1cdce5 17596Here's an example:
4009494e 17597
8a1cdce5
AC
17598@lisp
17599(setq gnus-post-method
17600 '(nngateway
17601 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17602 (nngateway-header-transformation
17603 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17604@end lisp
4009494e 17605
8a1cdce5 17606So, to use this, simply say something like:
4009494e 17607
8a1cdce5
AC
17608@lisp
17609(setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17610@end lisp
4009494e 17611
4009494e 17612
c5ecc769
G
17613@node The Empty Backend
17614@subsection The Empty Backend
17615@cindex nnnil
17616
17617@code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17618have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17619classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17620methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17621
17622@lisp
17623(setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17624(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17625 '((nnimap "foo")
17626 (nnml "")))
17627@end lisp
17628
8a1cdce5
AC
17629
17630@node Combined Groups
17631@section Combined Groups
17632
17633Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17634groups.
4009494e
GM
17635
17636@menu
8a1cdce5 17637* Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
4009494e
GM
17638@end menu
17639
4009494e 17640
8a1cdce5
AC
17641@node Virtual Groups
17642@subsection Virtual Groups
17643@cindex nnvirtual
17644@cindex virtual groups
17645@cindex merging groups
4009494e 17646
8a1cdce5
AC
17647An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17648other groups.
4009494e 17649
8a1cdce5
AC
17650For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17651put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17652big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
4009494e 17653
8a1cdce5
AC
17654You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17655regexp to match component groups.
4009494e 17656
8a1cdce5
AC
17657All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17658component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17659article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17660came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17661shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17662@kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17663and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17664(@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
4009494e 17665
8a1cdce5
AC
17666Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17667newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
4009494e 17668
8a1cdce5
AC
17669@lisp
17670(nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17671@end lisp
4009494e 17672
8a1cdce5
AC
17673The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17674smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
4009494e 17675
8a1cdce5
AC
17676Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17677idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17678If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17679and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
4009494e 17680
8a1cdce5
AC
17681@example
17682"^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17683@end example
4009494e 17684
8a1cdce5
AC
17685(Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17686shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17687characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
4009494e 17688
8a1cdce5
AC
17689This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17690end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17691the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17692sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17693(@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4009494e 17694
8a1cdce5
AC
17695One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17696group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17697zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
4009494e 17698
8a1cdce5
AC
17699@vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17700If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17701is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17702articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17703and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17704been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17705when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17706have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17707that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17708just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17709it---it'll have much the same effect.
4009494e 17710
8a1cdce5
AC
17711@code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17712When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17713has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17714whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17715there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17716and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17717not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
4009494e 17718
8a1cdce5
AC
17719@kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17720line from the article you respond to in these cases.
4009494e 17721
8a1cdce5
AC
17722@code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17723from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17724inherited.
4009494e 17725
4009494e 17726
8a1cdce5
AC
17727@node Email Based Diary
17728@section Email Based Diary
17729@cindex diary
17730@cindex email based diary
17731@cindex calendar
4009494e 17732
8a1cdce5
AC
17733This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17734and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17735sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17736reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17737Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17738namely, as event reminders.
4009494e 17739
8a1cdce5 17740Here is a typical scenario:
4009494e 17741
8a1cdce5
AC
17742@itemize @bullet
17743@item
17744You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17745to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17746@item
17747So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17748@item
17749You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17750@item
17751From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17752is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17753appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17754@item
17755Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17756of the night you're gonna have.
17757@item
17758Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17759message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17760@end itemize
4009494e 17761
8a1cdce5
AC
17762The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17763(that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17764real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17765explained in the sections below.
4009494e 17766
8a1cdce5
AC
17767@menu
17768* The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17769* The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17770* Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17771@end menu
4009494e
GM
17772
17773
8a1cdce5
AC
17774@node The NNDiary Back End
17775@subsection The NNDiary Back End
17776@cindex nndiary
17777@cindex the nndiary back end
4009494e 17778
8a1cdce5
AC
17779@code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17780Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17781@code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17782the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17783directory per group.
4009494e 17784
8a1cdce5
AC
17785 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17786@code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17787of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17788Timestamp} to see how it's done.
4009494e 17789
8a1cdce5
AC
17790@menu
17791* Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17792* Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17793* Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17794@end menu
4009494e 17795
8a1cdce5
AC
17796@node Diary Messages
17797@subsubsection Diary Messages
17798@cindex nndiary messages
17799@cindex nndiary mails
4009494e 17800
8a1cdce5
AC
17801@code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17802presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17803@code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17804@code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17805@code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17806@code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17807crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
4009494e 17808
8a1cdce5
AC
17809@itemize @bullet
17810@item
17811For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17812either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17813(separated by a comma).
17814@item
17815A field is either an integer, or a range.
17816@item
17817A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17818@item
17819Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17820@code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17821for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17822@item
17823As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17824mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17825that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17826@item
17827The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17828value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17829values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17830zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17831list of available time zone values, see the variable
17832@code{nndiary-headers}.
17833@end itemize
4009494e 17834
8a1cdce5
AC
17835As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17836for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
1783721:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17838what to do then):
4009494e 17839
8a1cdce5
AC
17840@example
17841X-Diary-Minute: 0
17842X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17843X-Diary-Dom: 1
17844X-Diary-Month: *
17845X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17846X-Diary-Dow: 1
17847X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17848@end example
4009494e 17849
8a1cdce5
AC
17850@node Running NNDiary
17851@subsubsection Running NNDiary
17852@cindex running nndiary
17853@cindex nndiary operation modes
4009494e 17854
8a1cdce5
AC
17855@code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17856and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17857mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17858from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17859as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17860mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
4009494e 17861
8a1cdce5
AC
17862One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17863``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17864sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17865messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17866being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17867the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17868(which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17869mode.
4009494e 17870
8a1cdce5
AC
17871In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17872things to do:
4009494e 17873
8a1cdce5
AC
17874@itemize @bullet
17875@item
17876Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17877line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e 17878
8a1cdce5
AC
17879@lisp
17880(setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17881@end lisp
17882@item
17883You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17884headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17885Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17886multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17887source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
01c52d31 17888
8a1cdce5
AC
17889As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17890@file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
4009494e 17891
8a1cdce5
AC
17892@example
17893:0 HD :
17894* ^X-Diary
17895.nndiary
17896@end example
17897@end itemize
4009494e 17898
8a1cdce5
AC
17899Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17900that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
4009494e 17901
8a1cdce5
AC
17902@defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17903This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17904@code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17905@code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17906@end defvar
4009494e 17907
8a1cdce5
AC
17908@defvar nndiary-split-methods
17909This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17910@code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17911@end defvar
4009494e 17912
8a1cdce5
AC
17913 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17914(something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17915@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
4009494e 17916
8a1cdce5
AC
17917 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17918@file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17919autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17920also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17921diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
4009494e 17922
8a1cdce5
AC
17923@node Customizing NNDiary
17924@subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17925@cindex customizing nndiary
17926@cindex nndiary customization
4009494e 17927
8a1cdce5
AC
17928Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17929The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17930browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17931two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
4009494e 17932
8a1cdce5
AC
17933@defvar nndiary-reminders
17934This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
1df7defd 17935appointments (e.g., 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
8a1cdce5
AC
17936before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17937diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17938mail.
17939@end defvar
4009494e 17940
8a1cdce5
AC
17941@defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17942Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17943default).
17944@end defvar
4009494e
GM
17945
17946
8a1cdce5
AC
17947@node The Gnus Diary Library
17948@subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17949@cindex gnus-diary
17950@cindex the gnus diary library
4009494e 17951
8a1cdce5
AC
17952Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17953so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17954@code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17955useful things for you.
4009494e 17956
8a1cdce5 17957 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e
GM
17958
17959@lisp
8a1cdce5 17960(require 'gnus-diary)
4009494e
GM
17961@end lisp
17962
8a1cdce5
AC
17963 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17964(@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17965(sorry if you used them before).
4009494e 17966
4009494e
GM
17967
17968@menu
8a1cdce5
AC
17969* Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17970* Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
17971* Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
17972* Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
4009494e
GM
17973@end menu
17974
8a1cdce5
AC
17975@node Diary Summary Line Format
17976@subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
17977@cindex diary summary buffer line
17978@cindex diary summary line format
4009494e 17979
8a1cdce5
AC
17980Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
17981something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
17982the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
17983see the event's date.
4009494e 17984
8a1cdce5
AC
17985 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
17986summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
1df7defd 17987for the next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
91af3942 17988while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
1df7defd 17989next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
4009494e 17990
8a1cdce5
AC
17991 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
17992@code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
17993expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
4009494e 17994
8a1cdce5
AC
17995@example
17996 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
17997@end example
4009494e 17998
8a1cdce5
AC
17999In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
18000following line to your diary groups'parameters:
4009494e 18001
8a1cdce5
AC
18002@lisp
18003(gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
18004@end lisp
4009494e 18005
8a1cdce5
AC
18006However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
18007Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
18008with the following user options:
4009494e 18009
8a1cdce5
AC
18010@defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
18011Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
18012Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
18013diary groups'parameters.
18014@end defvar
4009494e 18015
8a1cdce5
AC
18016@defvar gnus-diary-time-format
18017Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
18018used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
18019@end defvar
4009494e 18020
8a1cdce5
AC
18021@defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
18022Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
18023times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
18024format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
18025you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
18026@end defvar
4009494e 18027
8a1cdce5
AC
18028@node Diary Articles Sorting
18029@subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
18030@cindex diary articles sorting
18031@cindex diary summary lines sorting
18032@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
18033@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
18034@findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
4009494e 18035
8a1cdce5
AC
18036@code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18037Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18038@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18039@code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18040your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
4009494e 18041
8a1cdce5
AC
18042@code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18043@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18044buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18045default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18046Parameters}).
4009494e 18047
8a1cdce5
AC
18048@node Diary Headers Generation
18049@subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18050@cindex diary headers generation
18051@findex gnus-diary-check-message
4009494e 18052
8a1cdce5
AC
18053@code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18054@code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18055headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18056required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18057needed.
4009494e 18058
8a1cdce5
AC
18059 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18060moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18061automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
18062@code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
18063process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
4009494e 18064
8a1cdce5
AC
18065 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18066all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18067you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18068instance.
4009494e 18069
8a1cdce5
AC
18070@node Diary Group Parameters
18071@subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18072@cindex diary group parameters
4009494e 18073
8a1cdce5
AC
18074When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18075automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18076summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18077diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18078@code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18079to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18080on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18081automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
4009494e 18082
8a1cdce5
AC
18083@node Sending or Not Sending
18084@subsection Sending or Not Sending
4009494e 18085
8a1cdce5
AC
18086Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18087mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
4009494e 18088
8a1cdce5
AC
18089@itemize @bullet
18090@item
18091@code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
c7015153 18092messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
8a1cdce5
AC
18093appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18094sending the diary message to them as well.
18095@item
18096However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18097can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18098message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18099comes in very handy for private appointments.
18100@end itemize
4009494e 18101
8a1cdce5
AC
18102@node Gnus Unplugged
18103@section Gnus Unplugged
18104@cindex offline
18105@cindex unplugged
18106@cindex agent
18107@cindex Gnus agent
18108@cindex Gnus unplugged
4009494e 18109
8a1cdce5
AC
18110In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18111on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18112was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18113read news. Believe it or not.
4009494e 18114
8a1cdce5
AC
18115Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18116modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18117would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18118the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18119have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
4009494e 18120
8a1cdce5
AC
18121Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18122@code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18123for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18124functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18125reading news on a machine.
4009494e 18126
8a1cdce5
AC
18127Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18128fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18129by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
4009494e 18130
8a1cdce5 18131Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
4009494e 18132
8a1cdce5
AC
18133@menu
18134* Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18135* Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18136* Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18137* Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18138* Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18139* Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18140* Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18141* Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18142* Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18143* Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18144* Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18145* Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18146* Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18147* Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18148@end menu
4009494e 18149
c872595d 18150
8a1cdce5
AC
18151@node Agent Basics
18152@subsection Agent Basics
4009494e 18153
8a1cdce5 18154First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
4009494e 18155
8a1cdce5
AC
18156The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18157connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18158When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18159Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
4009494e 18160
8a1cdce5
AC
18161The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18162connected to the net continuously.
4009494e 18163
8a1cdce5
AC
18164@dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18165machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
4009494e 18166
8a1cdce5
AC
18167You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18168shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18169is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18170say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18171you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
4009494e 18172
8a1cdce5
AC
18173Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18174that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18175can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18176servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18177they're kinda like plugged always).
4009494e 18178
8a1cdce5
AC
18179So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18180connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18181servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18182the culprit.
4009494e 18183
8a1cdce5
AC
18184Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18185reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18186server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18187server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18188will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
4009494e 18189
8a1cdce5 18190Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
4009494e 18191
8a1cdce5 18192@itemize @bullet
4009494e 18193
8a1cdce5
AC
18194@item
18195@findex gnus-unplugged
18196You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18197Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18198already fetched while in this mode.
4009494e 18199
8a1cdce5
AC
18200@item
18201You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18202your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18203to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18204as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18205Source Specifiers}).
4009494e 18206
8a1cdce5
AC
18207@item
18208You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18209news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18210@kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18211all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18212articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
4009494e 18213
8a1cdce5
AC
18214@item
18215After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18216unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18217then you read the news offline.
4009494e 18218
8a1cdce5
AC
18219@item
18220And then you go to step 2.
18221@end itemize
4009494e 18222
8a1cdce5
AC
18223Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18224the Agent.
18225
18226@itemize @bullet
4009494e 18227
8a1cdce5
AC
18228@item
18229Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18230back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18231Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18232@kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18233Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18234added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
ba775afe 18235no servers are agentized.
4009494e 18236
8a1cdce5
AC
18237@item
18238Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18239you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18240parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18241is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
4009494e 18242
8a1cdce5
AC
18243Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18244(@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18245to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18246parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18247to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18248your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18249configure them.
4009494e 18250
8a1cdce5
AC
18251@item
18252Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18253@end itemize
4009494e 18254
4009494e 18255
8a1cdce5
AC
18256@node Agent Categories
18257@subsection Agent Categories
4009494e 18258
8a1cdce5
AC
18259One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18260newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18261There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18262find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18263to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18264mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18265you're interested in the articles anyway.
4009494e 18266
8a1cdce5
AC
18267One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18268downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18269groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18270category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18271buffer for creating and managing categories.
4009494e 18272
8a1cdce5
AC
18273If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18274Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18275alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18276difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18277less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18278sink.
4009494e 18279
8a1cdce5
AC
18280Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18281a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18282the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18283parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18284variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18285of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18286your settings.
4009494e 18287
8a1cdce5
AC
18288@menu
18289* Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18290* Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18291* Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18292@end menu
4009494e 18293
4009494e 18294
8a1cdce5
AC
18295@node Category Syntax
18296@subsubsection Category Syntax
4009494e 18297
8a1cdce5
AC
18298A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18299category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18300customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18301listed below.
4009494e 18302
8a1cdce5
AC
18303@cindex Agent Parameters
18304@table @code
18305@item agent-groups
18306The list of groups that are in this category.
4009494e 18307
8a1cdce5
AC
18308@item agent-predicate
18309A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18310are eligible for downloading; and
4009494e 18311
8a1cdce5
AC
18312@item agent-score
18313a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18314deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18315score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
4009494e 18316
8a1cdce5
AC
18317@item agent-enable-expiration
18318a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18319this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18320fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18321only groups that should not be expired.
4009494e 18322
8a1cdce5
AC
18323@item agent-days-until-old
18324an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18325before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
4009494e 18326
8a1cdce5
AC
18327@item agent-low-score
18328an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
4009494e 18329
8a1cdce5
AC
18330@item agent-high-score
18331an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
4009494e 18332
8a1cdce5
AC
18333@item agent-short-article
18334an integer that overrides the value of
18335@code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
4009494e 18336
8a1cdce5
AC
18337@item agent-long-article
18338an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
4009494e 18339
8a1cdce5
AC
18340@item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18341a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18342undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18343faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18344undownloaded faces.
18345@end table
4009494e 18346
8a1cdce5
AC
18347The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18348created.
4009494e 18349
8a1cdce5
AC
18350Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18351that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18352group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18353category.
4009494e 18354
8a1cdce5
AC
18355A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18356@code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18357article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18358predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
4009494e 18359
8a1cdce5
AC
18360Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18361their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18362@code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
4009494e 18363
8a1cdce5
AC
18364To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18365download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18366operators sprinkled in between.
4009494e 18367
8a1cdce5 18368Perhaps some examples are in order.
4009494e 18369
8a1cdce5
AC
18370Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18371for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
4009494e 18372
8a1cdce5
AC
18373@lisp
18374short
18375@end lisp
4009494e 18376
8a1cdce5
AC
18377Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18378short (for some value of ``short'').
4009494e 18379
8a1cdce5 18380Here's a more complex predicate:
4009494e 18381
8a1cdce5
AC
18382@lisp
18383(or high
18384 (and
18385 (not low)
18386 (not long)))
18387@end lisp
4009494e 18388
8a1cdce5
AC
18389This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18390or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18391drift.
4009494e 18392
8a1cdce5
AC
18393The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18394@code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18395@samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
4009494e 18396
8a1cdce5
AC
18397The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18398you want to do, you can write your own.
4009494e 18399
8a1cdce5
AC
18400When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18401bound to the value determined by calling
18402@code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18403example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18404@code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18405means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18406predicate to individual groups.
4009494e 18407
8a1cdce5
AC
18408@table @code
18409@item short
18410True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18411lines; default 100.
4009494e 18412
8a1cdce5
AC
18413@item long
18414True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18415lines; default 200.
4009494e 18416
8a1cdce5
AC
18417@item low
18418True if the article has a download score less than
18419@code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
4009494e 18420
8a1cdce5
AC
18421@item high
18422True if the article has a download score greater than
18423@code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
4009494e 18424
8a1cdce5
AC
18425@item spam
18426True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18427heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18428checksum and sees whether articles match.
4009494e 18429
8a1cdce5
AC
18430@item true
18431Always true.
4009494e 18432
8a1cdce5
AC
18433@item false
18434Always false.
4009494e
GM
18435@end table
18436
8a1cdce5
AC
18437If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18438to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18439@code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18440useful values.
4009494e 18441
8a1cdce5 18442For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
1df7defd 18443that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g., posted
8a1cdce5
AC
18444more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18445something along the lines of the following:
4009494e
GM
18446
18447@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
18448(defun my-article-old-p ()
18449 "Say whether an article is old."
18450 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18451 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
4009494e
GM
18452@end lisp
18453
8a1cdce5 18454with the predicate then defined as:
4009494e
GM
18455
18456@lisp
8a1cdce5 18457(not my-article-old-p)
4009494e
GM
18458@end lisp
18459
8a1cdce5
AC
18460or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18461@code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18462wherever.
4009494e 18463
8a1cdce5
AC
18464@lisp
18465(require 'gnus-agent)
18466(setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18467 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18468 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18469@end lisp
4009494e 18470
8a1cdce5 18471and simply specify your predicate as:
4009494e 18472
8a1cdce5
AC
18473@lisp
18474(not old)
18475@end lisp
4009494e 18476
8a1cdce5
AC
18477If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18478misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18479always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18480just don't give a damn.
4009494e 18481
8a1cdce5
AC
18482The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18483category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18484individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18485new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18486parameters like so:
4009494e 18487
8a1cdce5
AC
18488@lisp
18489(agent-predicate . short)
18490@end lisp
4009494e 18491
8a1cdce5
AC
18492This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18493Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18494@code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
4009494e 18495
8a1cdce5 18496The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
4009494e
GM
18497
18498@lisp
8a1cdce5 18499(agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
4009494e
GM
18500@end lisp
18501
8a1cdce5
AC
18502The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18503entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18504predicate is assumed to be a list.
4009494e 18505
4009494e 18506
8a1cdce5
AC
18507Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18508normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18509seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18510following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18511@code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18512@code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
4009494e 18513
8a1cdce5
AC
18514As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18515to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18516it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18517if it's to be specific to that group.
4009494e 18518
8a1cdce5
AC
18519In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18520three forms:
4009494e 18521
8a1cdce5
AC
18522@enumerate
18523@item
18524Score rule
4009494e 18525
8a1cdce5
AC
18526This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18527subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
4009494e 18528
8a1cdce5 18529example:
4009494e 18530
8a1cdce5
AC
18531@itemize @bullet
18532@item
18533Category specification
4009494e 18534
8a1cdce5
AC
18535@lisp
18536(("from"
18537 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18538("lines"
18539 (500 -100 nil <)))
18540@end lisp
4009494e 18541
8a1cdce5
AC
18542@item
18543Group/Topic Parameter specification
4009494e 18544
8a1cdce5
AC
18545@lisp
18546(agent-score ("from"
18547 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18548 ("lines"
18549 (500 -100 nil <)))
18550@end lisp
4009494e 18551
8a1cdce5
AC
18552Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18553@end itemize
4009494e 18554
8a1cdce5
AC
18555@item
18556Agent score file
18557
18558These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18559keywords stated above.
18560
18561example:
4009494e
GM
18562
18563@itemize @bullet
18564@item
8a1cdce5 18565Category specification
4009494e 18566
8a1cdce5
AC
18567@lisp
18568("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18569@end lisp
4009494e 18570
8a1cdce5 18571or perhaps
4009494e 18572
8a1cdce5
AC
18573@lisp
18574("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18575@end lisp
4009494e 18576
8a1cdce5
AC
18577@item
18578Group Parameter specification
4009494e 18579
8a1cdce5
AC
18580@lisp
18581(agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18582@end lisp
4009494e 18583
8a1cdce5
AC
18584Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18585about parenthesis?
18586@end itemize
4009494e 18587
8a1cdce5
AC
18588@item
18589Use @code{normal} score files
4009494e 18590
8a1cdce5
AC
18591If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18592your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18593@code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18594@code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
4009494e 18595
8a1cdce5
AC
18596These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18597parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18598files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18599relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
4009494e
GM
18600
18601@itemize @bullet
18602@item
8a1cdce5
AC
18603Category Specification
18604
18605@lisp
18606file
18607@end lisp
18608
4009494e 18609@item
8a1cdce5
AC
18610Group Parameter specification
18611
18612@lisp
18613(agent-score . file)
18614@end lisp
4009494e 18615@end itemize
8a1cdce5 18616@end enumerate
4009494e 18617
8a1cdce5
AC
18618@node Category Buffer
18619@subsubsection Category Buffer
4009494e 18620
8a1cdce5
AC
18621You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18622When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18623the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
4009494e 18624
8a1cdce5 18625The following commands are available in this buffer:
4009494e 18626
8a1cdce5
AC
18627@table @kbd
18628@item q
18629@kindex q (Category)
18630@findex gnus-category-exit
18631Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
4009494e 18632
8a1cdce5
AC
18633@item e
18634@kindex e (Category)
18635@findex gnus-category-customize-category
18636Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18637parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
4009494e 18638
8a1cdce5
AC
18639@item k
18640@kindex k (Category)
18641@findex gnus-category-kill
18642Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
4009494e 18643
8a1cdce5
AC
18644@item c
18645@kindex c (Category)
18646@findex gnus-category-copy
18647Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
4009494e 18648
8a1cdce5
AC
18649@item a
18650@kindex a (Category)
18651@findex gnus-category-add
18652Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
4009494e 18653
8a1cdce5
AC
18654@item p
18655@kindex p (Category)
18656@findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18657Edit the predicate of the current category
18658(@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
4009494e 18659
8a1cdce5
AC
18660@item g
18661@kindex g (Category)
18662@findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18663Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18664(@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
4009494e 18665
8a1cdce5
AC
18666@item s
18667@kindex s (Category)
18668@findex gnus-category-edit-score
18669Edit the download score rule of the current category
18670(@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
4009494e 18671
8a1cdce5
AC
18672@item l
18673@kindex l (Category)
18674@findex gnus-category-list
18675List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18676@end table
4009494e 18677
4009494e 18678
8a1cdce5
AC
18679@node Category Variables
18680@subsubsection Category Variables
4009494e 18681
8a1cdce5
AC
18682@table @code
18683@item gnus-category-mode-hook
18684@vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18685Hook run in category buffers.
4009494e 18686
8a1cdce5
AC
18687@item gnus-category-line-format
18688@vindex gnus-category-line-format
18689Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18690Variables}). Valid elements are:
4009494e 18691
8a1cdce5
AC
18692@table @samp
18693@item c
18694The name of the category.
4009494e 18695
8a1cdce5
AC
18696@item g
18697The number of groups in the category.
18698@end table
4009494e 18699
8a1cdce5
AC
18700@item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18701@vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18702Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
4009494e 18703
8a1cdce5
AC
18704@item gnus-agent-short-article
18705@vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18706Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
4009494e 18707
8a1cdce5
AC
18708@item gnus-agent-long-article
18709@vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18710Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
4009494e 18711
8a1cdce5
AC
18712@item gnus-agent-low-score
18713@vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18714Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
187150.
18716
18717@item gnus-agent-high-score
18718@vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18719Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
187200.
18721
18722@item gnus-agent-expire-days
18723@vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18724The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18725local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18726the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18727just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18728important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18729article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18730read.
18731Default 7.
18732
18733@item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18734@vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18735Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18736retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18737you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18738you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18739have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18740
18741@end table
4009494e 18742
4009494e 18743
8a1cdce5
AC
18744@node Agent Commands
18745@subsection Agent Commands
18746@findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18747@kindex J j (Agent)
4009494e 18748
8a1cdce5
AC
18749All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18750(@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18751toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
4009494e
GM
18752
18753
18754@menu
8a1cdce5
AC
18755* Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18756* Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18757* Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
4009494e
GM
18758@end menu
18759
4009494e 18760
4009494e 18761
4009494e 18762
8a1cdce5
AC
18763@node Group Agent Commands
18764@subsubsection Group Agent Commands
4009494e 18765
8a1cdce5
AC
18766@table @kbd
18767@item J u
18768@kindex J u (Agent Group)
18769@findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18770Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18771(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
4009494e 18772
8a1cdce5
AC
18773@item J c
18774@kindex J c (Agent Group)
18775@findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18776Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
4009494e 18777
8a1cdce5
AC
18778@item J s
18779@kindex J s (Agent Group)
18780@findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18781Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18782(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
4009494e 18783
8a1cdce5
AC
18784@item J S
18785@kindex J S (Agent Group)
18786@findex gnus-group-send-queue
18787Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18788(@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
4009494e 18789
8a1cdce5
AC
18790@item J a
18791@kindex J a (Agent Group)
18792@findex gnus-agent-add-group
18793Add the current group to an Agent category
18794(@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18795process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 18796
8a1cdce5
AC
18797@item J r
18798@kindex J r (Agent Group)
18799@findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18800Remove the current group from its category, if any
18801(@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18802process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4009494e 18803
8a1cdce5
AC
18804@item J Y
18805@kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18806@findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18807Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
4009494e 18808
4009494e 18809
8a1cdce5 18810@end table
4009494e 18811
4009494e 18812
8a1cdce5
AC
18813@node Summary Agent Commands
18814@subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
4009494e 18815
8a1cdce5
AC
18816@table @kbd
18817@item J #
18818@kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18819@findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18820Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
4009494e 18821
8a1cdce5
AC
18822@item J M-#
18823@kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18824@findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18825Remove the downloading mark from the article
18826(@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
4009494e 18827
8a1cdce5
AC
18828@cindex %
18829@item @@
18830@kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18831@findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18832Toggle whether to download the article
18833(@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18834default.
4009494e 18835
8a1cdce5
AC
18836@item J c
18837@kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18838@findex gnus-agent-catchup
18839Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
4009494e 18840
8a1cdce5
AC
18841@item J S
18842@kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18843@findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18844Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18845(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
4009494e 18846
8a1cdce5
AC
18847@item J s
18848@kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18849@findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18850Download all processable articles in this group.
18851(@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
4009494e 18852
8a1cdce5
AC
18853@item J u
18854@kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18855@findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18856Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18857(@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
4009494e 18858
8a1cdce5 18859@end table
4009494e 18860
4009494e 18861
8a1cdce5
AC
18862@node Server Agent Commands
18863@subsubsection Server Agent Commands
4009494e 18864
8a1cdce5
AC
18865@table @kbd
18866@item J a
18867@kindex J a (Agent Server)
18868@findex gnus-agent-add-server
18869Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18870(@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
4009494e 18871
8a1cdce5
AC
18872@item J r
18873@kindex J r (Agent Server)
18874@findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18875Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18876Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
4009494e 18877
8a1cdce5 18878@end table
4009494e 18879
4009494e 18880
8a1cdce5
AC
18881@node Agent Visuals
18882@subsection Agent Visuals
4009494e 18883
8a1cdce5
AC
18884If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18885active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18886stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18887something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18888placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18889there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18890When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18891placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18892You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18893placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
4009494e 18894
8a1cdce5
AC
18895While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18896available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18897fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18898way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18899less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18900adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18901the download status of each article so that you always know which
18902articles will be available when unplugged.
4009494e 18903
8a1cdce5
AC
18904The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18905@code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18906a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18907Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18908will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18909other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18910@samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18911(@samp{ }) will be displayed.
4009494e 18912
8a1cdce5
AC
18913The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18914are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18915result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18916that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18917face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18918tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18919conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18920that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18921to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
4009494e 18922
8a1cdce5
AC
18923If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18924each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18925undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18926being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18927downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18928users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18929database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18930to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18931of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18932normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
4009494e 18933
8a1cdce5
AC
18934If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18935undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18936group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18937parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18938a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18939(@pxref{Group Parameters}).
4009494e 18940
8a1cdce5
AC
18941The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18942can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18943even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18944is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18945This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18946fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18947the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18948expiring'' articles.
4009494e 18949
8a1cdce5
AC
18950@node Agent as Cache
18951@subsection Agent as Cache
4009494e 18952
8a1cdce5
AC
18953When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18954articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18955Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18956in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18957buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18958are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18959consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18960article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18961server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
4009494e 18962
8a1cdce5
AC
18963If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18964@pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18965plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18966synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18967sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
4009494e 18968
8a1cdce5
AC
18969@node Agent Expiry
18970@subsection Agent Expiry
4009494e 18971
8a1cdce5
AC
18972@vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18973@findex gnus-agent-expire
18974@kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18975@kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18976@findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18977@cindex agent expiry
18978@cindex Gnus agent expiry
18979@cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
4009494e 18980
8a1cdce5
AC
18981The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18982least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18983special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18984commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18985@code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18986that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18987efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18988@kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
4009494e 18989
0c502747
LMI
18990Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
18991to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
4009494e 18992
8a1cdce5
AC
18993The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18994prevent expiration in selected groups.
4009494e 18995
8a1cdce5
AC
18996@vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18997If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18998expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18999and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
19000are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
19001be kept indefinitely.
4009494e 19002
8a1cdce5
AC
19003If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
19004perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
19005commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
19006@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
4009494e 19007
8a1cdce5
AC
19008@node Agent Regeneration
19009@subsection Agent Regeneration
4009494e 19010
8a1cdce5
AC
19011@cindex agent regeneration
19012@cindex Gnus agent regeneration
19013@cindex regeneration
4009494e 19014
8a1cdce5
AC
19015The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
19016due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
19017@code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
19018to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
19019internal inconsistencies.
4009494e 19020
8a1cdce5
AC
19021For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
19022downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
19023know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
19024failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
19025@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
19026such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
4009494e 19027
8a1cdce5
AC
19028@findex gnus-agent-regenerate
19029@kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
19030The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
19031@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
19032you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
19033recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
4009494e 19034
8a1cdce5
AC
19035@findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19036@kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19037The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19038of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19039then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19040are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19041agent as unread.
4009494e 19042
8a1cdce5
AC
19043@node Agent and flags
19044@subsection Agent and flags
4009494e 19045
8a1cdce5 19046The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
65e7ca35 19047nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc.)@: on the server. Sadly,
8a1cdce5
AC
19048the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
19049the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
19050Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
19051to the flags in its own files.
19052
19053When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
19054changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
19055server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
4009494e 19056
8a1cdce5
AC
19057@vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19058If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19059never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19060the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19061ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19062any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
4009494e 19063
8a1cdce5
AC
19064If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19065re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19066@code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19067in the group buffer.
4009494e 19068
8a1cdce5
AC
19069Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19070all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19071server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19072the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19073re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19074removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19075operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19076directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
4009494e 19077
8a1cdce5
AC
19078@node Agent and IMAP
19079@subsection Agent and IMAP
4009494e 19080
8a1cdce5
AC
19081The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19082since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19083@acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19084make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
4009494e 19085
8a1cdce5
AC
19086Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19087expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
4009494e 19088
8a1cdce5 19089@itemize @bullet
4009494e 19090
8a1cdce5
AC
19091@item
19092Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
4009494e 19093
8a1cdce5
AC
19094@item
19095Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
4009494e 19096
8a1cdce5 19097@end itemize
4009494e 19098
8a1cdce5
AC
19099@node Outgoing Messages
19100@subsection Outgoing Messages
4009494e 19101
8a1cdce5
AC
19102By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19103and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19104You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
4009494e 19105
8a1cdce5
AC
19106You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19107(see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19108news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
4009494e 19109
8a1cdce5
AC
19110You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19111commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19112group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19113Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19114mail at any time.
4009494e 19115
8a1cdce5
AC
19116If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19117about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19118ask you to confirm your action (see
19119@code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
4009494e 19120
8a1cdce5
AC
19121@node Agent Variables
19122@subsection Agent Variables
4009494e 19123
8a1cdce5
AC
19124@table @code
19125@item gnus-agent
19126@vindex gnus-agent
19127Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19128the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19129automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19130back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
4009494e 19131
8a1cdce5
AC
19132To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19133(@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
4009494e 19134
4009494e 19135
8a1cdce5
AC
19136@item gnus-agent-directory
19137@vindex gnus-agent-directory
19138Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19139@file{~/News/agent/}.
4009494e 19140
8a1cdce5
AC
19141@item gnus-agent-handle-level
19142@vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19143Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19144be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19145which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19146by default.
4009494e 19147
8a1cdce5
AC
19148@item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19149@vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19150Hook run when connecting to the network.
4009494e 19151
8a1cdce5
AC
19152@item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19153@vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19154Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
4009494e 19155
8a1cdce5
AC
19156@item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19157@vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19158Hook run when finished fetching articles.
4009494e 19159
8a1cdce5
AC
19160@item gnus-agent-cache
19161@vindex gnus-agent-cache
19162Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
1df7defd 19163articles when plugged, e.g., essentially using the Agent as a cache.
8a1cdce5 19164The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
4009494e 19165
8a1cdce5
AC
19166@item gnus-agent-go-online
19167@vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19168If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19169automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19170@code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19171offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19172other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19173online status.
4009494e 19174
8a1cdce5
AC
19175@item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19176@vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19177If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19178mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19179thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19180read. The default is @code{t}.
4009494e 19181
8a1cdce5
AC
19182@item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19183@vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19184If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19185never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19186the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19187ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19188any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
4009494e 19189
8a1cdce5
AC
19190@item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19191@vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19192If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19193agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19194downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19195the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19196are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19197into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19198the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19199over and over again.
4009494e 19200
8a1cdce5
AC
19201@item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19202@vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19203The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19204them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19205the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19206have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19207limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19208performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19209connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19210@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19211However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19212available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19213see any cycling.
4009494e 19214
8a1cdce5
AC
19215@item gnus-server-unopen-status
19216@vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19217Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19218variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19219Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19220whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19221Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19222for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19223is only valid if the Agent is used.
4009494e 19224
8a1cdce5
AC
19225@item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19226@vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19227Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19228that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19229buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19230agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
4009494e 19231
8a1cdce5
AC
19232The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19233@code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19234have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19235ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19236(maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
4009494e 19237
8a1cdce5
AC
19238@item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19239@vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19240When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19241queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19242will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19243mail. The default is @code{t}.
4009494e 19244
8a1cdce5
AC
19245@item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19246@vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19247When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19248prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19249@kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 19250
8a1cdce5
AC
19251@item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19252@vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19253If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19254@file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19255automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19256which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19257to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19258as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19259If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19260removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
ba775afe 19261start Gnus. The default is @samp{nil}.
4009494e 19262
4009494e
GM
19263@end table
19264
4009494e 19265
8a1cdce5
AC
19266@node Example Setup
19267@subsection Example Setup
19268
19269If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19270setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19271@file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
4009494e
GM
19272
19273@lisp
8a1cdce5
AC
19274;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19275;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19276(setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
4009494e 19277
8a1cdce5
AC
19278;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19279;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19280(setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
4009494e 19281
8a1cdce5
AC
19282;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19283(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19284
19285;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19286;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19287;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
4009494e
GM
19288@end lisp
19289
8a1cdce5
AC
19290That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19291edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19292gnus}.
4009494e 19293
8a1cdce5
AC
19294If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19295automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19296subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19297@acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19298command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19299once.
4009494e 19300
8a1cdce5
AC
19301After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19302groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19303command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19304subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19305back all the killed groups.)
4009494e 19306
8a1cdce5
AC
19307You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19308with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19309find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
4009494e 19310
4009494e 19311
8a1cdce5
AC
19312@node Batching Agents
19313@subsection Batching Agents
19314@findex gnus-agent-batch
4009494e 19315
8a1cdce5
AC
19316Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19317written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19318following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
4009494e 19319
8a1cdce5
AC
19320You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19321following incantation:
4009494e 19322
8a1cdce5
AC
19323@example
19324#!/bin/sh
19325emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19326@end example
4009494e 19327
4009494e 19328
8a1cdce5
AC
19329@node Agent Caveats
19330@subsection Agent Caveats
4009494e 19331
8a1cdce5
AC
19332The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19333newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19334may ask:
4009494e 19335
8a1cdce5
AC
19336@table @dfn
19337@item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
4009494e 19338
8a1cdce5
AC
19339@strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19340@code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19341@code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
4009494e 19342
8a1cdce5
AC
19343@item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19344the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
4009494e 19345
8a1cdce5 19346@strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
4009494e 19347
8a1cdce5 19348@end table
4009494e 19349
8a1cdce5
AC
19350In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19351articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19352locally stored articles.
4009494e 19353
4009494e 19354
8a1cdce5
AC
19355@node Scoring
19356@chapter Scoring
19357@cindex scoring
4009494e 19358
8a1cdce5
AC
19359Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19360scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19361something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19362attention!
4009494e 19363
8a1cdce5
AC
19364@vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19365All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19366which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19367interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19368@code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
4009494e 19369
8a1cdce5
AC
19370Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19371before generating the summary buffer.
4009494e 19372
8a1cdce5
AC
19373There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19374entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19375lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
4009494e 19376
8a1cdce5
AC
19377There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19378Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19379temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19380silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
4009494e 19381
8a1cdce5
AC
19382@menu
19383* Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19384* Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19385* Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19386* Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19387* Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19388* Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19389* Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19390* Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19391* Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19392* Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19393* Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19394* Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19395* Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19396* Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19397* Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19398* Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19399@end menu
4009494e 19400
4009494e 19401
8a1cdce5
AC
19402@node Summary Score Commands
19403@section Summary Score Commands
19404@cindex score commands
4009494e 19405
8a1cdce5
AC
19406The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19407score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19408previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19409@dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19410entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
4009494e 19411
8a1cdce5
AC
19412The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19413if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
1df7defd 19414some other score file (e.g., @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
8a1cdce5
AC
19415score file the current one.
19416
19417General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
4009494e 19418
8a1cdce5 19419@table @kbd
4009494e 19420
8a1cdce5
AC
19421@item V s
19422@kindex V s (Summary)
19423@findex gnus-summary-set-score
19424Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
4009494e 19425
8a1cdce5
AC
19426@item V S
19427@kindex V S (Summary)
19428@findex gnus-summary-current-score
19429Display the score of the current article
19430(@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
4009494e 19431
8a1cdce5
AC
19432@item V t
19433@kindex V t (Summary)
19434@findex gnus-score-find-trace
19435Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19436(@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19437may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19438current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19439score file and edit it.
4009494e 19440
8a1cdce5
AC
19441@item V w
19442@kindex V w (Summary)
19443@findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19444List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
4009494e 19445
8a1cdce5
AC
19446@item V R
19447@kindex V R (Summary)
19448@findex gnus-summary-rescore
19449Run the current summary through the scoring process
19450(@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19451around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19452effect you're having.
4009494e 19453
8a1cdce5
AC
19454@item V c
19455@kindex V c (Summary)
19456@findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19457Make a different score file the current
19458(@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
4009494e 19459
8a1cdce5
AC
19460@item V e
19461@kindex V e (Summary)
19462@findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19463Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19464You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19465File Editing}).
4009494e 19466
8a1cdce5
AC
19467@item V f
19468@kindex V f (Summary)
19469@findex gnus-score-edit-file
19470Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19471(@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
4009494e 19472
8a1cdce5
AC
19473@item V F
19474@kindex V F (Summary)
19475@findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19476Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19477after editing score files.
4009494e 19478
8a1cdce5
AC
19479@item V C
19480@kindex V C (Summary)
19481@findex gnus-score-customize
19482Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19483(@code{gnus-score-customize}).
4009494e 19484
8a1cdce5 19485@end table
4009494e 19486
8a1cdce5 19487The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
4009494e
GM
19488
19489@table @kbd
4009494e 19490
8a1cdce5
AC
19491@item V m
19492@kindex V m (Summary)
19493@findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19494Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19495read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
4009494e 19496
8a1cdce5
AC
19497@item V x
19498@kindex V x (Summary)
19499@findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19500Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19501expunge all articles below this score
19502(@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19503@end table
4009494e 19504
8a1cdce5
AC
19505The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19506pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19507them.)
4009494e 19508
8a1cdce5
AC
19509@findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19510@findex gnus-summary-lower-score
4009494e 19511
8a1cdce5
AC
19512@enumerate
19513@item
19514The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19515or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19516@item
19517The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19518keys are available:
19519@table @kbd
4009494e 19520
8a1cdce5
AC
19521@item a
19522Score on the author name.
4009494e
GM
19523
19524@item s
8a1cdce5
AC
19525Score on the subject line.
19526
19527@item x
19528Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19529
19530@item r
19531Score on the @code{References} line.
19532
19533@item d
19534Score on the date.
4009494e
GM
19535
19536@item l
8a1cdce5 19537Score on the number of lines.
4009494e 19538
8a1cdce5
AC
19539@item i
19540Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
4009494e 19541
8a1cdce5
AC
19542@item e
19543Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19544if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
4009494e 19545
8a1cdce5
AC
19546@item f
19547Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19548the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19549@file{ADAPT} files.)
4009494e 19550
8a1cdce5
AC
19551@item b
19552Score on the body.
4009494e 19553
8a1cdce5
AC
19554@item h
19555Score on the head.
19556
19557@item t
19558Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19559files.)
4009494e 19560
4009494e
GM
19561@end table
19562
8a1cdce5
AC
19563@item
19564The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19565what headers you are scoring on.
4009494e 19566
8a1cdce5 19567@table @code
4009494e 19568
8a1cdce5 19569@item strings
4009494e 19570
8a1cdce5 19571@table @kbd
4009494e 19572
8a1cdce5
AC
19573@item e
19574Exact matching.
4009494e 19575
8a1cdce5
AC
19576@item s
19577Substring matching.
4009494e 19578
8a1cdce5
AC
19579@item f
19580Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
4009494e 19581
8a1cdce5
AC
19582@item r
19583Regexp matching
4009494e
GM
19584@end table
19585
8a1cdce5
AC
19586@item date
19587@table @kbd
4009494e 19588
8a1cdce5
AC
19589@item b
19590Before date.
4009494e 19591
8a1cdce5
AC
19592@item a
19593After date.
4009494e 19594
8a1cdce5
AC
19595@item n
19596This date.
19597@end table
4009494e 19598
8a1cdce5
AC
19599@item number
19600@table @kbd
4009494e 19601
8a1cdce5
AC
19602@item <
19603Less than number.
4009494e 19604
8a1cdce5
AC
19605@item =
19606Equal to number.
4009494e 19607
8a1cdce5
AC
19608@item >
19609Greater than number.
19610@end table
19611@end table
4009494e 19612
8a1cdce5
AC
19613@item
19614The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19615expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19616or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19617file.
4009494e 19618@table @kbd
4009494e 19619
8a1cdce5
AC
19620@item t
19621Temporary score entry.
4009494e 19622
8a1cdce5
AC
19623@item p
19624Permanent score entry.
4009494e 19625
8a1cdce5
AC
19626@item i
19627Immediately scoring.
19628@end table
4009494e 19629
8a1cdce5
AC
19630@item
19631If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19632the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19633in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
4009494e 19634
8a1cdce5 19635@end enumerate
4009494e 19636
8a1cdce5
AC
19637So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19638exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19639score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19640temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
4009494e 19641
8a1cdce5
AC
19642To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19643a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19644defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19645``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19646t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
4009494e 19647
8a1cdce5
AC
19648These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19649(@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19650(or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19651says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19652current score file.
4009494e 19653
8a1cdce5
AC
19654@vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19655The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19656pretend they are keymaps or not.
4009494e 19657
4009494e 19658
8a1cdce5
AC
19659@node Group Score Commands
19660@section Group Score Commands
19661@cindex group score commands
4009494e 19662
8a1cdce5 19663There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
4009494e 19664
8a1cdce5 19665@table @kbd
4009494e 19666
8a1cdce5
AC
19667@item W e
19668@kindex W e (Group)
19669@findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19670Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19671a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
4009494e 19672
8a1cdce5
AC
19673@item W f
19674@kindex W f (Group)
19675@findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19676Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19677all the time. This command will flush the cache
19678(@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
4009494e 19679
8a1cdce5 19680@end table
4009494e 19681
8a1cdce5 19682You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
4009494e 19683
8a1cdce5
AC
19684@findex gnus-batch-score
19685@cindex batch scoring
19686@example
19687$ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19688@end example
4009494e
GM
19689
19690
8a1cdce5
AC
19691@node Score Variables
19692@section Score Variables
19693@cindex score variables
4009494e 19694
8a1cdce5 19695@table @code
4009494e 19696
8a1cdce5
AC
19697@item gnus-use-scoring
19698@vindex gnus-use-scoring
19699If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19700general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
4009494e 19701
8a1cdce5
AC
19702@item gnus-kill-killed
19703@vindex gnus-kill-killed
19704If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19705articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19706may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19707to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19708group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19709variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
4009494e 19710
8a1cdce5
AC
19711@item gnus-kill-files-directory
19712@vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19713All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19714initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19715This is @file{~/News/} by default.
4009494e 19716
8a1cdce5
AC
19717@item gnus-score-file-suffix
19718@vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19719Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19720(@file{SCORE} by default.)
4009494e 19721
8a1cdce5
AC
19722@item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19723@vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19724@cindex score cache
19725All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19726score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19727bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19728to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19729@file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19730@file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19731variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19732be cached.
4009494e 19733
8a1cdce5
AC
19734@item gnus-save-score
19735@vindex gnus-save-score
19736If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19737scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19738Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
4009494e 19739
8a1cdce5
AC
19740If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19741with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19742across group visits.
4009494e 19743
8a1cdce5
AC
19744@item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19745@vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19746Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19747score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19748ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19749We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19750manually entered data.
4009494e 19751
8a1cdce5
AC
19752@item gnus-summary-default-score
19753@vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19754Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
01c52d31 19755
8a1cdce5
AC
19756@item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19757@vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19758Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19759this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19760articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19761and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
01c52d31 19762
8a1cdce5
AC
19763@item gnus-score-over-mark
19764@vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19765Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19766default. Default is @samp{+}.
4009494e 19767
8a1cdce5
AC
19768@item gnus-score-below-mark
19769@vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19770Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19771default. Default is @samp{-}.
4009494e 19772
8a1cdce5
AC
19773@item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19774@vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19775Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19776is called with the name of the group as the argument.
4009494e 19777
8a1cdce5
AC
19778Predefined functions available are:
19779@table @code
4009494e 19780
8a1cdce5
AC
19781@item gnus-score-find-single
19782@findex gnus-score-find-single
19783Only apply the group's own score file.
4009494e 19784
8a1cdce5
AC
19785@item gnus-score-find-bnews
19786@findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19787Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19788default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19789@file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19790@file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19791@samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19792then a regexp match is done.
4009494e 19793
8a1cdce5
AC
19794This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19795all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
4009494e 19796
8a1cdce5
AC
19797The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19798try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19799files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19800file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
4009494e 19801
8a1cdce5
AC
19802@item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19803@findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19804Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19805can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19806@file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19807server.
4009494e 19808
8a1cdce5
AC
19809@end table
19810This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19811these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19812all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19813functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19814that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19815should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19816ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19817Phu.
4009494e 19818
8a1cdce5
AC
19819For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19820overall score file, you could use the value
19821@example
19822(list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19823 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19824@end example
4009494e 19825
8a1cdce5
AC
19826@item gnus-score-expiry-days
19827@vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19828This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19829entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19830are expired. It's 7 by default.
4009494e 19831
8a1cdce5
AC
19832@item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19833@vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19834If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19835been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19836controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19837matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19838variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19839have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
4009494e 19840
8a1cdce5
AC
19841@item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19842@vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19843Function called with the name of the score file just written.
4009494e 19844
8a1cdce5
AC
19845@item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19846@vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19847If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19848simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19849threading---according to the current value of
19850@code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19851@code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19852simplified in this manner.
4009494e 19853
8a1cdce5 19854@end table
4009494e 19855
4009494e 19856
8a1cdce5
AC
19857@node Score File Format
19858@section Score File Format
19859@cindex score file format
4009494e 19860
8a1cdce5
AC
19861A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19862single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19863everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
4009494e 19864
8a1cdce5 19865Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
4009494e 19866
8a1cdce5
AC
19867@lisp
19868(("from"
19869 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19870 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19871 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19872 ("subject"
19873 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19874 ("xref"
19875 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19876 ("lines"
19877 (2 -100 nil <))
19878 (mark 0)
19879 (expunge -1000)
19880 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19881 (read-only nil)
19882 (orphan -10)
19883 (adapt t)
19884 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19885 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19886 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19887 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19888 (eval (ding)))
19889@end lisp
4009494e 19890
8a1cdce5
AC
19891This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19892Scoring}, for a different approach.
4009494e 19893
8a1cdce5
AC
19894Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19895@code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19896has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
01c52d31 19897
8a1cdce5 19898Six keys are supported by this alist:
01c52d31 19899
8a1cdce5 19900@table @code
01c52d31 19901
8a1cdce5
AC
19902@item STRING
19903If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19904match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19905@code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19906@code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19907these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19908article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19909will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19910perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19911perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19912last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19913final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19914entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19915to articles that matches these score entries.
4009494e 19916
8a1cdce5
AC
19917Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19918score entry has one to four elements.
19919@enumerate
4009494e
GM
19920
19921@item
8a1cdce5
AC
19922The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19923be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19924integer.
4009494e
GM
19925
19926@item
8a1cdce5
AC
19927If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19928element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19929interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19930is successful. If this element is not present, the
19931@code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19932instead. This is 1000 by default.
4009494e 19933
8a1cdce5
AC
19934@item
19935If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19936element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19937which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19938element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19939represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
4009494e 19940
8a1cdce5
AC
19941@item
19942If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19943element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19944whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19945be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19946@table @dfn
4009494e 19947
8a1cdce5
AC
19948@item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19949For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19950well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19951@code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19952element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19953be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19954that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19955one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19956@code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19957instead, if you feel like.
4009494e 19958
8a1cdce5
AC
19959@item Extra
19960Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19961gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19962case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19963header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19964@file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19965host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19966overviews:
4009494e 19967
8a1cdce5
AC
19968@lisp
19969("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19970 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19971@end lisp
4009494e 19972
8a1cdce5
AC
19973@item Lines, Chars
19974These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19975@code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
4009494e 19976
8a1cdce5 19977These predicates are true if
4009494e 19978
8a1cdce5
AC
19979@example
19980(PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19981@end example
01c52d31 19982
8a1cdce5
AC
19983evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19984@code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19985following form:
01c52d31 19986
8a1cdce5
AC
19987@lisp
19988(< header-value 4)
19989@end lisp
01c52d31 19990
8a1cdce5
AC
19991Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19992the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19993(It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19994it's not. I think.)
4009494e 19995
8a1cdce5
AC
19996When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19997@code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19998up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19999you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
4009494e 20000
8a1cdce5
AC
20001@item Date
20002For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
20003@code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
20004ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
20005this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
20006Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
20007sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
20008quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
4009494e 20009
8a1cdce5
AC
20010@cindex ISO8601
20011@cindex date
20012A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
20013date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
20014ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
20015you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
20016every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
20017for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
20018this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
20019the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
20020whole family, eh?)
4009494e 20021
8a1cdce5 20022@item Head, Body, All
65e7ca35 20023These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc.)@:
8a1cdce5 20024header uses.
4009494e 20025
8a1cdce5
AC
20026@item Followup
20027This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
20028@code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
20029articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
1df7defd 20030you to increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
8a1cdce5
AC
20031decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
20032trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
20033uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
20034files.)
4009494e 20035
8a1cdce5
AC
20036@item Thread
20037This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20038key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20039article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20040match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20041has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20042matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20043This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20044even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20045@code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
22bcf204 20046nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
8a1cdce5
AC
20047key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20048@end table
20049@end enumerate
4009494e 20050
8a1cdce5
AC
20051@cindex score file atoms
20052@item mark
20053The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20054lower than this number will be marked as read.
4009494e 20055
8a1cdce5
AC
20056@item expunge
20057The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20058lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
01c52d31 20059
8a1cdce5
AC
20060@item mark-and-expunge
20061The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20062lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20063summary buffer.
20064
20065@item thread-mark-and-expunge
20066The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20067a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20068and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20069says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20070
20071@item files
20072The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20073are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20074this one was.
20075
20076@item exclude-files
20077The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20078not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20079other.
20080
20081@item eval
20082The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20083ignored when handling global score files.
4009494e 20084
8a1cdce5
AC
20085@item read-only
20086Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20087should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20088@dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20089apply-to-all-groups score files.)
4009494e 20090
8a1cdce5
AC
20091@item orphan
20092The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20093parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20094some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20095will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
4009494e 20096
8a1cdce5 20097You can do this with the following two score file entries:
4009494e 20098
8a1cdce5
AC
20099@example
20100 (orphan -500)
20101 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20102@end example
4009494e 20103
8a1cdce5
AC
20104When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20105threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20106interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20107rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20108interesting threads, plus any new threads.
01c52d31 20109
1df7defd 20110I.e., the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
8a1cdce5
AC
20111interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20112scoring rules exist.
01c52d31 20113
8a1cdce5
AC
20114@item adapt
20115This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20116default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20117adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20118list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20119or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20120adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20121scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20122@code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20123not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20124groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20125insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20126it.
20127
20128@item adapt-file
20129All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20130will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20131if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20132file for a number of groups.
4009494e 20133
8a1cdce5
AC
20134@item local
20135@cindex local variables
20136The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20137@var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20138current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20139convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20140groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20141be evaluated.
4009494e
GM
20142@end table
20143
20144
8a1cdce5
AC
20145@node Score File Editing
20146@section Score File Editing
4009494e 20147
8a1cdce5
AC
20148You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20149might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20150with a mode for that.
4009494e 20151
8a1cdce5
AC
20152It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20153additional commands:
4009494e 20154
8a1cdce5 20155@table @kbd
4009494e 20156
8a1cdce5
AC
20157@item C-c C-c
20158@kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20159@findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20160Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20161(@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
4009494e 20162
8a1cdce5
AC
20163@item C-c C-d
20164@kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20165@findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20166Insert the current date in numerical format
20167(@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20168you were wondering.
4009494e 20169
8a1cdce5
AC
20170@item C-c C-p
20171@kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20172@findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20173The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20174intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20175first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20176you.
4009494e 20177
8a1cdce5 20178@end table
4009494e 20179
8a1cdce5 20180Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
4009494e 20181
8a1cdce5
AC
20182@vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20183@code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
4009494e 20184
8a1cdce5
AC
20185In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20186@kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
4009494e 20187
4009494e 20188
8a1cdce5
AC
20189@node Adaptive Scoring
20190@section Adaptive Scoring
20191@cindex adaptive scoring
4009494e 20192
8a1cdce5
AC
20193If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20194happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20195stupidity, to be precise.
4009494e 20196
8a1cdce5
AC
20197@vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20198When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20199article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20200these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20201You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20202@code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20203words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20204@code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20205variable to @code{(word line)}.
4009494e 20206
8a1cdce5
AC
20207@vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20208To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20209the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20210might look something like this:
4009494e 20211
8a1cdce5
AC
20212@lisp
20213(setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20214 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20215 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20216 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20217 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20218 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20219 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20220 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20221 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20222 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20223 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20224 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20225@end lisp
4009494e 20226
8a1cdce5
AC
20227As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20228variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20229a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20230pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20231that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20232@code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20233entries.
4009494e 20234
8a1cdce5
AC
20235Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20236will be applied to each article.
20237
20238To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20239articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20240score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20241lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20242
20243If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20244@code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20245That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20246should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20247
20248If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20249the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20250probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20251adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20252
20253The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20254@code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20255@code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20256@code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20257on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20258current article, thereby matching the following thread.
4009494e 20259
8a1cdce5
AC
20260If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20261to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20262changes result in articles getting marked as read.
4009494e 20263
8a1cdce5
AC
20264After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20265become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20266the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
4009494e 20267
8a1cdce5
AC
20268You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20269by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20270let you use different rules in different groups.
4009494e 20271
8a1cdce5
AC
20272@vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20273The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20274group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20275is @file{ADAPT}.
4009494e 20276
8a1cdce5
AC
20277@vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20278Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20279human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20280default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
4009494e 20281
8a1cdce5
AC
20282@vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20283When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20284give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20285matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20286the length of the match is less than
20287@code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20288this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20289this problem.
4009494e 20290
8a1cdce5
AC
20291@vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20292As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20293headers. If you adapt on words, the
20294@code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20295each instance of a word should add given a mark.
4009494e 20296
8a1cdce5
AC
20297@lisp
20298(setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20299 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20300 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20301 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20302 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20303@end lisp
4009494e 20304
8a1cdce5
AC
20305This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20306word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20307@code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20308score with 30 points.
4009494e 20309
8a1cdce5
AC
20310@vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20311@vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20312Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20313will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20314@code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
4009494e 20315
8a1cdce5
AC
20316@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20317Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20318scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20319an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20320variable defaults to @code{nil}.
4009494e 20321
8a1cdce5
AC
20322@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20323When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20324syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20325it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
4009494e 20326
8a1cdce5
AC
20327@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20328If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20329word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20330below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
4009494e 20331
8a1cdce5
AC
20332@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20333If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20334won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20335for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20336lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
4009494e 20337
8a1cdce5
AC
20338After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20339@code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20340what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
4009494e 20341
8a1cdce5
AC
20342Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20343likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20344that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20345rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
4009494e 20346
4009494e 20347
8a1cdce5
AC
20348@node Home Score File
20349@section Home Score File
4009494e 20350
8a1cdce5
AC
20351The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20352@dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20353for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20354@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
4009494e 20355
8a1cdce5
AC
20356However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20357a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20358could perhaps use the same home score file.
4009494e 20359
8a1cdce5
AC
20360@vindex gnus-home-score-file
20361The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20362be:
4009494e 20363
8a1cdce5
AC
20364@enumerate
20365@item
20366A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20367groups.
4009494e 20368
8a1cdce5
AC
20369@item
20370A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20371file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20372parameter.
4009494e 20373
8a1cdce5
AC
20374@item
20375A list. The elements in this list can be:
4009494e 20376
8a1cdce5
AC
20377@enumerate
20378@item
20379@code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20380group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
4009494e 20381
8a1cdce5
AC
20382@item
20383A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20384be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20385name of the group as the parameter.
4009494e 20386
8a1cdce5
AC
20387@item
20388A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20389@end enumerate
4009494e 20390
8a1cdce5
AC
20391The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20392for matches.
4009494e 20393
8a1cdce5 20394@end enumerate
4009494e 20395
8a1cdce5 20396So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
4009494e 20397
8a1cdce5
AC
20398@lisp
20399(setq gnus-home-score-file
20400 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20401@end lisp
4009494e 20402
8a1cdce5
AC
20403If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20404@file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
4009494e 20405
8a1cdce5
AC
20406@findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20407@lisp
20408(setq gnus-home-score-file
20409 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20410@end lisp
4009494e 20411
8a1cdce5
AC
20412This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20413Other functions include
20414
20415@table @code
20416@item gnus-current-home-score-file
20417@findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20418Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20419commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
4009494e 20420
8a1cdce5 20421@end table
4009494e 20422
8a1cdce5
AC
20423If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20424another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20425their own home score files:
4009494e 20426
8a1cdce5
AC
20427@lisp
20428(setq gnus-home-score-file
20429 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20430 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20431 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20432 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20433@end lisp
4009494e 20434
8a1cdce5
AC
20435@vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20436@code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20437@code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20438is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20439specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
4009494e 20440
8a1cdce5
AC
20441In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20442@code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20443(@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20444Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20445precedence over this variable.
4009494e 20446
4009494e 20447
8a1cdce5
AC
20448@node Followups To Yourself
20449@section Followups To Yourself
4009494e 20450
8a1cdce5
AC
20451Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20452the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20453this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20454articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20455respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20456to easily note when people answer what you've said.
4009494e 20457
8a1cdce5 20458@table @code
4009494e 20459
8a1cdce5
AC
20460@item gnus-score-followup-article
20461@findex gnus-score-followup-article
20462This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20463article.
4009494e 20464
8a1cdce5
AC
20465@item gnus-score-followup-thread
20466@findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20467This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20468your own article.
20469@end table
4009494e 20470
8a1cdce5
AC
20471@vindex message-sent-hook
20472These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20473@code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20474@lisp
20475(add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20476@end lisp
4009494e 20477
4009494e 20478
8a1cdce5
AC
20479If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20480the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20481mine:
4009494e 20482
8a1cdce5
AC
20483@example
20484<x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20485<x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20486@end example
4009494e 20487
8a1cdce5
AC
20488So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20489exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20490myself:
4009494e 20491
8a1cdce5
AC
20492@lisp
20493("references"
20494 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20495 1000 nil r))
20496@end lisp
4009494e 20497
8a1cdce5
AC
20498Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20499is system-dependent.
4009494e 20500
4009494e 20501
8a1cdce5
AC
20502@node Scoring On Other Headers
20503@section Scoring On Other Headers
20504@cindex scoring on other headers
4009494e 20505
8a1cdce5
AC
20506Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20507headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20508other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20509that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20510matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
4009494e 20511
8a1cdce5
AC
20512@vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20513You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20514variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20515@code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20516the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
20517inhibited for all groups.
4009494e 20518
8a1cdce5
AC
20519Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20520mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20521it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20522a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20523@samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
4009494e 20524
8a1cdce5 20525Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
4009494e 20526
8a1cdce5
AC
20527@lisp
20528(setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20529 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20530@end lisp
4009494e 20531
8a1cdce5
AC
20532Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20533@kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20534time if you have much mail.
4009494e 20535
8a1cdce5
AC
20536Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20537so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
4009494e 20538
8a1cdce5 20539See? Simple.
4009494e 20540
4009494e 20541
8a1cdce5
AC
20542@node Scoring Tips
20543@section Scoring Tips
20544@cindex scoring tips
4009494e 20545
8a1cdce5 20546@table @dfn
4009494e 20547
8a1cdce5
AC
20548@item Crossposts
20549@cindex crossposts
20550@cindex scoring crossposts
20551If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20552the @code{Xref} header.
20553@lisp
20554("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20555@end lisp
4009494e 20556
8a1cdce5
AC
20557@item Multiple crossposts
20558If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20559more than, say, 3 groups:
20560@lisp
20561("xref"
20562 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20563 -1000 nil r))
20564@end lisp
4009494e 20565
8a1cdce5
AC
20566@item Matching on the body
20567This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20568Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20569you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20570keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20571and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20572will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20573@code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20574the matches.
4009494e 20575
8a1cdce5
AC
20576@item Marking as read
20577You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20578number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20579in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20580@lisp
20581((mark -100))
20582@end lisp
20583You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
4009494e 20584
8a1cdce5
AC
20585@item Negated character classes
20586If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20587That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20588@code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
4009494e
GM
20589@end table
20590
4009494e 20591
8a1cdce5
AC
20592@node Reverse Scoring
20593@section Reverse Scoring
20594@cindex reverse scoring
4009494e 20595
8a1cdce5
AC
20596If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20597subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20598like this in your score file:
4009494e 20599
8a1cdce5
AC
20600@lisp
20601(("subject"
20602 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20603 (mark 1)
20604 (expunge 1))
20605@end lisp
4009494e 20606
8a1cdce5
AC
20607So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20608rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
4009494e
GM
20609
20610
8a1cdce5
AC
20611@node Global Score Files
20612@section Global Score Files
20613@cindex global score files
4009494e 20614
8a1cdce5
AC
20615Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20616nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20617in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
4009494e 20618
8a1cdce5
AC
20619What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20620all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20621big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
4009494e 20622
8a1cdce5
AC
20623@vindex gnus-global-score-files
20624All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20625@code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20626or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20627files are applicable to which group.
01c52d31 20628
8a1cdce5
AC
20629To use the score file
20630@file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20631all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20632say this:
4009494e 20633
8a1cdce5
AC
20634@lisp
20635(setq gnus-global-score-files
20636 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20637 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20638@end lisp
4009494e 20639
8a1cdce5
AC
20640@findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20641@noindent
20642Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20643directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20644If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20645use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
4009494e 20646
8a1cdce5
AC
20647Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20648somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
4009494e 20649
8a1cdce5
AC
20650If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20651just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20652world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20653wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20654sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20655premises! Yay! The net is saved!
4009494e 20656
8a1cdce5
AC
20657Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20658head:
4009494e 20659
8a1cdce5 20660@itemize @bullet
4009494e 20661
8a1cdce5
AC
20662@item
20663Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20664@item
20665To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20666@item
20667Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20668@item
20669Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20670lowered out of existence.
20671@item
20672Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20673articles completely.
4009494e 20674
8a1cdce5
AC
20675@item
20676Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20677should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20678old articles for a long time.
20679@end itemize
4009494e 20680
8a1cdce5
AC
20681@dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20682in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20683Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20684holding our breath yet?
4009494e 20685
4009494e 20686
8a1cdce5
AC
20687@node Kill Files
20688@section Kill Files
20689@cindex kill files
4009494e 20690
8a1cdce5
AC
20691Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20692entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20693Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
4009494e 20694
8a1cdce5
AC
20695In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20696than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20697files into score files.
4009494e 20698
8a1cdce5
AC
20699Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20700forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20701sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20702that isn't a very good idea.
4009494e 20703
8a1cdce5 20704Normal kill files look like this:
4009494e 20705
8a1cdce5
AC
20706@lisp
20707(gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20708(gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20709(gnus-expunge "X")
20710@end lisp
4009494e 20711
8a1cdce5
AC
20712This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20713marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
4009494e 20714
8a1cdce5
AC
20715Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20716encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20717interpreting it.
4009494e 20718
8a1cdce5 20719Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
4009494e 20720
8a1cdce5 20721@table @kbd
4009494e 20722
8a1cdce5
AC
20723@item M-k
20724@kindex M-k (Summary)
20725@findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20726Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
4009494e 20727
8a1cdce5
AC
20728@item M-K
20729@kindex M-K (Summary)
20730@findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20731Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20732@end table
4009494e 20733
8a1cdce5 20734Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
4009494e 20735
8a1cdce5 20736@table @kbd
4009494e 20737
8a1cdce5
AC
20738@item M-k
20739@kindex M-k (Group)
20740@findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20741Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
4009494e 20742
8a1cdce5
AC
20743@item M-K
20744@kindex M-K (Group)
20745@findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20746Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
4009494e 20747@end table
4009494e 20748
8a1cdce5 20749Kill file variables:
4009494e 20750
8a1cdce5
AC
20751@table @code
20752@item gnus-kill-file-name
20753@vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20754A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20755@file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20756this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20757The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20758course) is just called @file{KILL}.
4009494e 20759
8a1cdce5
AC
20760@vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20761@item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20762If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20763kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20764kills.
4009494e 20765
8a1cdce5
AC
20766@item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20767@vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20768@findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20769@findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20770A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20771@code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20772kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20773hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20774kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
4009494e 20775
8a1cdce5
AC
20776@item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20777@vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20778A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
4009494e
GM
20779
20780@end table
20781
20782
8a1cdce5
AC
20783@node Converting Kill Files
20784@section Converting Kill Files
20785@cindex kill files
20786@cindex converting kill files
4009494e 20787
8a1cdce5
AC
20788If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20789score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20790the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20791by hand.
4009494e 20792
8a1cdce5
AC
20793The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20794You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20795from
20796@uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
4009494e 20797
8a1cdce5
AC
20798If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20799non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20800hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20801before.
4009494e 20802
4009494e 20803
8a1cdce5
AC
20804@node Advanced Scoring
20805@section Advanced Scoring
4009494e 20806
8a1cdce5
AC
20807Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20808really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20809about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20810read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20811want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
4009494e 20812
8a1cdce5
AC
20813By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20814scoring patterns.
4009494e 20815
8a1cdce5
AC
20816@menu
20817* Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20818* Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20819* Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20820@end menu
4009494e 20821
4009494e 20822
8a1cdce5
AC
20823@node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20824@subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
4009494e 20825
8a1cdce5
AC
20826Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20827Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20828element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20829non-@code{nil} value.
4009494e 20830
8a1cdce5
AC
20831These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20832operator, and various match operators.
4009494e 20833
8a1cdce5 20834Logical operators:
4009494e 20835
8a1cdce5
AC
20836@table @code
20837@item &
20838@itemx and
20839This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20840one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20841evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20842@code{true}.
4009494e 20843
8a1cdce5
AC
20844@item |
20845@itemx or
20846This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20847one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20848then this operator will return @code{false}.
4009494e 20849
8a1cdce5
AC
20850@item !
20851@itemx not
89b163db 20852@itemx ¬
8a1cdce5
AC
20853This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20854logical negation of the value of its argument.
4009494e 20855
8a1cdce5 20856@end table
4009494e 20857
8a1cdce5
AC
20858There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20859apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20860instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20861current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20862grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20863@code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20864the ancestry you want to go.
4009494e 20865
8a1cdce5
AC
20866Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20867real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20868and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20869"Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20870simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
4009494e 20871
4009494e 20872
8a1cdce5
AC
20873@node Advanced Scoring Examples
20874@subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
4009494e 20875
8a1cdce5
AC
20876Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20877make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20878of parentheses.
4009494e 20879
8a1cdce5
AC
20880Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20881when he's talking about Gnus:
4009494e 20882
8a1cdce5
AC
20883@example
20884@group
20885((&
20886 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20887 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20888 1000)
20889@end group
20890@end example
4009494e 20891
8a1cdce5 20892Quite simple, huh?
4009494e 20893
8a1cdce5 20894When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
4009494e 20895
8a1cdce5
AC
20896@example
20897((&
20898 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20899 (|
20900 ("subject" "Gnus")
20901 ("lines" 100 >)))
20902 1000)
20903@end example
4009494e 20904
8a1cdce5
AC
20905However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20906really don't want to read what he's written:
4009494e 20907
8a1cdce5
AC
20908@example
20909((&
20910 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20911 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20912 -100000)
20913@end example
4009494e 20914
8a1cdce5
AC
20915Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20916socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20917white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20918very interesting:
4009494e 20919
8a1cdce5
AC
20920@example
20921((&
20922 (1-
20923 (&
20924 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20925 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20926 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20927 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20928 1000)
20929@end example
4009494e 20930
8a1cdce5
AC
20931Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20932in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20933subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20934parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
4009494e 20935
8a1cdce5
AC
20936@example
20937((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20938 -200)
20939((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20940 200)
20941@end example
4009494e 20942
8a1cdce5 20943The possibilities are endless.
4009494e 20944
8a1cdce5
AC
20945@node Advanced Scoring Tips
20946@subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
4009494e 20947
8a1cdce5
AC
20948The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20949That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20950result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20951of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20952the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20953(@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20954@samp{subject}) first.
4009494e 20955
8a1cdce5
AC
20956The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20957arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20958something like:
4009494e
GM
20959
20960@example
8a1cdce5
AC
20961...
20962(1-
20963 (1-
20964 ("from" "lars")))
20965...
4009494e
GM
20966@end example
20967
8a1cdce5
AC
20968Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20969current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
4009494e 20970
8a1cdce5
AC
20971@example
20972(1-
20973 (&
20974 ("from" "Lars")
20975 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20976@end example
4009494e 20977
8a1cdce5 20978than it is to say:
4009494e 20979
8a1cdce5
AC
20980@example
20981(&
20982 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20983 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20984@end example
4009494e
GM
20985
20986
8a1cdce5
AC
20987@node Score Decays
20988@section Score Decays
20989@cindex score decays
20990@cindex decays
4009494e 20991
8a1cdce5
AC
20992You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20993bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20994big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20995use them in any sensible way.
4009494e 20996
8a1cdce5
AC
20997@vindex gnus-decay-scores
20998@findex gnus-decay-score
20999@vindex gnus-decay-score-function
21000Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
21001When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
21002non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
21003mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
21004If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
1df7defd 21005regexp are treated. E.g., you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
8a1cdce5
AC
21006@emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
21007performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
21008@code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
21009function:
4009494e 21010
8a1cdce5
AC
21011@lisp
21012(defun gnus-decay-score (score)
21013 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
21014and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
21015 (let ((n (- score
21016 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
21017 (min (abs score)
21018 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
21019 (* (abs score)
21020 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
21021 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
44e97401 21022 ;; XEmacs's floor can handle only the floating point
8a1cdce5
AC
21023 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
21024 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
21025 (string-to-number
21026 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
21027 (floor n))))
21028@end lisp
4009494e 21029
8a1cdce5
AC
21030@vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
21031@vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
21032@code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
21033@code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
4009494e 21034
8a1cdce5
AC
21035@enumerate
21036@item
21037Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
4009494e 21038
8a1cdce5
AC
21039@item
21040Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
4009494e 21041
8a1cdce5
AC
21042@item
21043Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21044score.
21045@end enumerate
4009494e 21046
8a1cdce5
AC
21047If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21048with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21049the new score, which should be an integer.
4009494e 21050
8a1cdce5
AC
21051Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21052four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
4009494e 21053
8a1cdce5
AC
21054@node Searching
21055@chapter Searching
21056@cindex searching
4009494e 21057
8a1cdce5
AC
21058FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
21059comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
21060as well.
4009494e 21061
8a1cdce5
AC
21062This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
21063articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
fe3c5669
PE
21064provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
21065to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
4009494e 21066
8a1cdce5
AC
21067@menu
21068* nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21069* nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21070@end menu
4009494e 21071
8a1cdce5
AC
21072@node nnir
21073@section nnir
21074@cindex nnir
4009494e 21075
8a1cdce5
AC
21076This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21077within gnus.
4009494e 21078
8a1cdce5 21079@menu
156e3f9c 21080* What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
8a1cdce5 21081* Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
156e3f9c 21082* Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
8a1cdce5 21083@end menu
4009494e 21084
156e3f9c
G
21085@node What is nnir?
21086@subsection What is nnir?
8a1cdce5 21087
156e3f9c 21088@code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
8a1cdce5
AC
21089through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21090@code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
156e3f9c 21091@dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
8a1cdce5
AC
21092interface.
21093
21094The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21095configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
fe3c5669 21096created and maintained outside of Gnus.
8a1cdce5 21097
156e3f9c 21098
8a1cdce5
AC
21099@node Basic Usage
21100@subsection Basic Usage
21101
21102In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21103current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21104for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21105the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21106showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21107using the usual commands.
21108
21109The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group, and
21110some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
21111deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
21112alternative: you can @emph{warp} to the original group for the article
21113on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
21114@code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
21115@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers to
21116@kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works its
21117magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you can
21118read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article marks,
21119whatever. Go nuts.
21120
21121You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21122No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21123even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21124will search all the groups under that heading.
21125
21126Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21127@code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21128groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21129certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21130@code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21131
21132One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21133features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21134to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21135groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
fe3c5669 21136special search features for each engine separately.
8a1cdce5 21137
156e3f9c 21138
8a1cdce5
AC
21139@node Setting up nnir
21140@subsection Setting up nnir
21141
21142To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21143to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21144@code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21145like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21146below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21147a backend.
21148
21149If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21150servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21151don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21152query language anyway.
4009494e 21153
8a1cdce5
AC
21154@menu
21155* Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21156* The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21157* The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21158* The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21159* The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21160* The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
21161* The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21162* Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21163@end menu
4009494e 21164
8a1cdce5
AC
21165@node Associating Engines
21166@subsubsection Associating Engines
4009494e 21167
4009494e 21168
8a1cdce5
AC
21169When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21170use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21171setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21172name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21173named @code{home} you can use
4009494e 21174
8a1cdce5 21175@lisp
156e3f9c 21176(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
fe3c5669 21177 '((nnml "home"
156e3f9c
G
21178 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21179 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
8a1cdce5 21180@end lisp
4009494e 21181
8a1cdce5
AC
21182Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21183with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21184engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21185can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21186an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21187variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21188@code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21189servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21190to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21191@code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21192could change this to
4009494e 21193
8a1cdce5
AC
21194@lisp
21195'((nnimap . namazu)
21196 (nntp . gmane))
21197@end lisp
4009494e 21198
8a1cdce5
AC
21199@node The imap Engine
21200@subsubsection The imap Engine
4009494e 21201
fe3c5669 21202The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
4009494e 21203
fe3c5669 21204Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
8a1cdce5
AC
21205The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21206features (inspired by the Google search input language):
01c52d31 21207
8a1cdce5 21208@table @samp
4009494e 21209
8a1cdce5
AC
21210@item Boolean query operators
21211AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
1df7defd 21212operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
8a1cdce5 21213operators must be written with all capital letters to be
f99f1641 21214recognized. Also preceding a term with a @minus{} sign is equivalent to NOT
8a1cdce5 21215term.
4009494e 21216
fe3c5669 21217@item Automatic AND queries
8a1cdce5
AC
21218If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21219expression intended to match all components.
4009494e 21220
8a1cdce5
AC
21221@item Phrase searches
21222If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21223literal string.
4009494e 21224
8a1cdce5 21225@end table
4009494e 21226
8a1cdce5
AC
21227By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21228to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21229the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21230Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21231``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21232example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21233the query to the Message-ID header.
4009494e 21234
8a1cdce5
AC
21235Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21236@acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21237RFC3501.
4009494e 21238
8a1cdce5
AC
21239If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21240customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21241@acronym{IMAP} queries by default
4009494e 21242
8a1cdce5
AC
21243@lisp
21244(setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21245@end lisp
4009494e 21246
8a1cdce5
AC
21247@node The gmane Engine
21248@subsubsection The gmane Engine
4009494e 21249
fe3c5669 21250The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
4009494e 21251
8a1cdce5 21252Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
4009494e 21253
8a1cdce5
AC
21254@table @samp
21255@item Boolean query operators
21256AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
1df7defd 21257used to control operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
8a1cdce5 21258Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
e1dbe924 21259recognized.
4009494e 21260
8a1cdce5 21261@item Required and excluded terms
f99f1641
PE
21262+ and @minus{} can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g., football
21263@minus{}american
4009494e 21264
fe3c5669 21265@item Unicode handling
8a1cdce5
AC
21266The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21267in any language.
4009494e 21268
fe3c5669 21269@item Stopwords
8a1cdce5 21270Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
1df7defd
PE
21271can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g., +the) or
21272enclosing the word in quotes (e.g., "the").
4009494e 21273
8a1cdce5 21274@end table
4009494e 21275
8a1cdce5
AC
21276The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21277prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21278name (or part of a name) to match.
4009494e 21279
8a1cdce5
AC
21280@node The swish++ Engine
21281@subsubsection The swish++ Engine
4009494e 21282
e4920bc9 21283FIXME: Say something more here.
4009494e 21284
8a1cdce5
AC
21285Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21286@uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
4009494e 21287
8151d490
AC
21288@table @code
21289
21290@item nnir-swish++-program
21291The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21292
21293@item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21294A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21295swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21296
21297@item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21298The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21299to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21300
21301@end table
21302
8a1cdce5
AC
21303@node The swish-e Engine
21304@subsubsection The swish-e Engine
4009494e 21305
e4920bc9 21306FIXME: Say something more here.
4009494e 21307
8a1cdce5
AC
21308Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21309@uref{http://swish-e.org}
4009494e 21310
8151d490
AC
21311@table @code
21312
21313@item nnir-swish-e-program
21314The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21315
21316@item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21317A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21318swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21319
21320@item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21321The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21322to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21323
21324@end table
21325
8a1cdce5
AC
21326@node The namazu Engine
21327@subsubsection The namazu Engine
4009494e 21328
8a1cdce5
AC
21329Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21330One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21331where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
fe3c5669 21332variable.
4009494e 21333
8a1cdce5
AC
21334To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21335also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21336returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with `/'
21337instead of `.').
4009494e 21338
8a1cdce5
AC
21339For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21340@samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21341following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21342"/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21343the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21344the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21345correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
4009494e 21346
8a1cdce5
AC
21347Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21348variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21349important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21350output format. Good switches to use include `--sort', `--ascending',
21351`--early' and `--late'. Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21352information on valid switches.
4009494e 21353
8a1cdce5
AC
21354Mail must first be indexed with the `mknmz' program. Read the documentation
21355for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an example:
4009494e 21356
8a1cdce5
AC
21357@cartouche
21358@example
21359 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
4009494e 21360
8a1cdce5
AC
21361 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use `^' or `$' anchors.
21362 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
4009494e 21363
8a1cdce5
AC
21364 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21365 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
4009494e 21366
8a1cdce5
AC
21367 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21368 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
4009494e 21369
8a1cdce5
AC
21370 # The max length of a word.
21371 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
4009494e 21372
8a1cdce5
AC
21373 # The max length of a field.
21374 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21375@end example
21376@end cartouche
4009494e 21377
8a1cdce5
AC
21378For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21379@samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21380the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21381the following command:
4009494e 21382
8a1cdce5
AC
21383@example
21384mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21385@end example
4009494e 21386
8a1cdce5
AC
21387For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21388this command periodically, say every four hours.
4009494e 21389
8a1cdce5
AC
21390@node The hyrex Engine
21391@subsubsection The hyrex Engine
156e3f9c 21392This engine is obsolete.
4009494e 21393
8a1cdce5 21394@node Customizations
fe3c5669 21395@subsubsection Customizations
4009494e 21396
8a1cdce5
AC
21397@table @code
21398
21399@item nnir-method-default-engines
f99f1641 21400Alist of pairs of server backends and search engines. The default associations
8a1cdce5
AC
21401are
21402@example
21403(nnimap . imap)
21404(nntp . gmane)
21405@end example
4009494e 21406
8a1cdce5
AC
21407@item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21408A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21409when searching all groups on a server.
4009494e 21410
8a1cdce5
AC
21411@item nnir-summary-line-format
21412The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21413All the items from `gnus-summary-line-format' are available, along with
21414three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
4009494e
GM
21415
21416@example
8a1cdce5
AC
21417%Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21418%G Article original full group name (string)
21419%g Article original short group name (string)
4009494e
GM
21420@end example
21421
8a1cdce5 21422If nil (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
4009494e 21423
8a1cdce5
AC
21424@item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21425If non-nil, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21426the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21427group as arguments and populates the `nntp-server-buffer' with the
21428retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21429indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21430should return @code{nil}
4009494e 21431
8a1cdce5
AC
21432If this variable is nil, or if the provided function returns nil for a
21433search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be called instead."
4009494e
GM
21434
21435
8a1cdce5 21436@end table
4009494e 21437
4009494e 21438
8a1cdce5
AC
21439@node nnmairix
21440@section nnmairix
58333467 21441
8a1cdce5
AC
21442@cindex mairix
21443@cindex nnmairix
21444This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21445@code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21446Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21447bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
4009494e 21448
8a1cdce5
AC
21449@menu
21450* About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21451* nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21452* What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21453* Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21454* Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21455* nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21456* Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21457* nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21458* nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21459@end menu
4009494e 21460
8a1cdce5 21461@c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
1df7defd 21462@c E.g., adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
8a1cdce5 21463@c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
4009494e 21464
8a1cdce5
AC
21465@node About mairix
21466@subsection About mairix
4009494e 21467
8a1cdce5
AC
21468Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21469mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
1df7defd 21470GPL@. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
8a1cdce5
AC
21471runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21472be found at
21473@uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
4009494e 21474
8a1cdce5
AC
21475Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21476swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21477has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21478can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21479thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21480necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21481done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21482therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21483up.
4009494e 21484
8a1cdce5
AC
21485For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21486@code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21487end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21488results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21489which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21490made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21491mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21492for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21493searches.
4009494e 21494
8a1cdce5
AC
21495@node nnmairix requirements
21496@subsection nnmairix requirements
4009494e 21497
8a1cdce5
AC
21498Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21499direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
1df7defd
PE
21500server (e.g., an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21501access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g., via ssh.
4009494e 21502
8a1cdce5
AC
21503Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21504ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21505one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21506@code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
4009494e 21507
8a1cdce5
AC
21508If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21509you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21510@code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21511files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21512really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21513the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
4009494e 21514
8a1cdce5
AC
21515@node What nnmairix does
21516@subsection What nnmairix does
4009494e 21517
8a1cdce5
AC
21518The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21519either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21520database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
1df7defd 21521several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g., to quickly
8a1cdce5
AC
21522search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21523display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21524mails are in different folders.
4009494e 21525
8a1cdce5
AC
21526Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21527to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21528containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
1df7defd
PE
21529even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID@. If you check for
21530new mail in these folders (e.g., by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
8a1cdce5
AC
21531automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21532
21533You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21534creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21535then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21536does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21537strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21538claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21539the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
1df7defd 21540its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g., if you
8a1cdce5
AC
21541use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21542about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21543group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
4009494e 21544
8a1cdce5
AC
21545@code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21546a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21547the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21548different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21549@code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21550binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21551@code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21552present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21553You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21554but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
1df7defd 21555groups alongside your other mail, you can also create, e.g., a new
8a1cdce5
AC
21556@code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21557make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21558(@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21559mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21560folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
4009494e 21561
8a1cdce5
AC
21562@node Setting up mairix
21563@subsection Setting up mairix
4009494e 21564
8a1cdce5 21565First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
4009494e 21566
8a1cdce5
AC
21567Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21568(at least) the following entries:
4009494e 21569
8a1cdce5
AC
21570@example
21571# Your Maildir/MH base folder
21572base=~/Maildir
21573@end example
4009494e 21574
8a1cdce5
AC
21575This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21576are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21577with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21578directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
4009494e 21579
8a1cdce5
AC
21580@example
21581maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21582mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21583mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21584@end example
21585
21586This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21587base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21588@code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21589directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21590section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21591
21592@example
21593omit=zz_mairix-*
21594@end example
4009494e 21595
8a1cdce5
AC
21596@vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21597This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21598search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21599variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
4009494e 21600
8a1cdce5
AC
21601@example
21602mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21603database= ... location of database file ...
21604@end example
4009494e 21605
8a1cdce5
AC
21606The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21607search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21608with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
4009494e 21609
8a1cdce5 21610To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
4009494e 21611
8a1cdce5
AC
21612@example
21613base=~/Maildir
21614maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21615mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21616mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21617mformat=maildir
21618omit=zz_mairix-*
21619database=~/.mairixdatabase
21620@end example
4009494e 21621
8a1cdce5
AC
21622In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21623folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21624colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21625because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21626@code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21627@code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21628to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21629notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21630to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21631dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21632old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21633The other lines should be obvious.
4009494e 21634
8a1cdce5
AC
21635See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21636especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21637than you are used to.
4009494e 21638
8a1cdce5
AC
21639Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21640Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21641the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
4009494e 21642
8a1cdce5
AC
21643@node Configuring nnmairix
21644@subsection Configuring nnmairix
21645
21646In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21647(@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21648necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21649server. You will have to specify the following:
4009494e
GM
21650
21651@itemize @bullet
21652
21653@item
8a1cdce5
AC
21654The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21655want.
4009494e
GM
21656
21657@item
8a1cdce5
AC
21658The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21659searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21660Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21661which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21662@code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21663mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
1df7defd 21664However, you can also create, e.g., a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
8a1cdce5
AC
21665server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21666(@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21667just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21668@code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21669(@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21670@acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21671@code{nnimap} server here.
4009494e 21672
8a1cdce5
AC
21673@item
21674@vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21675The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21676be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
1df7defd 21677SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g., on your
8a1cdce5
AC
21678@acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21679mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21680@code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
4009494e 21681
8a1cdce5
AC
21682@item
21683The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
1df7defd 21684where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e., all searches which
8a1cdce5
AC
21685are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21686like.
4009494e 21687
8a1cdce5
AC
21688@item
21689If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
1df7defd 21690asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e., with hidden maildir
8a1cdce5
AC
21691folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21692@samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21693server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
4009494e 21694
8a1cdce5 21695@end itemize
4009494e 21696
8a1cdce5
AC
21697@node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21698@subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
4009494e 21699
8a1cdce5 21700In group mode:
4009494e 21701
8a1cdce5 21702@table @kbd
4009494e 21703
8a1cdce5
AC
21704@item G b c
21705@kindex G b c (Group)
21706@findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21707Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21708(@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21709this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
4009494e 21710
8a1cdce5
AC
21711@item G b s
21712@kindex G b s (Group)
21713@findex nnmairix-search
21714Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21715results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21716displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
4009494e 21717
8a1cdce5
AC
21718@item G b m
21719@kindex G b m (Group)
21720@findex nnmairix-widget-search
21721Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21722comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21723group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
4009494e 21724
8a1cdce5
AC
21725@item G b i
21726@kindex G b i (Group)
21727@findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21728Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21729only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
4009494e 21730
8a1cdce5
AC
21731@item G b g
21732@kindex G b g (Group)
21733@findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21734Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21735(@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21736automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21737@kbd{M-g}.
4009494e 21738
8a1cdce5
AC
21739@item G b q
21740@kindex G b q (Group)
21741@findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21742Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21743(@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
4009494e 21744
8a1cdce5
AC
21745@item G b t
21746@kindex G b t (Group)
21747@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21748Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
1df7defd 21749i.e., if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
8a1cdce5 21750(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
4009494e 21751
8a1cdce5
AC
21752@item G b u
21753@kindex G b u (Group)
21754@findex nnmairix-update-database
21755@vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21756Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21757(@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21758and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21759@code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21760options).
4009494e 21761
8a1cdce5
AC
21762@item G b r
21763@kindex G b r (Group)
21764@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21765Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21766marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
4009494e 21767
8a1cdce5
AC
21768@item G b d
21769@kindex G b d (Group)
21770@findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21771Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21772(@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21773you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
4009494e 21774
8a1cdce5
AC
21775@item G b a
21776@kindex G b a (Group)
21777@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21778Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21779(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21780behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21781update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21782mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21783upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21784lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21785entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
4009494e 21786
8a1cdce5
AC
21787@item G b p
21788@kindex G b p (Group)
21789@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21790Toggle marks propagation for this group
21791(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21792marks}).
4009494e 21793
8a1cdce5
AC
21794@item G b o
21795@kindex G b o (Group)
21796@findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21797Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21798@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
4009494e
GM
21799
21800@end table
21801
8a1cdce5 21802In summary mode:
4009494e 21803
8a1cdce5 21804@table @kbd
4009494e 21805
8a1cdce5
AC
21806@item $ m
21807@kindex $ m (Summary)
21808@findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21809Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21810message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21811(@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
4009494e 21812
8a1cdce5
AC
21813@item $ g
21814@kindex $ g (Summary)
21815@findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21816Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21817message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21818(@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
4009494e 21819
8a1cdce5
AC
21820@item $ t
21821@kindex $ t (Summary)
21822@findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21823Searches thread for the current article
21824(@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21825shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21826current article and enabled threads.
4009494e 21827
8a1cdce5
AC
21828@item $ f
21829@kindex $ f (Summary)
21830@findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21831Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21832(@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21833calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
4009494e 21834
8a1cdce5
AC
21835@item $ o
21836@kindex $ o (Summary)
21837@findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21838(Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
1df7defd
PE
21839originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that,
21840e.g., replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
8a1cdce5
AC
21841parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21842function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21843article file name as a fallback method.
4009494e 21844
8a1cdce5
AC
21845@item $ u
21846@kindex $ u (Summary)
21847@findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21848Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21849(@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21850tips and tricks}).
4009494e 21851
8a1cdce5 21852@end table
4009494e 21853
8a1cdce5
AC
21854@node Propagating marks
21855@subsection Propagating marks
4009494e 21856
8a1cdce5
AC
21857First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21858propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21859the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
4009494e 21860
8a1cdce5 21861@uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
4009494e 21862
8a1cdce5
AC
21863You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21864is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21865marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21866fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21867be useful to you.
4009494e 21868
8a1cdce5
AC
21869With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21870alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21871example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21872into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21873@samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21874all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21875create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21876can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21877implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21878groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
4009494e 21879
8a1cdce5
AC
21880There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21881@samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21882``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21883search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21884enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21885marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21886mail group it will be still shown as unread.
4009494e 21887
8a1cdce5
AC
21888You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21889tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21890created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21891@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21892shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21893even more cumbersome.
4009494e 21894
8a1cdce5
AC
21895Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21896automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21897@emph{marks propagation} is about.
4009494e 21898
e9a452d9 21899Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
8a1cdce5
AC
21900certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21901@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21902p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21903search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21904temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21905this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
4009494e 21906
8a1cdce5
AC
21907With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21908group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21909you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21910magically be set for the original article, too.
4009494e 21911
8a1cdce5 21912A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
4009494e 21913
8a1cdce5
AC
21914@vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21915Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21916not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21917dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21918will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21919via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21920details).
4009494e 21921
8a1cdce5
AC
21922Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21923article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
21924the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21925fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21926marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21927set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21928the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
4009494e 21929
8a1cdce5
AC
21930@vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21931If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21932original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21933search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21934way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21935marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21936setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
4009494e 21937
1df7defd 21938Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e., if you
8a1cdce5
AC
21939tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21940article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21941reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21942immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21943@code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21944not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21945groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21946maildir as its file format.
4009494e 21947
8a1cdce5
AC
21948@vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
21949If you work with this setup, just set
21950@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
21951happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
21952problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
21953usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
21954groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
21955back end using @kbd{G b d}.
4009494e 21956
8a1cdce5
AC
21957@node nnmairix tips and tricks
21958@subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
21959
21960@itemize
21961@item
21962Checking Mail
4009494e 21963
8a1cdce5
AC
21964@findex nnmairix-update-groups
21965I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
21966have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
21967Levels}).
4009494e 21968
8a1cdce5 21969I use the following to check for mails:
4009494e 21970
8a1cdce5
AC
21971@lisp
21972(defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
21973 (interactive "P")
21974 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
21975 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
21976 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
21977 (gnus-group-list-groups))
4009494e 21978
8a1cdce5
AC
21979(define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
21980@end lisp
4009494e 21981
8a1cdce5
AC
21982Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
21983server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
21984details.
4009494e 21985
8a1cdce5
AC
21986@item
21987Example: search group for ticked articles
4009494e 21988
8a1cdce5
AC
21989For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
21990articles always stay unread:
4009494e 21991
1df7defd 21992Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g., @samp{important}), use
8a1cdce5 21993@samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
4009494e 21994
8a1cdce5
AC
21995Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
21996activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
4009494e 21997
8a1cdce5
AC
21998So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
21999group? There are two options: You may simply use
22000@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
22001tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
22002@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
22003comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
22004also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
1df7defd 22005e.g., by marking an article as read.
4009494e 22006
8a1cdce5
AC
22007When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
22008article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
22009mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
22010for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
22011snippet and the doc string for details.
4009494e 22012
8a1cdce5
AC
22013@item
22014Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
4009494e 22015
8a1cdce5
AC
22016As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
22017the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
22018see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
22019should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
22020usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
1df7defd 22021@code{nnml}, i.e., you will suddenly see groups of the form
8a1cdce5
AC
22022@samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
22023simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
22024auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
22025@code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
22026Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
22027for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
4009494e 22028
8a1cdce5
AC
22029@lisp
22030(setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
22031 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
22032@end lisp
4009494e 22033
8a1cdce5 22034@end itemize
4009494e 22035
8a1cdce5
AC
22036@node nnmairix caveats
22037@subsection nnmairix caveats
4009494e 22038
8a1cdce5
AC
22039@itemize
22040@item
22041You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
22042you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
22043@code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
22044put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
22045an example server definition:
4009494e 22046
8a1cdce5
AC
22047@lisp
22048(nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
22049@end lisp
4009494e 22050
ee7683eb 22051(The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
8a1cdce5
AC
22052@code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
22053have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
22054mairix.)
4009494e 22055
8a1cdce5
AC
22056@item
22057If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
22058@code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
c3c65d73
TZ
22059@code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
22060@emph{extra careful} if you use
22061@code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
22062into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
22063check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
4009494e 22064
8a1cdce5
AC
22065@item
22066Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22067groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
4009494e 22068
8a1cdce5
AC
22069@item
22070If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22071@code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
4009494e 22072
8a1cdce5
AC
22073@item
22074mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
4009494e 22075
8a1cdce5
AC
22076@item
22077@code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22078completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22079called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22080back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22081don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22082own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22083folders.
4009494e 22084
4009494e 22085@item
8a1cdce5
AC
22086All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22087(@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22088is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22089it is gone for good.
4009494e
GM
22090
22091@item
8a1cdce5
AC
22092@findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22093If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22094``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22095delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22096@code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22097save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22098@code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22099@code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22100@code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
4009494e
GM
22101
22102@item
8a1cdce5
AC
22103The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22104for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
4009494e 22105
8a1cdce5
AC
22106A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22107comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22108@samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22109file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22110update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22111mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22112while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22113@samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22114after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22115non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22116``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22117to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
4009494e 22118
8a1cdce5 22119@end itemize
4009494e
GM
22120
22121@iftex
22122@iflatex
22123@chapter Message
22124@include message.texi
22125@chapter Emacs MIME
22126@include emacs-mime.texi
22127@chapter Sieve
22128@include sieve.texi
3d439cd1
CY
22129@chapter EasyPG
22130@include epa.texi
01c52d31
MB
22131@chapter SASL
22132@include sasl.texi
4009494e
GM
22133@end iflatex
22134@end iftex
22135
22136@node Various
22137@chapter Various
22138
22139@menu
22140* Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22141* Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22142* Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22143* Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22144* Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22145* Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
4009494e
GM
22146* Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22147* Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
4009494e 22148* Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
4009494e
GM
22149* Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22150* Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22151* Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22152* Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22153* Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22154* Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22155* Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22156* Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
64763fe3 22157* The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
4009494e
GM
22158* Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22159* Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22160@end menu
22161
22162
22163@node Process/Prefix
22164@section Process/Prefix
22165@cindex process/prefix convention
22166
22167Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22168articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22169
22170This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22171command to be performed on.
22172
22173It goes like this:
22174
22175If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22176articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22177negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22178with the current one.
22179
22180@vindex transient-mark-mode
22181If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22182active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22183
22184If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22185process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22186the process mark.
22187
22188If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22189process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22190
22191Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22192are avoided.
22193
22194Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22195process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22196marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22197@kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22198
22199@vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22200One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22201instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22202Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22203goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22204will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22205summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22206@code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22207
22208Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22209that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22210convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22211command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22212expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22213
22214
22215@node Interactive
22216@section Interactive
22217@cindex interaction
22218
22219@table @code
22220
22221@item gnus-novice-user
22222@vindex gnus-novice-user
22223If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22224World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22225really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22226to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22227default.
22228
22229@item gnus-expert-user
22230@vindex gnus-expert-user
22231If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
5e7d4a75
KY
22232questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22233no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22234without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22235articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22236confirmation.
4009494e
GM
22237
22238@item gnus-interactive-catchup
22239@vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22240Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22241is @code{t} by default.
22242
22243@item gnus-interactive-exit
22244@vindex gnus-interactive-exit
e21bac42
G
22245If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22246@code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22247querying. The default value is @code{t}.
4009494e
GM
22248@end table
22249
22250
22251@node Symbolic Prefixes
22252@section Symbolic Prefixes
22253@cindex symbolic prefixes
22254
22255Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22256instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22257@kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22258rule of 900 to the current article.
22259
22260This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22261additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22262``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22263doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22264for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22265file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22266same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22267
22268@kindex M-i (Summary)
22269@findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22270I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22271prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22272character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22273prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22274command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22275``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22276@code{b}''. You get the drift.
22277
22278Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22279hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22280functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22281
22282If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22283Interactive}.
22284
22285
22286@node Formatting Variables
22287@section Formatting Variables
22288@cindex formatting variables
22289
22290Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22291things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22292@code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22293output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22294Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22295be annoyed by.
22296
22297Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22298%(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22299lots of percentages everywhere.
22300
22301@menu
22302* Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22303* Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22304* Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22305* User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22306* Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22307* Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22308* Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22309* Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22310@end menu
22311
22312Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22313@code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22314@code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22315@code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22316@code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22317@code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22318@code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22319@code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22320
22321All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22322case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22323
22324@kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22325@findex gnus-update-format
22326Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22327specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22328update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22329examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22330
22331
22332
22333@node Formatting Basics
22334@subsection Formatting Basics
22335
22336Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22337buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22338spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22339
22340As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22341modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22342@dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22343@samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22344padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22345the right instead.
22346
22347You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22348particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22349means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22350less than 4 characters wide.
22351
22352Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22353@samp{%&user-date;}.
22354
22355
22356@node Mode Line Formatting
22357@subsection Mode Line Formatting
22358
22359Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22360@code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22361buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22362with the following two differences:
22363
22364@enumerate
22365
22366@item
22367There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22368
22369@item
22370The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22371Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22372@samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22373so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22374display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22375mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22376@code{mode-line-format} variable.
22377
22378@end enumerate
22379
22380
22381@node Advanced Formatting
22382@subsection Advanced Formatting
22383
22384It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22385Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22386be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22387look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22388
22389These are the valid modifiers:
22390
22391@table @code
22392@item pad
22393@itemx pad-left
22394Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22395length.
22396
22397@item pad-right
22398Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22399length.
22400
22401@item max
22402@itemx max-left
22403Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22404
22405@item max-right
22406Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22407length.
22408
22409@item cut
22410@itemx cut-left
22411Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22412
22413@item cut-right
22414Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22415
22416@item ignore
22417Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22418
22419@item form
22420Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22421used.
22422
22423Here's an example:
22424
22425@lisp
22426"~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22427@end lisp
22428
22429@end table
22430
22431Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22432will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22433This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22434the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22435@samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22436maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22437than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22438
22439Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22440last operation, padding.
22441
4009494e
GM
22442
22443@node User-Defined Specs
22444@subsection User-Defined Specs
22445
22446All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22447The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22448will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22449@samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22450a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22451it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22452be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22453specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22454should protect against that.
22455
22456Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22457Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22458
22459You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22460much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22461@samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22462given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22463inserted.
22464
22465
22466@node Formatting Fonts
22467@subsection Formatting Fonts
22468
9b3ebcb6
MB
22469@cindex %(, %)
22470@vindex gnus-mouse-face
4009494e
GM
22471There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22472variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22473the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22474highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22475over it.
22476
9b3ebcb6
MB
22477@cindex %@{, %@}
22478@vindex gnus-face-0
4009494e
GM
22479Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22480normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22481default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22482and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22483@code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22484@samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22485
9b3ebcb6 22486@cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
89b163db 22487@c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
9b3ebcb6 22488@vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
4009494e
GM
22489Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22490special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22491@code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22492@code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22493variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22494return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22495set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22496refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
47301027 22497(in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
4009494e
GM
22498XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22499guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22500paragraph.)
22501
22502Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22503
22504@lisp
22505;; @r{Create three face types.}
22506(setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22507(setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22508
22509;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22510;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22511;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22512(copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22513;; @r{Set the color.}
22514(set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22515(setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22516
22517;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22518(setq gnus-group-line-format
22519 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22520@end lisp
22521
22522I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22523and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22524
22525Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22526mode-line variables.
22527
22528@node Positioning Point
22529@subsection Positioning Point
22530
22531Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22532buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22533line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22534
22535You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22536
22537@findex gnus-goto-colon
22538You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22539function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22540
22541But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22542to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22543put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22544place point there.
22545
22546
22547@node Tabulation
22548@subsection Tabulation
22549
22550You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22551strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22552can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22553about lining up the following text afterwards.
22554
22555To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22556different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22557
22558@samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
2255950. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22560This is the soft tabulator.
22561
22562@samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
2256350. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
2256450 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22565
22566
22567@node Wide Characters
22568@subsection Wide Characters
22569
22570Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22571Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22572characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22573
22574The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22575characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22576these countries, that's not true.
22577
22578@vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22579To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22580@code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22581prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22582for Emacs.
22583
22584
22585@node Window Layout
22586@section Window Layout
22587@cindex window layout
22588
22589No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22590
22591@vindex gnus-use-full-window
22592If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22593other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22594@code{t} by default.
22595
22596Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22597glitches. Use at your own peril.
22598
22599@vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22600@code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22601buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22602
22603@lisp
71e691a5 22604((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
4009494e
GM
22605 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22606 (article 1.0))))
22607@end lisp
22608
22609This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22610other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22611configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22612possible names is listed below.
22613
22614The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
f99f1641 22615should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example:
4009494e
GM
22616
22617@lisp
22618(article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22619 (article 1.0)))
22620@end lisp
22621
22622This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22623half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22624you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22625reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22626@code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22627rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22628whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22629size spec per split.
22630
22631Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22632@code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
1df7defd 22633split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e., is the third or
4009494e
GM
22634fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22635present) gets focus.
22636
22637Here's a more complicated example:
22638
22639@lisp
22640(article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22641 (summary 0.25 point)
4009494e
GM
22642 (article 1.0)))
22643@end lisp
22644
22645If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22646then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22647occupy, not a percentage.
22648
22649If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22650precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22651split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
71e691a5 22652be used as a split.
4009494e
GM
22653
22654Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22655
22656@lisp
22657(article (horizontal 1.0
22658 (vertical 0.5
71e691a5 22659 (group 1.0))
4009494e
GM
22660 (vertical 1.0
22661 (summary 0.25 point)
4009494e
GM
22662 (article 1.0))))
22663@end lisp
22664
22665Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22666@code{horizontal} thingie?
22667
22668If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22669split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22670Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22671fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22672the screen is to be given to this strip.
22673
22674For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22675The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22676lines from the splits.
22677
22678To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22679may look like:
22680
22681@example
22682@group
22683split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22684frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22685horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22686vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22687buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22688size = number | frame-params
22689buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22690@end group
22691@end example
22692
22693The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22694top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22695return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22696may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22697
22698@vindex gnus-window-min-width
22699@vindex gnus-window-min-height
22700@cindex window height
22701@cindex window width
22702Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22703than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22704windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22705characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22706splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22707you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22708
22709If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22710@code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22711Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22712windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22713
22714@findex gnus-configure-frame
22715If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22716@code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22717that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22718nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22719three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22720@code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22721look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22722Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22723@code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22724configuration list.
22725
22726@lisp
22727(gnus-configure-frame
22728 '(horizontal 1.0
22729 (vertical 10
22730 (group 1.0)
22731 (article 0.3 point))
22732 (vertical 1.0
22733 (article 1.0)
22734 (horizontal 4
22735 (group 1.0)
22736 (article 10)))))
22737@end lisp
22738
22739You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22740@code{frame} split:
22741
22742@lisp
22743(gnus-configure-frame
22744 '(frame 1.0
22745 (vertical 1.0
22746 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22747 (article 1.0))
22748 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22749 (user-position . t)
22750 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22751 (picon 1.0))))
22752
22753@end lisp
22754
22755This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22756configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22757frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22758instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22759should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22760@xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22761Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22762accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22763is such a plist.
22764The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22765be found in its default value.
22766
22767Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22768@code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22769it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22770might be used:
22771
22772@lisp
22773(message (horizontal 1.0
22774 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22775 (vertical 0.24
22776 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22777 '(summary 0.5))
22778 (group 1.0))))
22779@end lisp
22780
22781One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22782for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22783accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22784
22785@lisp
22786(message
22787 (frame 1.0
22788 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22789 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22790 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22791 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22792 (name . "Message"))
22793 (message 1.0 point))))
22794@end lisp
22795
22796@findex gnus-add-configuration
22797Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22798complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22799of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22800you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22801
22802@lisp
22803(gnus-add-configuration
22804 '(article (vertical 1.0
22805 (group 4)
22806 (summary .25 point)
22807 (article 1.0))))
22808@end lisp
22809
22810You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22811@file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22812Gnus has been loaded.
22813
22814@vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22815If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22816won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22817``right'' window configuration, you can set
22818@code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22819
22820If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22821window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22822to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22823windows resized.
22824
06b840e0
LI
22825@subsection Window Configuration Names
22826
22827Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22828and when they're used:
22829
1e3b6001 22830@table @code
06b840e0
LI
22831@item group
22832The group buffer.
22833
22834@item summary
22835Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22836
22837@item article
22838Selecting an article.
22839
22840@item server
22841The server buffer.
22842
22843@item browse
22844Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22845
22846@item message
22847Composing a (new) message.
22848
22849@item only-article
22850Showing only the article buffer.
22851
22852@item edit-article
22853Editing an article.
22854
22855@item edit-form
22856Editing group parameters and the like.
22857
22858@item edit-score
22859Editing a server definition.
22860
22861@item post
22862Composing a news message.
22863
22864@item reply
22865Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22866
22867@item forward
22868Forwarding a message.
22869
22870@item reply-yank
22871Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22872
22873@item mail-bound
22874Bouncing a message.
22875
22876@item pipe
22877Sending an article to an external process.
22878
22879@item bug
22880Sending a bug report.
22881
22882@item score-trace
22883Displaying the score trace.
22884
22885@item score-words
22886Displaying the score words.
22887
22888@item split-trace
22889Displaying the split trace.
22890
22891@item compose-bounce
22892Composing a bounce message.
22893
22894@item mml-preview
22895Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22896
1e3b6001 22897@end table
06b840e0
LI
22898
22899
4009494e
GM
22900@subsection Example Window Configurations
22901
22902@itemize @bullet
22903@item
22904Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22905between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22906
22907@ifinfo
22908@example
22909+---+---------+
22910| G | Summary |
22911| r +---------+
22912| o | |
22913| u | Article |
22914| p | |
22915+---+---------+
22916@end example
22917@end ifinfo
22918
22919@lisp
22920(gnus-add-configuration
22921 '(article
22922 (horizontal 1.0
22923 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22924 (vertical 1.0
22925 (summary 0.16 point)
22926 (article 1.0)))))
22927
22928(gnus-add-configuration
22929 '(summary
22930 (horizontal 1.0
22931 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22932 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22933@end lisp
22934
22935@end itemize
22936
22937
22938@node Faces and Fonts
22939@section Faces and Fonts
22940@cindex faces
22941@cindex fonts
22942@cindex colors
22943
22944Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22945it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22946the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22947interface.
22948
22949
4009494e
GM
22950@node Mode Lines
22951@section Mode Lines
22952@cindex mode lines
22953
22954@vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22955@code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22956lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22957@code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22958@code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22959Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22960pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22961quicker.
22962
22963@cindex display-time
22964
22965@vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22966By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22967lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
1df7defd 22968to display (e.g., the subject of the article) is often longer than the
4009494e
GM
22969mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22970@code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22971elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
1df7defd 22972additional elements on the mode line (e.g., a clock), you should modify
4009494e
GM
22973this variable:
22974
22975@c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
22976@lisp
22977(add-hook 'display-time-hook
22978 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
22979 (+ 21
22980 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
22981 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
22982 (length display-time-string)))))
22983@end lisp
22984
22985If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
22986strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
22987that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
22988complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
22989configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
22990
22991
22992@node Highlighting and Menus
22993@section Highlighting and Menus
22994@cindex visual
22995@cindex highlighting
22996@cindex menus
22997
22998@vindex gnus-visual
22999The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
23000aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
23001colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
23002file.
23003
23004This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
23005following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
23006
23007@table @code
23008@item group-highlight
23009Do highlights in the group buffer.
23010@item summary-highlight
23011Do highlights in the summary buffer.
23012@item article-highlight
23013Do highlights in the article buffer.
23014@item highlight
23015Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
23016@item group-menu
23017Create menus in the group buffer.
23018@item summary-menu
23019Create menus in the summary buffers.
23020@item article-menu
23021Create menus in the article buffer.
23022@item browse-menu
23023Create menus in the browse buffer.
23024@item server-menu
23025Create menus in the server buffer.
23026@item score-menu
23027Create menus in the score buffers.
23028@item menu
23029Create menus in all buffers.
23030@end table
23031
23032So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
23033buffers, you could say something like:
23034
23035@lisp
23036(setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
23037@end lisp
23038
23039If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
23040
23041@lisp
23042(setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
23043@end lisp
23044
23045If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
23046in all Gnus buffers.
23047
23048Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
23049
23050@table @code
23051@item gnus-mouse-face
23052@vindex gnus-mouse-face
23053This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
23054mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
23055
23056@end table
23057
23058There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
23059
23060@table @code
23061
23062@item gnus-article-menu-hook
23063@vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
23064Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
23065
23066@item gnus-group-menu-hook
23067@vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23068Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23069
23070@item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23071@vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23072Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23073
23074@item gnus-server-menu-hook
23075@vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23076Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23077
23078@item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23079@vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23080Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23081
23082@item gnus-score-menu-hook
23083@vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23084Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23085
23086@end table
23087
23088
4009494e
GM
23089@node Daemons
23090@section Daemons
23091@cindex demons
23092@cindex daemons
23093
23094Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23095of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23096present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23097while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23098when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23099
23100Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23101@dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23102@var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23103
23104Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23105been idle for thirty minutes:
23106
23107@lisp
23108(gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23109@end lisp
23110
23111Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23112Emacs is idle:
23113
23114@lisp
23115(gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23116@end lisp
23117
23118This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23119in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23120@code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23121
23122If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23123@var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23124the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23125function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23126
23127If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23128be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23129@var{idle} minutes.
23130
23131If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23132will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23133minutes.
23134
23135And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23136the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23137time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23138
23139@vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23140(When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23141seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23142all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23143
23144So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23145your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23146
23147@findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23148@lisp
23149(gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23150@end lisp
23151
4009494e
GM
23152@findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23153@findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23154@findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23155@findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23156Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
8ccbef23 23157@code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
4009494e
GM
23158@code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23159@code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23160@code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23161@file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23162
23163@findex gnus-demon-init
23164@findex gnus-demon-cancel
23165@vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23166If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23167run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23168daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23169
23170Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23171functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23172is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23173behave.
23174
23175
4009494e
GM
23176@node Undo
23177@section Undo
23178@cindex undo
23179
23180It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23181Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23182In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23183
23184The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23185Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23186Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23187disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23188removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23189Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23190@code{undo} function.
23191
23192Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23193does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23194takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23195the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23196However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23197a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23198yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23199That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23200added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23201never be totally undoable.
23202
23203@findex gnus-undo-mode
23204@vindex gnus-use-undo
23205@findex gnus-undo
23206The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23207is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23208default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23209command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23210command.
23211
23212
23213@node Predicate Specifiers
23214@section Predicate Specifiers
23215@cindex predicate specifiers
23216
23217Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23218form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23219to type all that much.
23220
23221These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23222
23223Here's an example:
23224
23225@lisp
23226(or gnus-article-unseen-p
23227 gnus-article-unread-p)
23228@end lisp
23229
23230The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23231functions all take one parameter.
23232
23233@findex gnus-make-predicate
23234Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23235to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23236function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23237specifier.
23238
23239
23240@node Moderation
23241@section Moderation
23242@cindex moderation
23243
23244If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23245It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23246@samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23247get a copy.
23248
23249The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23250buffers. Put
23251
23252@lisp
23253(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23254@end lisp
23255
23256in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23257
23258If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23259supposed to work:
23260
23261@enumerate
23262@item
23263You split your incoming mail by matching on
23264@samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23265articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23266
23267@item
23268You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23269(edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23270
23271@item
23272If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23273articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23274@kbd{c} command.
23275@end enumerate
23276
23277To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23278
23279@lisp
23280(setq gnus-moderated-list
23281 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23282@end lisp
23283
23284
23285@node Fetching a Group
23286@section Fetching a Group
23287@cindex fetching a group
23288
23289@findex gnus-fetch-group
23290It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23291group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23292perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23293command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23294It takes the group name as a parameter.
23295
23296
23297@node Image Enhancements
23298@section Image Enhancements
23299
23300XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23301support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23302stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23303
23304@menu
23305* X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23306* Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23307* Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23308* Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
61b1af82 23309* Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
4009494e
GM
23310* XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23311@end menu
23312
23313
23314@node X-Face
23315@subsection X-Face
23316@cindex x-face
23317
23318@code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23319depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23320It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23321readers.
23322
23323@cindex x-face
23324@findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23325@vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23326@vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23327@iftex
23328@iflatex
23329\include{xface}
23330@end iflatex
23331@end iftex
23332@c @anchor{X-Face}
23333
23334Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
4b70e299 23335@samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
4009494e
GM
23336have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23337has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23338@code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23339will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23340from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23341faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23342default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23343@code{display} program.
23344
23345On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23346ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23347with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23348On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23349from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23350@code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23351@c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23352@c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23353
23354The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23355are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23356string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23357function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23358If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23359@code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23360
23361(Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23362@code{xface}).
23363
23364@noindent
23365Face and variable:
23366
23367@table @code
23368@item gnus-x-face
23369@vindex gnus-x-face
23370Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23371foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23372default colors are black and white.
01c52d31
MB
23373
23374@item gnus-face-properties-alist
23375@vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23376Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23377X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23378(png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23379XEmacs. Here are examples:
23380
23381@lisp
23382;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23383(setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23384 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23385 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23386
23387;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23388(setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23389 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23390 (png . (:relief -2))))
23391@end lisp
23392
23393@pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23394Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23395Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23396for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23397on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23398@samp{libcompface} library.
4009494e
GM
23399@end table
23400
23401If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23402@code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23403provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23404insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23405above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23406(depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23407
23408@findex gnus-random-x-face
23409@vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23410@vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23411@code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23412@code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23413converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23414@code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23415@samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23416header data as a string.
23417
23418@findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23419@code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23420@code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23421randomly generated data.
23422
23423@findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23424@vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23425@code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23426converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23427@code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23428
23429Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23430like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23431
23432@lisp
23433(setq message-required-news-headers
23434 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23435 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23436@end lisp
23437
23438Using the last function would be something like this:
23439
23440@lisp
23441(setq message-required-news-headers
23442 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23443 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23444 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23445 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23446@end lisp
23447
23448
23449@node Face
23450@subsection Face
23451@cindex face
23452
23453@c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23454
23455@code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23456ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23457represent the author of the message.
23458
23459@cindex face
23460@findex gnus-article-display-face
23461The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23462See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23463specifications.
23464
01c52d31
MB
23465The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23466displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23467
85d870a9 23468Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
4009494e
GM
23469PNG images.
23470@c Maybe add this:
23471@c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23472@c (featurep 'png)
23473@c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23474
23475Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23476easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23477
23478@findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23479@code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23480726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23481
23482@findex gnus-face-from-file
23483@vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23484@code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23485converts the file to Face format by using the
23486@code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23487
23488Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23489following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23490
23491@lisp
23492(setq message-required-news-headers
23493 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23494 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23495 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23496@end lisp
23497
23498
23499@node Smileys
23500@subsection Smileys
23501@cindex smileys
23502
23503@iftex
23504@iflatex
23505\gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23506\input{smiley}
23507@end iflatex
23508@end iftex
23509
23510@dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23511currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23512
23513In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23514@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23515
23516@lisp
23517(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23518@end lisp
23519
23520Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23521the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23522faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23523text and maps that to file names.
23524
23525@vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23526The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23527variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23528the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23529the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23530displayed.
23531
9b3ebcb6 23532The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
4009494e
GM
23533
23534@table @code
23535
9b3ebcb6
MB
23536@item smiley-style
23537@vindex smiley-style
23538Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23539@code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23540(more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23541images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23542face.
23543
4009494e
GM
23544@item smiley-data-directory
23545@vindex smiley-data-directory
9b3ebcb6
MB
23546Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23547variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
4009494e
GM
23548
23549@item gnus-smiley-file-types
23550@vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23551List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23552
23553@end table
23554
23555
23556@node Picons
23557@subsection Picons
23558
23559@iftex
23560@iflatex
23561\include{picons}
23562@end iflatex
23563@end iftex
23564
23565So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23566good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23567over your shoulder as you read news.
23568
23569What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23570
23571@iftex
23572@iflatex
23573\margindex{}
23574@end iflatex
23575@end iftex
23576
23577@quotation
23578@dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23579constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23580organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23581e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23582databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23583in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23584@code{GIF} formats.
23585@end quotation
23586
23587@vindex gnus-picon-databases
23588For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23589point your Web browser at
23590@uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23591
23592If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23593picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23594
23595To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23596@code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23597Picons databases.
23598
01c52d31
MB
23599@vindex gnus-picon-style
23600The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23601If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23602@code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23603
89b163db
G
23604@vindex gnus-picon-properties
23605The value of the variable @code{gnus-picon-properties} is a list of
23606properties applied to picons.
23607
4009494e
GM
23608The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23609
23610@table @code
23611
23612@item gnus-picon-databases
23613@vindex gnus-picon-databases
23614The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23615containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23616subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23617"/usr/local/faces")}.
23618
23619@item gnus-picon-news-directories
23620@vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23621List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23622newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23623
23624@item gnus-picon-user-directories
23625@vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23626List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23627faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23628
23629@item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23630@vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23631List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23632domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23633want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23634
23635@item gnus-picon-file-types
23636@vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23637Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23638@code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23639
4478e074
G
23640@item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23641@vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23642If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23643things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23644interesting.
23645
4009494e
GM
23646@end table
23647
61b1af82
G
23648@node Gravatars
23649@subsection Gravatars
23650
23651@iftex
23652@iflatex
23653\include{gravatars}
23654@end iflatex
23655@end iftex
23656
23657A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23658
23659You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23660
23661The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23662
23663@table @code
23664
23665@item gnus-gravatar-size
23666@vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23667The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23668number for the size is enough.
23669
229b59da
G
23670@item gnus-gravatar-properties
23671@vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23672List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
61b1af82 23673
fcf2d385
KY
23674@item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23675@vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23676Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23677should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23678@code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23679
61b1af82
G
23680@end table
23681
23682If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23683@lisp
23684(setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23685@end lisp
23686
23687If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23688
23689@lisp
23690(setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23691@end lisp
23692
4009494e
GM
23693
23694@node XVarious
23695@subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23696
23697@table @code
23698@item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23699@vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23700This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23701auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23702unusual directory structure.
23703
23704@item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23705@vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23706A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23707default.
23708
23709@end table
23710
23711@subsubsection Toolbar
23712
23713@table @code
23714
23715@item gnus-use-toolbar
23716@vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23717This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23718@code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23719be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23720@code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23721toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23722names show. The default is @code{default}.
23723
23724@item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23725@vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23726Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23727The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23728the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23729The default is that of the default toolbar.
23730
23731@item gnus-group-toolbar
23732@vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23733The toolbar in the group buffer.
23734
23735@item gnus-summary-toolbar
23736@vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23737The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23738
23739@item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23740@vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23741The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23742
23743@end table
23744
23745@iftex
23746@iflatex
23747\margindex{}
23748@end iflatex
23749@end iftex
23750
23751
23752@node Fuzzy Matching
23753@section Fuzzy Matching
23754@cindex fuzzy matching
23755
23756Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23757things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23758
23759As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23760It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23761means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23762
23763Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23764@samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23765out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23766adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23767manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23768
23769
23770@node Thwarting Email Spam
23771@section Thwarting Email Spam
23772@cindex email spam
23773@cindex spam
23774@cindex UCE
23775@cindex unsolicited commercial email
23776
23777In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23778and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23779foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23780people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23781lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23782people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23783well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23784perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23785in the end.
23786
23787The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23788false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23789have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23790mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23791(``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23792and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23793
23794This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23795
23796@menu
23797* The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23798* Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23799* SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23800* Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23801@end menu
23802
23803@node The problem of spam
23804@subsection The problem of spam
23805@cindex email spam
23806@cindex spam filtering approaches
23807@cindex filtering approaches, spam
23808@cindex UCE
23809@cindex unsolicited commercial email
23810
23811First, some background on spam.
23812
23813If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23814termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23815exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23816so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23817make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23818common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23819further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23820but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23821@emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23822
23823Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23824dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23825example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23826unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23827their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23828of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23829be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23830through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23831requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23832and processing.
23833
23834The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23835server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23836messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23837@samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23838discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23839lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23840from Bulgarian IPs.
23841
23842This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23843risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
65e7ca35 23844etc.)@: or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.)@: from contacting
4009494e
GM
23845you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23846
23847In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23848been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23849words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23850cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23851
23852Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23853processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23854@var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23855Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23856@var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23857database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23858of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23859of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23860spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23861
23862Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23863a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23864fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23865spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23866well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23867sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23868down for some time because of the incident.
23869
23870The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23871based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23872the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23873words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23874analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23875classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23876run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23877to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23878server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23879user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23880the server that it has misclassified mail.
23881
23882Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23883magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23884Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23885because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23886are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23887idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23888a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23889spam plague.
23890
23891@node Anti-Spam Basics
23892@subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23893@cindex email spam
23894@cindex spam
23895@cindex UCE
23896@cindex unsolicited commercial email
23897
23898One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23899@samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23900
23901First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23902put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23903chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23904@samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23905sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23906part of the mail address.)
23907
23908@lisp
23909(setq message-default-news-headers
23910 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23911@end lisp
23912
23913Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23914(@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23915
23916@lisp
23917(...
23918 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23919 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23920 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23921 "spam"))
23922 ...)
23923@end lisp
23924
23925This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23926@code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23927header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23928(This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23929
23930In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23931and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23932header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23933thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23934put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23935your fancy split rule in this way:
23936
23937@lisp
23938(
23939 ...
23940 (to "larsi" "misc")
23941 "spam")
23942@end lisp
23943
23944In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23945group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23946check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23947citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23948each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23949
23950This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23951just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23952spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23953to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23954
23955Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23956
23957
23958@node SpamAssassin
23959@subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23960@cindex SpamAssassin
23961@cindex Vipul's Razor
23962@cindex DCC
23963
23964The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23965avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23966that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23967easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23968fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23969though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23970easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23971
23972Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
23973which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
23974the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
23975recipes.
23976
23977If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
23978need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
23979@code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
23980Specifiers}) follow.
23981
23982@lisp
23983(setq mail-sources
23984 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
23985 (pop :user "jrl"
23986 :server "pophost"
23987 :postscript
23988 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
23989@end lisp
23990
23991Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
1df7defd 23992the mail contain, e.g., a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
4009494e
GM
23993filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
23994
23995@lisp
23996(setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
23997 ...))
23998@end lisp
23999
24000Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
24001
24002@lisp
24003(setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
24004 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
24005 ...))
24006@end lisp
24007
24008Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
24009programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
24010might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
24011call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
24012
24013@lisp
24014(setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
24015 ...))
24016(defun kevin-spamassassin ()
24017 (save-excursion
24018 (save-restriction
24019 (widen)
24020 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
24021 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
24022 "spam"))))
24023@end lisp
24024
01c52d31 24025Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
4009494e
GM
24026downloaded by default. You need to set
24027@code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
229b59da 24028(@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
4009494e
GM
24029
24030That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
24031might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
24032spam. And here is the nifty function:
24033
24034@lisp
d62672f3 24035(defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
4009494e
GM
24036 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
24037 (interactive)
d62672f3 24038 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
4009494e
GM
24039 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
24040@end lisp
24041
24042@node Hashcash
24043@subsection Hashcash
24044@cindex hashcash
24045
24046A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
01c52d31
MB
24047costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
24048the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
24049using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
24050but it may be useful in smaller communities.
4009494e
GM
24051
24052While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
24053work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
24054new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
24055will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
24056to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
24057instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
24058scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
24059The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
24060often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
24061one of them separately.
24062
24063@cindex X-Hashcash
24064The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
24065compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
01c52d31
MB
24066resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24067For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24068need to install to use this feature, see
24069@uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24070at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
4009494e 24071
01c52d31
MB
24072If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24073customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24074Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
4009494e
GM
24075
24076@lisp
01c52d31 24077(setq message-generate-hashcash t)
4009494e
GM
24078@end lisp
24079
4009494e
GM
24080You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24081
24082@table @code
24083
24084@item hashcash-default-payment
24085@vindex hashcash-default-payment
24086This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
01c52d31
MB
24087should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24088include 17 to 29.
4009494e
GM
24089
24090@item hashcash-payment-alist
24091@vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24092Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24093default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24094@var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24095or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24096that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24097@var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24098(normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24099
01c52d31
MB
24100@item hashcash-path
24101@vindex hashcash-path
24102Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24103be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24104(usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24105you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24106when you generate hashcash payments.
4009494e
GM
24107
24108@end table
24109
01c52d31
MB
24110Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24111hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24112in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24113@code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24114package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24115cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24116Hashcash Payments}).
4009494e
GM
24117
24118@node Spam Package
24119@section Spam Package
24120@cindex spam filtering
24121@cindex spam
24122
24123The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24124detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24125messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24126name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24127
24128@menu
24129* Spam Package Introduction::
24130* Filtering Incoming Mail::
24131* Detecting Spam in Groups::
24132* Spam and Ham Processors::
24133* Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24134* Spam Back Ends::
24135* Extending the Spam package::
24136* Spam Statistics Package::
24137@end menu
24138
24139@node Spam Package Introduction
24140@subsection Spam Package Introduction
24141@cindex spam filtering
24142@cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24143@cindex spam
24144
24145You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24146Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24147
01c52d31
MB
24148Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24149events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24150
4009494e
GM
24151@cindex spam-initialize
24152@vindex spam-use-stat
24153To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24154@code{spam-initialize}:
24155
24156@example
24157(spam-initialize)
24158@end example
24159
24160This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24161to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24162package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24163which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24164Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24165
24166There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24167of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24168
24169Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24170incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24171
24172The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24173suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24174new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24175incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24176``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24177
24178The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24179no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24180splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24181the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24182Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24183Groups}.
24184
24185@cindex spam back ends
24186In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24187to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24188ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24189``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24190forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24191
24192In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24193always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24194
24195The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24196groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24197the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24198using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24199Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24200spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24201into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24202
24203Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24204second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24205point, the Spam package does several things:
24206
24207First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24208according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24209and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24210processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24211spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24212the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24213to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24214group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24215Ham Processors}.
24216
24217If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24218yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24219group:
24220
24221@table @kbd
f7aa248a
G
24222@item $
24223@itemx M-d
4009494e
GM
24224@itemx M s x
24225@itemx S x
f7aa248a
G
24226@kindex $ (Summary)
24227@kindex M-d (Summary)
24228@kindex S x (Summary)
24229@kindex M s x (Summary)
4009494e
GM
24230@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24231@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24232Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24233(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24234@end table
24235
24236@noindent
24237Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24238as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24239
24240Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24241ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24242further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24243to be processed as ham by setting
24244@code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24245@code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24246
24247@vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24248@vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24249The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24250to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24251groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24252variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24253@code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24254group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24255or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24256variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24257If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24258as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24259
24260If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24261you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24262want each article to be processed only once, load the
24263@code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24264@code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24265Configuration Examples}.
24266
24267Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24268However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24269@code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24270the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24271
24272The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24273expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24274
24275If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24276as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
2427750 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24278
24279@node Filtering Incoming Mail
24280@subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24281@cindex spam filtering
24282@cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24283@cindex spam
24284
24285To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24286fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24287defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24288split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24289@code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24290
24291@example
24292(: spam-split)
24293@end example
24294
24295@vindex spam-split-group
24296@noindent
24297The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24298chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24299spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24300but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24301sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24302name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24303the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24304@samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24305@samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24306
24307@code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24308
24309@vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24310Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24311@code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
8ccbef23
G
24312you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24313@code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24314the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24315the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24316retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24317because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24318appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
229b59da 24319IMAP Splitting}.
4009494e
GM
24320
24321You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24322to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24323Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24324you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24325use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24326@code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24327ends, and the following split rule:
24328
24329@example
24330 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24331 (any "ding" "ding")
24332 (: spam-split)
24333 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24334 "mail")
24335@end example
24336
24337@noindent
24338The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24339folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24340SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24341sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24342list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24343of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24344
24345The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24346perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24347invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24348done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24349
24350@example
24351nnimap-split-fancy
24352 '(|
24353 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24354 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24355 (any "ding" "ding")
24356 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24357 (: spam-split)
24358 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24359 "mail")
24360@end example
24361
24362@noindent
24363This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24364your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24365particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24366spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24367mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24368blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24369spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24370
24371You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24372ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24373@file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24374@code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24375
24376@c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24377@c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24378@c don't.}
24379
24380@node Detecting Spam in Groups
24381@subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24382
24383To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24384@code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24385parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24386usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24387
24388You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24389ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24390@file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24391@code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24392
24393By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24394force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24395variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24396
24397If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24398can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24399For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24400the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24401@code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24402enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24403over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24404
24405@node Spam and Ham Processors
24406@subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24407@cindex spam filtering
24408@cindex spam filtering variables
24409@cindex spam variables
24410@cindex spam
24411
24412@vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24413Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24414a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24415processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24416processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24417ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24418package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24419
24420The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24421the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24422parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24423@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24424
24425@vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24426Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24427one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24428@code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24429groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24430@code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24431by customizing the corresponding variable
24432@code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24433parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24434also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24435classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24436groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24437@code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24438considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24439default.
24440
24441@vindex gnus-spam-mark
24442@cindex $
24443In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24444they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24445group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24446unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24447thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24448will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24449@code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24450should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24451buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24452@samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24453@kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24454group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24455processor which will study them as spam samples.
24456
24457Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24458@code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24459and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24460@samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24461low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24462are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24463use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24464should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24465
24466@defvar ham-marks
24467You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24468marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24469deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24470that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24471useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24472recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24473indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24474happy for you.
24475@end defvar
24476
24477@defvar spam-marks
24478You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24479marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24480the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24481you really want to.
24482@end defvar
24483
24484When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24485@code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24486to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24487explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24488@samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24489spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24490and nothing else.
24491
24492@vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24493When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24494marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24495not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24496@strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24497determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24498parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24499variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24500names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24501customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24502group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24503the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24504parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24505@code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24506set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24507
01c52d31 24508If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
4009494e
GM
24509@acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24510
24511Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24512expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24513group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24514
24515When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24516a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24517
24518@vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24519By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24520@code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24521to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24522to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24523
24524@vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24525By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24526@code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24527or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24528you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24529it there.
24530
24531@vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24532When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24533@strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24534the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24535@code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24536regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24537customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24538gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24539Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24540@code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24541articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24542that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24543group buffer then you need it here as well.
24544
01c52d31 24545If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
4009494e
GM
24546@acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24547
24548Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24549expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24550training} groups.
24551
24552@vindex spam-log-to-registry
24553The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24554this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24555variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24556what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24557multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24558entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24559
24560@vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24561Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24562be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24563@code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24564
24565@vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24566Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24567out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24568like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24569in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24570from the mail server.
24571
24572@vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24573When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24574only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24575spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24576
24577@node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24578@subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24579@cindex spam filtering
24580@cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24581@cindex spam configuration examples
24582@cindex spam
24583
24584@subsubheading Ted's setup
24585
24586From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24587@example
24588;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24589;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24590(gnus-registry-initialize)
24591(spam-initialize)
24592
24593(setq
24594 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24595 spam-use-BBDB t
24596 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24597 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24598 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24599 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24600 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24601 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24602 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24603 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
4009494e 24604 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
6b958814 24605 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
4009494e
GM
24606 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24607 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24608 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24609 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24610 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24611 (any "ding" "ding")
24612 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24613 (: spam-split)
24614 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24615 "mail"))
24616
24617;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24618
24619;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24620;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24621;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24622;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24623
24624((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24625
24626;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24627;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24628((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24629;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24630 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24631
24632;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24633((spam-autodetect . t))
24634
24635;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24636
24637;; @r{this is a spam group}
24638((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24639
24640 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24641 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24642 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24643
24644 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24645
24646 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24647 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24648
24649 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24650 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24651 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24652 (ham-marks
24653 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24654 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24655 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24656 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24657
24658;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24659;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24660;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24661
24662@end example
24663
01c52d31 24664@subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
4009494e
GM
24665From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24666
24667My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24668the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24669@samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
1df7defd 24670i.e., to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
4009494e
GM
24671positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24672@samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24673the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24674options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24675@samp{training.spam} folders.
24676
24677With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24678does most of the job for me:
24679
24680@lisp
24681 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24682 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24683 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24684 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24685 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24686 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24687 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24688@end lisp
24689
24690@itemize
24691
24692@item @b{The Spam folder:}
24693
24694In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
1df7defd 24695(i.e., legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
4009494e
GM
24696bogofilter or DCC).
24697
24698Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24699messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24700positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24701(@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24702those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24703to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24704and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24705
24706The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24707false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
1df7defd 24708have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e., chars) makes finding
4009494e
GM
24709other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24710(@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24711an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24712
24713@item @b{Ham folders:}
24714
24715In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24716(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24717mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
01c52d31 24718@samp{training.spam}.
4009494e
GM
24719@end itemize
24720
24721@subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24722
24723From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24724
24725With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24726(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24727groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24728
24729@lisp
24730 ("^gmane\\."
24731 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24732@end lisp
24733
24734Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24735because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
1df7defd 24736through my local news server (leafnode). I.e., the article numbers are
4009494e
GM
24737not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24738the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24739
24740@node Spam Back Ends
24741@subsection Spam Back Ends
24742@cindex spam back ends
24743
24744The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24745Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24746(@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24747and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24748Processors}).
24749
24750@menu
24751* Blacklists and Whitelists::
24752* BBDB Whitelists::
24753* Gmane Spam Reporting::
24754* Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24755* Blackholes::
24756* Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24757* Bogofilter::
01c52d31 24758* SpamAssassin back end::
4009494e
GM
24759* ifile spam filtering::
24760* Spam Statistics Filtering::
24761* SpamOracle::
24762@end menu
24763
24764@node Blacklists and Whitelists
24765@subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24766@cindex spam filtering
24767@cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24768@cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24769@cindex spam
24770
24771@defvar spam-use-blacklist
24772
24773Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24774splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24775will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24776filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24777be spammers.
24778
24779@end defvar
24780
24781@defvar spam-use-whitelist
24782
24783Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24784splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24785whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24786explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24787messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24788
24789@end defvar
24790
24791@defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24792
24793Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24794implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24795unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24796
24797@end defvar
24798
24799@defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24800
24801Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24802customizing the group parameters or the
24803@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24804added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24805spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24806
24807@emph{WARNING}
24808
24809Instead of the obsolete
24810@code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
01c52d31 24811that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
24812the same way, we promise.
24813
24814@end defvar
24815
24816@defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24817
24818Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24819customizing the group parameters or the
24820@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24821added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24822ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
01c52d31 24823whitelist.
4009494e
GM
24824
24825@emph{WARNING}
24826
24827Instead of the obsolete
24828@code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
01c52d31 24829that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
24830the same way, we promise.
24831
24832@end defvar
24833
24834Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24835consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24836sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24837blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24838use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24839
24840Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24841legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24842non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24843Emacs regular expression syntax.
24844
24845The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24846@code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24847the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24848directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24849@code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24850@file{blacklist} respectively.
24851
24852@node BBDB Whitelists
24853@subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24854@cindex spam filtering
24855@cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24856@cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24857@cindex spam
24858
24859@defvar spam-use-BBDB
24860
24861Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24862Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24863addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24864for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24865not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24866explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24867messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24868
24869@end defvar
24870
24871@defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24872
24873Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24874implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
1df7defd 24875unless the sender is in the BBDB@. Use with care. Only sender
4009494e
GM
24876addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24877classified as spammers.
24878
01c52d31
MB
24879While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24880for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24881@emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24882@code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to t, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24883will be exclusive.
24884
4009494e
GM
24885@end defvar
24886
24887@defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24888
24889Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24890customizing the group parameters or the
24891@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24892added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24893ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
01c52d31 24894BBDB.
4009494e
GM
24895
24896@emph{WARNING}
24897
24898Instead of the obsolete
24899@code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
01c52d31 24900that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
24901the same way, we promise.
24902
24903@end defvar
24904
24905@node Gmane Spam Reporting
24906@subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24907@cindex spam reporting
24908@cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24909@cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24910@cindex spam
24911
24912@defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24913
24914Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24915customizing the group parameters or the
24916@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24917added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24918articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24919HTTP request.
24920
24921Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24922
24923@emph{WARNING}
24924
24925Instead of the obsolete
24926@code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
01c52d31 24927that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
4009494e
GM
24928same way, we promise.
24929
24930@end defvar
24931
24932@defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24933
24934This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24935running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24936numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24937@code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
01c52d31
MB
24938@code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24939
24940@end defvar
24941
24942@defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24943
24944Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24945the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24946default is @code{user-mail-address}.
4009494e
GM
24947
24948@end defvar
24949
24950@node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24951@subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24952@cindex spam filtering
24953@cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24954@cindex spam
24955
24956@defvar spam-use-hashcash
24957
24958Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24959Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
01c52d31
MB
24960instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
24961token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
24962filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
24963are not assumed to be spam or ham.
4009494e
GM
24964
24965@end defvar
24966
24967@node Blackholes
24968@subsubsection Blackholes
24969@cindex spam filtering
24970@cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24971@cindex spam
24972
24973@defvar spam-use-blackholes
24974
24975This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
24976blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
24977when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
24978holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
24979list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
24980contains outdated servers.
24981
24982The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
01c52d31 24983@code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
4009494e
GM
24984you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
24985this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
24986possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
24987use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
24988
24989@end defvar
24990
24991@defvar spam-blackhole-servers
24992
24993The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
24994
24995@end defvar
24996
24997@defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
24998
24999A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
25000blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
25001
25002@end defvar
25003
25004@defvar spam-use-dig
25005
25006Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
25007The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
25008
25009@end defvar
25010
25011Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
25012ham processor for blackholes.
25013
25014@node Regular Expressions Header Matching
25015@subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
25016@cindex spam filtering
25017@cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
25018@cindex spam
25019
25020@defvar spam-use-regex-headers
25021
25022This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
25023message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
25024option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
25025@code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
25026Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
25027message is spam or ham, respectively.
25028
25029@end defvar
25030
25031@defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
25032
25033The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25034the message, positively identify it as spam.
25035
25036@end defvar
25037
25038@defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
25039
25040The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25041the message, positively identify it as ham.
25042
25043@end defvar
25044
25045Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
25046There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
25047
25048@node Bogofilter
25049@subsubsection Bogofilter
25050@cindex spam filtering
25051@cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
25052@cindex spam
25053
25054@defvar spam-use-bogofilter
25055
25056Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25057speedy Bogofilter.
25058
25059With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
25060articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
25061should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
25062category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
25063for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
25064the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
25065
25066Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25067threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25068documentation.
25069
25070If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25071processing will be turned off.
25072
25073You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25074
25075@end defvar
25076
25077@table @kbd
25078@item M s t
25079@itemx S t
25080@kindex M s t
25081@kindex S t
25082@findex spam-bogofilter-score
25083Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25084@end table
25085
25086@defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25087
25088Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25089speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25090similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25091must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25092procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25093installation documents for details.
25094
25095You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25096
25097@end defvar
25098
25099@defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25100Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25101customizing the group parameters or the
25102@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25103added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25104will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25105
25106@emph{WARNING}
25107
25108Instead of the obsolete
25109@code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25110that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25111the same way, we promise.
25112@end defvar
25113
25114@defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25115Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25116customizing the group parameters or the
25117@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25118added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25119articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
01c52d31 25120of non-spam messages.
4009494e
GM
25121
25122@emph{WARNING}
25123
25124Instead of the obsolete
25125@code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25126that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25127the same way, we promise.
25128@end defvar
25129
25130@defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25131
25132This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25133is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25134database directory.
25135
25136@end defvar
25137
25138The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25139purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25140@code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25141variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25142used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25143Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25144
01c52d31
MB
25145@node SpamAssassin back end
25146@subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25147@cindex spam filtering
25148@cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25149@cindex spam
25150
25151@defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25152
25153Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25154
25155SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25156and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25157trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25158spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25159mode.
25160
25161If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25162SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25163preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25164SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25165instead.
25166
25167You should not enable this if you use
25168@code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25169
25170@end defvar
25171
25172@defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25173
25174Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25175want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25176
25177You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25178
25179@end defvar
25180
25181@defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25182
25183This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25184@code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25185executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25186for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25187
25188@end defvar
25189
25190SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25191variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25192provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25193@code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25194spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25195been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25196to test this functionality.
25197
4009494e
GM
25198@node ifile spam filtering
25199@subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25200@cindex spam filtering
25201@cindex ifile, spam filtering
25202@cindex spam
25203
25204@defvar spam-use-ifile
25205
25206Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25207statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25208
25209@end defvar
25210
25211@defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25212
25213Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25214the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25215sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25216
25217@end defvar
25218
25219@defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25220
25221This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25222The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25223the default value of @samp{spam}.
25224@end defvar
25225
25226@defvar spam-ifile-database
25227
25228This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25229default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25230
25231@end defvar
25232
25233The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25234purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25235@code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25236should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25237functionality.
25238
25239@node Spam Statistics Filtering
25240@subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25241@cindex spam filtering
25242@cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25243@cindex spam-stat
25244@cindex spam
25245
25246This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25247statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25248using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25249initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25250spam-stat dictionary}.
25251
25252@defvar spam-use-stat
25253
25254@end defvar
25255
25256@defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25257Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25258customizing the group parameters or the
25259@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25260added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25261articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25262
25263@emph{WARNING}
25264
25265Instead of the obsolete
25266@code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25267that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25268the same way, we promise.
25269@end defvar
25270
25271@defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25272Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25273customizing the group parameters or the
25274@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25275added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25276articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
01c52d31 25277of non-spam messages.
4009494e
GM
25278
25279@emph{WARNING}
25280
25281Instead of the obsolete
25282@code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25283that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25284the same way, we promise.
25285@end defvar
25286
01c52d31 25287This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
4009494e
GM
25288@file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25289which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25290A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25291@code{spam-split} are provided.
25292
25293@node SpamOracle
25294@subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25295@cindex spam filtering
25296@cindex SpamOracle
25297@cindex spam
25298
25299An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25300statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25301installed separately.
25302
25303There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25304mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25305then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25306mail as a spam mail or not.
25307
25308One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25309@xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25310the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25311
25312The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25313call SpamOracle.
25314
25315@vindex spam-use-spamoracle
01c52d31 25316To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
4009494e
GM
25317@code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25318@code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25319Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25320filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25321moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25322messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25323
25324@example
25325(setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25326 spam-split-group "Junk"
6b958814 25327 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
4009494e 25328 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
4009494e
GM
25329 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25330@end example
25331
25332@defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25333Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25334SpamOracle.
25335@end defvar
25336
25337@defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25338Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
1df7defd 25339user's PATH@. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
4009494e
GM
25340can be customized.
25341@end defvar
25342
25343@defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25344By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25345store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25346@code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25347the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25348database to live somewhere special, set
25349@code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25350@end defvar
25351
25352SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25353message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25354false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25355the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25356(training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25357SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25358buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25359@file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25360convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25361@xref{Spam Package}.
25362
25363@defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25364Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25365customizing the group parameter or the
25366@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25367to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25368sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25369
25370@emph{WARNING}
25371
25372Instead of the obsolete
25373@code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25374that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25375the same way, we promise.
25376@end defvar
25377
25378@defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25379Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25380customizing the group parameter or the
25381@code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25382to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25383@emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
01c52d31 25384messages.
4009494e
GM
25385
25386@emph{WARNING}
25387
25388Instead of the obsolete
25389@code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
01c52d31 25390that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
4009494e
GM
25391the same way, we promise.
25392@end defvar
25393
25394@emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25395classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25396messages.
25397@example
25398 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25399 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25400 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25401@end example
25402For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25403ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
1df7defd 25404(e.g., because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
4009494e
GM
25405the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25406processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25407SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25408
25409@node Extending the Spam package
25410@subsection Extending the Spam package
25411@cindex spam filtering
25412@cindex spam elisp package, extending
25413@cindex extending the spam elisp package
25414
25415Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25416incoming mail, provide the following:
25417
25418@enumerate
25419
25420@item
25421Code
25422
25423@lisp
25424(defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25425 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25426@end lisp
25427
01c52d31 25428Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
4009494e 25429
01c52d31
MB
25430Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25431@code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
40ba43b4 25432register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
01c52d31
MB
25433routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25434register/unregister spam and ham.
4009494e
GM
25435
25436@item
25437Functionality
25438
01c52d31
MB
25439The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25440@code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25441existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25442do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25443why you aren't.
4009494e
GM
25444
25445@end enumerate
25446
25447For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25448
25449@enumerate
25450
25451@item
25452Code
25453
25454Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25455provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25456
25457Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
01c52d31
MB
25458variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25459@code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
4009494e
GM
25460processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25461
25462@lisp
25463(defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25464 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25465Only applicable to spam groups.")
25466
25467(defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25468 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25469Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25470
25471@end lisp
25472
25473@item
25474Gnus parameters
25475
25476Add
25477@lisp
25478(const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25479(const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25480@end lisp
25481to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25482sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25483variable customization.
25484
25485Add
25486@lisp
25487(variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25488@end lisp
25489to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
01c52d31
MB
25490@code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25491
25492Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25493@code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25494
25495
25496@enumerate
25497
25498@item
25499@code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25500
25501This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25502everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25503make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25504
25505@item
25506@code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25507
25508This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25509register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25510such a back end.
25511
25512@item
25513@code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25514
25515This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25516for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25517@code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25518back ends.
25519
25520@item
25521@code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25522
25523This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25524full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25525for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25526
25527@item
25528@code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25529
25530This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25531registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25532set up this way.
25533
25534@item
25535@code{spam-install-backend}
25536
25537This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25538check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25539abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25540
25541@item
25542@code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25543
25544Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25545articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25546never install such a back end.
25547@end enumerate
4009494e
GM
25548
25549@end enumerate
25550
25551@node Spam Statistics Package
25552@subsection Spam Statistics Package
25553@cindex Paul Graham
25554@cindex Graham, Paul
25555@cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25556@cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25557@cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25558
25559Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25560statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25561Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25562filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25563the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25564always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25565on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25566this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25567that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25568or not.
25569
25570The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25571with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25572either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25573collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25574word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25575non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25576probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25577than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25578
25579The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25580filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25581(@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25582
25583Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25584First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25585non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25586collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25587this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25588
25589@menu
25590* Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25591* Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25592* Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25593@end menu
25594
25595@node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25596@subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25597
25598Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25599create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25600one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25601for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25602need several hundred emails in both collections.
25603
25604Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25605creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25606per mail. Use the following:
25607
25608@defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25609Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25610is treated as one spam mail.
25611@end defun
25612
25613@defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25614Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25615file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25616@end defun
25617
25618Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25619directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25620the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25621@code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25622@file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25623@samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25624
25625When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25626locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25627to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25628@file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25629@code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25630
25631@defvar spam-stat
25632This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25633dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25634collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25635word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25636@end defvar
25637
25638If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25639reset the dictionary.
25640
25641@defun spam-stat-reset
25642Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25643@end defun
25644
25645When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25646be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25647(instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25648can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25649not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25650only non-spam mails.
25651
25652@defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25653Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25654to update the dictionary incrementally.
25655@end defun
25656
25657@defun spam-stat-save
25658Save the dictionary.
25659@end defun
25660
25661@defvar spam-stat-file
25662The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25663@file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25664@end defvar
25665
25666@node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25667@subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25668
25669This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25670@emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25671
25672First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25673
25674@lisp
25675(require 'spam-stat)
25676(spam-stat-load)
25677@end lisp
25678
25679This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25680created.
25681
25682Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25683determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25684the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25685use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25686
25687In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25688@samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25689spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25690@code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25691
25692@lisp
25693(setq nnmail-split-fancy
25694 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25695 "mail.misc"))
25696@end lisp
25697
25698@defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25699The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25700@end defvar
25701
25702If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25703the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25704expression are considered potential spam.
25705
25706@lisp
25707(setq nnmail-split-fancy
25708 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25709 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25710 "mail.misc"))
25711@end lisp
25712
25713If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25714creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25715consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25716non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25717mails, when creating the dictionary!
25718
25719@lisp
25720(setq nnmail-split-fancy
25721 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25722 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25723 "mail.misc"))
25724@end lisp
25725
25726You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25727HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25728@code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25729@samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25730nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25731dictionary!
25732
25733@lisp
25734(setq nnmail-split-fancy
25735 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25736 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25737 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25738 "mail.misc"))
25739@end lisp
25740
25741
25742@node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25743@subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25744
25745The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25746
25747@defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25748Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25749Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25750@end defun
25751
25752@defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25753Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25754mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25755@end defun
25756
25757@defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25758Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25759mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25760already been processed as non-spam.
25761@end defun
25762
25763@defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25764Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25765normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25766been processed as spam.
25767@end defun
25768
25769@defun spam-stat-save
25770Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25771variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25772@end defun
25773
25774@defun spam-stat-load
25775Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25776variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25777@end defun
25778
25779@defun spam-stat-score-word
25780Return the spam score for a word.
25781@end defun
25782
25783@defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25784Return the spam score for a buffer.
25785@end defun
25786
25787@defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25788Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25789spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25790@end defun
25791
25792Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25793following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25794
25795@lisp
25796(require 'spam-stat)
25797(spam-stat-load)
25798@end lisp
25799
25800Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25801
25802@smallexample
25803Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25804Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25805Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25806Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25807File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25808Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25809Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25810Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25811Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25812Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25813File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25814Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25815Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25816Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25817@end smallexample
25818
25819Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25820
25821@smallexample
25822Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25823Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25824Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25825Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25826Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25827Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25828@end smallexample
25829
64763fe3
MB
25830@node The Gnus Registry
25831@section The Gnus Registry
64763fe3
MB
25832@cindex registry
25833@cindex split
25834@cindex track
25835
25836The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25837Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25838cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25839experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25840features are pretty cool.
25841
25842Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25843of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25844
25845@enumerate
e52cac88
MB
25846@item
25847Split messages to their parent
64763fe3 25848
64763fe3 25849This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
1df7defd 25850the sender in addition to the Message-ID@. Several strategies are
64763fe3
MB
25851available.
25852
36d3245f
G
25853@item
25854Refer to messages by ID
25855
25856Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25857advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25858of the group the message is in.
25859
e52cac88
MB
25860@item
25861Store custom flags and keywords
25862
64763fe3
MB
25863The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25864instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25865persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25866etc. backends.
25867
e52cac88
MB
25868@item
25869Store arbitrary data
25870
64763fe3
MB
25871Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25872message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25873of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
64763fe3
MB
25874@end enumerate
25875
64763fe3 25876@menu
627abcdd 25877* Gnus Registry Setup::
36d3245f 25878* Registry Article Refer Method::
2fce4cd8 25879* Fancy splitting to parent::
867d4bb3
JB
25880* Store custom flags and keywords::
25881* Store arbitrary data::
64763fe3
MB
25882@end menu
25883
627abcdd
TZ
25884@node Gnus Registry Setup
25885@subsection Gnus Registry Setup
64763fe3
MB
25886
25887Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25888
25889@lisp
c3c65d73 25890(setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
64763fe3
MB
25891
25892(gnus-registry-initialize)
25893@end lisp
25894
25895This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25896and when you press @kbd{s} from the @code{*Group*} buffer. It also
65e7ca35 25897adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.)@: so
64763fe3
MB
25898it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25899@code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25900
25901Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25902what they do before you copy them blindly).
25903
25904@lisp
25905(setq
25906 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25907 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25908 ("nnrss" t)
25909 ("spam" t)
25910 ("train" t))
25911 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
c3c65d73 25912 ;; this is the default
64763fe3
MB
25913 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25914@end lisp
25915
c3c65d73
TZ
25916They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25917subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25918incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25919if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25920should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25921``spam'', or ``train.''
64763fe3
MB
25922
25923You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25924user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25925the general settings.
25926
25927@defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25928The groups that will not be followed by
25929@code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25930remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
54a8f337
KY
25931By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25932``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
c3c65d73 25933the word ``archive'' is not followed.
64763fe3
MB
25934@end defvar
25935
25936@defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25937The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25938registry will keep.
25939@end defvar
25940
c3c65d73
TZ
25941@defvar gnus-registry-max-pruned-entries
25942The maximum number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries
25943the registry will keep after pruning.
25944@end defvar
25945
64763fe3 25946@defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
c3c65d73
TZ
25947The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
25948default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eioio} in the same
25949directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
64763fe3
MB
25950@end defvar
25951
36d3245f
G
25952@node Registry Article Refer Method
25953@subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
25954
25955The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
25956in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
25957the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
25958Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25959
25960@vindex nnregistry
25961@vindex gnus-refer-article-method
25962
25963The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
25964advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
25965in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
25966be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
25967lines:
25968
25969@example
25970;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
25971;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
25972;; knows where the article is.
c3c65d73 25973(setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
36d3245f
G
25974
25975(gnus-registry-initialize)
25976
25977(setq gnus-refer-article-method
25978 '(current
e08ea0f8
KY
25979 (nnregistry)
25980 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
36d3245f
G
25981@end example
25982
25983The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
25984current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
25985all else fails, using Gmane.
25986
64763fe3
MB
25987@node Fancy splitting to parent
25988@subsection Fancy splitting to parent
25989
25990Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
25991
25992Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
25993remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
25994notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
25995strategy.
25996
25997When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
25998Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
25999mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
26000have to put a rule like this:
26001
26002@lisp
26003(setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
26004
26005 ;; split to parent: you need this
26006 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
26007
26008 ;; other rules, as an example
26009 (: spam-split)
26010 ;; default mailbox
26011 "mail")
26012@end lisp
26013
26014in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
26015following variables.
26016
26017@defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
26018This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
c17b81a7
G
26019Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender recipient)},
26020which may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large
26021and people don't stick to the same groups.
26022
26023When you decide to stop tracking any of those extra data, you can use
26024the command @code{gnus-registry-remove-extra-data} to purge it from
26025the existing registry entries.
64763fe3
MB
26026@end defvar
26027
26028@defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
26029This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
26030interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
26031@code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
c3c65d73
TZ
26032the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
26033works best.
64763fe3
MB
26034@end defvar
26035
26036@node Store custom flags and keywords
26037@subsection Store custom flags and keywords
26038
26039The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
26040can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
26041shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
26042
26043@defvar gnus-registry-marks
26044The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
26045default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
26046before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
26047it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
26048want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
26049
26050By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
26051@code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
26052keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
26053letter.
26054@end defvar
26055
26056@defun gnus-registry-mark-article
26057Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
26058will offer the available marks for completion.
26059@end defun
26060
627abcdd
TZ
26061You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
26062function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
26063this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
26064their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
26065
26066@lisp
26067;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
26068;; `gnus-registry-marks'):
2da9c605 26069;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
627abcdd
TZ
26070
26071;; show the marks by name (see `gnus-registry-marks'):
2da9c605 26072;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
627abcdd
TZ
26073@end lisp
26074
26075
64763fe3
MB
26076@node Store arbitrary data
26077@subsection Store arbitrary data
26078
26079The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26080store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26081storage).
26082
c3c65d73
TZ
26083@defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26084Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
64763fe3
MB
26085@end defun
26086
c3c65d73
TZ
26087@defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26088Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
64763fe3
MB
26089@end defun
26090
26091@defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26092If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26093registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26094the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26095default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26096precious.
26097@end defvar
26098
4009494e
GM
26099@node Other modes
26100@section Interaction with other modes
26101
26102@subsection Dired
26103@cindex dired
26104
26105@code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26106buffers. It is enabled with
26107@lisp
26108(add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26109@end lisp
26110
26111@table @kbd
26112@item C-c C-m C-a
26113@findex gnus-dired-attach
26114@cindex attachments, selection via dired
26115Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26116You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26117
26118@item C-c C-m C-l
26119@findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26120Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26121(@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26122buffer.
26123
26124@item C-c C-m C-p
26125@findex gnus-dired-print
26126Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26127there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26128@end table
26129
26130@node Various Various
26131@section Various Various
26132@cindex mode lines
26133@cindex highlights
26134
26135@table @code
26136
26137@item gnus-home-directory
26138@vindex gnus-home-directory
26139All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26140variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26141
26142@item gnus-directory
26143@vindex gnus-directory
26144Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26145this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26146variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26147
26148Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26149This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26150variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26151@file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26152
26153@item gnus-default-directory
26154@vindex gnus-default-directory
26155Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26156default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26157like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26158default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26159default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26160buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26161
26162@item gnus-verbose
26163@vindex gnus-verbose
26164This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26165the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26166will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26167most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26168shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26169
26170@item gnus-verbose-backends
26171@vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26172This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26173to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26174
01c52d31
MB
26175@item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26176@vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26177This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26178controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26179are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26180timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26181that go into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26182@w{@samp{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26183@code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26184displayed in the echo area.
26185
4009494e
GM
26186@item nnheader-max-head-length
26187@vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26188When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26189as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26190the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26191on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26192variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26193@code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26194but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26195@code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26196
26197@item nnheader-head-chop-length
26198@vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26199This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26200read when doing the operation described above.
26201
26202@item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26203@vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26204@cindex file names
26205@cindex invalid characters in file names
26206@cindex characters in file names
26207This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26208For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26209on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26210
26211@lisp
26212@group
26213(setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26214 '((?: . ?_)))
26215@end group
26216@end lisp
26217
26218In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26219Windows (phooey) systems.
26220
26221@item gnus-hidden-properties
26222@vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26223This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26224@code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26225makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26226
26227@item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26228@vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26229A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26230gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26231some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26232
26233@item gnus-shell-command-separator
26234@vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26235String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26236
26237@item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26238@vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26239
26240Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26241name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26242names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26243@samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26244group).
26245
26246@acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26247
b0b63450
MB
26248@item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26249@vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26250Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26251value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26252@code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26253value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26254renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26255set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26256emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
4009494e
GM
26257
26258@end table
26259
26260@node The End
26261@chapter The End
26262
26263Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26264touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26265
26266My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26267
26268Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26269
26270@quotation
26271@strong{Te Deum}
26272
26273@sp 1
26274Not because of victories @*
26275I sing,@*
26276having none,@*
26277but for the common sunshine,@*
26278the breeze,@*
26279the largess of the spring.
26280
26281@sp 1
26282Not for victory@*
26283but for the day's work done@*
26284as well as I was able;@*
26285not for a seat upon the dais@*
26286but at the common table.@*
26287@end quotation
26288
26289
26290@node Appendices
26291@chapter Appendices
26292
26293@menu
26294* XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26295* History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26296* On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26297* Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26298* Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26299* Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26300* Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26301* Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26302* Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26303@end menu
26304
26305
26306@node XEmacs
26307@section XEmacs
26308@cindex XEmacs
26309@cindex installing under XEmacs
26310
26311XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26312whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26313requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26314@samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26315@samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
26316@samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26317
26318
26319@node History
26320@section History
26321
26322@cindex history
26323@sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26324'94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26325
26326If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26327you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26328@uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26329distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26330known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26331
26332During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26333called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26334@dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26335(Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26336pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26337appropriate name, don't you think?)
26338
26339In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26340spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26341renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26342``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26343
26344@menu
26345* Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
4009494e
GM
26346* Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26347* Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26348* Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26349* Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26350* Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26351* Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26352* New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26353@end menu
26354
26355
26356@node Gnus Versions
26357@subsection Gnus Versions
26358@cindex ding Gnus
26359@cindex September Gnus
26360@cindex Red Gnus
26361@cindex Quassia Gnus
26362@cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26363@cindex Oort Gnus
26364@cindex No Gnus
89b163db 26365@cindex Ma Gnus
4009494e
GM
26366@cindex Gnus versions
26367
26368The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26369was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26370plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26371
26372In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26373releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26374
26375On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26376January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26377
26378On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26379It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26380
26381Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26382``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
263831999.
26384
26385On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26386Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26387
26388On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26389
bff3818b
KY
26390On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26391http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26392with the information when possible).
26393
89b163db
G
26394On the January 31th 2012, Ma Gnus was begun.
26395
f99f1641
PE
26396If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name---``(ding)
26397Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26398``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'', ``Ma Gnus''---don't
89b163db
G
26399panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly.
26400Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of
26401its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to
26402that instead.
4009494e
GM
26403
26404
4009494e
GM
26405@node Why?
26406@subsection Why?
26407
26408What's the point of Gnus?
26409
26410I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26411newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26412original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26413me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26414Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26415volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26416newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26417newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26418keep track of millions of people who post?
26419
26420Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26421like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26422reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26423to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26424interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26425and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26426everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26427every one of you to explore and invent.
26428
26429May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26430@kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26431
26432
26433@node Compatibility
26434@subsection Compatibility
26435
26436@cindex compatibility
26437Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26438bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26439but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26440
26441Our motto is:
26442@quotation
26443@cartouche
26444@center In a cloud bones of steel.
26445@end cartouche
26446@end quotation
26447
26448All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26449their names.
26450
26451The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26452Articles}.
26453
26454One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26455buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26456buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26457important variables have their values copied into their global
26458counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26459change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26460
26461All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26462fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26463changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26464maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26465speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26466peculiar results.
26467
26468@cindex hilit19
26469@cindex highlighting
26470Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26471remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26472(@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26473Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26474faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26475by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26476Away!
26477
26478Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26479fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26480code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26481does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26482
26483Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26484new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26485doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26486to stop doing it the old way.
26487
26488Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26489
26490@kindex M-x gnus-bug
26491@findex gnus-bug
26492@cindex reporting bugs
26493@cindex bugs
26494Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26495@sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26496please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26497
26498@vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26499If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26500may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26501@code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26502up at you.
26503
26504
26505@node Conformity
26506@subsection Conformity
26507
26508No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26509to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26510with, of course.
26511
26512@table @strong
26513
26514@item RFC (2)822
26515@cindex RFC 822
26516@cindex RFC 2822
26517There are no known breaches of this standard.
26518
26519@item RFC 1036
26520@cindex RFC 1036
26521There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26522
26523@item Son-of-RFC 1036
26524@cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26525We do have some breaches to this one.
26526
26527@table @emph
26528
26529@item X-Newsreader
26530@itemx User-Agent
26531These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26532to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26533articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26534either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26535it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26536@end table
26537
26538@item USEFOR
26539@cindex USEFOR
26540USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26541on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26542various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26543look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26544
f99f1641 26545@item MIME---RFC 2045--2049 etc
4009494e
GM
26546@cindex @acronym{MIME}
26547All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26548
f99f1641 26549@item Disposition Notifications---RFC 2298
4009494e
GM
26550Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26551
f99f1641 26552@item PGP---RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
4009494e
GM
26553@cindex RFC 1991
26554@cindex RFC 2440
26555RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
1df7defd 26556published as an informational RFC@. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
4009494e
GM
26557called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26558non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26559encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26560decryption).
26561
f99f1641 26562@item PGP/MIME---RFC 2015/3156
4009494e
GM
26563RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
265641991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26565Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26566
f99f1641 26567@item S/MIME---RFC 2633
4009494e
GM
26568RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26569
f99f1641 26570@item IMAP---RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
4009494e
GM
26571RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26572(@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26573authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26574lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26575protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26576integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26577GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26578
26579@end table
26580
26581If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26582mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26583know.
26584
26585
26586@node Emacsen
26587@subsection Emacsen
26588@cindex Emacsen
26589@cindex XEmacs
26590@cindex Mule
26591@cindex Emacs
26592
d55fe5bb 26593This version of Gnus should work on:
4009494e
GM
26594
26595@itemize @bullet
26596
26597@item
6ed7a66a 26598Emacs 23.1 and up.
4009494e
GM
26599
26600@item
26601XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26602
26603@end itemize
26604
26605This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26606that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26607Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
2660820.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26609
d55fe5bb
MB
26610@c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26611@c synced here!
4009494e
GM
26612
26613@node Gnus Development
26614@subsection Gnus Development
26615
26616Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
9b3ebcb6 26617discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
4009494e
GM
26618propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26619phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26620phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26621circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26622unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
9b3ebcb6 26623have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
4009494e 26624
f99f1641 26625After futzing around for 10--100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
4009494e 26626@dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
9b3ebcb6 26627and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
4009494e 26628supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
9b3ebcb6
MB
26629@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26630mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26631as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26632in Emacs.
4009494e
GM
26633
26634@cindex Incoming*
26635@vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
37a68866
MB
26636Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26637in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
4009494e 26638lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
37a68866 26639@xref{Mail Source Customization}.
4009494e
GM
26640
26641The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26642newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26643having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26644can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26645importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26646introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26647introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26648either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26649usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26650can't be assumed to do so.
26651
9b3ebcb6
MB
26652So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26653direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26654is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
4009494e 26655
9b3ebcb6
MB
26656@cindex Incoming*
26657@vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26658Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26659in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26660lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26661@xref{Mail Source Customization}.
4009494e
GM
26662
26663@node Contributors
26664@subsection Contributors
26665@cindex contributors
26666
26667The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26668people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26669gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26670every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26671tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26672type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26673work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26674off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26675Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26676``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26677
26678I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26679wrong show.
26680
26681@itemize @bullet
26682
26683@item
26684Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26685
26686@item
6b958814 26687Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
4009494e
GM
26688nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26689other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26690functionality and stuff.
26691
26692@item
26693Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26694well as numerous other things).
26695
26696@item
26697Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26698
26699@item
26700Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26701
26702@item
26703Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26704
26705@item
26706Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26707
26708@item
26709Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26710@dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26711
26712@item
26713Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26714
26715@item
01c52d31 26716Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
4009494e
GM
26717
26718@item
26719Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26720
26721@item
26722Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26723
26724@item
4c36be58 26725Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
4009494e
GM
26726
26727@item
26728Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26729
26730@item
26731Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26732distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26733
26734@item
26735Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26736
26737@item
26738Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26739
26740@item
26741Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26742
26743@item
26744Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26745.newsrc files.
26746
26747@item
26748Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26749
26750@item
26751David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26752
26753@item
26754Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26755
26756@item
01c52d31 26757Fran@,{c}ois Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
4009494e
GM
26758well as autoconf support.
26759
26760@end itemize
26761
26762This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26763Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26764
26765The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26766
26767Christopher Davis,
26768Andrew Eskilsson,
26769Kai Grossjohann,
26770Kevin Greiner,
26771Jesper Harder,
26772Paul Jarc,
26773Simon Josefsson,
01c52d31 26774David K@aa{}gedal,
4009494e
GM
26775Richard Pieri,
26776Fabrice Popineau,
26777Daniel Quinlan,
26778Michael Shields,
26779Reiner Steib,
26780Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26781Jack Vinson,
26782Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26783and
26784Teodor Zlatanov.
26785
26786Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26787
26788Jari Aalto,
26789Adrian Aichner,
26790Vladimir Alexiev,
26791Russ Allbery,
26792Peter Arius,
26793Matt Armstrong,
26794Marc Auslander,
26795Miles Bader,
26796Alexei V. Barantsev,
26797Frank Bennett,
26798Robert Bihlmeyer,
26799Chris Bone,
26800Mark Borges,
26801Mark Boyns,
26802Lance A. Brown,
26803Rob Browning,
26804Kees de Bruin,
26805Martin Buchholz,
26806Joe Buehler,
26807Kevin Buhr,
26808Alastair Burt,
26809Joao Cachopo,
26810Zlatko Calusic,
26811Massimo Campostrini,
26812Castor,
26813David Charlap,
26814Dan Christensen,
26815Kevin Christian,
26816Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26817James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26818Laura Conrad,
26819Michael R. Cook,
26820Glenn Coombs,
26821Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26822Neil Crellin,
26823Frank D. Cringle,
26824Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26825Andre Deparade,
26826Ulrik Dickow,
26827Dave Disser,
26828Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26829Joev Dubach,
26830Michael Welsh Duggan,
26831Dave Edmondson,
26832Paul Eggert,
26833Mark W. Eichin,
26834Karl Eichwalder,
26835Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26836Michael Ernst,
26837Luc Van Eycken,
26838Sam Falkner,
26839Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26840Sigbjorn Finne,
26841Sven Fischer,
26842Paul Fisher,
26843Decklin Foster,
26844Gary D. Foster,
26845Paul Franklin,
26846Guy Geens,
26847Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26848David S. Goldberg,
26849Michelangelo Grigni,
26850Dale Hagglund,
26851D. Hall,
26852Magnus Hammerin,
26853Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26854Raja R. Harinath,
26855Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26856P. E. Jareth Hein,
26857Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26858Scott Hofmann,
01c52d31 26859Tassilo Horn,
4009494e
GM
26860Marc Horowitz,
26861Gunnar Horrigmo,
26862Richard Hoskins,
26863Brad Howes,
26864Miguel de Icaza,
01c52d31 26865Fran@,{c}ois Felix Ingrand,
4009494e
GM
26866Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26867Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26868Lee Iverson,
26869Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26870Rajappa Iyer,
26871Andreas Jaeger,
26872Adam P. Jenkins,
26873Randell Jesup,
26874Fred Johansen,
26875Gareth Jones,
26876Greg Klanderman,
26877Karl Kleinpaste,
26878Michael Klingbeil,
26879Peter Skov Knudsen,
26880Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26881Petr Konecny,
26882Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26883Thor Kristoffersen,
26884Jens Lautenbacher,
26885Martin Larose,
26886Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26887Joerg Lenneis,
26888Carsten Leonhardt,
26889James LewisMoss,
26890Christian Limpach,
26891Markus Linnala,
26892Dave Love,
26893Mike McEwan,
26894Tonny Madsen,
26895Shlomo Mahlab,
26896Nat Makarevitch,
26897Istvan Marko,
26898David Martin,
26899Jason R. Mastaler,
26900Gordon Matzigkeit,
26901Timo Metzemakers,
26902Richard Mlynarik,
26903Lantz Moore,
26904Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26905Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26906Hrvoje Niksic,
26907Andy Norman,
26908Fred Oberhauser,
26909C. R. Oldham,
26910Alexandre Oliva,
26911Ken Olstad,
26912Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26913Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26914Ettore Perazzoli,
26915William Perry,
26916Stephen Peters,
26917Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26918Ulrich Pfeifer,
26919Matt Pharr,
26920Andy Piper,
26921John McClary Prevost,
26922Bill Pringlemeir,
26923Mike Pullen,
26924Jim Radford,
26925Colin Rafferty,
26926Lasse Rasinen,
26927Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26928Joe Reiss,
26929Renaud Rioboo,
26930Roland B. Roberts,
26931Bart Robinson,
26932Christian von Roques,
26933Markus Rost,
26934Jason Rumney,
26935Wolfgang Rupprecht,
26936Jay Sachs,
26937Dewey M. Sasser,
26938Conrad Sauerwald,
26939Loren Schall,
26940Dan Schmidt,
26941Ralph Schleicher,
26942Philippe Schnoebelen,
26943Andreas Schwab,
26944Randal L. Schwartz,
26945Danny Siu,
26946Matt Simmons,
26947Paul D. Smith,
26948Jeff Sparkes,
26949Toby Speight,
26950Michael Sperber,
26951Darren Stalder,
26952Richard Stallman,
26953Greg Stark,
26954Sam Steingold,
26955Paul Stevenson,
26956Jonas Steverud,
26957Paul Stodghill,
26958Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
26959Kurt Swanson,
26960Samuel Tardieu,
26961Teddy,
26962Chuck Thompson,
26963Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
26964Philippe Troin,
26965James Troup,
26966Trung Tran-Duc,
26967Jack Twilley,
26968Aaron M. Ucko,
26969Aki Vehtari,
26970Didier Verna,
26971Vladimir Volovich,
26972Jan Vroonhof,
26973Stefan Waldherr,
26974Pete Ware,
26975Barry A. Warsaw,
26976Christoph Wedler,
26977Joe Wells,
26978Lee Willis,
26979and
26980Lloyd Zusman.
26981
26982
26983For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
26984included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
26985(550kB and counting).
26986
26987Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
26988sure.
26989
26990Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
26991actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
26992
26993
26994@node New Features
26995@subsection New Features
26996@cindex new features
26997
26998@menu
26999* ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
27000* September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
27001* Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
27002* Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
27003* Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
27004* Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
89b163db
G
27005* No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13.
27006* Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
4009494e
GM
27007@end menu
27008
27009These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
27010@emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
27011Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
27012
27013@node ding Gnus
27014@subsubsection (ding) Gnus
27015
27016New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
27017
27018@itemize @bullet
27019
27020@item
27021The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
27022(@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
27023
27024@item
27025Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
27026(@pxref{Select Methods}).
27027
27028@item
27029You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
27030
27031@item
27032You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
27033All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
27034(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
27035
27036@item
27037Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
27038their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
27039can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
27040(@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27041
27042@item
27043Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
27044them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27045
27046@item
27047Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
27048entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
27049(@pxref{The Active File}).
27050
27051@item
27052Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
27053(@pxref{Group Levels}).
27054
27055@item
27056You can score articles according to any number of criteria
27057(@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
27058articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27059
27060@item
27061Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
27062manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
27063read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
27064
27065@item
27066Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
27067cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
27068
27069@item
27070You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27071operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27072
4009494e
GM
27073@item
27074You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27075(@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27076
27077@item
27078You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27079servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27080
27081@item
27082Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27083server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27084
27085@item
27086You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27087
27088@item
27089The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27090(@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27091
27092@item
27093You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27094of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27095
27096@item
27097Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27098glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27099
27100@item
27101Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27102
27103@item
27104Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27105(@pxref{Document Groups}).
27106
27107@item
27108Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27109Articles}).
27110
27111@item
27112URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27113Buttons}).
27114
27115@item
27116You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27117configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27118
4009494e
GM
27119@end itemize
27120
27121
27122@node September Gnus
27123@subsubsection September Gnus
27124
27125@iftex
27126@iflatex
27127\gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27128@end iflatex
27129@end iftex
27130
27131New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27132
27133@itemize @bullet
27134
27135@item
27136A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27137for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27138now obsolete.
27139
27140@item
27141Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27142missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27143Threading}).
27144
27145@lisp
27146(setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27147@end lisp
27148
27149@item
27150Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27151(@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27152
27153@item
27154Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27155referred.
27156
27157@item
01c52d31 27158Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
4009494e
GM
27159
27160@item
27161Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27162
27163@item
27164A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27165
27166@lisp
27167(setq gnus-use-trees t)
27168@end lisp
27169
27170@item
27171An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27172buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27173
27174@lisp
27175(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27176@end lisp
27177
27178@item
27179In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27180Groups}).
27181
27182@item
27183Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27184Topics}).
27185
27186@lisp
27187(add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27188@end lisp
27189
27190@item
27191Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27192
27193@item
27194Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27195is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27196
27197@lisp
27198(add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27199@end lisp
27200
27201@item
27202Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27203groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27204
27205@item
27206Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27207
27208@item
27209@code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27210news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27211else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27212
27213@item
c4d82de8 27214Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
4009494e
GM
27215
27216@item
27217The Gnus cache is much faster.
27218
27219@item
27220Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27221Groups}).
27222
27223@item
27224New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27225expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27226
27227@item
27228All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27229(@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27230
27231@item
27232There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27233marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27234
27235@item
27236The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27237articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27238bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27239
27240@item
27241Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27242(@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27243
27244@item
27245All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27246
27247@item
27248Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27249
27250@item
27251All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27252
27253@item
27254Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27255
27256@item
27257All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27258buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27259
27260@item
27261Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27262Layout}).
27263
27264@item
27265Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27266@iftex
27267@iflatex
27268\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27269@end iflatex
27270@end iftex
27271
4009494e
GM
27272@item
27273Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27274
27275@lisp
27276(setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27277@end lisp
27278
27279@item
27280Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27281
27282@item
27283Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27284
27285@item
27286Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27287(@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27288
27289@lisp
27290(setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27291 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27292@end lisp
27293
27294@item
27295Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27296refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27297
27298@lisp
27299(setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27300@end lisp
27301
27302@item
27303A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27304buffer to allow easier treatment.
27305
27306@item
27307Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27308
27309@item
27310Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27311Articles}).
27312
27313@lisp
27314(setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27315@end lisp
27316
27317@item
27318@code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27319articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27320
27321@lisp
27322(setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27323@end lisp
27324
27325@item
27326Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27327(@pxref{Article Washing}).
27328
27329@item
27330Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27331cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27332
27333@lisp
27334(setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27335@end lisp
27336
27337@item
27338Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27339
27340@item
27341Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27342
27343@item
27344Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27345
27346@end itemize
27347
27348
27349@node Red Gnus
27350@subsubsection Red Gnus
27351
27352New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27353
27354@iftex
27355@iflatex
27356\gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27357@end iflatex
27358@end iftex
27359
27360@itemize @bullet
27361
27362@item
27363@file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27364
27365@item
27366Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27367Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27368
27369@item
27370Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27371@code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27372Scoring}).
27373
27374@item
27375Article washing status can be displayed in the
27376article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27377
27378@item
27379@file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27380
27381@item
27382Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27383(@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27384
27385@lisp
27386(setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27387@end lisp
27388
27389@item
27390New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27391considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27392been added.
27393
27394@item
e4769531 27395@code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
4009494e
GM
27396Server Internals}).
27397
27398@item
27399Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27400Parameters}).
27401
27402@item
27403Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27404
27405@item
27406Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27407(@pxref{Article Signature}).
27408
27409@item
27410Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27411numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27412articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27413
27414@item
27415Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27416another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27417
27418@item
27419There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27420when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27421
27422@item
27423Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27424(@pxref{Undo}).
27425
27426@item
27427Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27428(@pxref{Score File Format}).
27429
27430@item
27431Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27432(@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27433
27434@lisp
27435(setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27436@end lisp
27437
27438@item
27439Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27440
27441@lisp
27442(setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27443@end lisp
27444
27445@item
27446Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27447normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27448
27449@item
27450A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27451the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27452
27453@item
27454A new command for reading collections of documents
27455(@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27456(@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27457
27458@item
27459Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27460Marks}).
27461
27462@item
27463A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27464server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27465
27466@item
27467A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27468(@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27469(@pxref{Web Searches}).
27470
27471@item
27472Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27473functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27474Sorting}).
27475
27476@item
27477Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27478Groups}).
27479
27480@item
27481Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27482Commands}).
27483@iftex
27484@iflatex
27485\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27486@end iflatex
27487@end iftex
27488
27489@item
27490Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27491Variables}).
27492
27493@item
27494Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27495Mail}).
27496
27497@item
27498More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27499mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27500
27501@item
27502Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27503
27504@end itemize
27505
27506
27507@node Quassia Gnus
27508@subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27509
27510New features in Gnus 5.6:
27511
27512@itemize @bullet
27513
27514@item
27515New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27516added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27517@xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27518
27519@item
27520The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27521before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27522group, which is created automatically.
27523
27524@item
27525@code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27526values.
27527
27528@item
1df7defd 27529@code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-IDs.
4009494e
GM
27530
27531@item
27532A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27533outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27534
27535@item
27536You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27537@kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27538
27539@item
27540 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27541
27542@item
27543@code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27544re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27545
27546@item
27547New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27548
27549@item
27550@kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27551details.
27552
27553@item
27554@kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27555@kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27556
27557@item
27558@code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27559control over simplification.
27560
27561@item
27562@kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27563
27564@item
27565@kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27566limit.
27567
27568@item
27569@kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27570
27571@item
27572@samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27573
27574@item
27575The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27576If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27577rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27578
27579@item
27580Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27581@kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27582
27583@item
27584New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27585text---@kbd{W d}.
27586
27587@item
27588For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27589@code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27590
27591@item
27592@code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27593controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27594
27595@item
27596A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27597has been added.
27598
27599@item
27600A history of where mails have been split is available.
27601
27602@item
27603A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27604
27605@item
27606Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27607@code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27608
27609@item
27610A new function for citing in Message has been
27611added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27612
27613@item
27614@code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27615
27616@item
27617A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27618been added.
27619
27620@item
27621A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27622@code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27623
27624@item
27625The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27626updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27627
27628@item
27629Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27630
27631@item
27632Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27633
27634@end itemize
27635
27636@node Pterodactyl Gnus
27637@subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27638
27639New features in Gnus 5.8:
27640
27641@itemize @bullet
27642
27643@item
27644The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27645many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27646
27647If you used procmail like in
27648
27649@lisp
27650(setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27651(setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27652(setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27653(setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27654@end lisp
27655
27656this now has changed to
27657
27658@lisp
27659(setq mail-sources
27660 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27661 :suffix ".in")))
27662@end lisp
27663
27664@xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27665
27666@item
27667Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27668Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27669
27670@item
27671Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27672many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27673
27674@item
27675@code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27676called to position point.
27677
27678@item
27679The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27680summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27681
27682@item
27683@code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27684of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27685
27686@item
27687The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27688subtly different manner.
27689
27690@item
27691New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27692@code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27693again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27694
27695@item
27696Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27697
27698@end itemize
27699
27700@node Oort Gnus
27701@subsubsection Oort Gnus
27702@cindex Oort Gnus
27703
27704New features in Gnus 5.10:
27705
27706@itemize @bullet
27707
27708@item Installation changes
27709@c ***********************
27710
27711@itemize @bullet
27712@item
27713Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27714
27715If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27716release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27717this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27718@file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27719read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27720@file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27721later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27722isn't save in general.
27723
27724@item
27725Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27726It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27727the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27728will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27729shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27730remove-installed-shadows}.
27731
27732@item
27733New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27734
27735Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27736first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27737@file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27738to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27739the second parameter.
27740
27741@file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
47301027 27742automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
4009494e
GM
27743@file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27744generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27745process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27746back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27747install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27748complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27749cycle used under Unix systems.
27750
27751The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27752superfluous, so they have been removed.
27753
27754@item
27755@file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27756
27757As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27758directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27759hierarchy.
27760
27761@c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
bff3818b 27762@c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
4009494e
GM
27763@item
27764@code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27765
27766If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27767@code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27768lisp directory into load-path.
27769
27770File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27771some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27772
27773@end itemize
27774
27775@item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27776@c *****************************************
27777
27778@itemize @bullet
27779
27780@item
27781The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27782@xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27783
27784@item
27785@acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27786
27787@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
321decc8 27788@acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
4009494e
GM
27789
27790@item
27791Improved anti-spam features.
27792
27793Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27794using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27795methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27796for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
01c52d31 27797are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
4009494e
GM
27798@c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27799
27800@item
27801Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27802
27803Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27804complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27805buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27806generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27807manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27808
27809@end itemize
27810
27811@item Changes in group mode
27812@c ************************
27813
27814@itemize @bullet
27815
27816@item
27817@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27818using @kbd{G M}.
27819
27820@item
27821Retrieval of charters and control messages
27822
27823There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27824control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27825
27826@item
27827The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27828
27829Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27830the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27831enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27832variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27833variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27834parameters, a'la:
27835@lisp
27836(setq gnus-parameters
27837 '(("mail\\..*"
27838 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27839 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27840 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27841 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27842@end lisp
27843
27844@item
27845Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27846
27847The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27848be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27849@code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27850@code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27851@code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
27852mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27853want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27854you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27855when getting new mail, remove the function.
27856
27857@item
27858Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27859
27860This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27861@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27862@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27863
27864@item
27865@code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27866@code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27867
27868The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27869instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27870variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27871@lisp
27872("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27873@end lisp
27874
37a68866
MB
27875@item
27876Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27877after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
9b3ebcb6 27878Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
37a68866 27879
4009494e
GM
27880@end itemize
27881
27882@item Changes in summary and article mode
27883@c **************************************
27884
27885@itemize @bullet
27886
27887@item
27888@kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27889(@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27890region if the region is active.
27891
27892@item
27893In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27894Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27895
27896@item
27897Article Buttons
27898
27899More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27900pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27901variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27902appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27903
27904@item
27905Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27906
27907@item
27908Picons
27909
27910The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27911the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27912
27913Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27914newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27915@xref{Picons}.
27916
27917@item
27918If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27919boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27920
27921@item
27922Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27923
27924@item
27925The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27926article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27927
27928@item
27929Warn about email replies to news
27930
27931Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
27932the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
27933you.
27934
27935@item
27936If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
27937non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
27938built.
27939
4009494e
GM
27940@item
27941Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
27942related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
27943
27944@item
27945The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
27946in English. @xref{Article Date}.
27947
27948@item
27949diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
27950@code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
27951
27952@item
27953Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
27954
27955Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
27956mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
27957though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
27958@code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
27959citations.
27960
27961The new command @kbd{W Y f}
27962(@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
27963Outlook (Express) articles.
27964
27965@item
27966@code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
27967
27968If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
27969not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
27970which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
27971what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
27972
27973This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
27974consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
27975message cited below.
27976
27977@item
65e7ca35 27978Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc.)@: are now displayed graphically in
4009494e
GM
27979Emacs too.
27980
27981Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
27982disable it.
27983
27984@item
27985Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
27986
27987@item
27988In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
27989and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
27990
27991@item
27992Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
27993
27994@item
27995@code{gnus-summary-line-format}
27996
27997The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
27998%s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
27999@code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
28000changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
28001recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
28002groups.
28003
28004@item
28005Deleting of attachments.
28006
28007The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
28008on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
28009external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
28010@acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
28011that support editing.
28012
28013@item
28014@code{gnus-default-charset}
28015
28016The default value is determined from the
28017@code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
28018@code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
28019@code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
28020
28021@item
28022Printing capabilities are enhanced.
28023
28024Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
28025Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
28026printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
28027
28028@item
28029Extended format specs.
28030
28031Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
28032@code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
28033format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
28034@samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
28035@code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
28036escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
28037
28038@item
28039@kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
28040@c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
28041
28042It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
28043(@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
28044out other articles.
28045
28046@item
28047Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
28048
28049If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
28050s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
28051(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
28052result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
28053
28054@item
28055Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
28056
28057@end itemize
28058
28059@item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28060@c ****************************************************
28061
28062@itemize @bullet
28063
28064@item
28065Delayed articles
28066
28067You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
28068buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
28069for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
28070
28071@item
28072If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28073the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28074
28075@item
28076The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28077Gcc articles as read.
28078
28079@item
28080Externalizing of attachments
28081
28082If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28083@code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28084local files as external parts.
28085
28086@item
28087The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28088@xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28089
28090@item
28091Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28092
28093Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28094different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28095algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28096only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28097cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28098see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28099default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28100@code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28101@code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28102
28103@item
28104Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28105
28106Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28107subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28108M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28109@kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28110appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28111followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28112
28113@item
28114References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28115start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28116@code{nil}.
28117
28118@item
28119Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28120
28121@item
28122Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28123
28124To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28125are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28126variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28127contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28128you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28129into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28130@code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28131incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28132was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28133was inserted directly.
28134
28135@item
28136@code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28137
bc79f9ab 28138@c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
4009494e
GM
28139Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28140mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28141compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28142enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28143
28144@item
28145@code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28146
28147The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28148@lisp
28149(define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28150 'bbdb-complete-name)
28151@end lisp
28152
28153@item
28154@code{gnus-posting-styles}
28155
28156Add a new format of match like
28157@lisp
28158((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28159 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28160@end lisp
28161The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28162@lisp
28163(header "to" "larsi.*org"
28164 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28165@end lisp
28166
28167@item
28168@code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28169
28170@samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28171added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28172need add those two headers too.
28173
28174@item
28175Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28176composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28177Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28178versions.
28179
28180@item
28181The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28182``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28183inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28184emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28185@c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28186
28187@item
28188Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28189
28190This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28191
28192@item
28193Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28194
28195In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28196the valid values.
28197
28198@item
28199Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28200
28201This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28202used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28203superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28204you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28205system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28206security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28207will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28208The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28209
28210@item
28211Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
f99f1641 282122015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630--2633).
4009494e
GM
28213
28214It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28215additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28216Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28217messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28218
28219@item
28220@acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28221C-m}.
28222
28223This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28224@code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28225
28226@item
28227The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28228@code{best}.
28229
28230The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28231convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28232used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28233invalidate the digital signature.
28234
28235@item
28236If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28237decompressed when activated.
28238@c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28239
28240@item
28241Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28242
28243Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28244Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28245send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28246Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28247and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28248controls this.
28249
28250@item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28251See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28252@xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
2b968687 28253@c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
d55fe5bb
MB
28254
28255@item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28256See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28257Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28258@c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
4009494e
GM
28259
28260@end itemize
28261
28262@item Changes in back ends
28263@c ***********************
28264
28265@itemize @bullet
28266@item
28267Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28268
28269@item
28270The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28271
28272@item
28273Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28274
28275Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28276
28277@item
28278The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28279
28280This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28281separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28282makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
1df7defd 28283sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within, e.g., a department. It
4009494e
GM
28284works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28285file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28286nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28287another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28288@file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28289The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28290@code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28291
28292@end itemize
28293
28294@item Appearance
28295@c *************
28296
28297@itemize @bullet
28298
28299@item
28300The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28301been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28302
28303@item
28304The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28305renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28306related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28307message, Message Manual}).
28308
28309@item
28310The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
d55fe5bb
MB
28311Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28312customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28313feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
4009494e
GM
28314
28315@item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28316in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28317Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28318in Gnus 5.10.9.
28319@end itemize
28320
28321
28322@item Miscellaneous changes
28323@c ************************
28324
28325@itemize @bullet
28326
28327@item
28328@code{gnus-agent}
28329
28330The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28331and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28332@code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28333only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28334default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28335enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28336of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28337unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28338@kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28339the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28340@kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28341behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28342nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28343is not needed any more.
28344
28345@item
28346Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28347
28348If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28349in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28350gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28351
28352@item
28353Dired integration
28354
28355@code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28356bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28357using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28358entry.
28359
28360@item
28361The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28362
28363@item
28364@code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28365
28366A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28367
28368@end itemize
28369
28370@end itemize
28371
01c52d31
MB
28372@node No Gnus
28373@subsubsection No Gnus
28374@cindex No Gnus
28375
28376New features in No Gnus:
28377@c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28378
28379@include gnus-news.texi
28380
89b163db
G
28381@node Ma Gnus
28382@subsubsection Ma Gnus
28383@cindex Ma Gnus
28384
28385I'm sure there will be lots of text here. It's really spelled 真
28386Gnus.
28387
28388New features in Ma Gnus:
28389
28390@itemize @bullet
28391
28392@item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28393@c ****************************************************
28394
28395@itemize @bullet
28396
28397@item
28398The new hooks @code{gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook} and
28399@code{gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook} are run before/after encoding
28400the message body of the Gcc copy of a sent message. See
28401@xref{Archived Messages}.
28402
28403@end itemize
28404
28405@end itemize
28406
4009494e
GM
28407@iftex
28408
28409@page
28410@node The Manual
28411@section The Manual
28412@cindex colophon
28413@cindex manual
28414
28415This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28416either @code{texi2dvi}
28417@iflatex
28418or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28419and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28420@end iflatex
28421to get what you hold in your hands now.
28422
28423The following conventions have been used:
28424
28425@enumerate
28426
28427@item
28428This is a @samp{string}
28429
28430@item
28431This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28432
28433@item
28434This is a @file{file}
28435
28436@item
28437This is a @code{symbol}
28438
28439@end enumerate
28440
28441So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28442mean:
28443
28444@lisp
28445(setq flargnoze "yes")
28446@end lisp
28447
28448If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28449
28450@lisp
28451(setq flumphel 'yes)
28452@end lisp
28453
28454@samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28455ever get them confused.
28456
28457@iflatex
28458@c @head
28459Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28460read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28461manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28462there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28463the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28464important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28465of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28466@end iflatex
28467
28468@end iftex
28469
28470
28471@node On Writing Manuals
28472@section On Writing Manuals
28473
28474I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28475that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28476implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28477straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28478functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
4b70e299
MB
28479implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28480in hand.
4009494e
GM
28481
28482This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28483documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28484looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28485started with Gnus.
28486
28487That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
4b70e299 28488reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
4009494e
GM
28489
28490
28491@page
28492@node Terminology
28493@section Terminology
28494
28495@cindex terminology
28496@table @dfn
28497
28498@item news
28499@cindex news
28500This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28501News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28502generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28503world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28504snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28505
28506@item mail
28507@cindex mail
28508Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28509readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28510there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28511not posting, and replying is not following up.
28512
28513@item reply
28514@cindex reply
28515Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28516
28517@item follow up
28518@cindex follow up
28519Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28520are reading.
28521
28522@item back end
28523@cindex back end
28524Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28525difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28526commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28527messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28528architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28529``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28530@key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28531Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28532``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28533number 4711''.
28534
28535So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28536end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28537accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28538layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28539``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28540file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28541
28542Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28543done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28544access the articles.
28545
28546However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28547would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28548method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28549confusing.
28550
28551@item native
28552@cindex native
28553Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
0afb49a1
LMI
28554default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28555have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
4009494e
GM
28556
28557@item foreign
28558@cindex foreign
0afb49a1
LMI
28559You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28560time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28561for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28562@samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
4009494e
GM
28563
28564@item secondary
28565@cindex secondary
0afb49a1
LMI
28566Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28567being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28568have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
4009494e
GM
28569
28570@item article
28571@cindex article
28572A message that has been posted as news.
28573
28574@item mail message
28575@cindex mail message
28576A message that has been mailed.
28577
28578@item message
28579@cindex message
28580A mail message or news article
28581
28582@item head
28583@cindex head
65e7ca35 28584The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.)@: is
4009494e
GM
28585put.
28586
28587@item body
28588@cindex body
28589The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28590body.
28591
28592@item header
28593@cindex header
28594A line from the head of an article.
28595
28596@item headers
28597@cindex headers
28598A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28599collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28600
28601@item @acronym{NOV}
28602@cindex @acronym{NOV}
4b70e299
MB
28603@acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28604header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28605of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28606back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28607Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28608
4009494e
GM
28609When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28610unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28611format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28612normal @sc{head} format.
28613
4b70e299
MB
28614The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28615Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28616where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28617information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28618an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28619references, etc.
28620
28621Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28622the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28623for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28624parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28625Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28626(@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28627know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28628
4009494e
GM
28629@item level
28630@cindex levels
f99f1641 28631Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1--9). The ones
4009494e 28632that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
f99f1641
PE
28633higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1--5 are considered
28634@dfn{subscribed}; 6--7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
4009494e
GM
28635are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28636articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28637
28638@item killed groups
28639@cindex killed groups
28640No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28641groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28642
28643@item zombie groups
28644@cindex zombie groups
28645Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28646
28647@item active file
28648@cindex active file
28649The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28650groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28651is rather large, as you might surmise.
28652
28653@item bogus groups
28654@cindex bogus groups
28655A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28656server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28657This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28658
28659@item activating
28660@cindex activating groups
28661The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28662number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28663Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28664
28665@item spool
28666@cindex spool
28667News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28668One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28669article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28670
28671@item server
28672@cindex server
28673A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28674
28675@item select method
28676@cindex select method
28677A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28678server settings.
28679
28680@item virtual server
28681@cindex virtual server
28682A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28683know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28684whole is a virtual server.
28685
28686@item washing
28687@cindex washing
28688Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28689result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28690original.
28691
28692@item ephemeral groups
28693@cindex ephemeral groups
28694@cindex temporary groups
28695Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28696groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28697group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28698
28699@item solid groups
28700@cindex solid groups
28701This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28702group buffer are solid groups.
28703
28704@item sparse articles
28705@cindex sparse articles
28706These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28707@code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28708
28709@item threading
28710@cindex threading
28711To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28712to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28713
28714@item root
28715@cindex root
28716@cindex thread root
28717The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28718articles in the thread.
28719
28720@item parent
28721@cindex parent
28722An article that has responses.
28723
28724@item child
28725@cindex child
28726An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28727
28728@item digest
28729@cindex digest
28730A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28731specified by RFC 1153.
28732
28733@item splitting
28734@cindex splitting, terminology
28735@cindex mail sorting
28736@cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28737The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28738incorrectly called mail filtering.
28739
28740@end table
28741
28742
28743@page
28744@node Customization
28745@section Customization
28746@cindex general customization
28747
28748All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28749section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28750for some quite common situations.
28751
28752@menu
28753* Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28754* Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28755* Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28756* Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28757@end menu
28758
28759
28760@node Slow/Expensive Connection
4b70e299 28761@subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
4009494e
GM
28762
28763If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28764over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
4b70e299 28765Gnus has to get from the server.
4009494e
GM
28766
28767@table @code
28768
28769@item gnus-read-active-file
28770Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28771entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28772also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28773@code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28774doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28775
28776@item gnus-nov-is-evil
4b70e299
MB
28777@vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28778Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28779default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28780(@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28781Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28782instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28783@code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28784@acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28785headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28786Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28787
28788As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28789@code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28790@code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
3c08d668
KY
28791@code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28792non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
261ff377 28793variables.
4009494e
GM
28794@end table
28795
28796
28797@node Slow Terminal Connection
28798@subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28799
28800Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28801Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28802possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28803
28804@table @code
28805
28806@item gnus-auto-center-summary
28807Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28808buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28809re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28810horizontal and vertical recentering.
28811
28812@item gnus-visible-headers
28813Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28814minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28815useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28816@samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28817
28818Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28819@lisp
28820(setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28821 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28822 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28823@end lisp
28824
28825@item gnus-use-full-window
28826By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28827While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28828have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28829want to read them anyway.
28830
28831@item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28832If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28833hidden initially.
28834
28835
28836@item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28837If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28838lines, which might save some time.
28839@end table
28840
28841
28842@node Little Disk Space
28843@subsection Little Disk Space
28844@cindex disk space
28845
28846The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28847sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28848
28849@table @code
28850
28851@item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28852If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28853only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28854use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28855default.
28856
28857@item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28858If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28859only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28860use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28861default.
28862
28863@item gnus-save-killed-list
28864If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28865should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28866and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28867variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28868
28869@end table
28870
28871
28872@node Slow Machine
28873@subsection Slow Machine
28874@cindex slow machine
28875
28876If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28877few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28878
28879Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28880@code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28881
28882Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28883@code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
4b70e299 28884summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
4009494e
GM
28885
28886
28887@page
28888@node Troubleshooting
28889@section Troubleshooting
28890@cindex troubleshooting
28891
28892Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28893problems, really.
28894
28895Ahem.
28896
28897@enumerate
28898
28899@item
28900Make sure your computer is switched on.
28901
28902@item
28903Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28904been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28905Gnus will work.
28906
28907@item
28908Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
5c3a9e4c 28909like @c
437ce4be 28910@samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
5c3a9e4c
MB
28911@c
28912you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28913files lying around. Delete these.
4009494e
GM
28914
28915@item
28916Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
28917@acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
28918
28919@item
28920@vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
28921Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
28922rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
28923you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
28924something like that.
28925@end enumerate
28926
28927If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
28928
28929@cindex bugs
28930@cindex reporting bugs
28931
28932@kindex M-x gnus-bug
28933@findex gnus-bug
28934If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
28935command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
28936me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
28937me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
28938
28939You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
28940@kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
28941a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
28942environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
28943time.
28944
28945It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
28946you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
28947back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
28948insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
28949for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
28950mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
28951
28952If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
28953it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
28954it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
28955the bug report.
28956
28957@cindex patches
28958If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
28959improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
28960
28961@cindex edebug
28962If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
28963in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
28964edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
28965(@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
28966Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
28967you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
28968step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
28969the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
28970then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
28971return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
28972placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
28973evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
28974@kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
28975@kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
28976
28977@cindex elp
28978@cindex profile
28979@cindex slow
28980Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
28981manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
28982can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
28983slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
28984helps isolating the real problem areas).
28985
1df7defd 28986A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP@. The profiler is
4009494e
GM
28987(or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
28988there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
1df7defd 28989part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g., @kbd{M-x
4009494e
GM
28990elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
28991RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
28992@kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
28993time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
28994longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
28995output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
28996profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
28997elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
28998complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
28999work perfectly.
29000
29001@cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
29002@cindex ding mailing list
29003If you just need help, you are better off asking on
29004@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
29005@email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
29006@email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
29007
29008
29009@page
29010@node Gnus Reference Guide
29011@section Gnus Reference Guide
29012
29013It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
29014can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
29015facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
29016workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
29017it.
29018
29019You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
29020will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
29021back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
29022(ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
29023and general methods of operation.
29024
29025@menu
29026* Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
29027* Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
29028* Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
29029* Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
29030* Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
29031* Group Info:: The group info format.
29032* Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
29033* Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
29034* Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
29035@end menu
29036
29037
29038@node Gnus Utility Functions
29039@subsection Gnus Utility Functions
29040@cindex Gnus utility functions
29041@cindex utility functions
29042@cindex functions
29043@cindex internal variables
29044
29045When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
29046vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
29047Below is a list of the most common ones.
29048
29049@table @code
29050
29051@item gnus-newsgroup-name
29052@vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
29053This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
29054
29055@item gnus-find-method-for-group
29056@findex gnus-find-method-for-group
29057A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
29058
29059@item gnus-group-real-name
29060@findex gnus-group-real-name
29061Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
29062name.
29063
29064@item gnus-group-prefixed-name
29065@findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
29066Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
29067(prefixed) Gnus group name.
29068
29069@item gnus-get-info
29070@findex gnus-get-info
465d0300 29071Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
4009494e
GM
29072
29073@item gnus-group-unread
29074@findex gnus-group-unread
29075The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29076unknown.
29077
29078@item gnus-active
29079@findex gnus-active
465d0300
G
29080The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29081article numbers) for @var{group}.
4009494e
GM
29082
29083@item gnus-set-active
29084@findex gnus-set-active
29085Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29086
29087@item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29088@findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29089Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29090exit.
29091
29092@item gnus-continuum-version
29093@findex gnus-continuum-version
29094Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29095number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29096versions.
29097
29098@item gnus-group-read-only-p
29099@findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29100Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29101
29102@item gnus-news-group-p
29103@findex gnus-news-group-p
29104Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29105
29106@item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29107@findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29108Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29109
29110@item gnus-server-to-method
29111@findex gnus-server-to-method
29112Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29113
29114@item gnus-server-equal
29115@findex gnus-server-equal
465d0300
G
29116Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29117two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29118this function will consider them equal.
4009494e
GM
29119
29120@item gnus-group-native-p
29121@findex gnus-group-native-p
29122Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29123
29124@item gnus-group-secondary-p
29125@findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29126Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29127
29128@item gnus-group-foreign-p
29129@findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29130Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29131
29132@item gnus-group-find-parameter
29133@findex gnus-group-find-parameter
465d0300
G
29134Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29135If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29136@var{group}.
4009494e
GM
29137
29138@item gnus-group-set-parameter
29139@findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29140Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29141
29142@item gnus-narrow-to-body
29143@findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29144Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29145
29146@item gnus-check-backend-function
29147@findex gnus-check-backend-function
29148Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29149@var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29150
29151@lisp
29152(gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29153@result{} t
29154@end lisp
29155
29156@item gnus-read-method
29157@findex gnus-read-method
29158Prompts the user for a select method.
29159
29160@end table
29161
29162
29163@node Back End Interface
29164@subsection Back End Interface
29165
29166Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29167groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29168server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29169of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29170examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29171@code{nnmbox-directory}.
29172
29173When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29174something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29175function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29176virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29177server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29178been opened, the function should fail.
29179
29180Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29181name. Take this example:
29182
29183@lisp
29184(nntp "odd-one"
29185 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29186 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29187@end lisp
29188
29189Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29190the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29191
29192The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29193The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29194server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29195
29196There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29197which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29198always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29199
29200All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29201@code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29202unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29203@dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29204talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29205the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29206return value.
29207
29208Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29209some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
f99f1641
PE
29210only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server'';
29211they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
4009494e
GM
29212more.
29213
29214Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29215few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29216the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29217possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29218confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29219numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29220mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29221@code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29222Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29223group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29224
29225The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29226article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29227assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29228if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29229the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29230also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29231of numbers as long as possible.
29232
29233Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29234Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29235@file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29236
29237In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29238@code{nnchoke}.
29239
29240@cindex @code{nnchoke}
29241
29242@menu
29243* Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29244* Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29245* Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29246* Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29247* Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29248* Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29249@end menu
29250
29251
29252@node Required Back End Functions
29253@subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29254
29255@table @code
29256
29257@item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29258
29259@var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29260@code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29261sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29262retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29263
29264The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29265value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29266This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29267of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29268
29269If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29270headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29271fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29272article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29273presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29274cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29275number, do maximum fetches.
29276
29277Here's an example HEAD:
29278
29279@example
29280221 1056 Article retrieved.
29281Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29282From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29283Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29284Subject: Re: Something very droll
29285Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29286Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29287Lines: 26
29288Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29289References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29290NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29291.
29292@end example
29293
29294So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29295these in the data buffer.
29296
29297Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29298
29299@example
29300headers = *head
29301head = error / valid-head
29302error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29303valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29304valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29305header = <text> eol
29306@end example
29307
29308@cindex BNF
29309(The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29310
29311If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29312@dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29313separated by tabs.
29314
29315@example
29316nov-buffer = *nov-line
29317nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29318field = <text except TAB>
29319@end example
29320
29321For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29322@pxref{Headers}.
29323
29324
29325@item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29326
29327@var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29328list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29329
29330If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29331may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29332server. In fact, it should do so.
29333
29334If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29335non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29336
29337
29338@item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29339
29340Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29341to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29342reason.
29343
29344There should be no data returned.
29345
29346
29347@item (nnchoke-request-close)
29348
29349Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29350have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29351should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29352function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29353
29354There should be no data returned.
29355
29356
29357@item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29358
29359If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29360physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29361non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29362attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29363
29364There should be no data returned.
29365
29366
29367@item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29368
29369This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29370
29371There should be no data returned.
29372
29373
29374@item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29375
29376The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29377@var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29378It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29379it would be nice if that were possible.
29380
29381If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29382in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29383possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29384another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29385into its article buffer.
29386
29387If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29388the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29389the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29390group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29391@code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29392on successful article retrieval.
29393
29394
bdaa75c7 29395@item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
4009494e
GM
29396
29397Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29398making @var{group} the current group.
29399
29400If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29401the current group.
29402
bdaa75c7
LMI
29403If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29404structure.
29405
4009494e
GM
29406Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29407
29408@example
29409211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29410@end example
29411
29412The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29413total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29414highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29415number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29416considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29417may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29418whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29419problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29420articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29421highest as 0.
29422
29423@example
29424group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29425error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29426info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29427@end example
29428
29429
29430@item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29431
29432Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29433a no-op on most back ends.
29434
29435There should be no data returned.
29436
29437
29438@item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29439
29440Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29441@emph{all}.
29442
29443Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29444
29445@example
29446ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29447ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29448@end example
29449
29450On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29451that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29452contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29453and the highest as 0.
29454
29455@example
29456active-file = *active-line
29457active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29458name = <string>
29459flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29460@end example
29461
29462The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29463(@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29464(@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29465
29466
29467@item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29468
29469This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29470the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29471instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29472completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29473function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29474clear if the posting could not be completed.
29475
29476There should be no result data from this function.
29477
29478@end table
29479
29480
29481@node Optional Back End Functions
29482@subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29483
29484@table @code
29485
29486@item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29487
29488@var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29489on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29490should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29491
29492The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29493@code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29494former is in the same format as the data from
29495@code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29496in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29497
29498@example
29499group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29500@end example
29501
29502
29503@item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29504
29505A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29506alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29507the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29508function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
01c52d31
MB
29509should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29510@code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29511the network resources).
4009494e
GM
29512
29513There should be no result data from this function.
29514
29515
29516@item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29517
29518When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29519summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29520user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29521@code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29522is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29523@var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29524might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29525and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29526
29527There should be no result data from this function.
29528
29529
29530@item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29531
29532Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
65e7ca35 29533marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc.)@: internally, and store them in
4009494e
GM
29534@file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29535all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29536propagate the mark information to the server.
29537
29538@var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29539
29540@example
29541(RANGE ACTION MARK)
29542@end example
29543
29544@var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29545@var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29546marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29547marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29548@code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
e21bac42
G
29549@code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29550@code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29551itself to these.
4009494e
GM
29552
29553Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29554effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29555@code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29556remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29557
29558An example action list:
29559
29560@example
29561(((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29562 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29563 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29564@end example
29565
29566The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29567mark on (currently not used for anything).
29568
29569There should be no result data from this function.
29570
29571@item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29572
29573If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29574function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29575returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29576@var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29577@var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29578
29579The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29580it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29581in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29582expirable.
29583
29584There should be no result data from this function.
29585
29586
29587@item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29588
29589This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29590request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29591another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29592the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29593@var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29594it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29595total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29596local if that's practical.
29597
29598There should be no result data from this function.
29599
29600
29601@item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29602
29603The result data from this function should be a description of
29604@var{group}.
29605
29606@example
29607description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29608name = <string>
29609description = <text>
29610@end example
29611
29612@item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29613
29614The result data from this function should be the description of all
29615groups available on the server.
29616
29617@example
29618description-buffer = *description-line
29619@end example
29620
29621
29622@item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29623
29624The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29625created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29626(i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29627the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29628in the active buffer format.
29629
29630It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29631might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29632just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29633Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29634many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29635back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29636server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29637
29638
29639@item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29640
29641This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29642
29643There should be no return data.
29644
29645
29646@item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29647
29648This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29649@var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29650numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29651should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29652non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29653they are.
29654
29655This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29656able to delete.
29657
29658There should be no result data returned.
29659
29660
29661@item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29662
29663This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29664@var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29665
29666This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29667removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29668should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29669@var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29670will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29671non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29672
29673If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29674that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29675optimizations.
29676
29677The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29678the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29679
29680There should be no data returned.
29681
29682
29683@item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29684
29685This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29686If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29687this function in short order.
29688
29689The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29690the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29691
29692The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29693article for that group.
29694
29695There should be no data returned.
29696
29697
29698@item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29699
29700This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29701@var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29702
29703There should be no data returned.
29704
29705
29706@item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29707
29708This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29709really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29710itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29711
29712There should be no data returned.
29713
29714
29715@item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29716
29717This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29718articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29719
29720There should be no data returned.
29721
29722@end table
29723
29724
29725@node Error Messaging
29726@subsubsection Error Messaging
29727
29728@findex nnheader-report
29729@findex nnheader-get-report
29730The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29731error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29732perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29733symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29734there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29735This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29736
29737@lisp
29738(nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29739
29740(nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29741@end lisp
29742
29743Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29744@code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29745recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29746takes one argument---the server symbol.
29747
29748Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29749so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29750@code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29751
29752
29753@node Writing New Back Ends
29754@subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29755
29756Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29757@code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29758@code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29759and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29760@code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29761editing articles.
29762
29763It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29764back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29765want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29766
29767All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29768package called @code{nnoo}.
29769
29770To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29771inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29772following macros:
29773
29774@table @code
29775
29776@item nnoo-declare
29777This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29778parameters. For instance:
29779
29780@lisp
29781(nnoo-declare nndir
29782 nnml nnmh)
29783@end lisp
29784
29785@code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29786both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29787
29788@item defvoo
29789This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29790a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29791declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29792
29793In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29794variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29795a function in those back ends.
29796
29797@lisp
29798(defvoo nndir-directory nil
29799 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29800 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29801@end lisp
29802
29803This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29804@code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29805of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29806
29807@item nnoo-define-basics
29808This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29809have.
29810
29811@lisp
29812(nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29813@end lisp
29814
29815@item deffoo
29816This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29817addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29818function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29819
29820@item nnoo-map-functions
29821This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29822functions from the parent back ends.
29823
29824@lisp
29825(nnoo-map-functions nndir
29826 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29827 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29828@end lisp
29829
29830This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29831third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29832@code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29833value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29834
29835@item nnoo-import
29836This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29837last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29838haven't already been defined.
29839
29840@lisp
29841(nnoo-import nndir
29842 (nnmh
29843 nnmh-request-list
29844 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29845 (nnml))
29846@end lisp
29847
29848This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29849on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29850@code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29851defined now.
29852
29853@end table
29854
29855Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29856
29857@lisp
29858;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
5dc584b5 29859;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
4009494e
GM
29860
29861;;; @r{Code:}
29862
29863(require 'nnheader)
29864(require 'nnmh)
29865(require 'nnml)
29866(require 'nnoo)
29867(eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29868
29869(nnoo-declare nndir
29870 nnml nnmh)
29871
29872(defvoo nndir-directory nil
29873 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29874 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29875
29876(defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29877 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29878 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29879
29880(defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29881 nil
29882 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29883(defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29884(defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29885
29886(defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29887(defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29888
29889;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29890
29891(nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29892
29893(deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29894 (setq nndir-directory
29895 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29896 server))
29897 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29898 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29899 (push `(nndir-current-group
29900 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29901 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29902 defs)
29903 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29904 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29905 defs)
29906 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29907
29908(nnoo-map-functions nndir
29909 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29910 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29911 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29912 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29913
29914(nnoo-import nndir
29915 (nnmh
29916 nnmh-status-message
29917 nnmh-request-list
29918 nnmh-request-newgroups))
29919
29920(provide 'nndir)
29921@end lisp
29922
29923
29924@node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29925@subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29926
29927@vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
29928@findex gnus-declare-backend
29929Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
29930declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
29931enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
29932
29933@code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
29934an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
29935
29936Here's an example:
29937
29938@lisp
29939(gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
29940@end lisp
29941
29942The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
29943
29944The abilities can be:
29945
29946@table @code
29947@item mail
29948This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
29949@item post
29950This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
29951@item post-mail
29952This back end supports both mail and news.
29953@item none
29954This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
29955different.
29956@item respool
29957It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
29958articles and groups.
29959@item address
29960The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
29961true for almost all back ends.
29962@item prompt-address
29963The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
29964@kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
29965@code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
29966@end table
29967
29968
29969@node Mail-like Back Ends
29970@subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
29971
29972One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
29973back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
29974common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
29975definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
29976
29977@lisp
29978(deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
29979 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
29980 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
29981@end lisp
29982
29983It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
29984and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
29985mail.
29986
29987This function takes four parameters.
29988
29989@table @var
29990@item method
29991This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
29992the call.
29993
29994@item exit-function
29995This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
29996
29997@item temp-directory
29998Where the temporary files should be stored.
29999
30000@item group
30001This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
30002performed for one group only.
30003@end table
30004
30005@code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
30006save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
30007find the article number assigned to this article.
30008
30009The function also uses the following variables:
30010@var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
30011this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
30012@var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
30013@var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
30014this:
30015
30016@example
30017(("a-group" (1 . 10))
30018 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
30019@end example
30020
30021
30022@node Score File Syntax
30023@subsection Score File Syntax
30024
fac916bf 30025Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
53964682 30026malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
4009494e
GM
30027as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
30028
30029Here's a typical score file:
30030
30031@lisp
30032(("summary"
b46a6a83 30033 ("Windows 95" -10000 nil s)
4009494e
GM
30034 ("Gnus"))
30035 ("from"
30036 ("Lars" -1000))
30037 (mark -100))
30038@end lisp
30039
30040BNF definition of a score file:
30041
30042@example
30043score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
30044element = rule / atom
30045rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
30046string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
30047number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
30048date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
30049quote = <ascii 34>
30050string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
30051 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
30052number-header = "lines" / "chars"
30053date-header = "date"
30054string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30055 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30056score = "nil" / <integer>
30057date = "nil" / <natural number>
30058string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
30059 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
30060 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
30061 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
30062number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30063 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30064number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
30065date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30066 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
30067date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
30068atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
30069required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
30070 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30071optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30072mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30073nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30074expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30075mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30076files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30077exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30078read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30079adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30080adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30081local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30082eval = "eval" space <form>
30083space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30084@end example
30085
30086Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30087discarded.
30088
30089As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30090space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30091left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30092one looong line, then that's ok.
30093
30094The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30095manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30096
30097
30098@node Headers
30099@subsection Headers
30100
30101Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30102corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30103almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30104just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30105
30106@dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30107RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30108@code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30109``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30110opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30111which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30112basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30113
30114These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30115@code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30116@code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30117setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30118@code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30119
30120All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30121contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30122
30123
30124@node Ranges
30125@subsection Ranges
30126
30127@sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30128using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30129
30130The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30131identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30132that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30133very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30134
30135The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30136sequence.
30137
30138@example
30139(1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30140@end example
30141
30142is transformed into
30143
30144@example
30145((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30146@end example
30147
30148To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30149lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30150
30151@example
30152((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30153@end example
30154
30155This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30156is slightly tricky:
30157
30158@example
30159((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30160@end example
30161
30162and
30163
30164@example
30165((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30166@end example
30167
30168are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30169
30170@example
30171(1 2 3 4 5)
30172@end example
30173
30174is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30175also valid:
30176
30177@example
30178(1 . 5)
30179@end example
30180
30181and is equal to the previous range.
30182
30183Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30184semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30185of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30186range handling.)
30187
30188@example
30189range = simple-range / normal-range
30190simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30191normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30192contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30193 number *[ " " contents ]
30194@end example
30195
30196Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30197marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30198Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30199need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30200totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30201sequences.)
30202
30203
30204@node Group Info
30205@subsection Group Info
30206
30207Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30208This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30209describes the group.
30210
30211Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30212second is a more complex one:
30213
30214@example
30215("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30216
30217("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30218 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30219 (nnml "")
30220 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30221@end example
30222
30223The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30224anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30225normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30226cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30227score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30228fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30229The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30230The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30231this section is about.
30232
30233Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30234In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30235three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30236
30237Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30238
30239@example
30240info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30241 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30242 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30243group = quote <string> quote
30244ralevel = rank / level
30245level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30246rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30247score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30248read = range
30249marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30250marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30251method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30252parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30253@end example
30254
30255Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30256@samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30257in pseudo-BNF.
30258
30259If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30260series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30261
30262@table @code
30263@item gnus-info-group
30264@itemx gnus-info-set-group
30265@findex gnus-info-group
30266@findex gnus-info-set-group
30267Get/set the group name.
30268
30269@item gnus-info-rank
30270@itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30271@findex gnus-info-rank
30272@findex gnus-info-set-rank
30273Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30274
30275@item gnus-info-level
30276@itemx gnus-info-set-level
30277@findex gnus-info-level
30278@findex gnus-info-set-level
30279Get/set the group level.
30280
30281@item gnus-info-score
30282@itemx gnus-info-set-score
30283@findex gnus-info-score
30284@findex gnus-info-set-score
30285Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30286
30287@item gnus-info-read
30288@itemx gnus-info-set-read
30289@findex gnus-info-read
30290@findex gnus-info-set-read
30291Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30292
30293@item gnus-info-marks
30294@itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30295@findex gnus-info-marks
30296@findex gnus-info-set-marks
30297Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30298
30299@item gnus-info-method
30300@itemx gnus-info-set-method
30301@findex gnus-info-method
30302@findex gnus-info-set-method
30303Get/set the group select method.
30304
30305@item gnus-info-params
30306@itemx gnus-info-set-params
30307@findex gnus-info-params
30308@findex gnus-info-set-params
30309Get/set the group parameters.
30310@end table
30311
30312All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30313functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30314
30315The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30316necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30317is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30318the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30319
30320
30321@node Extended Interactive
30322@subsection Extended Interactive
30323@cindex interactive
30324@findex gnus-interactive
30325
30326Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30327slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30328Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30329
30330@lisp
30331(defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30332 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30333 ...
30334 )
30335@end lisp
30336
30337The best thing to do would have been to implement
30338@code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30339@code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30340whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30341on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30342function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30343@code{interactive}.
30344
30345This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30346adds a few more.
30347
30348@table @samp
30349@item y
30350@vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30351The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30352variable.
30353
30354@item Y
30355@vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30356A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30357@code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30358
30359@item A
30360The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30361function.
30362
30363@item H
30364The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30365function.
30366
30367@item g
30368The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30369function.
30370
30371@end table
30372
30373
30374@node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30375@subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30376@cindex XEmacs
30377@cindex Emacsen
30378
30379While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30380platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30381like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30382
30383This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30384while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30385As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30386Gnus, that's very useful.
30387
30388I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30389Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30390@code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30391function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30392takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30393Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30394However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30395following function:
30396
30397@lisp
30398(defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30399 (start-itimer
30400 "gnus-run-at-time"
30401 `(lambda ()
30402 (,function ,@@args))
30403 time repeat))
30404@end lisp
30405
30406This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30407not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30408does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30409all over.
30410
30411In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30412I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30413for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30414
30415Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30416mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30417hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30418
30419
30420@node Various File Formats
30421@subsection Various File Formats
30422
30423@menu
30424* Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30425* Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30426@end menu
30427
30428
30429@node Active File Format
30430@subsubsection Active File Format
30431
30432The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30433question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30434in each group.
30435
30436Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30437
30438@example
30439soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30440alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30441comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30442comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30443no.general 1000 900 y
30444@end example
30445
30446Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30447
30448@example
30449active = *group-line
30450group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30451group = <non-white-space string>
30452spc = " "
30453high-number = <non-negative integer>
30454low-number = <positive integer>
30455flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30456@end example
30457
30458For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30459@samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30460
30461
30462@node Newsgroups File Format
30463@subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30464
30465The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30466groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30467have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30468the user.
30469
30470The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30471Here's the definition:
30472
30473@example
30474newsgroups = *line
30475line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30476group = <non-white-space string>
30477tab = <TAB>
30478description = <string>
30479@end example
30480
30481
30482@page
30483@node Emacs for Heathens
30484@section Emacs for Heathens
30485
30486Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30487Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30488If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30489region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30490is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30491phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30492you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30493cat instead.
30494
30495@menu
30496* Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30497* Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30498@end menu
30499
30500
30501@node Keystrokes
30502@subsection Keystrokes
30503
30504@itemize @bullet
30505@item
30506Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30507
30508@item
30509A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30510@end itemize
30511
30512Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30513key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30514(notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30515of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30516``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30517may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30518
30519The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30520normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30521the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30522that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30523keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30524which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30525to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30526
30527Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30528because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30529key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30530prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30531down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30532``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30533the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30534
30535This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30536meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30537means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30538work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30539suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30540it.
30541
30542
30543
30544@node Emacs Lisp
30545@subsection Emacs Lisp
30546
30547Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30548Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30549Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30550any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30551
30552Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30553functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30554interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30555certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30556(Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30557beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30558some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30559file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30560in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30561@file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30562
30563If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30564write the following:
30565
30566@lisp
30567(setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30568@end lisp
30569
30570This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30571set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30572you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30573change how Gnus works.
30574
30575If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30576read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30577start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30578@kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30579previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30580
30581Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30582@kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30583is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30584
30585Some pitfalls:
30586
30587If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30588that means:
30589
30590@lisp
30591(setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30592@end lisp
30593
99e65b2d
G
30594On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30595@samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
4009494e
GM
30596
30597@lisp
99e65b2d 30598(setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
4009494e
GM
30599@end lisp
30600
30601So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30602former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30603
30604@page
30605@include gnus-faq.texi
30606
30607@node GNU Free Documentation License
30608@chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30609@include doclicense.texi
30610
30611@node Index
30612@chapter Index
30613@printindex cp
30614
30615@node Key Index
30616@chapter Key Index
30617@printindex ky
30618
4009494e
GM
30619@bye
30620
30621@iftex
30622@iflatex
30623\end{document}
30624@end iflatex
30625@end iftex
30626
30627@c Local Variables:
30628@c mode: texinfo
89b163db 30629@c coding: utf-8
4009494e 30630@c End: